Document linespec/explicit locations & completion improvements (manual + NEWS)
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 @node Sample Session
550 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556 @iftex
557 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559 @end iftex
560
561 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576 $ @b{./m4}
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583 @b{bar}
584 0000
585 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588 @b{baz}
589 @b{Ctrl-d}
590 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596 @smallexample
597 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
600 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607 (@value{GDBP})
608 @end smallexample
609
610 @noindent
611 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614 that examples fit in this manual.
615
616 @smallexample
617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618 @end smallexample
619
620 @noindent
621 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624 @code{break} command.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639 @b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641 @b{foo}
642 0000
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648 context where it stops.
649
650 @smallexample
651 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660 the next line of the current function.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687 stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
709 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
711 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724 (@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740 533 xfree(rquote);
741 534
742 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746 537
747 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 540 @}
750 541
751 542 void
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762 540 @}
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764 $3 = 9
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766 $4 = 7
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775 assignments.
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779 $5 = 7
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781 $6 = 9
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788 example that caused trouble initially:
789
790 @smallexample
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792 Continuing.
793
794 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796 baz
797 0000
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @b{Ctrl-d}
807 Program exited normally.
808 @end smallexample
809
810 @noindent
811 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815 @smallexample
816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817 @end smallexample
818
819 @node Invocation
820 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823 The essentials are:
824 @itemize @bullet
825 @item
826 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827 @item
828 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829 @end itemize
830
831 @menu
832 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836 @end menu
837
838 @node Invoking GDB
839 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847 The command-line options described here are designed
848 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849 options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852 specifying an executable program:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860 specified:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864 @end smallexample
865
866 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867 to debug a running process:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885 option processing.
886 @smallexample
887 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888 @end smallexample
889 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896 @smallexample
897 @value{GDBP} --silent
898 @end smallexample
899
900 @noindent
901 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904 @noindent
905 Type
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} -help
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917 @samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920 @menu
921 * File Options:: Choosing files
922 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924 @end menu
925
926 @node File Options
927 @subsection Choosing Files
928
929 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945 argument and ignore it.
946
947 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955 @c it.
956
957 @table @code
958 @item -symbols @var{file}
959 @itemx -s @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--symbols}
961 @cindex @code{-s}
962 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964 @item -exec @var{file}
965 @itemx -e @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--exec}
967 @cindex @code{-e}
968 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971 @item -se @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--se}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974 file.
975
976 @item -core @var{file}
977 @itemx -c @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--core}
979 @cindex @code{-c}
980 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982 @item -pid @var{number}
983 @itemx -p @var{number}
984 @cindex @code{--pid}
985 @cindex @code{-p}
986 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988 @item -command @var{file}
989 @itemx -x @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--command}
991 @cindex @code{-x}
992 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996 @item -eval-command @var{command}
997 @itemx -ex @var{command}
998 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
999 @cindex @code{-ex}
1000 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005 @smallexample
1006 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008 @end smallexample
1009
1010 @item -init-command @var{file}
1011 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-ix}
1014 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1020 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021 @cindex @code{-iex}
1022 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023 after loading gdbinit files).
1024 @xref{Startup}.
1025
1026 @item -directory @var{directory}
1027 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--directory}
1029 @cindex @code{-d}
1030 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032 @item -r
1033 @itemx -readnow
1034 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1035 @cindex @code{-r}
1036 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040 @end table
1041
1042 @node Mode Options
1043 @subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046 batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048 @table @code
1049 @anchor{-nx}
1050 @item -nx
1051 @itemx -n
1052 @cindex @code{--nx}
1053 @cindex @code{-n}
1054 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057 @table @code
1058 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059 This is the system-wide init file.
1060 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063 have been processed.
1064 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065 This is the init file in your home directory.
1066 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067 command options have been processed.
1068 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069 This is the init file in the current directory.
1070 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1072 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073 @end table
1074
1075 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076 For documentation on how to write command files,
1077 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079 @anchor{-nh}
1080 @item -nh
1081 @cindex @code{--nh}
1082 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083 in your home directory.
1084 @xref{Startup}.
1085
1086 @item -quiet
1087 @itemx -silent
1088 @itemx -q
1089 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1090 @cindex @code{--silent}
1091 @cindex @code{-q}
1092 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1093 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095 @item -batch
1096 @cindex @code{--batch}
1097 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1100 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107 make this more useful, the message
1108
1109 @smallexample
1110 Program exited normally.
1111 @end smallexample
1112
1113 @noindent
1114 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116 mode.
1117
1118 @item -batch-silent
1119 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1121 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123 for an interactive session.
1124
1125 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126 messages, for example.
1127
1128 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131 @item -return-child-result
1132 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137 @item
1138 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141 @item
1142 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143 @item
1144 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145 the exit code will be -1.
1146 @end itemize
1147
1148 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150 interface.
1151
1152 @item -nowindows
1153 @itemx -nw
1154 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155 @cindex @code{-nw}
1156 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160 @item -windows
1161 @itemx -w
1162 @cindex @code{--windows}
1163 @cindex @code{-w}
1164 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165 used if possible.
1166
1167 @item -cd @var{directory}
1168 @cindex @code{--cd}
1169 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170 instead of the current directory.
1171
1172 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1174 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175 @cindex @code{-D}
1176 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180 @item -fullname
1181 @itemx -f
1182 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1183 @cindex @code{-f}
1184 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1188 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192 frame.
1193
1194 @item -annotate @var{level}
1195 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1196 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1197 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1201 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208 @item --args
1209 @cindex @code{--args}
1210 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212 This option stops option processing.
1213
1214 @item -baud @var{bps}
1215 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1216 @cindex @code{--baud}
1217 @cindex @code{-b}
1218 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -l @var{timeout}
1222 @cindex @code{-l}
1223 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224 for remote debugging.
1225
1226 @item -tty @var{device}
1227 @itemx -t @var{device}
1228 @cindex @code{--tty}
1229 @cindex @code{-t}
1230 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1232
1233 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234 @item -tui
1235 @cindex @code{--tui}
1236 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1237 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1240 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1253 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1255 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257 @item -write
1258 @cindex @code{--write}
1259 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1260 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261 (@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263 @item -statistics
1264 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268 @item -version
1269 @cindex @code{--version}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273 @item -configuration
1274 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1275 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1277 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279 @end table
1280
1281 @node Startup
1282 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287 @enumerate
1288 @item
1289 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292 @item
1293 @cindex init file
1294 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297 that file.
1298
1299 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300 @item
1301 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304 that file.
1305
1306 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307 @item
1308 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1310 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312 gets loaded.
1313
1314 @item
1315 Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318 @item
1319 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322 This is only done if the current directory is
1323 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1324 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326 @value{GDBN}.
1327
1328 @item
1329 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335 you must do something like the following:
1336
1337 @smallexample
1338 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339 @end smallexample
1340
1341 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342 off too late.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1347 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349 @item
1350 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353 @end enumerate
1354
1355 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1357 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365 @cindex init file name
1366 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1371 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376 @node Quitting GDB
1377 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @itemx q
1386 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1388 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390 error code.
1391 @end table
1392
1393 @cindex interrupt
1394 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1397 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398 until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404 @node Shell Commands
1405 @section Shell Commands
1406
1407 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409 just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411 @table @code
1412 @kindex shell
1413 @kindex !
1414 @cindex shell escape
1415 @item shell @var{command-string}
1416 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1417 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422 @end table
1423
1424 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426 @value{GDBN}:
1427
1428 @table @code
1429 @kindex make
1430 @cindex calling make
1431 @item make @var{make-args}
1432 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434 @end table
1435
1436 @node Logging Output
1437 @section Logging Output
1438 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444 @table @code
1445 @kindex set logging
1446 @item set logging on
1447 Enable logging.
1448 @item set logging off
1449 Disable logging.
1450 @cindex logging file name
1451 @item set logging file @var{file}
1452 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1455 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459 @kindex show logging
1460 @item show logging
1461 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462 @end table
1463
1464 @node Commands
1465 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473 @menu
1474 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475 * Completion:: Command completion
1476 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477 @end menu
1478
1479 @node Command Syntax
1480 @section Command Syntax
1481
1482 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1483 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1485 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1487 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489 @cindex abbreviation
1490 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1493 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498 @cindex repeating commands
1499 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1514 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518 @cindex comment
1519 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521 Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523 @cindex repeating command sequences
1524 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528 for editing.
1529
1530 @node Completion
1531 @section Command Completion
1532
1533 @cindex completion
1534 @cindex word completion
1535 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1538 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543 enter it). For example, if you type
1544
1545 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549 @smallexample
1550 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557 @smallexample
1558 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559 @end smallexample
1560
1561 @noindent
1562 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1565 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1571 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1573 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577 example:
1578
1579 @smallexample
1580 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1583 make_abs_section make_function_type
1584 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1585 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1586 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1587 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593 command.
1594
1595 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1597 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1598 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607 main
1608 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 @noindent
1614 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616 @table @code
1617 @kindex set max-completions
1618 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1621 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626 completion slow.
1627 @kindex show max-completions
1628 @item show max-completions
1629 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630 during completion.
1631 @end table
1632
1633 @cindex quotes in commands
1634 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1635 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1638 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639 @value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1642 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1643 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1644 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1645 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1646 Operators}).
1647
1648 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1649 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1650 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1651 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1652 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1653 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1654 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1655 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1656 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1660 func<int>() func<float>()
1661 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1662 @end smallexample
1663
1664 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1665 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1666 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1667 function:
1668
1669 @smallexample
1670 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1671 func<int>() func<float>()
1672 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1673 @end smallexample
1674
1675 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1676 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1677 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1678 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1679 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1680 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1681
1682 @smallexample
1683 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1684 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1685 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1686 bubble(double)
1687 @end smallexample
1688
1689 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1690 require quoting.
1691
1692 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1693 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1694 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1695 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1696
1697 @cindex completion of structure field names
1698 @cindex structure field name completion
1699 @cindex completion of union field names
1700 @cindex union field name completion
1701 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1702 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1703 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1704 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1705 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1706 left-hand-side:
1707
1708 @smallexample
1709 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1710 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1711 to_data to_isatty to_write
1712 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1713 to_flush to_read
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716 @noindent
1717 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1718 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1719 follows:
1720
1721 @smallexample
1722 struct ui_file
1723 @{
1724 int *magic;
1725 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1726 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1727 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1728 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1729 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1730 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1731 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1732 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1733 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1734 void *to_data;
1735 @}
1736 @end smallexample
1737
1738
1739 @node Help
1740 @section Getting Help
1741 @cindex online documentation
1742 @kindex help
1743
1744 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1745 using the command @code{help}.
1746
1747 @table @code
1748 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1749 @item help
1750 @itemx h
1751 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1752 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1753
1754 @smallexample
1755 (@value{GDBP}) help
1756 List of classes of commands:
1757
1758 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1759 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1760 data -- Examining data
1761 files -- Specifying and examining files
1762 internals -- Maintenance commands
1763 obscure -- Obscure features
1764 running -- Running the program
1765 stack -- Examining the stack
1766 status -- Status inquiries
1767 support -- Support facilities
1768 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1769 stopping the program
1770 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1771
1772 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1773 commands in that class.
1774 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1775 documentation.
1776 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1777 (@value{GDBP})
1778 @end smallexample
1779 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1780
1781 @item help @var{class}
1782 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1783 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1784 help display for the class @code{status}:
1785
1786 @smallexample
1787 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1788 Status inquiries.
1789
1790 List of commands:
1791
1792 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1793 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1794 info -- Generic command for showing things
1795 about the program being debugged
1796 show -- Generic command for showing things
1797 about the debugger
1798
1799 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1800 documentation.
1801 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1802 (@value{GDBP})
1803 @end smallexample
1804
1805 @item help @var{command}
1806 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1807 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1808
1809 @kindex apropos
1810 @item apropos @var{args}
1811 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1812 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1813 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1814
1815 @smallexample
1816 apropos alias
1817 @end smallexample
1818
1819 @noindent
1820 results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @c @group
1824 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1825 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1826 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1827 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1828 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1829 @c @end group
1830 @end smallexample
1831
1832 @kindex complete
1833 @item complete @var{args}
1834 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1835 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1836 command you want completed. For example:
1837
1838 @smallexample
1839 complete i
1840 @end smallexample
1841
1842 @noindent results in:
1843
1844 @smallexample
1845 @group
1846 if
1847 ignore
1848 info
1849 inspect
1850 @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1854 @end table
1855
1856 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1857 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1858 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1859 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1860 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1861 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1862 Index}.
1863
1864 @c @group
1865 @table @code
1866 @kindex info
1867 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1868 @item info
1869 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1870 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1871 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1872 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1873 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1874 @w{@code{help info}}.
1875
1876 @kindex set
1877 @item set
1878 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1879 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1880 @code{set prompt $}.
1881
1882 @kindex show
1883 @item show
1884 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1885 @value{GDBN} itself.
1886 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1887 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1888 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1889 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1890
1891 @kindex info set
1892 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1893 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1894 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1895 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1896 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1897 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1898 @end table
1899 @c @end group
1900
1901 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1902 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1903
1904 @table @code
1905 @kindex show version
1906 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1907 @item show version
1908 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1909 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1910 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1911 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1912 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1913 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1914 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1915 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1916 @value{GDBN}.
1917
1918 @kindex show copying
1919 @kindex info copying
1920 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1921 @item show copying
1922 @itemx info copying
1923 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1924
1925 @kindex show warranty
1926 @kindex info warranty
1927 @item show warranty
1928 @itemx info warranty
1929 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1930 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1931
1932 @kindex show configuration
1933 @item show configuration
1934 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1935 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1936 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1937 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1938 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1939 your report.
1940
1941 @end table
1942
1943 @node Running
1944 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1945
1946 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1947 debugging information when you compile it.
1948
1949 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1950 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1951 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1952 kill a child process.
1953
1954 @menu
1955 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1956 * Starting:: Starting your program
1957 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1958 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1959
1960 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1961 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1962 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1963 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1964
1965 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1966 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1967 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1968 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1969 @end menu
1970
1971 @node Compilation
1972 @section Compiling for Debugging
1973
1974 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1975 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1976 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1977 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1978 and addresses in the executable code.
1979
1980 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1981 the compiler.
1982
1983 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1984 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1985 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1986 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1987 executables containing debugging information.
1988
1989 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1990 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1991 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1992 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1993 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1994
1995 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1996 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1997 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1998
1999 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2000 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2001 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2002 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2003 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2004 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2005
2006 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2007 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2008 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2009
2010 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2011 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2012 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2013 format in @value{GDBN}.
2014
2015 @need 2000
2016 @node Starting
2017 @section Starting your Program
2018 @cindex starting
2019 @cindex running
2020
2021 @table @code
2022 @kindex run
2023 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2024 @item run
2025 @itemx r
2026 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2027 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2028 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2029 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2030 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2031
2032 @end table
2033
2034 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2035 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2036 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2037 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2038 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2039 message like this one:
2040
2041 @smallexample
2042 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2043 Try "help target" or "continue".
2044 @end smallexample
2045
2046 @noindent
2047 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2048 first (@pxref{load}).
2049
2050 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2051 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2052 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2053 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2054 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2055 divided into four categories:
2056
2057 @table @asis
2058 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2059 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2060 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2061 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2062 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2063 the arguments.
2064 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2065 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2066 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2067 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2068 below for details).
2069
2070 @item The @emph{environment.}
2071 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2072 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2073 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2074 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2075
2076 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2077 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2078 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2079 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2080 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2081 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2082 Directory}.
2083
2084 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2085 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2086 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2087 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2088 set a different device for your program.
2089 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2090
2091 @cindex pipes
2092 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2093 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2094 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2095 wrong program.
2096 @end table
2097
2098 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2099 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2100 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2101 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2102 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2103
2104 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2105 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2106 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2107 your current breakpoints.
2108
2109 @table @code
2110 @kindex start
2111 @item start
2112 @cindex run to main procedure
2113 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2114 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2115 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2116 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2117 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2118 procedure, depending on the language used.
2119
2120 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2121 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2122 the @samp{run} command.
2123
2124 @cindex elaboration phase
2125 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2126 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2127 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2128 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2129 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2130 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2131 will remain to halt execution.
2132
2133 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2134 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2135 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2136 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2137 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2138
2139 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2140 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2141 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2142 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2143 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2144 use the @code{starti} command.
2145
2146 @kindex starti
2147 @item starti
2148 @cindex run to first instruction
2149 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2150 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2151 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2152 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2153 the start of the elaboration phase.
2154
2155 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2156 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2157 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2158 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2159 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2160 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2161 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2162 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2163 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2164 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2165 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2166 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2167
2168 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2169 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2170 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2171 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2172
2173 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2174 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2175 environment:
2176
2177 @smallexample
2178 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2179 (@value{GDBP}) run
2180 @end smallexample
2181
2182 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2183 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2184
2185 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2186 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2187 @item set startup-with-shell
2188 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2189 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2190 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2191 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2192 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2193 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2194 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2195 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2196 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2197 startup failures such as:
2198
2199 @smallexample
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 Starting program: ./a.out
2202 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2203 @end smallexample
2204
2205 @noindent
2206 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2207 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2208 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2209 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2210 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2211 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2212
2213 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2214 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2215 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2216 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2217 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2218 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2219
2220 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2221 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2222 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2223 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2224 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2225 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2226
2227 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2228 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2229 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2230
2231 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2232 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2233
2234 @smallexample
2235 (@value{GDBP}) run
2236 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2237 @end smallexample
2238
2239 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2240 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2241
2242 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2243 @code{target native} command. For example,
2244
2245 @smallexample
2246 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2247 (@value{GDBP}) run
2248 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2249 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2250 (@value{GDBP}) run
2251 Starting program: ./a.out
2252 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2253 @end smallexample
2254
2255 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2256 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2257 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2258 disconnect.
2259
2260 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2261 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2262 proc}, @code{info os}.
2263
2264 @kindex set disable-randomization
2265 @item set disable-randomization
2266 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2267 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2268 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2269 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2270 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2271
2272 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2273 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2274
2275 @smallexample
2276 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2277 @end smallexample
2278
2279 @item set disable-randomization off
2280 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2281 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2282 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2283 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2284 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2285 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2286
2287 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2288 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2289 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2290 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2291 a code at its expected addresses.
2292
2293 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2294 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2295 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2296 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2297 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2298 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2299 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2300 a randomly chosen address.
2301
2302 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2303 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2304 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2305 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2306 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2307
2308 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2309 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2310
2311 @item show disable-randomization
2312 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2313 the virtual address space of the started program.
2314
2315 @end table
2316
2317 @node Arguments
2318 @section Your Program's Arguments
2319
2320 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2321 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2322 @code{run} command.
2323 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2324 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2325 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2326 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2327 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2328
2329 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2330 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2331 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2332 the program, not by the shell.
2333
2334 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2335 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2336
2337 @table @code
2338 @kindex set args
2339 @item set args
2340 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2341 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2342 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2343 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2344 it again without arguments.
2345
2346 @kindex show args
2347 @item show args
2348 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2349 @end table
2350
2351 @node Environment
2352 @section Your Program's Environment
2353
2354 @cindex environment (of your program)
2355 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2356 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2357 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2358 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2359 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2360 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2361 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2362
2363 @table @code
2364 @kindex path
2365 @item path @var{directory}
2366 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2367 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2368 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2369 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2370 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2371 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2372 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2373
2374 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2375 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2376 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2377 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2378 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2379 @var{directory} to the search path.
2380 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2381 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2382
2383 @kindex show paths
2384 @item show paths
2385 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2386 environment variable).
2387
2388 @kindex show environment
2389 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2390 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2391 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2392 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2393 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2394
2395 @kindex set environment
2396 @anchor{set environment}
2397 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2398 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2399 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2400 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2401 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2402 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2403 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2404 null value.
2405 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2406 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2407
2408 For example, this command:
2409
2410 @smallexample
2411 set env USER = foo
2412 @end smallexample
2413
2414 @noindent
2415 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2416 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2417 are not actually required.)
2418
2419 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2420 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2421 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2422 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2423 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2424
2425 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2426 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2427 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2428
2429 @kindex unset environment
2430 @anchor{unset environment}
2431 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2432 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2433 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2434 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2435 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2436
2437 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2438 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2439 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2440 @end table
2441
2442 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2443 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2444 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2445 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2446 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2447 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2448 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2449 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2450 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2451 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2452
2453 @node Working Directory
2454 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2455
2456 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2457 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2458 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2459 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2460 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2461 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2462 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2463 debugging.
2464
2465 @table @code
2466 @kindex set cwd
2467 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2468 @anchor{set cwd command}
2469 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2470 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2471 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2472 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2473 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2474 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2475 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2476 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2477 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2478 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2479 fallback.
2480
2481 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2482 the @code{cd} command.
2483 @xref{cd command}
2484
2485 @kindex show cwd
2486 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2487 @item show cwd
2488 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2489 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2490 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2491
2492 @kindex cd
2493 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2494 @anchor{cd command}
2495 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2496 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2497 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2498
2499 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2500 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2501 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2502 @xref{set cwd command}
2503
2504 @kindex pwd
2505 @item pwd
2506 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2507 @end table
2508
2509 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2510 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2511 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2512 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2513 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2514 current working directory of the debuggee.
2515
2516 @node Input/Output
2517 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2518
2519 @cindex redirection
2520 @cindex i/o
2521 @cindex terminal
2522 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2523 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2524 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2525 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2526 running your program.
2527
2528 @table @code
2529 @kindex info terminal
2530 @item info terminal
2531 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2532 program is using.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2536 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2537
2538 @smallexample
2539 run > outfile
2540 @end smallexample
2541
2542 @noindent
2543 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2544
2545 @kindex tty
2546 @cindex controlling terminal
2547 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2548 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2549 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2550 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2551 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 tty /dev/ttyb
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2559 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2560 that as their controlling terminal.
2561
2562 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2563 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2564 terminal.
2565
2566 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2567 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2568 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2569 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2570
2571 @cindex inferior tty
2572 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2573 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2574 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2575 program.
2576
2577 @table @code
2578 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2579 @kindex set inferior-tty
2580 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2581 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2582 @value{GDBN}.
2583
2584 @item show inferior-tty
2585 @kindex show inferior-tty
2586 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2587 @end table
2588
2589 @node Attach
2590 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2591 @kindex attach
2592 @cindex attach
2593
2594 @table @code
2595 @item attach @var{process-id}
2596 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2597 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2598 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2599 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2600 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2601
2602 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2603 executing the command.
2604 @end table
2605
2606 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2607 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2608 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2609 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2610
2611 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2612 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2613 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2614 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2615 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2616 Specify Files}.
2617
2618 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2619 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2620 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2621 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2622 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2623 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2624 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2625
2626 @table @code
2627 @kindex detach
2628 @item detach
2629 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2630 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2631 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2632 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2633 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2634 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2635 executing the command.
2636 @end table
2637
2638 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2639 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2640 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2641 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2642 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2643 Messages}).
2644
2645 @node Kill Process
2646 @section Killing the Child Process
2647
2648 @table @code
2649 @kindex kill
2650 @item kill
2651 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2652 @end table
2653
2654 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2655 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2656 is running.
2657
2658 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2659 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2660 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2661 outside the debugger.
2662
2663 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2664 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2665 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2666 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2667 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2668 breakpoint settings).
2669
2670 @node Inferiors and Programs
2671 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2672
2673 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2674 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2675 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2676 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2677 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2678 from multiple executables.
2679
2680 @cindex inferior
2681 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2682 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2683 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2684 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2685 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2686 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2687 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2688 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2689 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2690 threads running in it.
2691
2692 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2693 inferiors}}:
2694
2695 @table @code
2696 @kindex info inferiors
2697 @item info inferiors
2698 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2699
2700 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2701
2702 @enumerate
2703 @item
2704 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2705
2706 @item
2707 the target system's inferior identifier
2708
2709 @item
2710 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2711
2712 @end enumerate
2713
2714 @noindent
2715 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2716 indicates the current inferior.
2717
2718 For example,
2719 @end table
2720 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2721
2722 @smallexample
2723 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2724 Num Description Executable
2725 2 process 2307 hello
2726 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2727 @end smallexample
2728
2729 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2730
2731 @table @code
2732 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2733 @item inferior @var{infno}
2734 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2735 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2736 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2737 @end table
2738
2739 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2740 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2741 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2742 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2743 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2744 information on convenience variables.
2745
2746 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2747 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2748 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2749 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2750 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2751 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2752
2753 @table @code
2754 @kindex add-inferior
2755 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2756 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2757 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2758 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2759 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2760 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2761
2762 @kindex clone-inferior
2763 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2764 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2765 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2766 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2767 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2768
2769 @smallexample
2770 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2771 Num Description Executable
2772 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2773 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2774 Added inferior 2.
2775 1 inferiors added.
2776 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2777 Num Description Executable
2778 2 <null> helloworld
2779 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2780 @end smallexample
2781
2782 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2783
2784 @kindex remove-inferiors
2785 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2786 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2787 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2788 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2789
2790 @end table
2791
2792 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2793 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2794 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2795 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2796
2797 @table @code
2798 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2799 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2800 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2801 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2802 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2803 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2804
2805 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2806 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2807 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2808 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2809 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2810 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2811 @end table
2812
2813 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2814 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2815 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2816 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2817
2818
2819 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2820 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2821
2822 @table @code
2823 @kindex set print inferior-events
2824 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2825 @item set print inferior-events
2826 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2827 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2828 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2829 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2830 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2831 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2832
2833 @kindex show print inferior-events
2834 @item show print inferior-events
2835 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2836 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2837 @end table
2838
2839 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2840 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2841 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2842
2843
2844 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2845 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2846 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2847 info program-spaces}} command.
2848
2849 @table @code
2850 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2851 @item maint info program-spaces
2852 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2853 @value{GDBN}.
2854
2855 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2856
2857 @enumerate
2858 @item
2859 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2860
2861 @item
2862 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2863 the @code{file} command.
2864
2865 @end enumerate
2866
2867 @noindent
2868 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2869 indicates the current program space.
2870
2871 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2872 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2873 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2874
2875 @smallexample
2876 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2877 Id Executable
2878 * 1 hello
2879 2 goodbye
2880 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2881 @end smallexample
2882
2883 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2884 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2885 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2886 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2887 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2888
2889 @smallexample
2890 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2891 Id Executable
2892 * 1 vfork-test
2893 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2894 @end smallexample
2895
2896 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2897 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2898 @end table
2899
2900 @node Threads
2901 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2902
2903 @cindex threads of execution
2904 @cindex multiple threads
2905 @cindex switching threads
2906 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2907 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2908 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2909 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2910 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2911 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2912 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2913
2914 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2915 programs:
2916
2917 @itemize @bullet
2918 @item automatic notification of new threads
2919 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2920 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2921 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2922 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2923 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2924 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2925 messages on thread start and exit.
2926 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2927 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2928 isn't compatible with the program.
2929 @end itemize
2930
2931 @cindex focus of debugging
2932 @cindex current thread
2933 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2934 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2935 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2936 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2937 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2938
2939 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2940 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2941 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2942 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2943 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2944 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2945 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2946 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2947 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2948 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2949
2950 @smallexample
2951 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2952 @end smallexample
2953
2954 @noindent
2955 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2956 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2957 further qualifier.
2958
2959 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2960 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2961 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2962 @c program?
2963 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2964 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2965 @c threads ab initio?
2966
2967 @anchor{thread numbers}
2968 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2969 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2970 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2971 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2972 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2973 between threads of different inferiors.
2974
2975 @cindex qualified thread ID
2976 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2977 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2978 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2979 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2980 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2981 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2982 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2983 inferior.
2984
2985 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2986 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2987 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2988 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2989
2990 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2991 @cindex thread ID lists
2992 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2993 argument. A list element can be:
2994
2995 @enumerate
2996 @item
2997 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2998 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2999 @samp{1}.
3000
3001 @item
3002 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3003 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3004 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3005
3006 @item
3007 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3008 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3009 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3010 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3011 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3012
3013 @end enumerate
3014
3015 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3016 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3017 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3018 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3019 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3020 7.1}.
3021
3022
3023 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3024 @cindex global thread number
3025 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3026 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3027 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3028 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3029 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3030 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3031
3032 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3033 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3034 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3035
3036 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3037 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3038 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3039 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3040 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3041 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3042 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3043 general information on convenience variables.
3044
3045 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3046 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3047 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3048
3049 @smallexample
3050 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3051 @end smallexample
3052
3053 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3054
3055 @smallexample
3056 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3057 @end smallexample
3058
3059 @table @code
3060 @kindex info threads
3061 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3062
3063 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3064 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3065 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3066 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3067
3068 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3069
3070 @enumerate
3071 @item
3072 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3073
3074 @item
3075 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3076 option was specified
3077
3078 @item
3079 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3080
3081 @item
3082 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3083 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3084 program itself.
3085
3086 @item
3087 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3088 @end enumerate
3089
3090 @noindent
3091 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3092 indicates the current thread.
3093
3094 For example,
3095 @end table
3096 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3097
3098 @smallexample
3099 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3100 Id Target Id Frame
3101 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3102 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3103 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3104 at threadtest.c:68
3105 @end smallexample
3106
3107 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3108 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3109 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3110
3111 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3112 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3113
3114 @smallexample
3115 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3116 Id GId Target Id Frame
3117 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3118 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3119 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3120 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3121 @end smallexample
3122
3123 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3124 Solaris-specific command:
3125
3126 @table @code
3127 @item maint info sol-threads
3128 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3129 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3130 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3131 @end table
3132
3133 @table @code
3134 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3135 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3136 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3137 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3138 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3139 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3140
3141 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3142 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3143
3144 @smallexample
3145 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3146 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3147 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3148 8 printf ("hello\n");
3149 @end smallexample
3150
3151 @noindent
3152 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3153 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3154 threads.
3155
3156 @kindex thread apply
3157 @cindex apply command to several threads
3158 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3159 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3160 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3161 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3162 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3163 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3164 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3165 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3166
3167
3168 @kindex thread name
3169 @cindex name a thread
3170 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3171 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3172 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3173 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3174
3175 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3176 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3177 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3178 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3179 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3180
3181 @kindex thread find
3182 @cindex search for a thread
3183 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3184 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3185 matches the supplied regular expression.
3186
3187 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3188 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3189 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3190 is the LWP id.
3191
3192 @smallexample
3193 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3194 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3195 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3196 Id Target Id Frame
3197 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3198 @end smallexample
3199
3200 @kindex set print thread-events
3201 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3202 @item set print thread-events
3203 @itemx set print thread-events on
3204 @itemx set print thread-events off
3205 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3206 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3207 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3208 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3209 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3210
3211 @kindex show print thread-events
3212 @item show print thread-events
3213 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3214 have started and exited.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3218 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3219 programs with multiple threads.
3220
3221 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3222 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3223
3224 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3225 @table @code
3226 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3227 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3228 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3229 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3230 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3231 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3232 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3233 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3234 macro.
3235
3236 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3237 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3238 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3239 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3240 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3241 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3242
3243 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3244 refers to the default system directories that are
3245 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3246 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3247 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3248
3249 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3250 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3251 was loaded in the inferior process.
3252
3253 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3254 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3255 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3256 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3257 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3258 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3259 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3260
3261 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3262 only on some platforms.
3263
3264 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3265 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3266 Display current libthread_db search path.
3267
3268 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3269 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3270 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3271 @item set debug libthread-db
3272 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3273 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3274 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3275 @end table
3276
3277 @node Forks
3278 @section Debugging Forks
3279
3280 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3281 @cindex multiple processes
3282 @cindex processes, multiple
3283 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3284 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3285 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3286 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3287 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3288 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3289 will cause it to terminate.
3290
3291 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3292 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3293 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3294 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3295 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3296 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3297 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3298 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3299 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3300 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3301
3302 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3303 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3304 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3305 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3306
3307 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3308 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3309 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3310
3311 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3312 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3313
3314 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3315 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3316
3317 @table @code
3318 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3319 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3320 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3321 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3322 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3323
3324 @table @code
3325 @item parent
3326 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3327 unimpeded. This is the default.
3328
3329 @item child
3330 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3331 unimpeded.
3332
3333 @end table
3334
3335 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3336 @item show follow-fork-mode
3337 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3338 @end table
3339
3340 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3341 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3342 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3343
3344 @table @code
3345 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3346 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3347 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3348 retain debugger control over them both.
3349
3350 @table @code
3351 @item on
3352 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3353 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3354 independently. This is the default.
3355
3356 @item off
3357 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3358 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3359 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3360 is held suspended.
3361
3362 @end table
3363
3364 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3365 @item show detach-on-fork
3366 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3367 @end table
3368
3369 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3370 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3371 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3372 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3373 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3374 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3375
3376 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3377 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3378 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3379 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3380 and Programs}.
3381
3382 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3383 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3384 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3385 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3386 the child process's @code{main}.
3387
3388 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3389 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3390
3391 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3392 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3393 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3394 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3395 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3396 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3397 command.
3398
3399 @table @code
3400 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3401 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3402
3403 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3404 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3405
3406 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3407
3408 @table @code
3409 @item new
3410 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3411 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3412 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3413 original inferior.
3414
3415 For example:
3416
3417 @smallexample
3418 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3419 (gdb) info inferior
3420 Id Description Executable
3421 * 1 <null> prog1
3422 (@value{GDBP}) run
3423 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3424 Program exited normally.
3425 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3426 Id Description Executable
3427 1 <null> prog1
3428 * 2 <null> prog2
3429 @end smallexample
3430
3431 @item same
3432 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3433 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3434 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3435 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3436 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3437
3438 For example:
3439
3440 @smallexample
3441 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3442 Id Description Executable
3443 * 1 <null> prog1
3444 (@value{GDBP}) run
3445 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3446 Program exited normally.
3447 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3448 Id Description Executable
3449 * 1 <null> prog2
3450 @end smallexample
3451
3452 @end table
3453 @end table
3454
3455 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3456 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3457
3458 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3459 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3460 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3461
3462 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3463 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3464
3465 @cindex checkpoint
3466 @cindex restart
3467 @cindex bookmark
3468 @cindex snapshot of a process
3469 @cindex rewind program state
3470
3471 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3472 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3473 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3474 later.
3475
3476 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3477 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3478 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3479 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3480 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3481
3482 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3483 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3484 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3485 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3486 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3487 start again from there.
3488
3489 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3490 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3491
3492 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3493
3494 @table @code
3495 @kindex checkpoint
3496 @item checkpoint
3497 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3498 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3499 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3500
3501 @kindex info checkpoints
3502 @item info checkpoints
3503 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3504 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3505 listed:
3506
3507 @table @code
3508 @item Checkpoint ID
3509 @item Process ID
3510 @item Code Address
3511 @item Source line, or label
3512 @end table
3513
3514 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3515 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3516 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3517 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3518 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3519 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3520 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3521
3522 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3523 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3524 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3525 the debugger.
3526
3527 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3528 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3529 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3530
3531 @end table
3532
3533 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3534 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3535 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3536 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3537 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3538 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3539 previously read data can be read again.
3540
3541 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3542 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3543 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3544 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3545 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3546 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3547
3548 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3549 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3550 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3551 different execution path this time.
3552
3553 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3554 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3555 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3556 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3557 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3558 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3559 potentially pose a problem.
3560
3561 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3562
3563 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3564 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3565 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3566 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3567 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3568 next.
3569
3570 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3571 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3572 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3573 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3574 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3575
3576 @node Stopping
3577 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3578
3579 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3580 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3581 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3582
3583 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3584 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3585 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3586 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3587 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3588 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3589 explicitly request this information at any time.
3590
3591 @table @code
3592 @kindex info program
3593 @item info program
3594 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3595 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3596 @end table
3597
3598 @menu
3599 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3600 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3601 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3602 Skipping over functions and files
3603 * Signals:: Signals
3604 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3605 @end menu
3606
3607 @node Breakpoints
3608 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3609
3610 @cindex breakpoints
3611 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3612 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3613 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3614 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3615 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3616 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3617 program.
3618
3619 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3620 the executable is run.
3621
3622 @cindex watchpoints
3623 @cindex data breakpoints
3624 @cindex memory tracing
3625 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3626 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3627 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3628 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3629 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3630 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3631 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3632 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3633 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3634 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3635 same commands.
3636
3637 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3638 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3639 Automatic Display}.
3640
3641 @cindex catchpoints
3642 @cindex breakpoint on events
3643 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3644 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3645 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3646 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3647 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3648 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3649 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3650
3651 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3652 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3653 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3654 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3655 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3656 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3657 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3658 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3659 enable it again.
3660
3661 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3662 @cindex breakpoint lists
3663 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3664 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3665 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3666 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3667 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3668 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3669 are operated on.
3670
3671 @menu
3672 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3673 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3674 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3675 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3676 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3677 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3678 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3679 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3680 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3681 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3682 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3683 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3684 @end menu
3685
3686 @node Set Breaks
3687 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3688
3689 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3690 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3691 @c
3692 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3693
3694 @kindex break
3695 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3696 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3697 @cindex latest breakpoint
3698 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3699 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3700 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3701 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3702 convenience variables.
3703
3704 @table @code
3705 @item break @var{location}
3706 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3707 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3708 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3709 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3710 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3711
3712 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3713 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3714 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3715 that situation.
3716
3717 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3718 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3719 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3720
3721 @item break
3722 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3723 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3724 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3725 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3726 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3727 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3728 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3729 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3730 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3731 inside loops.
3732
3733 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3734 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3735 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3736 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3737 existed when your program stopped.
3738
3739 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3740 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3741 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3742 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3743 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3744 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3745 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3746
3747 @kindex tbreak
3748 @item tbreak @var{args}
3749 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3750 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3751 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3752 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3753
3754 @kindex hbreak
3755 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3756 @item hbreak @var{args}
3757 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3758 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3759 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3760 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3761 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3762 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3763 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3764 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3765 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3766 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3767 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3768 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3769 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3770 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3771 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3772 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3773 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3774 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3775
3776 @kindex thbreak
3777 @item thbreak @var{args}
3778 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3779 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3780 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3781 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3782 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3783 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3784 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3785 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3786
3787 @kindex rbreak
3788 @cindex regular expression
3789 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3790 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3791 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3792 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3793 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3794 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3795 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3796 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3797 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3798
3799 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3800 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3801 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3802 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3803 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3804 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3805
3806 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3807 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3808 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3809 classes.
3810
3811 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3812 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3813 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3814
3815 @smallexample
3816 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3817 @end smallexample
3818
3819 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3820 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3821 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3822 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3823 every function in a given file:
3824
3825 @smallexample
3826 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3827 @end smallexample
3828
3829 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3830 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3831
3832 @kindex info breakpoints
3833 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3834 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3835 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3836 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3837 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3838 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3839 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3840
3841 @table @emph
3842 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3843 @item Type
3844 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3845 @item Disposition
3846 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3847 @item Enabled or Disabled
3848 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3849 that are not enabled.
3850 @item Address
3851 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3852 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3853 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3854 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3855 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3856 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3857 @item What
3858 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3859 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3860 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3861 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3862 @end table
3863
3864 @noindent
3865 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3866 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3867 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3868 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3869 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3870 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3871
3872 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3873 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3874 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3875 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3876
3877 @noindent
3878 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3879 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3880 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3881 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3882 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3883
3884 @noindent
3885 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3886 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3887 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3888 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3889 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3890 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3891
3892 @noindent
3893 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3894 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3895
3896 @end table
3897
3898 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3899 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3900 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3901 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3902
3903 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3904 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3905 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3906 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3907
3908 @itemize @bullet
3909 @item
3910 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3911
3912 @item
3913 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3914 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3915
3916 @item
3917 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3918 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3919
3920 @item
3921 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3922 several places where that function is inlined.
3923 @end itemize
3924
3925 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3926 the relevant locations.
3927
3928 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3929 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3930 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3931 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3932 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3933 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3934 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3935
3936 For example:
3937
3938 @smallexample
3939 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3940 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3941 stop only if i==1
3942 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3943 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3944 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3945 @end smallexample
3946
3947 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
3948 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3949 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3950 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
3951 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
3952 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
3953 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
3954 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
3955 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
3956 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
3957 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
3958
3959 @cindex pending breakpoints
3960 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3961 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3962 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3963 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3964 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3965 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3966 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3967 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3968 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3969 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3970 is not yet resolved.
3971
3972 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3973 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3974 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3975 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3976 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3977 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3978
3979 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3980 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3981 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3982 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3983
3984 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3985 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3986 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3987
3988 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3989 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3990 address specification to an address:
3991
3992 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3993 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3994 @table @code
3995 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3996 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3997 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3998
3999 @item set breakpoint pending on
4000 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4001 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4002
4003 @item set breakpoint pending off
4004 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4005 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4006 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4007
4008 @item show breakpoint pending
4009 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4010 @end table
4011
4012 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4013 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4014 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4015
4016 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4017 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4018 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4019 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4020 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4021 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4022 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4023 breakpoints.
4024
4025 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4026
4027 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4028 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4029 @table @code
4030 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4031 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4032 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4033 breakpoint must be used.
4034
4035 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4036 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4037 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4038 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4039 @end table
4040
4041 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4042 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4043 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4044 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4045 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4046 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4047 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4048 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4049 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4050
4051 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4052 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4053 @table @code
4054 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4055 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4056 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4057 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4058
4059 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4060 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4061 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4062 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4063 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4064 @end table
4065
4066 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4067 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4068 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4069
4070 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4071 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4072
4073 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4074
4075 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4076 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4077 @table @code
4078 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4079 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4080 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4081 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4082 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4083
4084 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4085 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4086 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4087 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4088 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4089 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4090 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4091 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4092 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4093 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4094 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4095 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4096 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4097
4098 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4099 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4100 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4101 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4102 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4103 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4104 @end table
4105
4106
4107 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4108 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4109 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4110 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4111 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4112 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4113 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4114 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4115
4116
4117 @node Set Watchpoints
4118 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4119
4120 @cindex setting watchpoints
4121 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4122 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4123 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4124 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4125 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4126
4127 @itemize @bullet
4128 @item
4129 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4130
4131 @item
4132 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4133 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4134 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4135
4136 @item
4137 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4138 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4139 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4140 @end itemize
4141
4142 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4143 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4144 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4145 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4146 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4147 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4148 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4149 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4150 the expression changes.
4151
4152 @cindex software watchpoints
4153 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4154 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4155 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4156 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4157 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4158 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4159 culprit.)
4160
4161 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4162 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4163 slow down the running of your program.
4164
4165 @table @code
4166 @kindex watch
4167 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4168 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4169 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4170 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4171 to watch the value of a single variable:
4172
4173 @smallexample
4174 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4175 @end smallexample
4176
4177 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4178 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4179 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4180 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4181 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4182 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4183
4184 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4185 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4186 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4187 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4188 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4189 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4190 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4191 error.
4192
4193 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4194 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4195 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4196 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4197 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4198 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4199 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4200 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4201 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4202 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4203 Examples:
4204
4205 @smallexample
4206 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4207 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4208 @end smallexample
4209
4210 @kindex rwatch
4211 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4212 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4213 by the program.
4214
4215 @kindex awatch
4216 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4217 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4218 or written into by the program.
4219
4220 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4221 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4222 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4223 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4224 @end table
4225
4226 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4227 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4228 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4229 a never-changing value:
4230
4231 @smallexample
4232 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4233 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4234 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4235 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4236 @end smallexample
4237
4238 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4239 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4240 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4241 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4242 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4243 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4244
4245 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4246 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4247 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4248 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4249 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4250 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4251 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4252 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4253
4254 @table @code
4255 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4256 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4257 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4258
4259 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4260 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4261 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4262 @end table
4263
4264 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4265 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4266 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4267
4268 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4269
4270 @smallexample
4271 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4272 @end smallexample
4273
4274 @noindent
4275 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4276
4277 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4278 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4279 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4280 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4281 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4282 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4283 will print a message like this:
4284
4285 @smallexample
4286 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4287 @end smallexample
4288
4289 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4290 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4291 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4292 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4293 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4294 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4295 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4296 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4297
4298 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4299 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4300 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4301 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4302 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4303 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4304
4305 @smallexample
4306 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4307 @end smallexample
4308
4309 @noindent
4310 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4311
4312 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4313 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4314 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4315 expression with separately allocated resources.
4316
4317 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4318 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4319 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4320
4321 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4322 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4323 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4324 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4325 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4326 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4327 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4328 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4329 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4330
4331 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4332 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4333 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4334 watched expression from every thread.
4335
4336 @quotation
4337 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4338 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4339 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4340 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4341 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4342 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4343 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4344 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4345 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4346 @end quotation
4347
4348 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4349
4350 @node Set Catchpoints
4351 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4352 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4353 @cindex exception handlers
4354 @cindex event handling
4355
4356 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4357 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4358 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4359
4360 @table @code
4361 @kindex catch
4362 @item catch @var{event}
4363 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4364
4365 @table @code
4366 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4367 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4368 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4369 @kindex catch throw
4370 @kindex catch rethrow
4371 @kindex catch catch
4372 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4373 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4374
4375 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4376 regular expression will be caught.
4377
4378 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4379 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4380 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4381 exception being thrown.
4382
4383 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4384 @value{GDBN}:
4385
4386 @itemize @bullet
4387 @item
4388 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4389 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4390 supported.
4391
4392 @item
4393 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4394 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4395 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4396 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4397 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4398 built.
4399
4400 @item
4401 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4402 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4403
4404 @item
4405 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4406 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4407 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4408 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4409
4410 @item
4411 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4412 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4413 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4414 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4415 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4416 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4417 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4418 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4419 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4420
4421 @item
4422 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4423
4424 @item
4425 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4426 @end itemize
4427
4428 @item exception
4429 @kindex catch exception
4430 @cindex Ada exception catching
4431 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4432 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4433 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4434 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4435 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4436
4437 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4438 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4439 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4440 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4441 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4442 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4443 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4444 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4445
4446 @item exception unhandled
4447 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4448 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4449
4450 @item assert
4451 @kindex catch assert
4452 A failed Ada assertion.
4453
4454 @item exec
4455 @kindex catch exec
4456 @cindex break on fork/exec
4457 A call to @code{exec}.
4458
4459 @item syscall
4460 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4461 @kindex catch syscall
4462 @cindex break on a system call.
4463 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4464 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4465 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4466 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4467 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4468 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4469 will be caught.
4470
4471 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4472 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4473 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4474 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4475
4476 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4477 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4478 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4479 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4480
4481 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4482 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4483 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4484 available choices.
4485
4486 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4487 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4488 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4489 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4490 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4491 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4492 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4493 behind the OS upgrades).
4494
4495 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4496 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4497 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4498 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4499 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4500 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4501 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4502 syscall groups available on your environment.
4503
4504 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4505 arguments to it:
4506
4507 @smallexample
4508 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4509 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4510 (@value{GDBP}) r
4511 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4512
4513 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4514 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4515 (@value{GDBP}) c
4516 Continuing.
4517
4518 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4519 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4520 (@value{GDBP})
4521 @end smallexample
4522
4523 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4524
4525 @smallexample
4526 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4527 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4528 (@value{GDBP}) r
4529 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4530
4531 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4532 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4533 (@value{GDBP}) c
4534 Continuing.
4535
4536 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4537 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4538 (@value{GDBP})
4539 @end smallexample
4540
4541 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4542 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4543 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4544
4545 @smallexample
4546 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4547 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4548 (@value{GDBP}) r
4549 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4550
4551 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4552 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4553 (@value{GDBP}) c
4554 Continuing.
4555
4556 Program exited normally.
4557 (@value{GDBP})
4558 @end smallexample
4559
4560 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4561
4562 @smallexample
4563 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4564 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4565 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4566 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4567 (@value{GDBP}) r
4568 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4569
4570 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4571 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4572
4573 (@value{GDBP}) c
4574 Continuing.
4575 @end smallexample
4576
4577 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4578 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4579 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4580 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4581
4582 @smallexample
4583 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4584 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4585 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4586 (@value{GDBP})
4587 @end smallexample
4588
4589 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4590 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4591 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4592 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4593 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4594 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4595
4596 @smallexample
4597 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4598 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4599 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4600 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4601 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4602 (@value{GDBP})
4603 @end smallexample
4604
4605 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4606
4607 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4608 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4609
4610 @smallexample
4611 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4612 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4613 @end smallexample
4614
4615 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4616
4617 @item fork
4618 @kindex catch fork
4619 A call to @code{fork}.
4620
4621 @item vfork
4622 @kindex catch vfork
4623 A call to @code{vfork}.
4624
4625 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4626 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4627 @kindex catch load
4628 @kindex catch unload
4629 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4630 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4631 matches one of the affected libraries.
4632
4633 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4634 @kindex catch signal
4635 The delivery of a signal.
4636
4637 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4638 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4639 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4640
4641 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4642 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4643 signal names.
4644
4645 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4646 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4647 will be caught.
4648
4649 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4650 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4651 catchpoint.
4652
4653 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4654 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4655 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4656 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4657 commands.
4658
4659 @end table
4660
4661 @item tcatch @var{event}
4662 @kindex tcatch
4663 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4664 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4665
4666 @end table
4667
4668 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4669
4670
4671 @node Delete Breaks
4672 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4673
4674 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4675 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4676 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4677 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4678 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4679 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4680
4681 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4682 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4683 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4684 their breakpoint numbers.
4685
4686 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4687 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4688 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4689
4690 @table @code
4691 @kindex clear
4692 @item clear
4693 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4694 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4695 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4696 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4697
4698 @item clear @var{location}
4699 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4700 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4701 most useful ones are listed below:
4702
4703 @table @code
4704 @item clear @var{function}
4705 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4706 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4707
4708 @item clear @var{linenum}
4709 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4710 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4711 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4712 @end table
4713
4714 @cindex delete breakpoints
4715 @kindex delete
4716 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4717 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4718 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4719 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4720 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4721 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4722 @end table
4723
4724 @node Disabling
4725 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4726
4727 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4728 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4729 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4730 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4731 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4732
4733 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4734 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4735 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4736 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4737 do not know which numbers to use.
4738
4739 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4740 affects all of its locations.
4741
4742 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4743 different states of enablement:
4744
4745 @itemize @bullet
4746 @item
4747 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4748 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4749 @item
4750 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4751 @item
4752 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4753 disabled.
4754 @item
4755 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4756 N times, then becomes disabled.
4757 @item
4758 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4759 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4760 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4761 @end itemize
4762
4763 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4764 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4765
4766 @table @code
4767 @kindex disable
4768 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4769 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4770 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4771 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4772 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4773 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4774 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4775
4776 @kindex enable
4777 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4778 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4779 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4780
4781 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4782 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4783 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4784
4785 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4786 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4787 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4788 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4789 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4790 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4791 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4792
4793 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4794 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4795 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4796 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4797 @end table
4798
4799 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4800 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4801 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4802 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4803 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4804 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4805 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4806 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4807 Stepping}.)
4808
4809 @node Conditions
4810 @subsection Break Conditions
4811 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4812 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4813
4814 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4815 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4816 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4817 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4818 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4819 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4820 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4821 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4822
4823 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4824 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4825 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4826 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4827 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4828
4829 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4830 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4831 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4832 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4833 one.
4834
4835 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4836 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4837 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4838 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4839 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4840 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4841 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4842 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4843 conditions for the
4844 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4845 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4846
4847 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4848 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4849 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4850 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4851 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4852 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4853
4854 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4855 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4856 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4857 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4858 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4859
4860 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4861 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4862 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4863 with the @code{condition} command.
4864
4865 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4866 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4867 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4868 catchpoint.
4869
4870 @table @code
4871 @kindex condition
4872 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4873 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4874 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4875 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4876 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4877 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4878 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4879 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4880 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4881 prints an error message:
4882
4883 @smallexample
4884 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4885 @end smallexample
4886
4887 @noindent
4888 @value{GDBN} does
4889 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4890 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4891 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4892
4893 @item condition @var{bnum}
4894 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4895 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4896 @end table
4897
4898 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4899 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4900 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4901 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4902 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4903 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4904 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4905 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4906 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4907 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4908 your program reaches it.
4909
4910 @table @code
4911 @kindex ignore
4912 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4913 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4914 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4915 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4916 takes no action.
4917
4918 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4919 a count of zero.
4920
4921 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4922 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4923 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4924 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4925
4926 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4927 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4928 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4929
4930 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4931 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4932 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4933 Variables}.
4934 @end table
4935
4936 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4937
4938
4939 @node Break Commands
4940 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4941
4942 @cindex breakpoint commands
4943 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4944 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4945 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4946 enable other breakpoints.
4947
4948 @table @code
4949 @kindex commands
4950 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4951 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4952 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4953 @itemx end
4954 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4955 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4956 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4957
4958 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4959 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4960
4961 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4962 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4963 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4964 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4965 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4966 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4967 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4968 Expressions}).
4969 @end table
4970
4971 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4972 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4973
4974 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4975 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4976 that resumes execution.
4977
4978 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4979 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4980 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4981 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4982 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4983
4984 @kindex silent
4985 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4986 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4987 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4988 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4989 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4990 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4991
4992 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4993 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4994 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4995
4996 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4997 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4998
4999 @smallexample
5000 break foo if x>0
5001 commands
5002 silent
5003 printf "x is %d\n",x
5004 cont
5005 end
5006 @end smallexample
5007
5008 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5009 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5010 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5011 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5012 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5013 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5014 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5015
5016 @smallexample
5017 break 403
5018 commands
5019 silent
5020 set x = y + 4
5021 cont
5022 end
5023 @end smallexample
5024
5025 @node Dynamic Printf
5026 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5027
5028 @cindex dynamic printf
5029 @cindex dprintf
5030 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5031 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5032 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5033 having to recompile it.
5034
5035 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5036 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5037 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5038 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5039 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5040 redirects to files and so forth.
5041
5042 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5043 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5044 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5045 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5046 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5047 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5048 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5049
5050 @table @code
5051 @kindex dprintf
5052 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5053 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5054 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5055 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5056
5057 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5058 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5059 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5060 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5061 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5062 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5063
5064 @table @code
5065 @item gdb
5066 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5067 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5068
5069 @item call
5070 @kindex dprintf-style call
5071 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5072 @code{printf}).
5073
5074 @item agent
5075 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5076 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5077 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5078 support running commands on the target.
5079 @end table
5080
5081 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5082 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5083 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5084 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5085 command.
5086
5087 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5088 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5089 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5090 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5091 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5092 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5093
5094 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5095 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5096 you could do the following:
5097
5098 @example
5099 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5100 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5101 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5102 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5103 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5104 (gdb) info break
5105 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5106 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5107 continue
5108 (gdb)
5109 @end example
5110
5111 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5112 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5113 the variable settings.
5114
5115 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5116 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5117 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5118 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5119 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5120 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5121
5122 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5123 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5124 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5125
5126 @end table
5127
5128 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5129 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5130 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5131 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5132 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5133 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5134
5135 @node Save Breakpoints
5136 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5137
5138 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5139 breakpoints}} command.
5140
5141 @table @code
5142 @kindex save breakpoints
5143 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5144 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5145 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5146 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5147 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5148 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5149 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5150 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5151 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5152 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5153 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5154 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5155 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5156 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5157 that can no longer be recreated.
5158 @end table
5159
5160 @node Static Probe Points
5161 @subsection Static Probe Points
5162
5163 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5164 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5165 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5166 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5167 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5168
5169 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5170 ELF-compatible systems:
5171
5172 @itemize @bullet
5173
5174 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5175 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5176 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5177 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5178 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5179 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5180 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5181 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5182
5183 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5184 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5185 C@t{++} languages.
5186 @end itemize
5187
5188 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5189 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5190 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5191 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5192 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5193 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5194 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5195 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5196 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5197
5198 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5199 probes}, with optional arguments:
5200
5201 @table @code
5202 @kindex info probes
5203 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5204 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5205 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5206 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5207
5208 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5209 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5210 probes from all providers are listed.
5211
5212 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5213 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5214 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5215
5216 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5217 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5218 given, all object files are considered.
5219
5220 @item info probes all
5221 List the available static probes, from all types.
5222 @end table
5223
5224 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5225 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5226 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5227 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5228 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5229
5230 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5231 commands, with optional arguments:
5232
5233 @table @code
5234 @kindex enable probes
5235 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5236 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5237 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5238 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5239
5240 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5241 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5242 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5243
5244 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5245 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5246 given, all object files are considered.
5247
5248 @kindex disable probes
5249 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5250 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5251 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5252 @end table
5253
5254 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5255 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5256 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5257 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5258 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5259 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5260 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5261 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5262 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5263 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5264 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5265 at the current probe point.
5266
5267 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5268 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5269 an error message.
5270
5271
5272 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5273 @node Error in Breakpoints
5274 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5275
5276 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5277 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5278
5279 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5280 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5281 @smallexample
5282 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5283 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5284 @end smallexample
5285
5286 @noindent
5287 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5288 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5289 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5290
5291 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5292 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5293
5294 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5295 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5296 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5297
5298 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5299 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5300 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5301 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5302
5303 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5304 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5305 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5306 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5307 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5308 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5309 first in the bundle.
5310
5311 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5312 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5313 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5314 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5315 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5316 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5317 is hit.
5318
5319 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5320 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5321
5322 @smallexample
5323 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5324 @end smallexample
5325
5326 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5327 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5328 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5329 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5330 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5331 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5332 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5333 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5334
5335 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5336 adjusted breakpoints:
5337
5338 @smallexample
5339 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5340 to 0x00010410.
5341 @end smallexample
5342
5343 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5344 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5345 frequently than expected.
5346
5347 @node Continuing and Stepping
5348 @section Continuing and Stepping
5349
5350 @cindex stepping
5351 @cindex continuing
5352 @cindex resuming execution
5353 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5354 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5355 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5356 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5357 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5358 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5359 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5360 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5361 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5362 handlers}).)
5363
5364 @table @code
5365 @kindex continue
5366 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5367 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5368 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5369 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5370 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5371 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5372 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5373 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5374 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5375 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5376
5377 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5378 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5379 @code{continue} is ignored.
5380
5381 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5382 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5383 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5384 @code{continue}.
5385 @end table
5386
5387 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5388 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5389 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5390 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5391
5392 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5393 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5394 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5395 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5396 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5397 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5398
5399 @table @code
5400 @kindex step
5401 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5402 @item step
5403 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5404 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5405 abbreviated @code{s}.
5406
5407 @quotation
5408 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5409 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5410 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5411 @c distinction here.
5412 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5413 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5414 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5415 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5416 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5417 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5418 below.
5419 @end quotation
5420
5421 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5422 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5423 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5424 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5425 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5426 called within the line.
5427
5428 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5429 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5430 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5431 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5432 was any debugging information about the routine.
5433
5434 @item step @var{count}
5435 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5436 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5437 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5438
5439 @kindex next
5440 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5441 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5442 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5443 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5444 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5445 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5446 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5447 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5448
5449 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5450
5451
5452 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5453 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5454 @c
5455 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5456 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5457 @c function are executed without stopping.
5458
5459 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5460 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5461 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5462
5463 @kindex set step-mode
5464 @item set step-mode
5465 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5466 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5467 @itemx set step-mode on
5468 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5469 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5470 information rather than stepping over it.
5471
5472 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5473 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5474 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5475
5476 @item set step-mode off
5477 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5478 debug information. This is the default.
5479
5480 @item show step-mode
5481 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5482 source line debug information.
5483
5484 @kindex finish
5485 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5486 @item finish
5487 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5488 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5489 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5490
5491 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5492 ,Returning from a Function}).
5493
5494 @kindex until
5495 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5496 @cindex run until specified location
5497 @item until
5498 @itemx u
5499 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5500 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5501 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5502 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5503 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5504 than the address of the jump.
5505
5506 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5507 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5508 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5509 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5510 through the next iteration.
5511
5512 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5513 stack frame.
5514
5515 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5516 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5517 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5518 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5519 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5520
5521 @smallexample
5522 (@value{GDBP}) f
5523 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5524 206 expand_input();
5525 (@value{GDBP}) until
5526 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5527 @end smallexample
5528
5529 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5530 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5531 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5532 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5533 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5534 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5535 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5536
5537 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5538 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5539 argument.
5540
5541 @item until @var{location}
5542 @itemx u @var{location}
5543 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5544 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5545 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5546 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5547 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5548 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5549 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5550 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5551 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5552 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5553 invocations have returned.
5554
5555 @smallexample
5556 94 int factorial (int value)
5557 95 @{
5558 96 if (value > 1) @{
5559 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5560 98 @}
5561 99 return (value);
5562 100 @}
5563 @end smallexample
5564
5565
5566 @kindex advance @var{location}
5567 @item advance @var{location}
5568 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5569 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5570 @ref{Specify Location}.
5571 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5572 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5573 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5574 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5575
5576
5577 @kindex stepi
5578 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5579 @item stepi
5580 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5581 @itemx si
5582 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5583
5584 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5585 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5586 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5587 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5588
5589 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5590
5591 @need 750
5592 @kindex nexti
5593 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5594 @item nexti
5595 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5596 @itemx ni
5597 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5598 proceed until the function returns.
5599
5600 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5601
5602 @end table
5603
5604 @anchor{range stepping}
5605 @cindex range stepping
5606 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5607 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5608 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5609 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5610 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5611 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5612 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5613 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5614 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5615 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5616 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5617 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5618 if necessary:
5619
5620 @table @code
5621 @kindex set range-stepping
5622 @kindex show range-stepping
5623 @item set range-stepping
5624 @itemx show range-stepping
5625 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5626
5627 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5628 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5629 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5630 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5631 default is @code{on}.
5632
5633 @end table
5634
5635 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5636 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5637 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5638
5639 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5640 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5641 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5642 a particular file when stepping.
5643
5644 For example, consider the following C function:
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 101 int func()
5648 102 @{
5649 103 foo(boring());
5650 104 bar(boring());
5651 105 @}
5652 @end smallexample
5653
5654 @noindent
5655 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5656 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5657 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5658 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5659
5660 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5661 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5662 is called from many places.
5663
5664 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5665 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5666 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5667 @code{foo}.
5668
5669 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5670 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5671 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5672
5673 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5674 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5675 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5676 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5677 the underlying system.
5678 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5679 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5680
5681 @table @code
5682 @kindex skip
5683 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5684 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5685 that specify what to skip.
5686 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5687
5688 @table @code
5689 @item -file @var{file}
5690 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5691 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5692
5693 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5694 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5695 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5696 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5697 over when stepping.
5698
5699 @smallexample
5700 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5701 @end smallexample
5702
5703 @item -function @var{linespec}
5704 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5705 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5706 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5707 @xref{Specify Location}.
5708
5709 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5710 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5711 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5712 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5713
5714 This form is useful for complex function names.
5715 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5716 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5717 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5718 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5719 regular expression makes this easier.
5720
5721 @smallexample
5722 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5723 @end smallexample
5724
5725 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5726 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5727
5728 @smallexample
5729 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5730 @end smallexample
5731 @end table
5732
5733 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5734 will be skipped.
5735
5736 @kindex skip function
5737 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5738 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5739 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5740 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5741
5742 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5743 will be skipped.
5744
5745 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5746 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5747
5748 @kindex skip file
5749 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5750 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5751 will be skipped over when stepping.
5752
5753 @smallexample
5754 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5755 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5756 @end smallexample
5757
5758 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5759 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5760 @end table
5761
5762 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5763 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5764
5765 @table @code
5766 @kindex info skip
5767 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5768 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5769 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5770 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5771
5772 @table @emph
5773 @item Identifier
5774 A number identifying this skip.
5775 @item Enabled or Disabled
5776 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5777 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5778 @item Glob
5779 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5780 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5781 @item File
5782 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5783 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5784 @item RE
5785 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5786 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5787 @item Function
5788 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5789 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5790 @end table
5791
5792 @kindex skip delete
5793 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5794 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5795 skips.
5796
5797 @kindex skip enable
5798 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5799 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5800 skips.
5801
5802 @kindex skip disable
5803 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5804 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5805 skips.
5806
5807 @end table
5808
5809 @node Signals
5810 @section Signals
5811 @cindex signals
5812
5813 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5814 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5815 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5816 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5817 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5818 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5819 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5820 requested an alarm).
5821
5822 @cindex fatal signals
5823 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5824 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5825 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5826 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5827 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5828 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5829
5830 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5831 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5832 signal.
5833
5834 @cindex handling signals
5835 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5836 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5837 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5838 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5839 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5840
5841 @table @code
5842 @kindex info signals
5843 @kindex info handle
5844 @item info signals
5845 @itemx info handle
5846 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5847 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5848 the defined types of signals.
5849
5850 @item info signals @var{sig}
5851 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5852
5853 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5854
5855 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5856 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5857 for details about this command.
5858
5859 @kindex handle
5860 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5861 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5862 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5863 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5864 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5865 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5866 say what change to make.
5867 @end table
5868
5869 @c @group
5870 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5871 Their full names are:
5872
5873 @table @code
5874 @item nostop
5875 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5876 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5877
5878 @item stop
5879 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5880 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5881
5882 @item print
5883 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5884
5885 @item noprint
5886 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5887 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5888
5889 @item pass
5890 @itemx noignore
5891 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5892 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5893 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5894
5895 @item nopass
5896 @itemx ignore
5897 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5898 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5899 @end table
5900 @c @end group
5901
5902 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5903 program until you
5904 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5905 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5906 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5907 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5908 program sees that signal when you continue.
5909
5910 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5911 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5912 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5913 erroneous signals.
5914
5915 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5916 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5917 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5918 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5919 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5920 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5921 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5922 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5923 Program a Signal}.
5924
5925 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5926 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5927
5928 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5929 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5930 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5931 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5932 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5933 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5934 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5935 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5936 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5937 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5938 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5939 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5940 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5941
5942 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5943
5944 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5945 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5946 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5947 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5948
5949 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5950 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5951 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5952 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5953
5954 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5955 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5956
5957 @smallexample
5958 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5959 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5960 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5961 (@value{GDBP}) c
5962 Continuing.
5963
5964 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5965 main () sigusr1.c:28
5966 28 p = 0;
5967 (@value{GDBP}) si
5968 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5969 9 @{
5970 @end smallexample
5971
5972 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5973 program to receive the signal first:
5974
5975 @smallexample
5976 (@value{GDBP}) n
5977 28 p = 0;
5978 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5979 (@value{GDBP}) si
5980 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5981 9 @{
5982 (@value{GDBP})
5983 @end smallexample
5984
5985 @cindex extra signal information
5986 @anchor{extra signal information}
5987
5988 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5989 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5990 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5991 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5992 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5993 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5994 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5995 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5996 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5997 system header.
5998
5999 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6000 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6001
6002 @smallexample
6003 @group
6004 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6005 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6006 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6007 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6008 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6009 type = struct @{
6010 int si_signo;
6011 int si_errno;
6012 int si_code;
6013 union @{
6014 int _pad[28];
6015 struct @{...@} _kill;
6016 struct @{...@} _timer;
6017 struct @{...@} _rt;
6018 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6019 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6020 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6021 @} _sifields;
6022 @}
6023 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6024 type = struct @{
6025 void *si_addr;
6026 @}
6027 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6028 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6029 @end group
6030 @end smallexample
6031
6032 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6033
6034 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6035 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6036 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6037 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6038 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6039 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6040 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6041 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6042 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6043 information is displayed.
6044
6045 The usual output of a segfault is:
6046 @smallexample
6047 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6048 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6049 68 value = *(p + len);
6050 @end smallexample
6051
6052 While a bound violation is presented as:
6053 @smallexample
6054 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6055 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6056 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6057 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6058 68 value = *(p + len);
6059 @end smallexample
6060
6061 @node Thread Stops
6062 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6063
6064 @cindex stopped threads
6065 @cindex threads, stopped
6066
6067 @cindex continuing threads
6068 @cindex threads, continuing
6069
6070 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6071 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6072 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6073 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6074 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6075 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6076 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6077 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6078 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6079
6080 @menu
6081 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6082 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6083 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6084 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6085 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6086 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6087 @end menu
6088
6089 @node All-Stop Mode
6090 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6091
6092 @cindex all-stop mode
6093
6094 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6095 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6096 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6097 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6098 underfoot.
6099
6100 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6101 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6102 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6103
6104 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6105 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6106 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6107 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6108 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6109 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6110 stops.
6111
6112 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6113 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6114 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6115 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6116
6117 @cindex automatic thread selection
6118 @cindex switching threads automatically
6119 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6120 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6121 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6122 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6123 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6124 thread.
6125
6126 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6127 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6128
6129 @table @code
6130 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6131 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6132 @cindex lock scheduler
6133 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6134 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6135 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6136 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6137 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6138 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6139 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6140 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6141 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6142 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6143 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6144 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6145 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6146 @code{on} in replay mode.
6147
6148 @item show scheduler-locking
6149 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6150 @end table
6151
6152 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6153 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6154 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6155 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6156 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6157 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6158 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6159 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6160 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6161 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6162 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6163 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6164 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6165 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6166
6167 @table @code
6168 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6169 @item set schedule-multiple
6170 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6171 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6172 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6173 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6174 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6175 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6176
6177 @item show schedule-multiple
6178 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6179 multiple processes.
6180 @end table
6181
6182 @node Non-Stop Mode
6183 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6184
6185 @cindex non-stop mode
6186
6187 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6188 @c with more details.
6189
6190 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6191 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6192 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6193 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6194 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6195 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6196
6197 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6198 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6199 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6200 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6201 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6202 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6203 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6204 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6205 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6206 independently and simultaneously.
6207
6208 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6209 or attach to your program:
6210
6211 @smallexample
6212 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6213 set pagination off
6214
6215 # Finally, turn it on!
6216 set non-stop on
6217 @end smallexample
6218
6219 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6220
6221 @table @code
6222 @kindex set non-stop
6223 @item set non-stop on
6224 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6225 @item set non-stop off
6226 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6227 @kindex show non-stop
6228 @item show non-stop
6229 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6230 @end table
6231
6232 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6233 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6234 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6235 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6236 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6237 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6238 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6239 default.
6240
6241 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6242 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6243 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6244
6245 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6246 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6247 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6248 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6249 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6250
6251 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6252 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6253 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6254 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6255 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6256
6257 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6258
6259 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6260 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6261 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6262 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6263 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6264 previously current thread.
6265
6266 @node Background Execution
6267 @subsection Background Execution
6268
6269 @cindex foreground execution
6270 @cindex background execution
6271 @cindex asynchronous execution
6272 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6273
6274 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6275 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6276 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6277 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6278 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6279 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6280
6281 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6282 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6283
6284 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6285 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6286 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6287 are:
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @kindex run&
6291 @item run
6292 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6293
6294 @item attach
6295 @kindex attach&
6296 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6297
6298 @item step
6299 @kindex step&
6300 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6301
6302 @item stepi
6303 @kindex stepi&
6304 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6305
6306 @item next
6307 @kindex next&
6308 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6309
6310 @item nexti
6311 @kindex nexti&
6312 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6313
6314 @item continue
6315 @kindex continue&
6316 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6317
6318 @item finish
6319 @kindex finish&
6320 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6321
6322 @item until
6323 @kindex until&
6324 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6325
6326 @end table
6327
6328 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6329 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6330 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6331 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6332 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6333 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6334
6335 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6336 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6337
6338 @table @code
6339 @kindex interrupt
6340 @item interrupt
6341 @itemx interrupt -a
6342
6343 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6344 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6345 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6346 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6347 @end table
6348
6349 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6350 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6351
6352 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6353 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6354 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6355
6356 @table @code
6357 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6358 @cindex thread breakpoints
6359 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6360 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6361 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6362 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6363 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6364 specify some source line.
6365
6366 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6367 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6368 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6369 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6370 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6371
6372 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6373 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6374 program.
6375
6376 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6377 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6378 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6379
6380 @smallexample
6381 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6382 @end smallexample
6383
6384 @end table
6385
6386 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6387 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6388 thread list. For example:
6389
6390 @smallexample
6391 (@value{GDBP}) c
6392 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6393 @end smallexample
6394
6395 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6396 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6397 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6398 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6399 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6400 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6401 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6402 command.
6403
6404 @node Interrupted System Calls
6405 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6406
6407 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6408 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6409 @cindex premature return from system calls
6410 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6411 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6412 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6413 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6414 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6415 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6416 stop execution.
6417
6418 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6419 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6420 style anyways.
6421
6422 For example, do not write code like this:
6423
6424 @smallexample
6425 sleep (10);
6426 @end smallexample
6427
6428 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6429 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6430
6431 Instead, write this:
6432
6433 @smallexample
6434 int unslept = 10;
6435 while (unslept > 0)
6436 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6437 @end smallexample
6438
6439 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6440 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6441 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6442 @value{GDBN}.
6443
6444 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6445 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6446 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6447 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6448
6449 @node Observer Mode
6450 @subsection Observer Mode
6451
6452 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6453 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6454 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6455 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6456 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6457
6458 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6459 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6460 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6461 mode.
6462
6463 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6464 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6465 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6466 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6467 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6468
6469 @table @code
6470
6471 @kindex observer
6472 @item set observer on
6473 @itemx set observer off
6474 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6475 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6476 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6477 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6478
6479 @item show observer
6480 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6481
6482 @kindex may-write-registers
6483 @item set may-write-registers on
6484 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6485 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6486 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6487 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6488
6489 @item show may-write-registers
6490 Show the current permission to write registers.
6491
6492 @kindex may-write-memory
6493 @item set may-write-memory on
6494 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6495 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6496 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6497 defaults to @code{on}.
6498
6499 @item show may-write-memory
6500 Show the current permission to write memory.
6501
6502 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6503 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6504 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6505 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6506 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6507 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6508
6509 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6510 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6511
6512 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6513 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6514 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6515 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6516 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6517 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6518 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6519
6520 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6521 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6522
6523 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6524 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6525 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6526 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6527 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6528 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6529 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6530
6531 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6532 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6533
6534 @kindex may-interrupt
6535 @item set may-interrupt on
6536 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6537 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6538 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6539 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6540 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6541
6542 @item show may-interrupt
6543 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6544
6545 @end table
6546
6547 @node Reverse Execution
6548 @chapter Running programs backward
6549 @cindex reverse execution
6550 @cindex running programs backward
6551
6552 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6553 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6554 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6555 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6556
6557 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6558 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6559 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6560 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6561 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6562 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6563
6564 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6565 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6566 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6567 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6568 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6569 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6570 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6571 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6572 prior values@footnote{
6573 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6574 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6575 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6576
6577 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6578 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6579 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6580 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6581 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6582 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6583 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6584 }.
6585
6586 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6587 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6588
6589 @table @code
6590 @kindex reverse-continue
6591 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6592 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6593 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6594 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6595 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6596 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6597 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6598
6599 @kindex reverse-step
6600 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6601 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6602 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6603 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6604
6605 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6606 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6607 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6608 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6609 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6610 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6611
6612 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6613 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6614
6615 @kindex reverse-stepi
6616 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6617 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6618 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6619 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6620 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6621 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6622 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6623
6624 @kindex reverse-next
6625 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6626 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6627 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6628 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6629 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6630 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6631 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6632 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6633 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6634 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6635
6636 @kindex reverse-nexti
6637 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6638 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6639 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6640 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6641 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6642 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6643 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6644 frame) is reached.
6645
6646 @kindex reverse-finish
6647 @item reverse-finish
6648 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6649 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6650 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6651 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6652
6653 @kindex set exec-direction
6654 @item set exec-direction
6655 Set the direction of target execution.
6656 @item set exec-direction reverse
6657 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6658 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6659 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6660 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6661 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6662 @item set exec-direction forward
6663 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6664 This is the default.
6665 @end table
6666
6667
6668 @node Process Record and Replay
6669 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6670 @cindex process record and replay
6671 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6672
6673 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6674 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6675 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6676
6677 @cindex replay mode
6678 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6679 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6680 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6681 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6682 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6683 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6684 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6685 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6686 execution log.
6687
6688 @cindex record mode
6689 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6690 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6691 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6692 for future replay.
6693
6694 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6695 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6696 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6697 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6698 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6699 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6700
6701 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6702 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6703 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6704 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6705
6706 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6707 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6708
6709 @table @code
6710 @kindex target record
6711 @kindex target record-full
6712 @kindex target record-btrace
6713 @kindex record
6714 @kindex record full
6715 @kindex record btrace
6716 @kindex record btrace bts
6717 @kindex record btrace pt
6718 @kindex record bts
6719 @kindex record pt
6720 @kindex rec
6721 @kindex rec full
6722 @kindex rec btrace
6723 @kindex rec btrace bts
6724 @kindex rec btrace pt
6725 @kindex rec bts
6726 @kindex rec pt
6727 @item record @var{method}
6728 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6729 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6730 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6731 recording methods are available:
6732
6733 @table @code
6734 @item full
6735 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6736 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6737 execution.
6738
6739 @item btrace @var{format}
6740 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6741 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6742 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6743 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6744 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6745 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6746 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6747
6748 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6749 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6750 formats are available:
6751
6752 @table @code
6753 @item bts
6754 @cindex branch trace store
6755 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6756 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6757 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6758
6759 @item pt
6760 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6761 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6762 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6763 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6764
6765 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6766 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6767 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6768
6769 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6770 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6771 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6772 buffer-size with care.
6773 @end table
6774
6775 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6776 @end table
6777
6778 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6779 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6780 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6781 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6782
6783 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6784 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6785 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6786 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6787 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6788
6789 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6790 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6791 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6792 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6793 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6794 does not support these two modes.
6795
6796 @kindex record stop
6797 @kindex rec s
6798 @item record stop
6799 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6800 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6801 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6802
6803 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6804 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6805 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6806 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6807 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6808
6809 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6810 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6811 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6812 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6813 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6814
6815 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6816 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6817
6818 @kindex record goto
6819 @item record goto
6820 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6821 ways to specify the location to go to:
6822
6823 @table @code
6824 @item record goto begin
6825 @itemx record goto start
6826 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6827
6828 @item record goto end
6829 Go to the end of the execution log.
6830
6831 @item record goto @var{n}
6832 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6833 @end table
6834
6835 @kindex record save
6836 @item record save @var{filename}
6837 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6838 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6839 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6840
6841 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6842
6843 @kindex record restore
6844 @item record restore @var{filename}
6845 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6846 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6847
6848 @kindex set record full
6849 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6850 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6851 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6852 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6853
6854 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6855 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6856 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6857 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6858 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6859 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6860 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6861 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6862
6863 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6864 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6865 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6866
6867 @kindex show record full
6868 @item show record full insn-number-max
6869 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6870 recording method.
6871
6872 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6873 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6874 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6875 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6876 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6877 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6878 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6879 oldest one to be deleted.
6880
6881 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6882 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6883
6884 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6885 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6886
6887 @item set record full memory-query
6888 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6889 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6890 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6891 case.
6892
6893 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6894 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6895 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6896 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6897 results.
6898
6899 @item show record full memory-query
6900 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6901
6902 @kindex set record btrace
6903 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6904 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6905 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6906 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6907 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6908 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6909 You can use the following command for that:
6910
6911 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6912 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6913 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6914 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6915 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6916 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6917 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6918 position.
6919
6920 @kindex show record btrace
6921 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6922 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6923
6924 @kindex set record btrace bts
6925 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6926 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6927 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6928 format. Default is 64KB.
6929
6930 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6931 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6932 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6933 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6934 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6935 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6936 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6937
6938 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6939 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6940
6941 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6942 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6943
6944 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6945 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6946 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6947
6948 @kindex set record btrace pt
6949 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6950 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6951 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6952 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6953
6954 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6955 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6956 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6957 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6958 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6959 actual buffer size for each thread.
6960
6961 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6962 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6963
6964 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6965 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6966
6967 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6968 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6969 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6970
6971 @kindex info record
6972 @item info record
6973 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6974 method:
6975
6976 @table @code
6977 @item full
6978 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6979 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6980
6981 @itemize @bullet
6982 @item
6983 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6984 @item
6985 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6986 @item
6987 Highest recorded instruction number.
6988 @item
6989 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6990 @item
6991 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6992 @item
6993 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6994 @end itemize
6995
6996 @item btrace
6997 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6998
6999 @itemize @bullet
7000 @item
7001 Recording format.
7002 @item
7003 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7004 @item
7005 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7006 instructions.
7007 @item
7008 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7009 @end itemize
7010
7011 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7012 @itemize @bullet
7013 @item
7014 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7015 @end itemize
7016
7017 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7018 @itemize @bullet
7019 @item
7020 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7021 @end itemize
7022 @end table
7023
7024 @kindex record delete
7025 @kindex rec del
7026 @item record delete
7027 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7028 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7029 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7030 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7031
7032 @kindex record instruction-history
7033 @kindex rec instruction-history
7034 @item record instruction-history
7035 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7036 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7037 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7038 are printed in execution order.
7039
7040 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7041 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7042 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7043
7044 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7045 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7046 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7047 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7048 @code{/p} modifier.
7049
7050 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7051 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7052 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7053
7054 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7055 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7056
7057 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7058 disassemble:
7059
7060 @table @code
7061 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7062 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7063 @var{insn}.
7064
7065 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7066 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7067 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7068 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7069 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7070 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7071
7072 @item record instruction-history
7073 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7074
7075 @item record instruction-history -
7076 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7077
7078 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7079 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7080 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7081 number @var{end} is included.
7082 @end table
7083
7084 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7085
7086 @kindex set record
7087 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7088 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7089 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7090 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7091 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7092
7093 @kindex show record
7094 @item show record instruction-history-size
7095 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7096 instruction-history} command.
7097
7098 @kindex record function-call-history
7099 @kindex rec function-call-history
7100 @item record function-call-history
7101 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7102 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7103 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7104 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7105 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7106 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7107 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7108 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7109 given together.
7110
7111 @smallexample
7112 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7113 1 void foo (void)
7114 2 @{
7115 3 @}
7116 4
7117 5 void bar (void)
7118 6 @{
7119 7 ...
7120 8 foo ();
7121 9 ...
7122 10 @}
7123 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7124 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7125 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7126 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7127 @end smallexample
7128
7129 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7130 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7131 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7132 to print:
7133
7134 @table @code
7135 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7136 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7137
7138 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7139 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7140 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7141 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7142 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7143
7144 @item record function-call-history
7145 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7146
7147 @item record function-call-history -
7148 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7149
7150 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7151 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7152 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7153 @end table
7154
7155 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7156
7157 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7158 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7159 Define how many lines to print in the
7160 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7161 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7162
7163 @item show record function-call-history-size
7164 Show how many lines to print in the
7165 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7166 @end table
7167
7168
7169 @node Stack
7170 @chapter Examining the Stack
7171
7172 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7173 stopped and how it got there.
7174
7175 @cindex call stack
7176 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7177 is generated.
7178 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7179 the arguments of the call,
7180 and the local variables of the function being called.
7181 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7182 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7183 stack}.
7184
7185 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7186 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7187
7188 @cindex selected frame
7189 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7190 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7191 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7192 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7193 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7194 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7195
7196 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7197 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7198 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7199
7200 @menu
7201 * Frames:: Stack frames
7202 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7203 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7204 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7205 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7206
7207 @end menu
7208
7209 @node Frames
7210 @section Stack Frames
7211
7212 @cindex frame, definition
7213 @cindex stack frame
7214 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7215 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7216 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7217 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7218 which the function is executing.
7219
7220 @cindex initial frame
7221 @cindex outermost frame
7222 @cindex innermost frame
7223 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7224 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7225 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7226 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7227 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7228 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7229 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7230 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7231
7232 @cindex frame pointer
7233 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7234 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7235 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7236 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7237 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7238 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7239
7240 @cindex frame number
7241 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7242 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7243 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7244 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7245 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7246
7247 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7248 @c underflow problems.
7249 @cindex frameless execution
7250 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7251 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7252 @smallexample
7253 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7254 @end smallexample
7255 generates functions without a frame.)
7256 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7257 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7258 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7259 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7260 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7261 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7262 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7263
7264 @node Backtrace
7265 @section Backtraces
7266
7267 @cindex traceback
7268 @cindex call stack traces
7269 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7270 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7271 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7272 stack.
7273
7274 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7275 @table @code
7276 @kindex backtrace
7277 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7278 @item backtrace
7279 @itemx bt
7280 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7281 frames in the stack.
7282
7283 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7284 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7285
7286 @item backtrace @var{n}
7287 @itemx bt @var{n}
7288 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7289
7290 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7291 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7292 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7293
7294 @item backtrace full
7295 @itemx bt full
7296 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7297 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7298 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7299 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7300
7301 @item backtrace no-filters
7302 @itemx bt no-filters
7303 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7304 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7305 @itemx bt no-filters full
7306 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7307 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7308 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7309 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7310 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7311 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7312 support.
7313 @end table
7314
7315 @kindex where
7316 @kindex info stack
7317 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7318 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7319
7320 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7321 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7322 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7323 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7324 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7325 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7326 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7327 multi-threaded program.
7328
7329 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7330 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7331 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7332 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7333 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7334 line number.
7335
7336 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7337 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7338
7339 @smallexample
7340 @group
7341 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7342 at builtin.c:993
7343 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7344 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7345 at macro.c:71
7346 (More stack frames follow...)
7347 @end group
7348 @end smallexample
7349
7350 @noindent
7351 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7352 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7353 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7354
7355 @noindent
7356 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7357 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7358 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7359 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7360 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7361
7362 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7363 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7364 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7365 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7366 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7367 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7368 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7369 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7370 such a backtrace might look like:
7371
7372 @smallexample
7373 @group
7374 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7375 at builtin.c:993
7376 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7377 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7378 at macro.c:71
7379 (More stack frames follow...)
7380 @end group
7381 @end smallexample
7382
7383 @noindent
7384 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7385 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7386
7387 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7388 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7389 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7390
7391 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7392 @cindex program entry point
7393 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7394 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7395 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7396 @code{main}@footnote{
7397 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7398 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7399 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7400 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7401 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7402 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7403
7404 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7405 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7406
7407 @table @code
7408 @item set backtrace past-main
7409 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7410 @kindex set backtrace
7411 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7412
7413 @item set backtrace past-main off
7414 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7415 default.
7416
7417 @item show backtrace past-main
7418 @kindex show backtrace
7419 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7420
7421 @item set backtrace past-entry
7422 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7423 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7424 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7425 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7426
7427 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7428 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7429 application. This is the default.
7430
7431 @item show backtrace past-entry
7432 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7433
7434 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7435 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7436 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7437 @cindex backtrace limit
7438 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7439 or zero means unlimited levels.
7440
7441 @item show backtrace limit
7442 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7443 @end table
7444
7445 You can control how file names are displayed.
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @item set filename-display
7449 @itemx set filename-display relative
7450 @cindex filename-display
7451 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7452
7453 @item set filename-display basename
7454 Display only basename of a filename.
7455
7456 @item set filename-display absolute
7457 Display an absolute filename.
7458
7459 @item show filename-display
7460 Show the current way to display filenames.
7461 @end table
7462
7463 @node Selection
7464 @section Selecting a Frame
7465
7466 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7467 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7468 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7469 of the stack frame just selected.
7470
7471 @table @code
7472 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7473 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7474 @item frame @var{n}
7475 @itemx f @var{n}
7476 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7477 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7478 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7479 @code{main}.
7480
7481 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7482 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7483 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7484 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7485 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7486 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7487 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7488 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7489
7490 @kindex up
7491 @item up @var{n}
7492 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7493 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7494 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7495
7496 @kindex down
7497 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7498 @item down @var{n}
7499 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7500 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7501 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7502 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7503 @end table
7504
7505 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7506 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7507 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7508 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7509
7510 @need 1000
7511 For example:
7512
7513 @smallexample
7514 @group
7515 (@value{GDBP}) up
7516 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7517 at env.c:10
7518 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7519 @end group
7520 @end smallexample
7521
7522 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7523 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7524 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7525 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7526 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7527 for details.
7528
7529 @table @code
7530 @kindex select-frame
7531 @item select-frame
7532 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7533 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7534 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7535 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7536
7537 @kindex down-silently
7538 @kindex up-silently
7539 @item up-silently @var{n}
7540 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7541 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7542 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7543 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7544 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7545 distracting.
7546 @end table
7547
7548 @node Frame Info
7549 @section Information About a Frame
7550
7551 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7552 stack frame.
7553
7554 @table @code
7555 @item frame
7556 @itemx f
7557 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7558 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7559 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7560 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7561 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7562
7563 @kindex info frame
7564 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7565 @item info frame
7566 @itemx info f
7567 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7568 including:
7569
7570 @itemize @bullet
7571 @item
7572 the address of the frame
7573 @item
7574 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7575 @item
7576 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7577 @item
7578 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7579 @item
7580 the address of the frame's arguments
7581 @item
7582 the address of the frame's local variables
7583 @item
7584 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7585 @item
7586 which registers were saved in the frame
7587 @end itemize
7588
7589 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7590 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7591 the usual conventions.
7592
7593 @item info frame @var{addr}
7594 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7595 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7596 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7597 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7598 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7599 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7600
7601 @kindex info args
7602 @item info args
7603 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7604
7605 @item info locals
7606 @kindex info locals
7607 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7608 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7609 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7610
7611 @end table
7612
7613 @node Frame Filter Management
7614 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7615 @cindex managing frame filters
7616
7617 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7618 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7619
7620 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7621 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7622
7623 @table @code
7624 @kindex info frame-filter
7625 @item info frame-filter
7626 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7627 their name, priority and enabled status.
7628
7629 @kindex disable frame-filter
7630 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7631 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7632 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7633 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7634 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7635 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7636 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7637 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7638 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7639 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7640 may be enabled again later.
7641
7642 @kindex enable frame-filter
7643 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7644 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7645 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7646 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7647 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7648 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7649 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7650 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7651 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7652
7653 Example:
7654
7655 @smallexample
7656 (gdb) info frame-filter
7657
7658 global frame-filters:
7659 Priority Enabled Name
7660 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7661 100 Yes Reverse
7662
7663 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7664 Priority Enabled Name
7665 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7666
7667 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7668 Priority Enabled Name
7669 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7670
7671 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7672 (gdb) info frame-filter
7673
7674 global frame-filters:
7675 Priority Enabled Name
7676 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7677 100 Yes Reverse
7678
7679 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7680 Priority Enabled Name
7681 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7682
7683 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7684 Priority Enabled Name
7685 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7686
7687 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7688 (gdb) info frame-filter
7689
7690 global frame-filters:
7691 Priority Enabled Name
7692 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7693 100 Yes Reverse
7694
7695 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7696 Priority Enabled Name
7697 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7698
7699 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7700 Priority Enabled Name
7701 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7702 @end smallexample
7703
7704 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7705 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7706 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7707 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7708 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7709 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7710 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7711
7712 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7713 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7714 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7715 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7716 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7717 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7718 dictionary resides.
7719
7720 Example:
7721
7722 @smallexample
7723 (gdb) info frame-filter
7724
7725 global frame-filters:
7726 Priority Enabled Name
7727 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7728 100 Yes Reverse
7729
7730 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7731 Priority Enabled Name
7732 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7733
7734 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7735 Priority Enabled Name
7736 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7737
7738 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7739 (gdb) info frame-filter
7740
7741 global frame-filters:
7742 Priority Enabled Name
7743 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7744 50 Yes Reverse
7745
7746 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7747 Priority Enabled Name
7748 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7749
7750 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7751 Priority Enabled Name
7752 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7753 @end smallexample
7754 @end table
7755
7756 @node Source
7757 @chapter Examining Source Files
7758
7759 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7760 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7761 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7762 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7763 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7764 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7765 source files by explicit command.
7766
7767 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7768 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7769 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7770
7771 @menu
7772 * List:: Printing source lines
7773 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7774 * Edit:: Editing source files
7775 * Search:: Searching source files
7776 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7777 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7778 @end menu
7779
7780 @node List
7781 @section Printing Source Lines
7782
7783 @kindex list
7784 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7785 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7786 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7787 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7788 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7789
7790 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7791
7792 @table @code
7793 @item list @var{linenum}
7794 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7795 current source file.
7796
7797 @item list @var{function}
7798 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7799 @var{function}.
7800
7801 @item list
7802 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7803 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7804 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7805 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7806 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7807
7808 @item list -
7809 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7810 @end table
7811
7812 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7813 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7814 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7815
7816 @table @code
7817 @kindex set listsize
7818 @item set listsize @var{count}
7819 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7820 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7821 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7822 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7823
7824 @kindex show listsize
7825 @item show listsize
7826 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7827 @end table
7828
7829 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7830 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7831 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7832 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7833 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7834
7835 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7836 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7837 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7838 to specify some source line.
7839
7840 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7841
7842 @table @code
7843 @item list @var{location}
7844 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7845
7846 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7847 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7848 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7849 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7850 the same source file as the first location.
7851
7852 @item list ,@var{last}
7853 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7854
7855 @item list @var{first},
7856 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7857
7858 @item list +
7859 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7860
7861 @item list -
7862 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7863
7864 @item list
7865 As described in the preceding table.
7866 @end table
7867
7868 @node Specify Location
7869 @section Specifying a Location
7870 @cindex specifying location
7871 @cindex location
7872 @cindex source location
7873
7874 @menu
7875 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7876 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7877 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7878 @end menu
7879
7880 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7881 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7882 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7883 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7884 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7885
7886 @node Linespec Locations
7887 @subsection Linespec Locations
7888 @cindex linespec locations
7889
7890 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7891 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7892 specifying a linespec:
7893
7894 @table @code
7895 @item @var{linenum}
7896 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7897
7898 @item -@var{offset}
7899 @itemx +@var{offset}
7900 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7901 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7902 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7903 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7904 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7905 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7906 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7907 linespec.
7908
7909 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7910 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7911 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7912 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7913 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7914 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7915 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7916
7917 @item @var{function}
7918 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7919 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7920
7921 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7922 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7923
7924 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7925 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7926 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7927 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7928 functions in different source files.
7929
7930 @item @var{label}
7931 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7932 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7933 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7934 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7935
7936 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7937 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7938 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7939 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7940 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7941 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7942
7943 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7944 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7945 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7946 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7947 each one of those probes.
7948 @end table
7949
7950 @node Explicit Locations
7951 @subsection Explicit Locations
7952 @cindex explicit locations
7953
7954 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7955 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7956
7957 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7958 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7959 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7960 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7961 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7962
7963 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7964 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7965 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7966 the symbol table to know.
7967
7968 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7969 following table:
7970
7971 @table @code
7972 @item -source @var{filename}
7973 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7974 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7975 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7976 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7977 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7978
7979 @item -function @var{function}
7980 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7981 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7982 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7983 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7984
7985 @item -label @var{label}
7986 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7987 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7988 selected stack frame.
7989
7990 @item -line @var{number}
7991 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7992 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7993 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7994 relative to the current line.
7995 @end table
7996
7997 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7998 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7999
8000 @node Address Locations
8001 @subsection Address Locations
8002 @cindex address locations
8003
8004 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8005 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8006
8007 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8008 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8009 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8010 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8011 source files.
8012
8013 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8014 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8015 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8016 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8017 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8018 of @var{address}:
8019
8020 @table @code
8021 @item @var{expression}
8022 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8023
8024 @item @var{funcaddr}
8025 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8026 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8027 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8028 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8029 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8030 (although the Pascal form also works).
8031
8032 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8033 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8034
8035 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8036 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8037 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8038 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8039 functions with identical names in different source files.
8040 @end table
8041
8042 @node Edit
8043 @section Editing Source Files
8044 @cindex editing source files
8045
8046 @kindex edit
8047 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8048 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8049 The editing program of your choice
8050 is invoked with the current line set to
8051 the active line in the program.
8052 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8053 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8054
8055 @table @code
8056 @item edit @var{location}
8057 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8058 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8059 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8060 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8061 command most commonly used:
8062
8063 @table @code
8064 @item edit @var{number}
8065 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8066
8067 @item edit @var{function}
8068 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8069 @end table
8070
8071 @end table
8072
8073 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8074 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8075 @footnote{
8076 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8077 following command-line syntax:
8078 @smallexample
8079 ex +@var{number} file
8080 @end smallexample
8081 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8082 the file where to start editing.}.
8083 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8084 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8085 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8086 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8087 @smallexample
8088 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8089 export EDITOR
8090 gdb @dots{}
8091 @end smallexample
8092 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8093 @smallexample
8094 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8095 gdb @dots{}
8096 @end smallexample
8097
8098 @node Search
8099 @section Searching Source Files
8100 @cindex searching source files
8101
8102 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8103 regular expression.
8104
8105 @table @code
8106 @kindex search
8107 @kindex forward-search
8108 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8109 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8110 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8111 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8112 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8113 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8114 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8115 @code{fo}.
8116
8117 @kindex reverse-search
8118 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8119 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8120 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8121 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8122 this command as @code{rev}.
8123 @end table
8124
8125 @node Source Path
8126 @section Specifying Source Directories
8127
8128 @cindex source path
8129 @cindex directories for source files
8130 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8131 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8132 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8133 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8134 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8135 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8136 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8137
8138 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8139 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8140 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8141 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8142 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8143 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8144 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8145 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8146 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8147 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8148 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8149
8150 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8151 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8152 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8153 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8154 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8155 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8156
8157 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8158 source files.
8159
8160 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8161 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8162 each line is in the file.
8163
8164 @kindex directory
8165 @kindex dir
8166 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8167 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8168 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8169
8170 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8171 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8172
8173 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8174 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8175 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8176 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8177 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8178 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8179 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8180 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8181 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8182 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8183 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8184 name to look up the sources.
8185
8186 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8187 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8188 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8189 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8190 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8191 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8192 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8193 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8194
8195 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8196 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8197 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8198 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8199 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8200 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8201 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8202
8203 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8204 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8205 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8206 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8207 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8208 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8209 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8210 command.
8211
8212 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8213 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8214 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8215 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8216 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8217 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8218 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8219
8220 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8221 @cindex default source path substitution
8222 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8223 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8224 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8225 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8226 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8227 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8228 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8229 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8230 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8231 together.
8232
8233 @table @code
8234 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8235 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8236 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8237 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8238 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8239 part of absolute file names) or
8240 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8241 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8242
8243 @kindex cdir
8244 @kindex cwd
8245 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8246 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8247 @cindex compilation directory
8248 @cindex current directory
8249 @cindex working directory
8250 @cindex directory, current
8251 @cindex directory, compilation
8252 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8253 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8254 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8255 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8256 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8257 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8258
8259 @item directory
8260 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8261
8262 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8263 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8264
8265 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8266 @kindex set directories
8267 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8268 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8269
8270 @item show directories
8271 @kindex show directories
8272 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8273
8274 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8275 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8276 @kindex set substitute-path
8277 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8278 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8279 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8280
8281 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8282 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8283
8284 @smallexample
8285 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8286 @end smallexample
8287
8288 @noindent
8289 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8290 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8291 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8292
8293 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8294 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8295 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8296 the substitution.
8297
8298 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8299
8300 @smallexample
8301 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8302 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8303 @end smallexample
8304
8305 @noindent
8306 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8307 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8308 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8309 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8310
8311
8312 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8313 @kindex unset substitute-path
8314 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8315 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8316 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8317
8318 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8319
8320 @item show substitute-path [path]
8321 @kindex show substitute-path
8322 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8323 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8324
8325 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8326 rules.
8327
8328 @end table
8329
8330 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8331 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8332 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8333
8334 @enumerate
8335 @item
8336 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8337
8338 @item
8339 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8340 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8341 directories in one command.
8342 @end enumerate
8343
8344 @node Machine Code
8345 @section Source and Machine Code
8346 @cindex source line and its code address
8347
8348 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8349 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8350 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8351 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8352 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8353 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8354 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8355 well as hex.
8356
8357 @table @code
8358 @kindex info line
8359 @item info line @var{location}
8360 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8361 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8362 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8363 @end table
8364
8365 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8366 the object code for the first line of function
8367 @code{m4_changequote}:
8368
8369 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8370 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8371 @smallexample
8372 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8373 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8374 @end smallexample
8375
8376 @noindent
8377 @cindex code address and its source line
8378 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8379 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8380 @smallexample
8381 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8382 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8383 @end smallexample
8384
8385 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8386 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8387 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8388 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8389 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8390 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8391 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8392 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8393 Variables}).
8394
8395 @table @code
8396 @kindex disassemble
8397 @cindex assembly instructions
8398 @cindex instructions, assembly
8399 @cindex machine instructions
8400 @cindex listing machine instructions
8401 @item disassemble
8402 @itemx disassemble /m
8403 @itemx disassemble /s
8404 @itemx disassemble /r
8405 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8406 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8407 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8408 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8409 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8410 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8411 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8412 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8413 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8414 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8415
8416 @table @code
8417 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8418 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8419 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8420 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8421 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8422 @end table
8423
8424 @noindent
8425 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8426 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8427
8428 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8429 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8430
8431 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8432 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8433 @end table
8434
8435 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8436 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8437
8438 @smallexample
8439 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8440 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8441 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8442 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8443 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8444 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8445 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8446 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8447 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8448 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8449 End of assembler dump.
8450 @end smallexample
8451
8452 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8453 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8454 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8455
8456 @smallexample
8457 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8458 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8459 5 @{
8460 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8461 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8462 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8463 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8464 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8465
8466 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8467 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8468 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8469
8470 7 return 0;
8471 8 @}
8472 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8473 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8474 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8475
8476 End of assembler dump.
8477 @end smallexample
8478
8479 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8480 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8481 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8482 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8483 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8484 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8485 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8486 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8487 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8488
8489 @file{foo.h}:
8490
8491 @smallexample
8492 int
8493 foo (int a)
8494 @{
8495 if (a < 0)
8496 return a * 2;
8497 if (a == 0)
8498 return 1;
8499 return a + 10;
8500 @}
8501 @end smallexample
8502
8503 @file{foo.c}:
8504
8505 @smallexample
8506 #include "foo.h"
8507 volatile int x, y;
8508 int
8509 main ()
8510 @{
8511 x = foo (y);
8512 return 0;
8513 @}
8514 @end smallexample
8515
8516 @smallexample
8517 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8518 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8519 5 @{
8520
8521 6 x = foo (y);
8522 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8523 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8524
8525 7 return 0;
8526 8 @}
8527 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8528 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8529 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8530 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8531
8532 End of assembler dump.
8533 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8534 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8535 foo.c:
8536 5 @{
8537 6 x = foo (y);
8538 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8539
8540 foo.h:
8541 4 if (a < 0)
8542 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8543 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8544
8545 6 if (a == 0)
8546 7 return 1;
8547 8 return a + 10;
8548 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8549 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8550 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8551 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8552
8553 foo.c:
8554 6 x = foo (y);
8555 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8556
8557 7 return 0;
8558 8 @}
8559 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8560 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8561
8562 foo.h:
8563 5 return a * 2;
8564 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8565 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8566 End of assembler dump.
8567 @end smallexample
8568
8569 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8570
8571 @smallexample
8572 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8573 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8574 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8575 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8576 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8577 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8578 End of assembler dump.
8579 @end smallexample
8580
8581 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8582 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8583 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8584 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8585
8586 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8587 mnemonics or other syntax.
8588
8589 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8590 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8591 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8592 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8593 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8594
8595 @table @code
8596 @kindex set disassembler-options
8597 @cindex disassembler options
8598 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8599 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8600 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8601 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8602 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8603 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8604 The default value is the empty string.
8605
8606 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8607 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8608 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8609 and S/390.
8610
8611 @kindex show disassembler-options
8612 @item show disassembler-options
8613 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8614 @end table
8615
8616 @table @code
8617 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8618 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8619 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8620 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8621 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8622 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8623
8624 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8625 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8626 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8627 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8628
8629 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8630 @item show disassembly-flavor
8631 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8632 @end table
8633
8634 @table @code
8635 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8636 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8637 @item set disassemble-next-line
8638 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8639 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8640 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8641 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8642 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8643 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8644 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8645 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8646 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8647 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8648 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8649 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8650 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8651 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8652 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8653 instruction.
8654 @end table
8655
8656
8657 @node Data
8658 @chapter Examining Data
8659
8660 @cindex printing data
8661 @cindex examining data
8662 @kindex print
8663 @kindex inspect
8664 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8665 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8666 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8667 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8668 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8669 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8670
8671 @table @code
8672 @item print @var{expr}
8673 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8674 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8675 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8676 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8677 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8678 Formats}.
8679
8680 @item print
8681 @itemx print /@var{f}
8682 @cindex reprint the last value
8683 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8684 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8685 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8686 @end table
8687
8688 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8689 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8690 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8691
8692 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8693 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8694 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8695 Table}.
8696
8697 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8698 @kindex explore
8699 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8700 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8701 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8702 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8703 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8704 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8705 embedded in the higher level data types.
8706
8707 @table @code
8708 @item explore @var{arg}
8709 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8710 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8711 @end table
8712
8713 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8714 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8715 C program as
8716
8717 @smallexample
8718 struct SimpleStruct
8719 @{
8720 int i;
8721 double d;
8722 @};
8723
8724 struct ComplexStruct
8725 @{
8726 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8727 int arr[10];
8728 @};
8729 @end smallexample
8730
8731 @noindent
8732 followed by variable declarations as
8733
8734 @smallexample
8735 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8736 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8737 @end smallexample
8738
8739 @noindent
8740 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8741 @code{explore} command as follows.
8742
8743 @smallexample
8744 (gdb) explore cs
8745 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8746 the following fields:
8747
8748 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8749 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8750
8751 Enter the field number of choice:
8752 @end smallexample
8753
8754 @noindent
8755 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8756 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8757 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8758 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8759 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8760 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8761 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8762 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8763
8764 @smallexample
8765 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8766 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8767 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8768 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8769
8770 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8771 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8772
8773 Press enter to return to parent value:
8774 @end smallexample
8775
8776 @noindent
8777 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8778 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8779 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8780 to explore.
8781
8782 @smallexample
8783 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8784 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8785
8786 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8787
8788 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8789
8790 Press enter to return to parent value:
8791 @end smallexample
8792
8793 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8794 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8795 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8796 level data structure).
8797
8798 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8799 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8800 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8801 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8802 same example as above, your can explore the type
8803 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8804 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8805
8806 @smallexample
8807 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8808 @end smallexample
8809
8810 @noindent
8811 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8812 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8813 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8814 example.
8815
8816 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8817 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8818 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8819 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8820 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8821
8822 @table @code
8823 @item explore value @var{expr}
8824 @cindex explore value
8825 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8826 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8827 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8828 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8829 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8830
8831 @item explore type @var{arg}
8832 @cindex explore type
8833 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8834 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8835 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8836 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8837 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8838 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8839 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8840 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8841 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8842 @end table
8843
8844 @menu
8845 * Expressions:: Expressions
8846 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8847 * Variables:: Program variables
8848 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8849 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8850 * Memory:: Examining memory
8851 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8852 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8853 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8854 * Value History:: Value history
8855 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8856 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8857 * Registers:: Registers
8858 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8859 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8860 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8861 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8862 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8863 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8864 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8865 character set than GDB does
8866 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8867 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8868 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8869 @end menu
8870
8871 @node Expressions
8872 @section Expressions
8873
8874 @cindex expressions
8875 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8876 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8877 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8878 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8879 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8880 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8881 @ref{Compilation}.
8882
8883 @cindex arrays in expressions
8884 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8885 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8886 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8887 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8888 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8889 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8890
8891 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8892 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8893 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8894 languages.
8895
8896 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8897 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8898
8899 @cindex casts, in expressions
8900 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8901 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8902 at that address in memory.
8903 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8904
8905 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8906 to programming languages:
8907
8908 @table @code
8909 @item @@
8910 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8911 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8912
8913 @item ::
8914 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8915 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8916
8917 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8918 @cindex type casting memory
8919 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8920 @cindex casts, to view memory
8921 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8922 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8923 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8924 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8925 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8926 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8927 @end table
8928
8929 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8930 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8931 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8932
8933 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8934 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8935 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8936 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8937 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8938 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8939 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8940
8941 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8942 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8943 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8944 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8945 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8946 as well.
8947
8948 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8949 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8950 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8951 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8952 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8953 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8954 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8955 choices.
8956
8957 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8958 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8959 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8960
8961 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8962 @smallexample
8963 @group
8964 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8965 [0] cancel
8966 [1] all
8967 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8968 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8969 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8970 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8971 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8972 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8973 > 2 4 6
8974 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8975 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8976 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8977 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8978 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8979 breakpoints.
8980 (@value{GDBP})
8981 @end group
8982 @end smallexample
8983
8984 @table @code
8985 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8986 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8987 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8988
8989 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8990 is ambiguous.
8991
8992 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8993 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8994 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8995 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8996 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8997 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8998 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8999 in the use of the menu.
9000
9001 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9002 when an ambiguity is detected.
9003
9004 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9005 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9006
9007 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9008 @item show multiple-symbols
9009 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9010 @end table
9011
9012 @node Variables
9013 @section Program Variables
9014
9015 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9016 in your program.
9017
9018 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9019 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9020
9021 @itemize @bullet
9022 @item
9023 global (or file-static)
9024 @end itemize
9025
9026 @noindent or
9027
9028 @itemize @bullet
9029 @item
9030 visible according to the scope rules of the
9031 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9032 @end itemize
9033
9034 @noindent This means that in the function
9035
9036 @smallexample
9037 foo (a)
9038 int a;
9039 @{
9040 bar (a);
9041 @{
9042 int b = test ();
9043 bar (b);
9044 @}
9045 @}
9046 @end smallexample
9047
9048 @noindent
9049 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9050 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9051 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9052 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9053
9054 @cindex variable name conflict
9055 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9056 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9057 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9058 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9059 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9060 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9061 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9062
9063 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9064 @ifnotinfo
9065 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9066 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9067 @end ifnotinfo
9068 @smallexample
9069 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9070 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9071 @end smallexample
9072
9073 @noindent
9074 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9075 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9076 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9077 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9078
9079 @smallexample
9080 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9081 @end smallexample
9082
9083 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9084 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9085 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9086 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9087 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 void
9091 foo (int a)
9092 @{
9093 if (a < 10)
9094 bar (a);
9095 else
9096 process (a); /* Stop here */
9097 @}
9098
9099 int
9100 bar (int a)
9101 @{
9102 foo (a + 5);
9103 @}
9104 @end smallexample
9105
9106 @noindent
9107 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9108 here is what you might see
9109 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9110
9111 @smallexample
9112 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9113 $1 = 10
9114 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9115 $2 = 5
9116 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9117 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9118 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9119 $3 = 5
9120 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9121 $4 = 0
9122 @end smallexample
9123
9124 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9125 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9126 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9127 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9128 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9129
9130 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9131 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9132 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9133 @code{some_global}.
9134
9135 @smallexample
9136 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9137 $1 = 23
9138 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9139 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9140 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9141 $2 = 27
9142 @end smallexample
9143
9144 @cindex wrong values
9145 @cindex variable values, wrong
9146 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9147 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9148 @quotation
9149 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9150 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9151 scope, and just before exit.
9152 @end quotation
9153 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9154 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9155 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9156 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9157 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9158 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9159 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9160 variable definitions may be gone.
9161
9162 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9163 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9164 when compiling.
9165
9166 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9167 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9168 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9169 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9170 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9171 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9172 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9173
9174 @smallexample
9175 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9176 @end smallexample
9177
9178 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9179 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9180 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9181 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9182 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9183
9184 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9185 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9186 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9187 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9188
9189 @cindex no debug info variables
9190 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9191 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9192 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9193 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9194 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9195 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9196 example, in a C program:
9197
9198 @smallexample
9199 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9200 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9201 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9202 $1 = 3.14
9203 @end smallexample
9204
9205 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9206 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9207 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9208 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9209 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9210
9211 @smallexample
9212 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9213 29 i++;
9214 (gdb) next
9215 30 e (i);
9216 (gdb) print i
9217 $1 = 31
9218 (gdb) print i@@entry
9219 $2 = 30
9220 @end smallexample
9221
9222 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9223 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9224 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9225 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9226 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9227 For program code
9228
9229 @smallexample
9230 char var0[] = "A";
9231 signed char var1[] = "A";
9232 @end smallexample
9233
9234 You get during debugging
9235 @smallexample
9236 (gdb) print var0
9237 $1 = "A"
9238 (gdb) print var1
9239 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9240 @end smallexample
9241
9242 @node Arrays
9243 @section Artificial Arrays
9244
9245 @cindex artificial array
9246 @cindex arrays
9247 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9248 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9249 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9250 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9251 program.
9252
9253 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9254 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9255 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9256 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9257 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9258 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9259 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9260 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9261 example. If a program says
9262
9263 @smallexample
9264 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9265 @end smallexample
9266
9267 @noindent
9268 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9269
9270 @smallexample
9271 p *array@@len
9272 @end smallexample
9273
9274 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9275 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9276 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9277 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9278 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9279
9280 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9281 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9282 The value need not be in memory:
9283 @smallexample
9284 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9285 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9286 @end smallexample
9287
9288 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9289 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9290 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9291 @smallexample
9292 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9293 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9294 @end smallexample
9295
9296 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9297 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9298 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9299 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9300 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9301 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9302 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9303 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9304 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9305 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9306
9307 @smallexample
9308 set $i = 0
9309 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9310 @key{RET}
9311 @key{RET}
9312 @dots{}
9313 @end smallexample
9314
9315 @node Output Formats
9316 @section Output Formats
9317
9318 @cindex formatted output
9319 @cindex output formats
9320 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9321 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9322 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9323 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9324 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9325
9326 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9327 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9328 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9329 letters supported are:
9330
9331 @table @code
9332 @item x
9333 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9334 hexadecimal.
9335
9336 @item d
9337 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9338
9339 @item u
9340 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9341
9342 @item o
9343 Print as integer in octal.
9344
9345 @item t
9346 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9347 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9348 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9349 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9350
9351 @item a
9352 @cindex unknown address, locating
9353 @cindex locate address
9354 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9355 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9356 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9357
9358 @smallexample
9359 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9360 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9361 @end smallexample
9362
9363 @noindent
9364 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9365 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9366
9367 @item c
9368 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9369 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9370 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9371 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9372
9373 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9374 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9375 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9376 data.
9377
9378 @item f
9379 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9380 using typical floating point syntax.
9381
9382 @item s
9383 @cindex printing strings
9384 @cindex printing byte arrays
9385 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9386 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9387 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9388 natural types.
9389
9390 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9391 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9392 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9393 array.
9394
9395 @item z
9396 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9397 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9398 to the size of the integer type.
9399
9400 @item r
9401 @cindex raw printing
9402 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9403 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9404 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9405 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9406 pretty-printer which might exist.
9407 @end table
9408
9409 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9410
9411 @smallexample
9412 p/x $pc
9413 @end smallexample
9414
9415 @noindent
9416 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9417 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9418
9419 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9420 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9421 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9422
9423 @node Memory
9424 @section Examining Memory
9425
9426 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9427 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9428
9429 @cindex examining memory
9430 @table @code
9431 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9432 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9433 @itemx x @var{addr}
9434 @itemx x
9435 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9436 @end table
9437
9438 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9439 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9440 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9441 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9442 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9443
9444 @table @r
9445 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9446 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9447 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9448 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9449 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9450 @c 4.1.2.
9451
9452 @item @var{f}, the display format
9453 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9454 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9455 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9456 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9457 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9458
9459 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9460 The unit size is any of
9461
9462 @table @code
9463 @item b
9464 Bytes.
9465 @item h
9466 Halfwords (two bytes).
9467 @item w
9468 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9469 @item g
9470 Giant words (eight bytes).
9471 @end table
9472
9473 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9474 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9475 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9476 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9477 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9478 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9479 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9480 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9481 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9482 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9483 be altered.
9484
9485 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9486 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9487 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9488 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9489 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9490 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9491 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9492 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9493 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9494 a value from memory).
9495 @end table
9496
9497 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9498 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9499 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9500 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9501 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9502
9503 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9504 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9505 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9506
9507 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9508 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9509 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9510 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9511 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9512
9513 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9514 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9515 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9516 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9517 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9518 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9519 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9520 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9521 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9522
9523 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9524 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9525 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9526 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9527 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9528 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9529
9530 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9531 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9532 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9533 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9534 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9535 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9536 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9537
9538 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9539 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9540
9541 @smallexample
9542 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9543 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9544 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9545 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9546 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9547 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9548 @end smallexample
9549
9550 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9551 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9552 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9553 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9554 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9555 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9556 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9557 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9558 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9559
9560 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9561 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9562 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9563
9564 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9565 @cindex addressable memory unit
9566 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9567 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9568 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9569 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9570 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9571 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9572 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9573 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9574 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9575
9576 @cindex remote memory comparison
9577 @cindex target memory comparison
9578 @cindex verify remote memory image
9579 @cindex verify target memory image
9580 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9581 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9582 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9583 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9584 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9585 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9586
9587 @table @code
9588 @kindex compare-sections
9589 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9590 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9591 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9592 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9593 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9594 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9595
9596 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9597 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9598 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9599 @end table
9600
9601 @node Auto Display
9602 @section Automatic Display
9603 @cindex automatic display
9604 @cindex display of expressions
9605
9606 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9607 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9608 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9609 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9610 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9611 The automatic display looks like this:
9612
9613 @smallexample
9614 2: foo = 38
9615 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9616 @end smallexample
9617
9618 @noindent
9619 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9620 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9621 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9622 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9623 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9624 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9625
9626 @table @code
9627 @kindex display
9628 @item display @var{expr}
9629 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9630 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9631
9632 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9633
9634 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9635 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9636 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9637 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9638 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9639
9640 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9641 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9642 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9643 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9644 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9645 @end table
9646
9647 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9648 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9649 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9650
9651 @table @code
9652 @kindex delete display
9653 @kindex undisplay
9654 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9655 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9656 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9657 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9658 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9659 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9660 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9661
9662 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9663 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9664
9665 @kindex disable display
9666 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9667 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9668 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9669 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9670 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9671 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9672 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9673 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9674
9675 @kindex enable display
9676 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9677 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9678 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9679 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9680 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9681 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9682 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9683
9684 @item display
9685 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9686 done when your program stops.
9687
9688 @kindex info display
9689 @item info display
9690 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9691 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9692 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9693 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9694 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9695 @end table
9696
9697 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9698 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9699 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9700 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9701 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9702 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9703 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9704 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9705 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9706 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9707 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9708
9709 @node Print Settings
9710 @section Print Settings
9711
9712 @cindex format options
9713 @cindex print settings
9714 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9715 and symbols are printed.
9716
9717 @noindent
9718 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9719
9720 @table @code
9721 @kindex set print
9722 @item set print address
9723 @itemx set print address on
9724 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9725 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9726 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9727 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9728 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9729 @code{set print address on}:
9730
9731 @smallexample
9732 @group
9733 (@value{GDBP}) f
9734 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9735 at input.c:530
9736 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9737 @end group
9738 @end smallexample
9739
9740 @item set print address off
9741 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9742 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9743
9744 @smallexample
9745 @group
9746 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9747 (@value{GDBP}) f
9748 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9749 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9750 @end group
9751 @end smallexample
9752
9753 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9754 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9755 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9756 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9757
9758 @kindex show print
9759 @item show print address
9760 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9761 @end table
9762
9763 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9764 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9765 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9766 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9767 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9768 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9769 it prints a symbolic address:
9770
9771 @table @code
9772 @item set print symbol-filename on
9773 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9774 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9775 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9776 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9777
9778 @item set print symbol-filename off
9779 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9780 default.
9781
9782 @item show print symbol-filename
9783 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9784 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9785 @end table
9786
9787 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9788 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9789 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9790
9791 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9792 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9793
9794 @table @code
9795 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9796 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9797 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9798 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9799 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9800 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9801 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9802 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9803
9804 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9805 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9806 symbolic address.
9807 @end table
9808
9809 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9810 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9811 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9812 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9813 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9814 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9815 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9816 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9817
9818 @smallexample
9819 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9820 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9821 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9822 @end smallexample
9823
9824 @quotation
9825 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9826 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9827 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9828 @end quotation
9829
9830 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9831 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9832
9833 @table @code
9834 @item set print symbol on
9835 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9836 one exists.
9837
9838 @item set print symbol off
9839 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9840 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9841 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9842
9843 @item show print symbol
9844 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9845 address.
9846 @end table
9847
9848 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9849
9850 @table @code
9851 @item set print array
9852 @itemx set print array on
9853 @cindex pretty print arrays
9854 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9855 but uses more space. The default is off.
9856
9857 @item set print array off
9858 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9859
9860 @item show print array
9861 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9862 arrays.
9863
9864 @cindex print array indexes
9865 @item set print array-indexes
9866 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9867 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9868 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9869 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9870
9871 @item set print array-indexes off
9872 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9873
9874 @item show print array-indexes
9875 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9876 arrays.
9877
9878 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9879 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9880 @cindex number of array elements to print
9881 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9882 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9883 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9884 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9885 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9886 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9887 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9888 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9889
9890 @item show print elements
9891 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9892 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9893
9894 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9895 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9896 @cindex printing frame argument values
9897 @cindex print all frame argument values
9898 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9899 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9900 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9901 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9902 values are:
9903
9904 @table @code
9905 @item all
9906 The values of all arguments are printed.
9907
9908 @item scalars
9909 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9910 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9911 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9912 only scalar arguments are shown:
9913
9914 @smallexample
9915 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9916 at frame-args.c:23
9917 @end smallexample
9918
9919 @item none
9920 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9921 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9922
9923 @smallexample
9924 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9925 at frame-args.c:23
9926 @end smallexample
9927 @end table
9928
9929 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9930 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9931 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9932 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9933 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9934 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9935 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9936 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9937 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9938 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9939
9940 @item show print frame-arguments
9941 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9942
9943 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9944 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9945
9946 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9947 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9948 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9949 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9950 This is the default.
9951
9952 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9953 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9954
9955 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9956 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9957 @kindex set print entry-values
9958 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9959 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9960 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9961 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9962 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9963
9964 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9965 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9966 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9967 @code{no} setting.
9968
9969 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9970 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
9971 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9972 this information.
9973
9974 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9975
9976 @table @code
9977 @item no
9978 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9979 point.
9980 @smallexample
9981 #0 equal (val=5)
9982 #0 different (val=6)
9983 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9984 #0 born (val=10)
9985 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9986 @end smallexample
9987
9988 @item only
9989 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9990 values are never printed.
9991 @smallexample
9992 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9993 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9994 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9995 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9996 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9997 @end smallexample
9998
9999 @item preferred
10000 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10001 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10002 value for such parameter.
10003 @smallexample
10004 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10005 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10006 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10007 #0 born (val=10)
10008 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10009 @end smallexample
10010
10011 @item if-needed
10012 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10013 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10014 parameter.
10015 @smallexample
10016 #0 equal (val=5)
10017 #0 different (val=6)
10018 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10019 #0 born (val=10)
10020 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10021 @end smallexample
10022
10023 @item both
10024 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10025 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10026 optimizations.
10027 @smallexample
10028 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10029 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10030 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10031 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10032 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10033 @end smallexample
10034
10035 @item compact
10036 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10037 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10038 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10039 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10040 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10041 @smallexample
10042 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10043 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10044 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10045 #0 born (val=10)
10046 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10047 @end smallexample
10048
10049 @item default
10050 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10051 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10052 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10053 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10054 @smallexample
10055 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10056 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10057 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10058 #0 born (val=10)
10059 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10060 @end smallexample
10061 @end table
10062
10063 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10064 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10065
10066 @item show print entry-values
10067 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10068 entry.
10069
10070 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10071 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10072 @cindex repeated array elements
10073 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10074 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10075 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10076 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10077 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10078 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10079 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10080 is 10.
10081
10082 @item show print repeats
10083 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10084 elements.
10085
10086 @item set print null-stop
10087 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10088 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10089 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10090 contain only short strings.
10091 The default is off.
10092
10093 @item show print null-stop
10094 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10095 @sc{null} character.
10096
10097 @item set print pretty on
10098 @cindex print structures in indented form
10099 @cindex indentation in structure display
10100 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10101 per line, like this:
10102
10103 @smallexample
10104 @group
10105 $1 = @{
10106 next = 0x0,
10107 flags = @{
10108 sweet = 1,
10109 sour = 1
10110 @},
10111 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10112 @}
10113 @end group
10114 @end smallexample
10115
10116 @item set print pretty off
10117 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10118
10119 @smallexample
10120 @group
10121 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10122 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10123 @end group
10124 @end smallexample
10125
10126 @noindent
10127 This is the default format.
10128
10129 @item show print pretty
10130 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10131
10132 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10133 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10134 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10135 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10136 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10137 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10138 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10139 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10140
10141 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10142 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10143 international character sets, and is the default.
10144
10145 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10146 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10147
10148 @item set print union on
10149 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10150 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10151 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10152
10153 @item set print union off
10154 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10155 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10156 instead.
10157
10158 @item show print union
10159 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10160 structures and other unions.
10161
10162 For example, given the declarations
10163
10164 @smallexample
10165 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10166 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10167 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10168 Bug_forms;
10169
10170 struct thing @{
10171 Species it;
10172 union @{
10173 Tree_forms tree;
10174 Bug_forms bug;
10175 @} form;
10176 @};
10177
10178 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10179 @end smallexample
10180
10181 @noindent
10182 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10183
10184 @smallexample
10185 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10186 @end smallexample
10187
10188 @noindent
10189 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10190
10191 @smallexample
10192 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10193 @end smallexample
10194
10195 @noindent
10196 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10197 and in Pascal.
10198 @end table
10199
10200 @need 1000
10201 @noindent
10202 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10203
10204 @table @code
10205 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10206 @item set print demangle
10207 @itemx set print demangle on
10208 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10209 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10210 linkage. The default is on.
10211
10212 @item show print demangle
10213 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10214
10215 @item set print asm-demangle
10216 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10217 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10218 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10219 The default is off.
10220
10221 @item show print asm-demangle
10222 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10223 or demangled form.
10224
10225 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10226 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10227 @kindex set demangle-style
10228 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10229 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10230 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10231
10232 @table @code
10233 @item auto
10234 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10235 This is the default.
10236
10237 @item gnu
10238 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10239
10240 @item hp
10241 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10242
10243 @item lucid
10244 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10245
10246 @item arm
10247 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10248 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10249 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10250 require further enhancement to permit that.
10251
10252 @end table
10253 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10254
10255 @item show demangle-style
10256 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10257
10258 @item set print object
10259 @itemx set print object on
10260 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10261 @cindex display derived types
10262 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10263 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10264 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10265 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10266 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10267 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10268 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10269
10270 @item set print object off
10271 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10272 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10273
10274 @item show print object
10275 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10276
10277 @item set print static-members
10278 @itemx set print static-members on
10279 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10280 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10281
10282 @item set print static-members off
10283 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10284
10285 @item show print static-members
10286 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10287
10288 @item set print pascal_static-members
10289 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10290 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10291 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10292 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10293
10294 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10295 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10296
10297 @item show print pascal_static-members
10298 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10299
10300 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10301 @item set print vtbl
10302 @itemx set print vtbl on
10303 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10304 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10305 @cindex VTBL display
10306 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10307 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10308 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10309
10310 @item set print vtbl off
10311 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10312
10313 @item show print vtbl
10314 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10315 @end table
10316
10317 @node Pretty Printing
10318 @section Pretty Printing
10319
10320 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10321 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10322 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10323
10324 @menu
10325 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10326 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10327 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10328 @end menu
10329
10330 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10331 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10332
10333 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10334 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10335 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10336
10337 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10338 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10339 pretty-printers with their names.
10340 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10341 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10342 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10343 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10344
10345 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10346 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10347 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10348 do anything special.
10349
10350 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10351
10352 @itemize @bullet
10353 @item
10354 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10355 all inferiors.
10356
10357 @item
10358 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10359 when debugging that program.
10360 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10361
10362 @item
10363 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10364 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10365 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10366 @end itemize
10367
10368 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10369 pretty-printers are selected,
10370
10371 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10372 for new types.
10373
10374 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10375 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10376
10377 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10378
10379 @smallexample
10380 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10381 $1 = @{
10382 static npos = 4294967295,
10383 _M_dataplus = @{
10384 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10385 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10386 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10387 @},
10388 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10389 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10390 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10391 @}
10392 @}
10393 @end smallexample
10394
10395 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10396
10397 @smallexample
10398 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10399 $2 = "abcd"
10400 @end smallexample
10401
10402 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10403 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10404 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10405
10406 @table @code
10407 @kindex info pretty-printer
10408 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10409 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10410 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10411
10412 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10413 whose pretty-printers to list.
10414 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10415 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10416 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10417 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10418 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10419
10420 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10421 to list.
10422
10423 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10424 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10425 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10426 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10427
10428 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10429 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10430 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10431 @end table
10432
10433 Example:
10434
10435 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10436 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10437 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10438 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10439
10440 @smallexample
10441 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10442 library1.so:
10443 foo
10444 library2.so:
10445 bar
10446 bar1
10447 bar2
10448 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10449 library2.so:
10450 bar
10451 bar1
10452 bar2
10453 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10454 1 printer disabled
10455 2 of 3 printers enabled
10456 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10457 library1.so:
10458 foo [disabled]
10459 library2.so:
10460 bar
10461 bar1
10462 bar2
10463 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10464 1 printer disabled
10465 1 of 3 printers enabled
10466 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10467 library1.so:
10468 foo [disabled]
10469 library2.so:
10470 bar
10471 bar1 [disabled]
10472 bar2
10473 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10474 1 printer disabled
10475 0 of 3 printers enabled
10476 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10477 library1.so:
10478 foo [disabled]
10479 library2.so:
10480 bar [disabled]
10481 bar1 [disabled]
10482 bar2
10483 @end smallexample
10484
10485 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10486 as can each individual subprinter.
10487
10488 @node Value History
10489 @section Value History
10490
10491 @cindex value history
10492 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10493 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10494 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10495 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10496 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10497 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10498 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10499 symbol table.
10500
10501 @cindex @code{$}
10502 @cindex @code{$$}
10503 @cindex history number
10504 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10505 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10506 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10507 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10508 history number.
10509
10510 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10511 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10512 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10513 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10514 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10515 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10516 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10517
10518 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10519 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10520
10521 @smallexample
10522 p *$
10523 @end smallexample
10524
10525 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10526 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10527
10528 @smallexample
10529 p *$.next
10530 @end smallexample
10531
10532 @noindent
10533 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10534 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10535
10536 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10537 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10538
10539 @smallexample
10540 print x
10541 set x=5
10542 @end smallexample
10543
10544 @noindent
10545 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10546 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10547
10548 @table @code
10549 @kindex show values
10550 @item show values
10551 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10552 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10553 values} does not change the history.
10554
10555 @item show values @var{n}
10556 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10557
10558 @item show values +
10559 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10560 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10561 @end table
10562
10563 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10564 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10565
10566 @node Convenience Vars
10567 @section Convenience Variables
10568
10569 @cindex convenience variables
10570 @cindex user-defined variables
10571 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10572 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10573 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10574 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10575 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10576
10577 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10578 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10579 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10580 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10581 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10582
10583 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10584 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10585 For example:
10586
10587 @smallexample
10588 set $foo = *object_ptr
10589 @end smallexample
10590
10591 @noindent
10592 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10593 @code{object_ptr}.
10594
10595 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10596 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10597 value with another assignment at any time.
10598
10599 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10600 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10601 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10602 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10603
10604 @table @code
10605 @kindex show convenience
10606 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10607 @item show convenience
10608 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10609 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10610 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10611
10612 @kindex init-if-undefined
10613 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10614 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10615 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10616 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10617 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10618 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10619 override default values used in a command script.
10620
10621 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10622 any side-effects do not occur.
10623 @end table
10624
10625 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10626 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10627 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10628
10629 @smallexample
10630 set $i = 0
10631 print bar[$i++]->contents
10632 @end smallexample
10633
10634 @noindent
10635 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10636
10637 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10638 values likely to be useful.
10639
10640 @table @code
10641 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10642 @item $_
10643 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10644 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10645 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10646 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10647 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10648 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10649 to the type of @code{$__}.
10650
10651 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10652 @item $__
10653 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10654 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10655 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10656
10657 @item $_exitcode
10658 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10659 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10660 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10661 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10662
10663 @item $_exitsignal
10664 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10665 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10666 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10667 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10668
10669 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10670 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10671 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10672 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10673 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10674
10675 @smallexample
10676 #include <signal.h>
10677
10678 int
10679 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10680 @{
10681 raise (SIGALRM);
10682 return 0;
10683 @}
10684 @end smallexample
10685
10686 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10687 or signalled would be:
10688
10689 @smallexample
10690 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10691 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10692 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10693 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10694 >echo The program has exited\n
10695 >else
10696 >echo The program has signalled\n
10697 >end
10698 >end
10699 (@value{GDBP}) run
10700 Starting program:
10701
10702 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10703 The program no longer exists.
10704 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10705 The program has signalled
10706 @end smallexample
10707
10708 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10709 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10710 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10711 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10712
10713 @smallexample
10714 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10715 The program has exited
10716 @end smallexample
10717
10718 @item $_exception
10719 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10720 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10721
10722 @item $_probe_argc
10723 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10724 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10725
10726 @item $_sdata
10727 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10728 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10729 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10730 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10731 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10732
10733 @item $_siginfo
10734 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10735 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10736 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10737 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10738 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10739
10740 @item $_tlb
10741 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10742 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10743 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10744 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10745 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10746 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10747
10748 @item $_inferior
10749 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10750 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10751
10752 @item $_thread
10753 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10754
10755 @item $_gthread
10756 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10757
10758 @end table
10759
10760 @node Convenience Funs
10761 @section Convenience Functions
10762
10763 @cindex convenience functions
10764 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10765 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10766 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10767 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10768 @value{GDBN}.
10769
10770 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10771 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10772
10773 @table @code
10774
10775 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10776 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10777 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10778 returns zero.
10779
10780 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10781 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10782 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10783 it is @code{void}:
10784
10785 @smallexample
10786 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10787 $1 = void
10788 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10789 $2 = 1
10790 (@value{GDBP}) run
10791 Starting program: ./a.out
10792 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10793 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10794 $3 = 0
10795 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10796 $4 = 0
10797 @end smallexample
10798
10799 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10800 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10801 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10802 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10803 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10804 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10805 anymore.
10806
10807 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10808 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10809
10810 @smallexample
10811 void
10812 foo (void)
10813 @{
10814 @}
10815 @end smallexample
10816
10817 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10818
10819 @smallexample
10820 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10821 $1 = void
10822 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10823 $2 = 1
10824 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10825 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10826 $3 = void
10827 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10828 $4 = 1
10829 @end smallexample
10830
10831 @end table
10832
10833 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10834 @code{Python} support.
10835
10836 @table @code
10837
10838 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10839 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10840 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10841 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10842 Otherwise it returns zero.
10843
10844 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10845 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10846 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10847 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10848 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10849 regular expression support.
10850
10851 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10852 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10853 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10854 Otherwise it returns zero.
10855
10856 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10857 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10858 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10859
10860 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10861 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10862 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10863 Otherwise it returns zero.
10864
10865 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10866 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10867 The default is 1.
10868
10869 Example:
10870
10871 @smallexample
10872 (gdb) backtrace
10873 #0 bottom_func ()
10874 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10875 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10876 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10877 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10878 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10879 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10880 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10881 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10882 $1 = 1
10883 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10884 $1 = 1
10885 @end smallexample
10886
10887 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10888 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10889 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10890 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10891
10892 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10893 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10894 The default is 1.
10895
10896 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10897 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10898 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10899 Otherwise it returns zero.
10900
10901 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10902 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10903 The default is 1.
10904
10905 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10906 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10907 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10908 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10909
10910 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10911 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10912 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10913 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10914
10915 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10916 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10917 The default is 1.
10918
10919 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10920 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10921 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10922 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10923
10924 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10925 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10926 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10927
10928 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10929 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10930 an enumerated type:
10931
10932 @smallexample
10933 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10934 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10935 @end smallexample
10936
10937 @end table
10938
10939 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10940 convenience functions.
10941
10942 @table @code
10943 @item help function
10944 @kindex help function
10945 @cindex show all convenience functions
10946 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10947 @end table
10948
10949 @node Registers
10950 @section Registers
10951
10952 @cindex registers
10953 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10954 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10955 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10956 your machine.
10957
10958 @table @code
10959 @kindex info registers
10960 @item info registers
10961 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10962 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10963
10964 @kindex info all-registers
10965 @cindex floating point registers
10966 @item info all-registers
10967 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10968 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10969
10970 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10971 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10972 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10973 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10974 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10975 @end table
10976
10977 @anchor{standard registers}
10978 @cindex stack pointer register
10979 @cindex program counter register
10980 @cindex process status register
10981 @cindex frame pointer register
10982 @cindex standard registers
10983 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10984 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10985 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10986 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10987 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10988 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10989 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10990 you could print the program counter in hex with
10991
10992 @smallexample
10993 p/x $pc
10994 @end smallexample
10995
10996 @noindent
10997 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10998
10999 @smallexample
11000 x/i $pc
11001 @end smallexample
11002
11003 @noindent
11004 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11005 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11006 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11007 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11008 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11009 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11010 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11011
11012 @smallexample
11013 set $sp += 4
11014 @end smallexample
11015
11016 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11017 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11018 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11019 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11020 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11021 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11022 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11023
11024 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11025 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11026 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11027 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11028 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11029 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11030 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11031
11032 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11033 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11034 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11035 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11036 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11037 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11038 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11039 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11040 prints the data in both formats.
11041
11042 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11043 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11044 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11045 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11046 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11047 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11048 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11049
11050 @smallexample
11051 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11052 $1 = @{
11053 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11054 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11055 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11056 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11057 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11058 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11059 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11060 @}
11061 @end smallexample
11062
11063 @noindent
11064 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11065 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11066 value to a @code{struct} member:
11067
11068 @smallexample
11069 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11070 @end smallexample
11071
11072 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11073 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11074 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11075 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11076 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11077 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11078
11079 @cindex caller-saved registers
11080 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11081 @cindex volatile registers
11082 @cindex <not saved> values
11083 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11084 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11085 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11086 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11087 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11088 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11089 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11090 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11091 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11092 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11093 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11094 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11095 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11096 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11097 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11098 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11099 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11100 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11101 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11102 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11103 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11104 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11105 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11106
11107 @node Floating Point Hardware
11108 @section Floating Point Hardware
11109 @cindex floating point
11110
11111 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11112 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11113
11114 @table @code
11115 @kindex info float
11116 @item info float
11117 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11118 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11119 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11120 the ARM and x86 machines.
11121 @end table
11122
11123 @node Vector Unit
11124 @section Vector Unit
11125 @cindex vector unit
11126
11127 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11128 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11129
11130 @table @code
11131 @kindex info vector
11132 @item info vector
11133 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11134 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11135 @end table
11136
11137 @node OS Information
11138 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11139 @cindex OS information
11140
11141 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11142 you debug your program.
11143
11144 @cindex auxiliary vector
11145 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11146 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11147 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11148 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11149 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11150 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11151 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11152 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11153 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11154 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11155 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11156 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11157
11158 @table @code
11159 @kindex info auxv
11160 @item info auxv
11161 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11162 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11163 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11164 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11165 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11166 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11167 an unrecognized tag.
11168 @end table
11169
11170 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11171 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11172 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11173 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11174 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11175 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11176 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11177
11178 @table @code
11179 @kindex info os
11180 @item info os @var{infotype}
11181
11182 Display OS information of the requested type.
11183
11184 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11185
11186 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11187 @table @code
11188 @kindex info os cpus
11189 @item cpus
11190 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11191 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11192 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11193 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11194 kernel initialization.
11195
11196 @kindex info os files
11197 @item files
11198 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11199 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11200 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11201 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11202
11203 @kindex info os modules
11204 @item modules
11205 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11206 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11207 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11208 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11209 in memory.
11210
11211 @kindex info os msg
11212 @item msg
11213 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11214 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11215 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11216 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11217 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11218 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11219 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11220 the message queue was last changed.
11221
11222 @kindex info os processes
11223 @item processes
11224 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11225 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11226 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11227 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11228 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11229 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11230
11231 @kindex info os procgroups
11232 @item procgroups
11233 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11234 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11235 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11236 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11237 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11238 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11239 and the process group leader is listed first.
11240
11241 @kindex info os semaphores
11242 @item semaphores
11243 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11244 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11245 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11246 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11247 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11248
11249 @kindex info os shm
11250 @item shm
11251 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11252 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11253 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11254 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11255 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11256 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11257 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11258
11259 @kindex info os sockets
11260 @item sockets
11261 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11262 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11263 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11264 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11265 connection.
11266
11267 @kindex info os threads
11268 @item threads
11269 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11270 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11271 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11272 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11273 process is not listed.
11274 @end table
11275
11276 @item info os
11277 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11278 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11279 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11280 types, this command will report an error.
11281 @end table
11282
11283 @node Memory Region Attributes
11284 @section Memory Region Attributes
11285 @cindex memory region attributes
11286
11287 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11288 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11289 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11290 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11291 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11292 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11293 user can override the fetched regions.
11294
11295 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11296 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11297 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11298 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11299 all memory.
11300
11301 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11302 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11303
11304 @table @code
11305 @kindex mem
11306 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11307 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11308 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11309 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11310 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11311 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11312
11313 @item mem auto
11314 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11315 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11316
11317 @kindex delete mem
11318 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11319 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11320 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11321
11322 @kindex disable mem
11323 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11324 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11325 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11326 It may be enabled again later.
11327
11328 @kindex enable mem
11329 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11330 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11331
11332 @kindex info mem
11333 @item info mem
11334 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11335 for each region:
11336
11337 @table @emph
11338 @item Memory Region Number
11339 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11340 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11341 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11342
11343 @item Lo Address
11344 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11345
11346 @item Hi Address
11347 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11348
11349 @item Attributes
11350 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11351 @end table
11352 @end table
11353
11354
11355 @subsection Attributes
11356
11357 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11358 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11359 write accesses to a memory region.
11360
11361 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11362 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11363 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11364
11365 @table @code
11366 @item ro
11367 Memory is read only.
11368 @item wo
11369 Memory is write only.
11370 @item rw
11371 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11372 @end table
11373
11374 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11375 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11376 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11377 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11378 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11379
11380 @table @code
11381 @item 8
11382 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11383 @item 16
11384 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11385 @item 32
11386 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11387 @item 64
11388 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11389 @end table
11390
11391 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11392 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11393 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11394 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11395 @c
11396 @c @table @code
11397 @c @item hwbreak
11398 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11399 @c @item swbreak (default)
11400 @c @end table
11401
11402 @subsubsection Data Cache
11403 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11404 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11405 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11406 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11407 registers.
11408
11409 @table @code
11410 @item cache
11411 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11412 @item nocache
11413 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11414 @end table
11415
11416 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11417 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11418 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11419 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11420 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11421
11422 @table @code
11423 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11424 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11425 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11426 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11427 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11428 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11429 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11430 The default value is @code{on}.
11431 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11432 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11433 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11434 @end table
11435
11436
11437 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11438 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11439 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11440 @c
11441 @c @table @code
11442 @c @item verify
11443 @c @item noverify (default)
11444 @c @end table
11445
11446 @node Dump/Restore Files
11447 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11448 @cindex dump/restore files
11449 @cindex append data to a file
11450 @cindex dump data to a file
11451 @cindex restore data from a file
11452
11453 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11454 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11455 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11456 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11457 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11458 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11459 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11460
11461 @table @code
11462
11463 @kindex dump
11464 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11465 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11466 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11467 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11468
11469 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11470 @table @code
11471 @item binary
11472 Raw binary form.
11473 @item ihex
11474 Intel hex format.
11475 @item srec
11476 Motorola S-record format.
11477 @item tekhex
11478 Tektronix Hex format.
11479 @item verilog
11480 Verilog Hex format.
11481 @end table
11482
11483 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11484 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11485 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11486 form.
11487
11488 @kindex append
11489 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11490 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11491 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11492 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11493 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11494
11495 @kindex restore
11496 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11497 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11498 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11499 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11500 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11501
11502 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11503 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11504 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11505 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11506 from that location.
11507
11508 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11509 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11510 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11511 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11512
11513 @end table
11514
11515 @node Core File Generation
11516 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11517 @cindex dump core from inferior
11518
11519 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11520 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11521 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11522 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11523 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11524 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11525 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11526
11527 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11528 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11529 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11530
11531 @table @code
11532 @kindex gcore
11533 @kindex generate-core-file
11534 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11535 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11536 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11537 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11538 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11539 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11540
11541 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11542 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11543
11544 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11545 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11546 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11547
11548 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11549 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11550 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11551 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11552 Enable or disable the use of the file
11553 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11554 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11555 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11556 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11557
11558 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11559 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11560 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11561 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11562 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11563 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11564 about the bits that can be set in the
11565 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11566 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11567
11568 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11569 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11570 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11571 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11572 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11573 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11574 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11575 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11576 @end table
11577
11578 @node Character Sets
11579 @section Character Sets
11580 @cindex character sets
11581 @cindex charset
11582 @cindex translating between character sets
11583 @cindex host character set
11584 @cindex target character set
11585
11586 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11587 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11588 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11589 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11590 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11591 @dfn{target character set}.
11592
11593 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11594 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11595 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11596 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11597 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11598 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11599 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11600 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11601 character and string literals in expressions.
11602
11603 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11604 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11605 target-charset} command, described below.
11606
11607 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11608 support:
11609
11610 @table @code
11611 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11612 @kindex set target-charset
11613 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11614 list of supported target character sets, type
11615 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11616
11617 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11618 @kindex set host-charset
11619 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11620
11621 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11622 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11623 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11624 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11625 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11626
11627 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11628 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11629 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11630
11631 @item set charset @var{charset}
11632 @kindex set charset
11633 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11634 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11635 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11636 for both host and target.
11637
11638 @item show charset
11639 @kindex show charset
11640 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11641
11642 @item show host-charset
11643 @kindex show host-charset
11644 Show the name of the current host character set.
11645
11646 @item show target-charset
11647 @kindex show target-charset
11648 Show the name of the current target character set.
11649
11650 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11651 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11652 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11653 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11654 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11655 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11656
11657 @item show target-wide-charset
11658 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11659 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11660 @end table
11661
11662 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11663 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11664 @file{charset-test.c}:
11665
11666 @smallexample
11667 #include <stdio.h>
11668
11669 char ascii_hello[]
11670 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11671 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11672 char ibm1047_hello[]
11673 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11674 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11675
11676 main ()
11677 @{
11678 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11679 @}
11680 @end smallexample
11681
11682 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11683 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11684 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11685
11686 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11687
11688 @smallexample
11689 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11690 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11691 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11692 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11693 @dots{}
11694 (@value{GDBP})
11695 @end smallexample
11696
11697 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11698 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11699 strings:
11700
11701 @smallexample
11702 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11703 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11704 (@value{GDBP})
11705 @end smallexample
11706
11707 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11708 initial character set:
11709 @smallexample
11710 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11711 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11712 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11713 (@value{GDBP})
11714 @end smallexample
11715
11716 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11717 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11718 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11719 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11720 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11721
11722 @smallexample
11723 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11724 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11725 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11726 $2 = 72 'H'
11727 (@value{GDBP})
11728 @end smallexample
11729
11730 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11731 literals you use in expressions:
11732
11733 @smallexample
11734 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11735 $3 = 43 '+'
11736 (@value{GDBP})
11737 @end smallexample
11738
11739 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11740 character.
11741
11742 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11743 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11744 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11745
11746 @smallexample
11747 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11748 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11749 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11750 $5 = 200 '\310'
11751 (@value{GDBP})
11752 @end smallexample
11753
11754 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11755 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11756
11757 @smallexample
11758 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11759 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11760 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11761 @end smallexample
11762
11763 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11764 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11765 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11766 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11767 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11768
11769 @smallexample
11770 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11771 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11772 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11773 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11774 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11775 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11776 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11777 $7 = 72 '\110'
11778 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11779 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11780 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11781 $9 = 200 'H'
11782 (@value{GDBP})
11783 @end smallexample
11784
11785 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11786 string literals you use in expressions:
11787
11788 @smallexample
11789 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11790 $10 = 78 '+'
11791 (@value{GDBP})
11792 @end smallexample
11793
11794 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11795 character.
11796
11797 @node Caching Target Data
11798 @section Caching Data of Targets
11799 @cindex caching data of targets
11800
11801 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11802 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11803 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11804 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11805 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11806 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11807 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11808 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11809 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11810 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11811 is executing.
11812 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11813 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11814 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11815 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11816 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11817 in the code segment.
11818 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11819 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11820
11821 @table @code
11822 @kindex set remotecache
11823 @item set remotecache on
11824 @itemx set remotecache off
11825 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11826 with old scripts.
11827
11828 @kindex show remotecache
11829 @item show remotecache
11830 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11831
11832 @kindex set stack-cache
11833 @item set stack-cache on
11834 @itemx set stack-cache off
11835 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11836 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11837
11838 @kindex show stack-cache
11839 @item show stack-cache
11840 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11841
11842 @kindex set code-cache
11843 @item set code-cache on
11844 @itemx set code-cache off
11845 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11846 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11847 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11848
11849 @kindex show code-cache
11850 @item show code-cache
11851 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11852 accesses.
11853
11854 @kindex info dcache
11855 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11856 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11857 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11858 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11859 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11860 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11861
11862 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11863 printed in hex.
11864
11865 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11866 @cindex dcache size
11867 @kindex set dcache size
11868 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11869
11870 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11871 @cindex dcache line-size
11872 @kindex set dcache line-size
11873 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11874 Must be a power of 2.
11875
11876 @item show dcache size
11877 @kindex show dcache size
11878 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11879
11880 @item show dcache line-size
11881 @kindex show dcache line-size
11882 Show default size of dcache lines.
11883
11884 @end table
11885
11886 @node Searching Memory
11887 @section Search Memory
11888 @cindex searching memory
11889
11890 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11891 @code{find} command.
11892
11893 @table @code
11894 @kindex find
11895 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11896 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11897 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11898 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11899 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11900 @end table
11901
11902 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11903 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11904
11905 @table @r
11906 @item @var{s}, search query size
11907 The size of each search query value.
11908
11909 @table @code
11910 @item b
11911 bytes
11912 @item h
11913 halfwords (two bytes)
11914 @item w
11915 words (four bytes)
11916 @item g
11917 giant words (eight bytes)
11918 @end table
11919
11920 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11921 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11922 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11923
11924 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11925 value's type in the current language.
11926 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11927 pattern as a mixture of types.
11928 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11929 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11930 which is typically four bytes.
11931
11932 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11933 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11934 @end table
11935
11936 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11937 (@code{"}).
11938 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11939 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11940
11941 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11942 number of matches found.
11943
11944 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11945 @samp{$_}.
11946 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11947
11948 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11949
11950 @smallexample
11951 void
11952 hello ()
11953 @{
11954 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11955 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11956 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11957 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11958 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11959 @}
11960 @end smallexample
11961
11962 @noindent
11963 you get during debugging:
11964
11965 @smallexample
11966 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11967 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11968 1 pattern found
11969 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11970 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11971 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11972 2 patterns found
11973 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11974 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11975 1 pattern found
11976 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11977 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11978 1 pattern found
11979 (gdb) print $numfound
11980 $1 = 1
11981 (gdb) print $_
11982 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11983 @end smallexample
11984
11985 @node Value Sizes
11986 @section Value Sizes
11987
11988 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11989 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11990 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11991 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11992 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11993
11994 @table @code
11995 @kindex set max-value-size
11996 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11997 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11998 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11999 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12000 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12001
12002 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12003 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12004
12005 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12006 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12007 currently 16 bytes.
12008
12009 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12010 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12011 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12012 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12013 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12014 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12015 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12016 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12017
12018 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12019
12020 @kindex show max-value-size
12021 @item show max-value-size
12022 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12023 allocate for the contents of a value.
12024 @end table
12025
12026 @node Optimized Code
12027 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12028 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12029 @cindex debugging optimized code
12030
12031 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12032 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12033 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12034 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12035 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12036 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12037 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12038
12039 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12040 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12041 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12042 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12043
12044 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12045 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12046 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12047 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12048 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12049 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12050
12051 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12052 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12053 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12054 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12055 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12056
12057 @menu
12058 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12059 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12060 @end menu
12061
12062 @node Inline Functions
12063 @section Inline Functions
12064 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12065
12066 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12067 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12068 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12069 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12070 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12071 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12072 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12073 @code{info frame} command.
12074
12075 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12076 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12077 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12078 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12079 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12080 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12081 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12082 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12083 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12084 local variables in the caller.
12085
12086 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12087 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12088 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12089 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12090 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12091 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12092 instructions are executed.
12093
12094 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12095 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12096 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12097 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12098
12099 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12100 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12101
12102 @itemize @bullet
12103 @item
12104 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12105 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12106 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12107 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12108 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12109 or inside the inlined function instead.
12110
12111 @item
12112 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12113 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12114 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12115 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12116
12117 @end itemize
12118
12119 @node Tail Call Frames
12120 @section Tail Call Frames
12121 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12122
12123 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12124 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12125 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12126 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12127 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12128
12129 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12130 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12131 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12132 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12133 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12134 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12135 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12136
12137 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12138 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12139 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12140 this information.
12141
12142 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12143 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12144
12145 @smallexample
12146 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12147 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12148 (gdb) info frame
12149 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12150 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12151 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12152 source language c++.
12153 Arglist at unknown address.
12154 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12155 @end smallexample
12156
12157 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12158 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12159 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12160 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12161 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12162 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12163
12164 @table @code
12165 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12166 @item set debug entry-values
12167 @kindex set debug entry-values
12168 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12169 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12170 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12171 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12172 result.
12173
12174 @item show debug entry-values
12175 @kindex show debug entry-values
12176 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12177 values at function entry and tail calls.
12178 @end table
12179
12180 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12181 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12182 reference by variable @code{x}):
12183
12184 @smallexample
12185 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12186 void (*x) (void) = c;
12187 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12188 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12189 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12190
12191 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12192 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12193 a () at t.c:3
12194 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12195 (gdb) bt
12196 #0 a () at t.c:3
12197 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12198 @end smallexample
12199
12200 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12201
12202 @smallexample
12203 int i;
12204 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12205 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12206 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12207 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12208 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12209 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12210 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12211 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12212
12213 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12214 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12215 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12216 (gdb) bt
12217 #0 f () at t.c:2
12218 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12219 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12220 @end smallexample
12221
12222 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12223 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12224
12225 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12226 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12227 @set ARROW @click{}
12228 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12229 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12230 @end ifset
12231 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12232 @set ARROW ->
12233 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12234 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12235 @end ifclear
12236
12237 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12238 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12239 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12240
12241 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12242 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12243 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12244 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12245 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12246 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12247
12248 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12249 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12250 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12251 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12252 omitted.
12253
12254 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12255 entry may fail:
12256
12257 @smallexample
12258 int v;
12259 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12260 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12261 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12262 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12263 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12264 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12265
12266 (gdb) bt
12267 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12268 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12269 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12270 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12271 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12272 @end smallexample
12273
12274 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12275 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12276 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12277 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12278 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12279
12280 @node Macros
12281 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12282
12283 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12284 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12285 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12286 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12287 where it was defined.
12288
12289 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12290 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12291 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12292 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12293
12294 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12295 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12296 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12297 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12298 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12299 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12300 see @ref{List}.
12301
12302 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12303 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12304 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12305
12306 @table @code
12307
12308 @kindex macro expand
12309 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12310 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12311 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12312 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12313 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12314 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12315 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12316 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12317 it can be any string of tokens.
12318
12319 @kindex macro exp1
12320 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12321 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12322 @cindex expand macro once
12323 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12324 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12325 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12326 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12327 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12328 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12329 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12330 can be any string of tokens.
12331
12332 @kindex info macro
12333 @cindex macro definition, showing
12334 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12335 @cindex macros, from debug info
12336 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12337 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12338 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12339 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12340 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12341 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12342
12343 @kindex info macros
12344 @item info macros @var{location}
12345 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12346 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12347 command-line where those definitions were established.
12348
12349 @kindex macro define
12350 @cindex user-defined macros
12351 @cindex defining macros interactively
12352 @cindex macros, user-defined
12353 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12354 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12355 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12356 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12357 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12358 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12359 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12360 @var{arglist}.
12361
12362 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12363 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12364 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12365 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12366 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12367
12368 @kindex macro undef
12369 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12370 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12371 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12372 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12373 in the program being debugged.
12374
12375 @kindex macro list
12376 @item macro list
12377 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12378 @end table
12379
12380 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12381 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12382 show our source files:
12383
12384 @smallexample
12385 $ cat sample.c
12386 #include <stdio.h>
12387 #include "sample.h"
12388
12389 #define M 42
12390 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12391
12392 main ()
12393 @{
12394 #define N 28
12395 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12396 #undef N
12397 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12398 #define N 1729
12399 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12400 @}
12401 $ cat sample.h
12402 #define Q <
12403 $
12404 @end smallexample
12405
12406 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12407 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12408 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12409 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12410 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12411 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12412 information.
12413
12414 @smallexample
12415 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12416 $
12417 @end smallexample
12418
12419 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12420
12421 @smallexample
12422 $ gdb -nw sample
12423 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12424 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12425 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12426 (@value{GDBP})
12427 @end smallexample
12428
12429 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12430 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12431 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12432
12433 @smallexample
12434 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12435 3
12436 4 #define M 42
12437 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12438 6
12439 7 main ()
12440 8 @{
12441 9 #define N 28
12442 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12443 11 #undef N
12444 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12445 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12446 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12447 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12448 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12449 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12450 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12451 #define Q <
12452 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12453 expands to: (42 + 1)
12454 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12455 expands to: once (M + 1)
12456 (@value{GDBP})
12457 @end smallexample
12458
12459 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12460 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12461 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12462 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12463
12464 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12465 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12466
12467 @smallexample
12468 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12469 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12470 (@value{GDBP}) run
12471 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12472
12473 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12474 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12475 (@value{GDBP})
12476 @end smallexample
12477
12478 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12479
12480 @smallexample
12481 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12482 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12483 #define N 28
12484 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12485 expands to: 28 < 42
12486 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12487 $1 = 1
12488 (@value{GDBP})
12489 @end smallexample
12490
12491 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12492 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12493 thereof) in force at each point:
12494
12495 @smallexample
12496 (@value{GDBP}) next
12497 Hello, world!
12498 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12499 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12500 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12501 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12502 (@value{GDBP}) next
12503 We're so creative.
12504 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12505 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12506 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12507 #define N 1729
12508 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12509 expands to: 1729 < 42
12510 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12511 $2 = 0
12512 (@value{GDBP})
12513 @end smallexample
12514
12515 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12516 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12517 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12518 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12519
12520 @smallexample
12521 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12522 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12523 -D__STDC__=1
12524 (@value{GDBP})
12525 @end smallexample
12526
12527
12528 @node Tracepoints
12529 @chapter Tracepoints
12530 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12531 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12532
12533 @cindex tracepoints
12534 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12535 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12536 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12537 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12538 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12539 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12540 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12541
12542 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12543 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12544 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12545 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12546 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12547 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12548 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12549 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12550 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12551 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12552 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12553
12554 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12555 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12556 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12557 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12558 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12559 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12560 Packets}.
12561
12562 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12563 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12564 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12565
12566 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12567
12568 @menu
12569 * Set Tracepoints::
12570 * Analyze Collected Data::
12571 * Tracepoint Variables::
12572 * Trace Files::
12573 @end menu
12574
12575 @node Set Tracepoints
12576 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12577
12578 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12579 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12580 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12581 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12582 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12583 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12584 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12585
12586 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12587 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12588 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12589 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12590 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12591 tracepoint was hit.
12592
12593 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12594 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12595 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12596 either.
12597
12598 @cindex fast tracepoints
12599 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12600 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12601 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12602
12603 @cindex static tracepoints
12604 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12605 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12606 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12607 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12608 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12609 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12610 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12611 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12612 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12613 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12614 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12615 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12616 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12617 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12618 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12619 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12620 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12621 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12622 static tracepoint marker.
12623
12624 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12625 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12626
12627 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12628 conditions and actions.
12629
12630 @menu
12631 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12632 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12633 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12634 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12635 * Trace State Variables::
12636 * Tracepoint Actions::
12637 * Listing Tracepoints::
12638 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12639 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12640 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12641 @end menu
12642
12643 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12644 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12645
12646 @table @code
12647 @cindex set tracepoint
12648 @kindex trace
12649 @item trace @var{location}
12650 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12651 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12652 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12653 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12654 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12655 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12656 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12657 in tracing}).
12658 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12659 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12660 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12661 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12662 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12663 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12664 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12665 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12666 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12667 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12668 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12669 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12670
12671 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12672
12673 @smallexample
12674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12675
12676 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12677
12678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12679
12680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12681
12682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12683 @end smallexample
12684
12685 @noindent
12686 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12687
12688 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12689 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12690 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12691 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12692 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12693 information on tracepoint conditions.
12694
12695 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12696 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12697 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12698 @kindex ftrace
12699 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12700 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12701 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12702 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12703 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12704 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12705 message.
12706
12707 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12708 @code{trace}.
12709
12710 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12711 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12712 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12713 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12714 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12715 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12716 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12717 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12718
12719 @example
12720 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12721 @end example
12722
12723 @noindent
12724 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12725 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12726
12727 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12728 @cindex set static tracepoint
12729 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12730 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12731 @kindex strace
12732 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12733 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12734 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12735 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12736 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12737
12738 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12739 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12740 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12741 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12742 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12743 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12744 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12745 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12746 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12747 tracing engine:
12748
12749 @smallexample
12750 main ()
12751 @{
12752 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12753 @}
12754 @end smallexample
12755
12756 @noindent
12757 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12758 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12759
12760 @smallexample
12761 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12762 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12763 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12764 Data: "str %s"
12765 [etc...]
12766 @end smallexample
12767
12768 @noindent
12769 so you may probe the marker above with:
12770
12771 @smallexample
12772 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12773 @end smallexample
12774
12775 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12776 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12777 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12778 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12779 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12780 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12781 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12782 the @samp{Data:} field.
12783
12784 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12785 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12786 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12787
12788 @vindex $tpnum
12789 @cindex last tracepoint number
12790 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12791 @cindex tracepoint number
12792 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12793 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12794
12795 @kindex delete tracepoint
12796 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12797 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12798 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12799 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12800 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12801
12802 Examples:
12803
12804 @smallexample
12805 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12806
12807 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12808 @end smallexample
12809
12810 @noindent
12811 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12812 @end table
12813
12814 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12815 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12816
12817 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12818
12819 @table @code
12820 @kindex disable tracepoint
12821 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12822 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12823 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12824 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12825 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12826 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12827 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12828 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12829 next trace experiment.
12830
12831 @kindex enable tracepoint
12832 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12833 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12834 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12835 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12836 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12837 next time a trace experiment is run.
12838 @end table
12839
12840 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12841 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12842
12843 @table @code
12844 @kindex passcount
12845 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12846 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12847 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12848 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12849 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12850 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12851 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12852 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12853 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12854 user.
12855
12856 Examples:
12857
12858 @smallexample
12859 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12860 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12861
12862 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12863 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12864 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12865 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12866 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12867 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12868 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12869 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12870 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12871 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12872 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12873 @end smallexample
12874 @end table
12875
12876 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12877 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12878 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12879 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12880
12881 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12882 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12883 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12884 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12885 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12886 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12887 is true.
12888
12889 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12890 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12891 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12892 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12893 just as with breakpoints.
12894
12895 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12896 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12897 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12898 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12899 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12900 accesses, and so forth.
12901
12902 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12903 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12904 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12905 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12906 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12907 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12908 search through.
12909
12910 @smallexample
12911 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12912 @end smallexample
12913
12914 @node Trace State Variables
12915 @subsection Trace State Variables
12916 @cindex trace state variables
12917
12918 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12919 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12920 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12921 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12922 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12923 integers.
12924
12925 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12926 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12927 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12928 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12929
12930 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12931 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12932 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12933 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12934 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12935 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12936 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12937 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12938 variable with the same name.
12939
12940 @table @code
12941
12942 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12943 @kindex tvariable
12944 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12945 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12946 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12947 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12948 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12949 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12950 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12951 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12952 value. The default initial value is 0.
12953
12954 @item info tvariables
12955 @kindex info tvariables
12956 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12957 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12958 currently running.
12959
12960 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12961 @kindex delete tvariable
12962 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12963 are specified.
12964
12965 @end table
12966
12967 @node Tracepoint Actions
12968 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12969
12970 @table @code
12971 @kindex actions
12972 @cindex tracepoint actions
12973 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12974 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12975 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12976 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12977 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12978 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12979 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12980 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12981 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12982 @code{while-stepping}.
12983
12984 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12985 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12986 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12987
12988 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12989 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12990 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12991
12992 @smallexample
12993 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12994
12995 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12996
12997 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12998 @end smallexample
12999
13000 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13001 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13002 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13003 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13004 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13005 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13006 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13007 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13008
13009 @smallexample
13010 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13011 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13012 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13013 > collect bar,baz
13014 > collect $regs
13015 > while-stepping 12
13016 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13017 > end
13018 end
13019 @end smallexample
13020
13021 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13022 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13023 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13024 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13025 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13026 special arguments are supported:
13027
13028 @table @code
13029 @item $regs
13030 Collect all registers.
13031
13032 @item $args
13033 Collect all function arguments.
13034
13035 @item $locals
13036 Collect all local variables.
13037
13038 @item $_ret
13039 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13040 of a backtrace.
13041
13042 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13043 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13044 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13045 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13046 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13047 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13048
13049 @item $_probe_argc
13050 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13051 tracepoint is located.
13052 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13053
13054 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13055 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13056 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13057 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13058
13059 @item $_sdata
13060 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13061 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13062 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13063 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13064 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13065 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13066 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13067 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13068 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13069
13070 @smallexample
13071 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13072 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13073 @end smallexample
13074
13075 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13076 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13077 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13078 @value{GDBN}.
13079 @end table
13080
13081 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13082 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13083 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13084
13085 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13086 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13087 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13088 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13089 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13090 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13091 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13092 @samp{mystr}.
13093
13094 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13095 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13096
13097 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13098 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13099 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13100 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13101 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13102 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13103 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13104 action were used.
13105
13106 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13107 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13108 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13109 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13110 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13111 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13112
13113 @smallexample
13114 > while-stepping 12
13115 > collect $regs, myglobal
13116 > end
13117 >
13118 @end smallexample
13119
13120 @noindent
13121 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13122 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13123 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13124 @code{stepping}.
13125
13126 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13127 @kindex set default-collect
13128 @cindex default collection action
13129 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13130 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13131 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13132 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13133 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13134 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13135
13136 @item show default-collect
13137 @kindex show default-collect
13138 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13139 tracepoint hit.
13140
13141 @end table
13142
13143 @node Listing Tracepoints
13144 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13145
13146 @table @code
13147 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13148 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13149 @cindex information about tracepoints
13150 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13151 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13152 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13153 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13154 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13155 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13156
13157 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13158 tracing:
13159
13160 @itemize @bullet
13161 @item
13162 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13163
13164 @item
13165 the state about installed on target of each location
13166 @end itemize
13167
13168 @smallexample
13169 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13170 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13171 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13172 while-stepping 20
13173 collect globfoo, $regs
13174 end
13175 collect globfoo2
13176 end
13177 pass count 1200
13178 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13179 collect $eip
13180 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13181 installed on target
13182 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13183 installed on target
13184 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13185 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13186 not installed on target
13187 (@value{GDBP})
13188 @end smallexample
13189
13190 @noindent
13191 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13192 @end table
13193
13194 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13195 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13196
13197 @table @code
13198 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13199 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13200 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13201 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13202 program.
13203
13204 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13205
13206 @table @emph
13207 @item Count
13208 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13209 stable identifier.
13210 @item ID
13211 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13212 @item Enabled or Disabled
13213 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13214 that are not enabled.
13215 @item Address
13216 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13217 @item What
13218 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13219 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13220 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13221 will be left blank.
13222 @end table
13223
13224 @noindent
13225 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13226
13227 @table @emph
13228 @item Data
13229 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13230 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13231 marker call.
13232 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13233 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13234 @end table
13235
13236 @smallexample
13237 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13238 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13239 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13240 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13241 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13242 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13243 Data: str %s
13244 (@value{GDBP})
13245 @end smallexample
13246 @end table
13247
13248 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13249 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13250
13251 @table @code
13252 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13253 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13254 @cindex collected data discarded
13255 @item tstart
13256 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13257 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13258 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13259 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13260 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13261 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13262 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13263 information, and so forth.
13264
13265 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13266 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13267 @item tstop
13268 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13269 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13270 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13271 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13272 needs to be stopped quickly.
13273
13274 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13275 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13276 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13277
13278 @kindex tstatus
13279 @cindex status of trace data collection
13280 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13281 @item tstatus
13282 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13283 collection.
13284 @end table
13285
13286 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13287
13288 @smallexample
13289 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13290 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13291 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13292 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13293 > while-stepping 11
13294 > collect $regs
13295 > end
13296 > end
13297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13298 [time passes @dots{}]
13299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13300 @end smallexample
13301
13302 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13303 @cindex disconnected tracing
13304 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13305 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13306 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13307 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13308 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13309 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13310 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13311 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13312
13313 @table @code
13314 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13315 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13316 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13317 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13318 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13319 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13320 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13321 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13322
13323 @item show disconnected-tracing
13324 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13325 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13326
13327 @end table
13328
13329 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13330 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13331 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13332 it will continue after reconnection.
13333
13334 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13335 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13336 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13337 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13338 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13339 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13340 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13341 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13342 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13343 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13344
13345 @cindex circular trace buffer
13346 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13347 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13348 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13349 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13350 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13351 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13352 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13353 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13354 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13355 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13356 the next run.
13357
13358 @table @code
13359 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13360 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13361 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13362 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13363 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13364 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13365 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13366
13367 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13368 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13369 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13370 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13371 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13372 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13373
13374 @end table
13375
13376 @table @code
13377 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13378 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13379 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13380 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13381 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13382 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13383 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13384 likes. This is also the default.
13385
13386 @item show trace-buffer-size
13387 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13388 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13389 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13390 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13391 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13392 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13393 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13394 @end table
13395
13396 @table @code
13397 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13398 @kindex set trace-user
13399
13400 @item show trace-user
13401 @kindex show trace-user
13402
13403 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13404 @kindex set trace-notes
13405 Set the trace run's notes.
13406
13407 @item show trace-notes
13408 @kindex show trace-notes
13409 Show the trace run's notes.
13410
13411 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13412 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13413 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13414 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13415 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13416
13417 @item show trace-stop-notes
13418 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13419 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13420
13421 @end table
13422
13423 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13424 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13425
13426 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13427 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13428 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13429 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13430 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13431 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13432 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13433 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13434 mentioned here.
13435
13436 @itemize @bullet
13437
13438 @item
13439 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13440 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13441 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13442 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13443 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13444 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13445 cannot be collected either.
13446
13447 @item
13448 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13449 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13450 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13451 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13452 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13453 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13454 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13455 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13456 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13457 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13458
13459 @item
13460 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13461 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13462 in a misleading way.
13463
13464 @item
13465 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13466 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13467 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13468 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13469 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13470 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13471 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13472 by @code{ptr}.
13473
13474 @item
13475 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13476 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13477 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13478 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13479 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13480 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13481 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13482 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13483 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13484 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13485 invalid address.
13486
13487 @item
13488 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13489 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13490 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13491 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13492 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13493 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13494 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13495 it to zero.
13496
13497 @end itemize
13498
13499 @node Analyze Collected Data
13500 @section Using the Collected Data
13501
13502 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13503 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13504 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13505 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13506 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13507 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13508 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13509 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13510 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13511 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13512 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13513 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13514 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13515 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13516 the buffer will fail.
13517
13518 @menu
13519 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13520 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13521 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13522 @end menu
13523
13524 @node tfind
13525 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13526
13527 @kindex tfind
13528 @cindex select trace snapshot
13529 @cindex find trace snapshot
13530 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13531 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13532 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13533 snapshot is selected.
13534
13535 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13536
13537 @table @code
13538 @item tfind start
13539 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13540 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13541
13542 @item tfind none
13543 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13544
13545 @item tfind end
13546 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13547
13548 @item tfind
13549 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13550 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13551
13552 @item tfind -
13553 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13554 retracing earlier steps.
13555
13556 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13557 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13558 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13559 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13560 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13561
13562 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13563 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13564 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13565 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13566 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13567
13568 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13569 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13570 addresses (exclusive).
13571
13572 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13573 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13574 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13575
13576 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13577 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13578 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13579 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13580 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13581 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13582 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13583 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13584 @end table
13585
13586 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13587 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13588 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13589 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13590 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13591 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13592 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13593 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13594 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13595 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13596 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13597 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13598 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13599 tracepoint as the current one.
13600
13601 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13602 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13603 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13604 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13605 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13606
13607 @smallexample
13608 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13609 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13610 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13611 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13612 > tfind
13613 > end
13614
13615 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13616 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13617 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13618 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13619 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13620 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13621 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13622 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13623 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13624 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13625 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13626 @end smallexample
13627
13628 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13629 the buffer:
13630
13631 @smallexample
13632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13634 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13635 > tfind line
13636 > end
13637
13638 Frame 0, X = 1
13639 Frame 7, X = 2
13640 Frame 13, X = 255
13641 @end smallexample
13642
13643 @node tdump
13644 @subsection @code{tdump}
13645 @kindex tdump
13646 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13647 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13648
13649 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13650 the current trace snapshot.
13651
13652 @smallexample
13653 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13655 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13656 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13657 > end
13658
13659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13660
13661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13662 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13663 at gdb_test.c:444
13664 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13665
13666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13667 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13668 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13669 d1 0x18 24
13670 d2 0x80 128
13671 d3 0x33 51
13672 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13673 d5 0x22 34
13674 d6 0xe0 224
13675 d7 0x380035 3670069
13676 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13677 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13678 a2 0x100 256
13679 a3 0x322000 3284992
13680 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13681 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13682 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13683 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13684 ps 0x0 0
13685 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13686 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13687 fpstatus 0x0 0
13688 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13689 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13690 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13691 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13692 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13693 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13694 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13695 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13696 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13697
13698 (@value{GDBP})
13699 @end smallexample
13700
13701 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13702 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13703 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13704 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13705
13706 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13707 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13708 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13709 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13710 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13711 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13712 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13713 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13714 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13715 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13716
13717 @node save tracepoints
13718 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13719 @kindex save tracepoints
13720 @kindex save-tracepoints
13721 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13722
13723 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13724 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13725 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13726 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13727 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13728 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13729
13730 @node Tracepoint Variables
13731 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13732 @cindex tracepoint variables
13733 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13734
13735 @table @code
13736 @vindex $trace_frame
13737 @item (int) $trace_frame
13738 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13739 snapshot is selected.
13740
13741 @vindex $tracepoint
13742 @item (int) $tracepoint
13743 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13744
13745 @vindex $trace_line
13746 @item (int) $trace_line
13747 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13748
13749 @vindex $trace_file
13750 @item (char []) $trace_file
13751 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13752
13753 @vindex $trace_func
13754 @item (char []) $trace_func
13755 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13756 @end table
13757
13758 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13759 use @code{output} instead.
13760
13761 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13762 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13763 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13764 which are managed by the target.
13765
13766 @smallexample
13767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13768
13769 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13770 > output $trace_file
13771 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13772 > tfind
13773 > end
13774 @end smallexample
13775
13776 @node Trace Files
13777 @section Using Trace Files
13778 @cindex trace files
13779
13780 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13781 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13782 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13783 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13784 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13785
13786 @table @code
13787
13788 @kindex tsave
13789 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13790 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13791 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13792 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13793 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13794 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13795 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13796 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13797 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13798 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13799 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13800 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13801 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13802 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13803 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13804
13805 @kindex target tfile
13806 @kindex tfile
13807 @kindex target ctf
13808 @kindex ctf
13809 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13810 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13811 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13812 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13813 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13814 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13815 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13816 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13817 the host.
13818
13819 @smallexample
13820 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13821 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13822 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13823 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13824 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13825 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13826 i = 0
13827 a = 0
13828 b = 1 '\001'
13829 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13830 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13831 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13832 $1 = 1
13833 @end smallexample
13834
13835 @end table
13836
13837 @node Overlays
13838 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13839 @cindex overlays
13840
13841 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13842 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13843 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13844 use overlays.
13845
13846 @menu
13847 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13848 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13849 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13850 mapped by asking the inferior.
13851 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13852 @end menu
13853
13854 @node How Overlays Work
13855 @section How Overlays Work
13856 @cindex mapped overlays
13857 @cindex unmapped overlays
13858 @cindex load address, overlay's
13859 @cindex mapped address
13860 @cindex overlay area
13861
13862 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13863 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13864 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13865 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13866 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13867
13868 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13869 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13870 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13871 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13872 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13873 largest overlay as well.
13874
13875 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13876 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13877 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13878 there.
13879
13880 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13881 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13882 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13883
13884 @smallexample
13885 @group
13886 Data Instruction Larger
13887 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13888 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13889 | | | | | |
13890 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13891 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13892 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13893 | and heap | | | | | |
13894 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13895 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13896 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13897 | | | | | |
13898 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13899 address | | | | | |
13900 | overlay | <-' | | |
13901 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13902 | | <---. | | load address
13903 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13904 | | | |
13905 +-----------+ | |
13906 +-----------+
13907 | |
13908 +-----------+
13909
13910 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13911 @end group
13912 @end smallexample
13913
13914 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13915 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13916 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13917 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13918 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13919 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13920 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13921 program and the overlay area.
13922
13923 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13924 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13925 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13926 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13927 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13928 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13929 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13930
13931 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13932 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13933 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13934
13935 @itemize @bullet
13936
13937 @item
13938 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13939 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13940 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13941 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13942
13943 @item
13944 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13945 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13946 your program's performance.
13947
13948 @item
13949 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13950 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13951 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13952 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13953 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13954 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13955 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13956
13957 @item
13958 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13959 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13960 instruction and data spaces.
13961
13962 @end itemize
13963
13964 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13965 improved in many ways:
13966
13967 @itemize @bullet
13968
13969 @item
13970 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13971 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13972 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13973 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13974 area in the usual way.
13975
13976 @item
13977 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13978 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13979
13980 @item
13981 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13982 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13983 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13984 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13985 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13986 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13987 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13988
13989 @end itemize
13990
13991
13992 @node Overlay Commands
13993 @section Overlay Commands
13994
13995 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13996 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13997 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13998 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13999 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14000 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14001
14002 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14003 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14004
14005 @table @code
14006 @item overlay off
14007 @kindex overlay
14008 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14009 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14010 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14011 overlay support is disabled.
14012
14013 @item overlay manual
14014 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14015 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14016 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14017 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14018 commands described below.
14019
14020 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14021 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14022 @cindex map an overlay
14023 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14024 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14025 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14026 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14027 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14028 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14029
14030 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14031 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14032 @cindex unmap an overlay
14033 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14034 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14035 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14036 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14037
14038 @item overlay auto
14039 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14040 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14041 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14042 Overlay Debugging}.
14043
14044 @item overlay load-target
14045 @itemx overlay load
14046 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14047 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14048 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14049 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14050 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14051 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14052
14053 @item overlay list-overlays
14054 @itemx overlay list
14055 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14056 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14057 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14058
14059 @end table
14060
14061 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14062 of the function the address falls in:
14063
14064 @smallexample
14065 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14066 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14067 @end smallexample
14068 @noindent
14069 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14070 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14071 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14072 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14073
14074 @smallexample
14075 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14076 No sections are mapped.
14077 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14078 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14079 @end smallexample
14080 @noindent
14081 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14082 name normally:
14083
14084 @smallexample
14085 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14086 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14087 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14088 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14089 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14090 @end smallexample
14091
14092 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14093 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14094 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14095 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14096 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14097
14098 @itemize @bullet
14099 @item
14100 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14101 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14102 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14103 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14104 @item
14105 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14106 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14107 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14108 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14109 breakpoints properly.
14110 @end itemize
14111
14112
14113 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14114 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14115 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14116
14117 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14118 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14119 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14120 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14121 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14122 current state of the overlays.
14123
14124 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14125 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14126
14127 @table @asis
14128
14129 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14130 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14131
14132 @smallexample
14133 struct
14134 @{
14135 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14136 unsigned long vma;
14137
14138 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14139 unsigned long size;
14140
14141 /* The overlay's load address. */
14142 unsigned long lma;
14143
14144 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14145 zero otherwise. */
14146 unsigned long mapped;
14147 @}
14148 @end smallexample
14149
14150 @item @code{_novlys}:
14151 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14152 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14153
14154 @end table
14155
14156 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14157 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14158 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14159 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14160 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14161 currently mapped.
14162
14163 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14164 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14165 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14166 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14167 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14168 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14169 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14170 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14171 are not being executed.
14172
14173 @node Overlay Sample Program
14174 @section Overlay Sample Program
14175 @cindex overlay example program
14176
14177 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14178 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14179 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14180 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14181 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14182 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14183 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14184
14185 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14186 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14187 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14188 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14189
14190 @table @file
14191 @item overlays.c
14192 The main program file.
14193 @item ovlymgr.c
14194 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14195 @item foo.c
14196 @itemx bar.c
14197 @itemx baz.c
14198 @itemx grbx.c
14199 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14200 @item d10v.ld
14201 @itemx m32r.ld
14202 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14203 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14204 @end table
14205
14206 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14207 cross-compiler like this:
14208
14209 @smallexample
14210 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14211 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14212 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14213 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14214 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14215 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14216 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14217 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14218 @end smallexample
14219
14220 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14221 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14222 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14223
14224
14225 @node Languages
14226 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14227 @cindex languages
14228
14229 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14230 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14231 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14232 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14233 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14234 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14235
14236 @cindex working language
14237 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14238 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14239 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14240 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14241 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14242 language}.
14243
14244 @menu
14245 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14246 * Show:: Displaying the language
14247 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14248 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14249 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14250 @end menu
14251
14252 @node Setting
14253 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14254
14255 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14256 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14257 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14258 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14259 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14260 are printed, etc.
14261
14262 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14263 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14264 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14265 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14266 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14267 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14268 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14269 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14270 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14271 Displaying the Language}.
14272
14273 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14274 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14275 another language. In that case, make the
14276 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14277 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14278 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14279
14280 @menu
14281 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14282 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14283 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14284 @end menu
14285
14286 @node Filenames
14287 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14288
14289 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14290 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14291
14292 @table @file
14293 @item .ada
14294 @itemx .ads
14295 @itemx .adb
14296 @itemx .a
14297 Ada source file.
14298
14299 @item .c
14300 C source file
14301
14302 @item .C
14303 @itemx .cc
14304 @itemx .cp
14305 @itemx .cpp
14306 @itemx .cxx
14307 @itemx .c++
14308 C@t{++} source file
14309
14310 @item .d
14311 D source file
14312
14313 @item .m
14314 Objective-C source file
14315
14316 @item .f
14317 @itemx .F
14318 Fortran source file
14319
14320 @item .mod
14321 Modula-2 source file
14322
14323 @item .s
14324 @itemx .S
14325 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14326 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14327 @end table
14328
14329 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14330 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14331
14332 @node Manually
14333 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14334
14335 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14336 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14337 your program.
14338
14339 @kindex set language
14340 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14341 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14342 a language, such as
14343 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14344 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14345
14346 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14347 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14348 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14349 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14350 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14351 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14352 command such as:
14353
14354 @smallexample
14355 print a = b + c
14356 @end smallexample
14357
14358 @noindent
14359 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14360 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14361 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14362 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14363
14364 @node Automatically
14365 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14366
14367 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14368 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14369 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14370 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14371 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14372 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14373 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14374 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14375 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14376
14377 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14378 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14379 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14380 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14381 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14382
14383 @node Show
14384 @section Displaying the Language
14385
14386 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14387 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14388
14389 @table @code
14390 @item show language
14391 @anchor{show language}
14392 @kindex show language
14393 Display the current working language. This is the
14394 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14395 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14396
14397 @item info frame
14398 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14399 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14400 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14401 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14402 information listed here.
14403
14404 @item info source
14405 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14406 Display the source language of this source file.
14407 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14408 information listed here.
14409 @end table
14410
14411 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14412 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14413 with a language explicitly:
14414
14415 @table @code
14416 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14417 @kindex set extension-language
14418 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14419 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14420
14421 @item info extensions
14422 @kindex info extensions
14423 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14424 @end table
14425
14426 @node Checks
14427 @section Type and Range Checking
14428
14429 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14430 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14431 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14432 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14433 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14434 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14435 errors when your program is running.
14436
14437 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14438 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14439 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14440 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14441
14442 @menu
14443 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14444 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14445 @end menu
14446
14447 @cindex type checking
14448 @cindex checks, type
14449 @node Type Checking
14450 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14451
14452 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14453 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14454 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14455 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14456
14457 @smallexample
14458 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14459
14460 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14461 $1 = 2
14462 @exdent but
14463 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14464 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14465 @end smallexample
14466
14467 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14468 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14469
14470 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14471 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14472 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14473 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14474 expressions like the second example above.
14475
14476 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14477 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14478 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14479 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14480 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14481 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14482
14483 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14484
14485 @kindex set check type
14486 @kindex show check type
14487 @table @code
14488 @item set check type on
14489 @itemx set check type off
14490 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14491 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14492 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14493
14494 @item show check type
14495 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14496 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14497 @end table
14498
14499 @cindex range checking
14500 @cindex checks, range
14501 @node Range Checking
14502 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14503
14504 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14505 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14506 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14507 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14508 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14509
14510 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14511 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14512 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14513 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14514
14515 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14516 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14517 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14518 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14519 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14520 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14521
14522 @smallexample
14523 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14524 @end smallexample
14525
14526 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14527 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14528 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14529
14530 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14531
14532 @kindex set check range
14533 @kindex show check range
14534 @table @code
14535 @item set check range auto
14536 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14537 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14538 each language.
14539
14540 @item set check range on
14541 @itemx set check range off
14542 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14543 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14544 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14545 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14546
14547 @item set check range warn
14548 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14549 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14550 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14551 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14552 systems).
14553
14554 @item show range
14555 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14556 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14557 @end table
14558
14559 @node Supported Languages
14560 @section Supported Languages
14561
14562 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14563 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14564 @c This is false ...
14565 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14566 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14567 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14568 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14569 language.
14570
14571 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14572 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14573 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14574 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14575 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14576 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14577 language reference or tutorial.
14578
14579 @menu
14580 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14581 * D:: D
14582 * Go:: Go
14583 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14584 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14585 * Fortran:: Fortran
14586 * Pascal:: Pascal
14587 * Rust:: Rust
14588 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14589 * Ada:: Ada
14590 @end menu
14591
14592 @node C
14593 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14594
14595 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14596 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14597
14598 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14599 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14600 together.
14601
14602 @cindex C@t{++}
14603 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14604 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14605 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14606 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14607 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14608 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14609 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14610
14611 @menu
14612 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14613 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14614 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14615 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14616 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14617 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14618 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14619 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14620 @end menu
14621
14622 @node C Operators
14623 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14624
14625 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14626
14627 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14628 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14629 often defined on groups of types.
14630
14631 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14632
14633 @itemize @bullet
14634
14635 @item
14636 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14637 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14638
14639 @item
14640 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14641 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14642
14643 @item
14644 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14645
14646 @item
14647 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14648
14649 @end itemize
14650
14651 @noindent
14652 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14653 in order of increasing precedence:
14654
14655 @table @code
14656 @item ,
14657 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14658 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14659 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14660
14661 @item =
14662 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14663 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14664
14665 @item @var{op}=
14666 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14667 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14668 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14669 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14670 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14671
14672 @item ?:
14673 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14674 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14675 should be of an integral type.
14676
14677 @item ||
14678 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14679
14680 @item &&
14681 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14682
14683 @item |
14684 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14685
14686 @item ^
14687 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14688
14689 @item &
14690 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14691
14692 @item ==@r{, }!=
14693 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14694 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14695
14696 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14697 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14698 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14699 and non-zero for true.
14700
14701 @item <<@r{, }>>
14702 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14703
14704 @item @@
14705 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14706
14707 @item +@r{, }-
14708 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14709 pointer types.
14710
14711 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14712 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14713 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14714 integral types.
14715
14716 @item ++@r{, }--
14717 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14718 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14719 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14720 operation takes place.
14721
14722 @item *
14723 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14724 @code{++}.
14725
14726 @item &
14727 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14728
14729 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14730 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14731 to examine the address
14732 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14733 stored.
14734
14735 @item -
14736 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14737 precedence as @code{++}.
14738
14739 @item !
14740 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14741 @code{++}.
14742
14743 @item ~
14744 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14745 @code{++}.
14746
14747
14748 @item .@r{, }->
14749 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14750 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14751 pointer based on the stored type information.
14752 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14753
14754 @item .*@r{, }->*
14755 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14756
14757 @item []
14758 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14759 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14760
14761 @item ()
14762 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14763
14764 @item ::
14765 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14766 and @code{class} types.
14767
14768 @item ::
14769 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14770 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14771 above.
14772 @end table
14773
14774 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14775 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14776 predefined meaning.
14777
14778 @node C Constants
14779 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14780
14781 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14782
14783 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14784 following ways:
14785
14786 @itemize @bullet
14787 @item
14788 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14789 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14790 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14791 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14792 @code{long} value.
14793
14794 @item
14795 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14796 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14797 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14798 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14799 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14800 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14801 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14802 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14803 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14804 constant.
14805
14806 @item
14807 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14808 integral equivalents.
14809
14810 @item
14811 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14812 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14813 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14814 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14815 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14816 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14817 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14818 @samp{\n} for newline.
14819
14820 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14821 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14822 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14823 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14824
14825 @item
14826 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14827 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14828 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14829 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14830 characters.
14831
14832 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14833 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14834 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14835
14836 @item
14837 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14838 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14839
14840 @item
14841 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14842 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14843 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14844 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14845 @end itemize
14846
14847 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14848 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14849
14850 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14851 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14852
14853 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14854 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14855 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14856 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14857 @quotation
14858 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14859 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14860 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14861 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14862 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14863 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14864 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14865 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14866 @end quotation
14867
14868 @enumerate
14869
14870 @cindex member functions
14871 @item
14872 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14873
14874 @smallexample
14875 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14876 @end smallexample
14877
14878 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14879 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14880 @item
14881 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14882 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14883 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14884 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14885 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14886
14887 @cindex call overloaded functions
14888 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14889 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14890 @item
14891 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14892 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14893 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14894 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14895 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14896 default arguments.
14897
14898 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14899 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14900 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14901 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14902 number of function arguments.
14903
14904 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14905 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14906 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14907
14908 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14909 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14910 @smallexample
14911 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14912 @end smallexample
14913
14914 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14915 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14916
14917 @cindex reference declarations
14918 @item
14919 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14920 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14921 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14922
14923 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14924 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14925 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14926 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14927 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14928
14929 @item
14930 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14931 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14932 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14933 necessary, for example in an expression like
14934 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14935 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14936 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14937
14938 @item
14939 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14940 specification.
14941 @end enumerate
14942
14943 @node C Defaults
14944 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14945
14946 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14947
14948 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14949 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14950 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14951 selects the working language.
14952
14953 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14954 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14955 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14956 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14957 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14958 for further details.
14959
14960 @node C Checks
14961 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14962
14963 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14964
14965 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14966 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14967 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14968 constants to pointers.
14969
14970 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14971 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14972 that is not itself an array.
14973
14974 @node Debugging C
14975 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14976
14977 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14978 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14979 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14980 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14981
14982 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14983 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14984 ,Expressions}.
14985
14986 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14987 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14988
14989 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14990
14991 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14992 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14993
14994 @table @code
14995 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14996 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14997 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14998 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14999 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15000 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15001
15002 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15003 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15004 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15005 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15006 classes.
15007 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15008
15009 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15010 @item catch throw
15011 @itemx catch rethrow
15012 @itemx catch catch
15013 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15014 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15015
15016 @cindex inheritance
15017 @item ptype @var{typename}
15018 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15019 @var{typename}.
15020 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15021
15022 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15023 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15024 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15025 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15026 multiple inheritance is in use.
15027
15028 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15029 @item demangle @var{name}
15030 Demangle @var{name}.
15031 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15032
15033 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15034 @item set print demangle
15035 @itemx show print demangle
15036 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15037 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15038 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15039 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15040 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15041
15042 @item set print object
15043 @itemx show print object
15044 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15045 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15046
15047 @item set print vtbl
15048 @itemx show print vtbl
15049 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15050 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15051 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15052 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15053
15054 @kindex set overload-resolution
15055 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15056 @item set overload-resolution on
15057 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15058 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15059 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15060 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15061 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15062 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15063
15064 @item set overload-resolution off
15065 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15066 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15067 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15068 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15069 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15070 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15071 argument types.
15072
15073 @kindex show overload-resolution
15074 @item show overload-resolution
15075 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15076
15077 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15078 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15079 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15080 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15081 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15082 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15083 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15084 @end table
15085
15086 @node Decimal Floating Point
15087 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15088 @cindex decimal floating point format
15089
15090 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15091 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15092 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15093 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15094
15095 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15096 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15097 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15098 configured target.
15099
15100 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15101 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15102 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15103
15104 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15105 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15106 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15107
15108 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15109 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15110 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15111
15112 @node D
15113 @subsection D
15114
15115 @cindex D
15116 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15117 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15118 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15119
15120 @node Go
15121 @subsection Go
15122
15123 @cindex Go (programming language)
15124 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15125 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15126
15127 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15128
15129 @table @code
15130 @cindex current Go package
15131 @item The current Go package
15132 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15133 specifying global variables and functions.
15134
15135 For example, given the program:
15136
15137 @example
15138 package main
15139 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15140 func main () @{
15141 // ...
15142 @}
15143 @end example
15144
15145 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15146
15147 @example
15148 (gdb) p myglob
15149 (gdb) p main.myglob
15150 @end example
15151
15152 @cindex builtin Go types
15153 @item Builtin Go types
15154 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15155 as a string.
15156
15157 @cindex builtin Go functions
15158 @item Builtin Go functions
15159 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15160 function and handles it internally.
15161
15162 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15163 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15164 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15165 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15166 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15167 @end table
15168
15169 @node Objective-C
15170 @subsection Objective-C
15171
15172 @cindex Objective-C
15173 This section provides information about some commands and command
15174 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15175 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15176 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15177
15178 @menu
15179 * Method Names in Commands::
15180 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15181 @end menu
15182
15183 @node Method Names in Commands
15184 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15185
15186 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15187 names as line specifications:
15188
15189 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15190 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15191 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15192 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15193 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15194 @itemize
15195 @item @code{clear}
15196 @item @code{break}
15197 @item @code{info line}
15198 @item @code{jump}
15199 @item @code{list}
15200 @end itemize
15201
15202 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15203
15204 @smallexample
15205 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15206 @end smallexample
15207
15208 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15209 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15210 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15211 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15212 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15213 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15214 debugged, enter:
15215
15216 @smallexample
15217 break -[Fruit create]
15218 @end smallexample
15219
15220 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15221 enter:
15222
15223 @smallexample
15224 list +[NSText initialize]
15225 @end smallexample
15226
15227 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15228 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15229 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15230 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15231
15232 @smallexample
15233 break create
15234 @end smallexample
15235
15236 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15237 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15238 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15239 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15240 none apply.
15241
15242 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15243 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15244
15245 @smallexample
15246 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15247 @end smallexample
15248
15249 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15250 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15251 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15252 @kindex print-object
15253 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15254
15255 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15256
15257 @smallexample
15258 print -[@var{object} hash]
15259 @end smallexample
15260
15261 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15262 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15263 @noindent
15264 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15265 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15266 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15267 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15268 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15269 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15270
15271 @node OpenCL C
15272 @subsection OpenCL C
15273
15274 @cindex OpenCL C
15275 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15276
15277 @menu
15278 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15279 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15280 * OpenCL C Operators::
15281 @end menu
15282
15283 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15284 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15285
15286 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15287 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15288 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15289 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15290 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15291
15292 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15293 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15294
15295 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15296 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15297 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15298 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15299
15300 @node OpenCL C Operators
15301 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15302
15303 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15304 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15305 vector data types.
15306
15307 @node Fortran
15308 @subsection Fortran
15309 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15310
15311 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15312 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15313
15314 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15315 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15316 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15317 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15318 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15319 underscore.
15320
15321 @menu
15322 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15323 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15324 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15325 @end menu
15326
15327 @node Fortran Operators
15328 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15329
15330 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15331
15332 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15333 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15334 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15335
15336 @table @code
15337 @item **
15338 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15339 of the second one.
15340
15341 @item :
15342 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15343 represent a section of array.
15344
15345 @item %
15346 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15347 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15348 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15349 union type.
15350 @end table
15351
15352 @node Fortran Defaults
15353 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15354
15355 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15356
15357 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15358 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15359 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15360 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15361
15362 @node Special Fortran Commands
15363 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15364
15365 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15366
15367 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15368 such as displaying common blocks.
15369
15370 @table @code
15371 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15372 @kindex info common
15373 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15374 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15375 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15376 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15377 printed.
15378 @end table
15379
15380 @node Pascal
15381 @subsection Pascal
15382
15383 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15384 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15385 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15386 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15387 syntax.
15388
15389 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15390 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15391 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15392
15393 @node Rust
15394 @subsection Rust
15395
15396 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15397 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15398 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15399 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15400
15401 @itemize @bullet
15402 @item
15403 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15404 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15405 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15406
15407 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15408 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15409 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15410 @samp{B}.
15411
15412 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15413 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15414
15415 @item
15416 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15417 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15418 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15419 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15420 @samp{K::x::y}.
15421
15422 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15423 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15424 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15425 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15426 scope.
15427
15428 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15429 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15430
15431 @item
15432 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15433 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15434
15435 @item
15436 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15437
15438 @item
15439 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15440 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15441 never be destroyed.
15442
15443 @item
15444 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15445 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15446 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15447
15448 @item
15449 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15450 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15451 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15452 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15453 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15454 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15455 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15456 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15457
15458 @item
15459 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15460 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15461 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15462 @itemize @bullet
15463
15464 @item
15465 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15466
15467 @item
15468 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15469
15470 @item
15471 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15472
15473 @item
15474 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15475 type names.
15476
15477 @item
15478 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15479
15480 @item
15481 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15482 available in the crate.
15483 @end itemize
15484 @end itemize
15485
15486 @node Modula-2
15487 @subsection Modula-2
15488
15489 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15490
15491 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15492 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15493 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15494 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15495 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15496 table.
15497
15498 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15499 @menu
15500 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15501 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15502 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15503 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15504 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15505 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15506 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15507 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15508 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15509 @end menu
15510
15511 @node M2 Operators
15512 @subsubsection Operators
15513 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15514
15515 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15516 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15517 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15518 following definitions hold:
15519
15520 @itemize @bullet
15521
15522 @item
15523 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15524 their subranges.
15525
15526 @item
15527 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15528
15529 @item
15530 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15531
15532 @item
15533 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15534 @var{type}}.
15535
15536 @item
15537 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15538
15539 @item
15540 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15541
15542 @item
15543 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15544 @end itemize
15545
15546 @noindent
15547 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15548 increasing precedence:
15549
15550 @table @code
15551 @item ,
15552 Function argument or array index separator.
15553
15554 @item :=
15555 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15556 @var{value}.
15557
15558 @item <@r{, }>
15559 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15560 types.
15561
15562 @item <=@r{, }>=
15563 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15564 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15565 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15566
15567 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15568 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15569 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15570 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15571 comment character.
15572
15573 @item IN
15574 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15575 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15576
15577 @item OR
15578 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15579
15580 @item AND@r{, }&
15581 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15582
15583 @item @@
15584 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15585
15586 @item +@r{, }-
15587 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15588 and difference on set types.
15589
15590 @item *
15591 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15592 on set types.
15593
15594 @item /
15595 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15596 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15597
15598 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15599 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15600 precedence as @code{*}.
15601
15602 @item -
15603 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15604
15605 @item ^
15606 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15607
15608 @item NOT
15609 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15610 @code{^}.
15611
15612 @item .
15613 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15614 precedence as @code{^}.
15615
15616 @item []
15617 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15618
15619 @item ()
15620 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15621 as @code{^}.
15622
15623 @item ::@r{, }.
15624 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15625 @end table
15626
15627 @quotation
15628 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15629 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15630 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15631 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15632 @end quotation
15633
15634
15635 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15636 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15637 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15638
15639 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15640 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15641
15642 @table @var
15643
15644 @item a
15645 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15646
15647 @item c
15648 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15649
15650 @item i
15651 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15652
15653 @item m
15654 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15655 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15656 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15657
15658 @item n
15659 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15660
15661 @item r
15662 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15663
15664 @item t
15665 represents a type.
15666
15667 @item v
15668 represents a variable.
15669
15670 @item x
15671 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15672 explanation of the function for details.
15673 @end table
15674
15675 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15676
15677 @table @code
15678 @item ABS(@var{n})
15679 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15680
15681 @item CAP(@var{c})
15682 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15683 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15684
15685 @item CHR(@var{i})
15686 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15687
15688 @item DEC(@var{v})
15689 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15690
15691 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15692 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15693 new value.
15694
15695 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15696 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15697 set.
15698
15699 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15700 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15701
15702 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15703 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15704
15705 @item INC(@var{v})
15706 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15707
15708 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15709 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15710 new value.
15711
15712 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15713 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15714 there. Returns the new set.
15715
15716 @item MAX(@var{t})
15717 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15718
15719 @item MIN(@var{t})
15720 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15721
15722 @item ODD(@var{i})
15723 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15724
15725 @item ORD(@var{x})
15726 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15727 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15728 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15729 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15730
15731 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15732 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15733 variable or a type.
15734
15735 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15736 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15737
15738 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15739 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15740 variable or a type.
15741
15742 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15743 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15744 @end table
15745
15746 @quotation
15747 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15748 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15749 an error.
15750 @end quotation
15751
15752 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15753 @node M2 Constants
15754 @subsubsection Constants
15755
15756 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15757 ways:
15758
15759 @itemize @bullet
15760
15761 @item
15762 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15763 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15764 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15765 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15766
15767 @item
15768 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15769 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15770 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15771 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15772 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15773 digits.
15774
15775 @item
15776 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15777 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15778 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15779 followed by a @samp{C}.
15780
15781 @item
15782 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15783 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15784 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15785 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15786 sequences.
15787
15788 @item
15789 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15790
15791 @item
15792 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15793 @code{FALSE}.
15794
15795 @item
15796 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15797
15798 @item
15799 Set constants are not yet supported.
15800 @end itemize
15801
15802 @node M2 Types
15803 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15804 @cindex Modula-2 types
15805
15806 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15807 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15808 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15809 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15810 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15811 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15812
15813 The first example contains the following section of code:
15814
15815 @smallexample
15816 VAR
15817 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15818 r: [20..40] ;
15819 @end smallexample
15820
15821 @noindent
15822 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15823 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15824
15825 @smallexample
15826 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15827 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15828 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15829 SET OF CHAR
15830 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15831 21
15832 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15833 [20..40]
15834 @end smallexample
15835
15836 @noindent
15837 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15838
15839 @smallexample
15840 VAR
15841 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15842 @end smallexample
15843
15844 @noindent
15845 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15846
15847 @smallexample
15848 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15849 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15850 @end smallexample
15851
15852 @noindent
15853 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15854 expressions using the debugger.
15855
15856 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15857 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15858
15859 @smallexample
15860 VAR
15861 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15862 @end smallexample
15863
15864 @smallexample
15865 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15866 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15867 @end smallexample
15868
15869 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15870 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15871 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15872 above.
15873
15874 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15875
15876 @smallexample
15877 TYPE
15878 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15879 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15880 VAR
15881 s: t ;
15882 BEGIN
15883 s := blue ;
15884 @end smallexample
15885
15886 @noindent
15887 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15888 and value of a variable.
15889
15890 @smallexample
15891 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15892 $1 = blue
15893 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15894 type = [blue..yellow]
15895 @end smallexample
15896
15897 @noindent
15898 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15899 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15900 their @code{C} counterparts.
15901
15902 @smallexample
15903 VAR
15904 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15905 BEGIN
15906 s[1] := 1 ;
15907 @end smallexample
15908
15909 @smallexample
15910 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15911 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15912 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15913 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15914 @end smallexample
15915
15916 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15917 pointer types as shown in this example:
15918
15919 @smallexample
15920 VAR
15921 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15922 BEGIN
15923 NEW(s) ;
15924 s^[1] := 1 ;
15925 @end smallexample
15926
15927 @noindent
15928 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15929
15930 @smallexample
15931 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15932 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15933 @end smallexample
15934
15935 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15936 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15937 types:
15938
15939 @smallexample
15940 TYPE
15941 foo = RECORD
15942 f1: CARDINAL ;
15943 f2: CHAR ;
15944 f3: myarray ;
15945 END ;
15946
15947 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15948 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15949 VAR
15950 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15951 @end smallexample
15952
15953 @noindent
15954 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15955 below.
15956
15957 @smallexample
15958 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15959 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15960 f1 : CARDINAL;
15961 f2 : CHAR;
15962 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15963 END
15964 @end smallexample
15965
15966 @node M2 Defaults
15967 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15968 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15969
15970 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15971 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15972 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15973 selected the working language.
15974
15975 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15976 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15977 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15978 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15979
15980 @node Deviations
15981 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15982 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15983
15984 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15985 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15986
15987 @itemize @bullet
15988 @item
15989 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15990 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15991 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15992 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15993 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15994 returned a pointer.)
15995
15996 @item
15997 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15998 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15999 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16000 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16001
16002 @item
16003 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16004 argument.
16005
16006 @item
16007 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16008 @end itemize
16009
16010 @node M2 Checks
16011 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16012 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16013
16014 @quotation
16015 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16016 range checking.
16017 @end quotation
16018 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16019
16020 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16021
16022 @itemize @bullet
16023 @item
16024 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16025 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16026
16027 @item
16028 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16029 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16030 @end itemize
16031
16032 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16033 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16034
16035 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16036 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16037
16038 @node M2 Scope
16039 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16040 @cindex scope
16041 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16042 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16043 @ifinfo
16044 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16045 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16046 @end ifinfo
16047 @ifnotinfo
16048 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16049 @end ifnotinfo
16050
16051 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16052 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16053 similar syntax:
16054
16055 @smallexample
16056
16057 @var{module} . @var{id}
16058 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16059 @end smallexample
16060
16061 @noindent
16062 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16063 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16064 identifier within your program, except another module.
16065
16066 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16067 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16068 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16069 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16070
16071 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16072 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16073 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16074 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16075 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16076 @var{module}.
16077
16078 @node GDB/M2
16079 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16080
16081 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16082 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16083 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16084 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16085 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16086 analogue in Modula-2.
16087
16088 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16089 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16090 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16091 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16092 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16093 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16094
16095 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16096 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16097 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16098
16099 @node Ada
16100 @subsection Ada
16101 @cindex Ada
16102
16103 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16104 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16105 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16106 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16107 to be difficult.
16108
16109
16110 @cindex expressions in Ada
16111 @menu
16112 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16113 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16114 in @value{GDBN}.
16115 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16116 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16117 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16118 subprograms.
16119 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16120 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16121 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16122 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16123 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16124 Profile
16125 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16126 @end menu
16127
16128 @node Ada Mode Intro
16129 @subsubsection Introduction
16130 @cindex Ada mode, general
16131
16132 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16133 syntax, with some extensions.
16134 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16135
16136 @itemize @bullet
16137 @item
16138 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16139 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16140 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16141 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16142
16143 @item
16144 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16145 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16146
16147 @item
16148 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16149 @end itemize
16150
16151 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16152 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16153 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16154 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16155 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16156
16157 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16158 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16159 was translated from an Ada source file.
16160
16161 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16162 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16163 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16164 middle (to allow based literals).
16165
16166 @node Omissions from Ada
16167 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16168 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16169
16170 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16171
16172 @itemize @bullet
16173 @item
16174 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16175
16176 @itemize @minus
16177 @item
16178 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16179 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16180
16181 @item
16182 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16183
16184 @item
16185 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16186
16187 @item
16188 @t{'Tag}.
16189
16190 @item
16191 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16192 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16193
16194 @item
16195 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16196 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16197
16198 @item
16199 @t{'Address}.
16200 @end itemize
16201
16202 @item
16203 The names in
16204 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16205 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16206 not currently available.
16207
16208 @item
16209 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16210 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16211 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16212 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16213 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16214 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16215 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16216 indeterminate values.
16217
16218 @item
16219 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16220 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16221 are not implemented.
16222
16223 @item
16224 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16225 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16226 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16227 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16228 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16229
16230 @smallexample
16231 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16232 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16233 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16234 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16235 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16236 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16237 @end smallexample
16238
16239 Changing a
16240 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16241 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16242 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16243 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16244 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16245 declared to have a type such as:
16246
16247 @smallexample
16248 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16249 Id : Integer;
16250 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16251 end record;
16252 @end smallexample
16253
16254 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16255 assignments:
16256
16257 @smallexample
16258 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16259 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16260 @end smallexample
16261
16262 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16263 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16264 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16265 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16266 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16267 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16268 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16269 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16270
16271 @item
16272 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16273
16274 @item
16275 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16276 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16277 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16278 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16279 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16280 the proper resolution.
16281
16282 @item
16283 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16284
16285 @item
16286 Entry calls are not implemented.
16287
16288 @item
16289 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16290 formats are not supported.
16291
16292 @item
16293 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16294
16295 @item
16296 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16297 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16298 context.
16299 Should your program
16300 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16301 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16302 @end itemize
16303
16304 @node Additions to Ada
16305 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16306 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16307
16308 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16309 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16310
16311 @itemize @bullet
16312 @item
16313 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16314 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16315 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16316 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16317 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16318 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16319 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16320 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16321
16322 @item
16323 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16324 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16325 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16326
16327 @item
16328 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16329 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16330
16331 @item
16332 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16333 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16334 @end itemize
16335
16336 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16337 additions specific to Ada:
16338
16339 @itemize @bullet
16340 @item
16341 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16342 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16343
16344 @smallexample
16345 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16346 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16347 @end smallexample
16348
16349 @item
16350 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16351 the value of its right-hand operand.
16352 This allows, for example,
16353 complex conditional breaks:
16354
16355 @smallexample
16356 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16357 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16358 @end smallexample
16359
16360 @item
16361 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16362 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16363 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16364 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16365 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16366 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16367 in strings. For example,
16368 @smallexample
16369 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16370 @end smallexample
16371 @noindent
16372 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16373 after each period.
16374
16375 @item
16376 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16377 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16378 to write
16379
16380 @smallexample
16381 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16382 @end smallexample
16383
16384 @item
16385 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16386 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16387 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16388 of 3 might print as
16389
16390 @smallexample
16391 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16392 @end smallexample
16393
16394 @noindent
16395 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16396 clause.
16397
16398 @item
16399 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16400 multi-character subsequence of
16401 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16402 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16403 in place of @t{a'length}.
16404
16405 @item
16406 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16407 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16408 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16409 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16410 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16411 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16412 For example,
16413 @smallexample
16414 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16415 @end smallexample
16416
16417 @item
16418 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16419 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16420 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16421 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16422 object.
16423
16424 @end itemize
16425
16426 @node Overloading support for Ada
16427 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16428 @cindex overloading, Ada
16429
16430 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16431 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16432 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16433 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16434 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16435 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16436
16437 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16438 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16439 use, for instance:
16440
16441 @smallexample
16442 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16443 Multiple matches for f
16444 [0] cancel
16445 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16446 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16447 >
16448 @end smallexample
16449
16450 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16451 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16452 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16453
16454 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16455 case:
16456
16457 @table @code
16458
16459 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16460 @item set ada print-signatures
16461 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16462 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16463 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16464
16465 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16466 @item show ada print-signatures
16467 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16468 overloads selection menu.
16469 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16470
16471 @end table
16472
16473 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16474 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16475
16476 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16477 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16478 before reaching the main procedure.
16479 As defined in the Ada Reference
16480 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16481 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16482 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16483 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16484
16485 @node Ada Exceptions
16486 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16487
16488 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16489
16490 @table @code
16491 @kindex info exceptions
16492 @item info exceptions
16493 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16494 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16495 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16496 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16497 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16498 @end table
16499
16500 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16501 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16502 argument.
16503
16504 @smallexample
16505 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16506 All defined Ada exceptions:
16507 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16508 program_error: 0x613d20
16509 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16510 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16511 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16512 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16513 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16514 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16515 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16516 @end smallexample
16517
16518 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16519 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16520
16521 @node Ada Tasks
16522 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16523 @cindex Ada, tasking
16524
16525 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16526 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16527
16528 @table @code
16529 @kindex info tasks
16530 @item info tasks
16531 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16532
16533
16534 @smallexample
16535 @iftex
16536 @leftskip=0.5cm
16537 @end iftex
16538 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16539 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16540 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16541 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16542 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16543 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16544
16545 @end smallexample
16546
16547 @noindent
16548 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16549 task currently being inspected.
16550
16551 @table @asis
16552 @item ID
16553 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16554
16555 @item TID
16556 The Ada task ID.
16557
16558 @item P-ID
16559 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16560
16561 @item Pri
16562 The base priority of the task.
16563
16564 @item State
16565 Current state of the task.
16566
16567 @table @code
16568 @item Unactivated
16569 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16570 executing.
16571
16572 @item Runnable
16573 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16574 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16575
16576 @item Terminated
16577 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16578 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16579 terminated themselves.
16580
16581 @item Child Activation Wait
16582 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16583
16584 @item Accept Statement
16585 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16586
16587 @item Waiting on entry call
16588 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16589
16590 @item Async Select Wait
16591 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16592 select statement.
16593
16594 @item Delay Sleep
16595 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16596 alternative open.
16597
16598 @item Child Termination Wait
16599 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16600 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16601 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16602
16603 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16604 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16605 finish terminating.
16606
16607 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16608 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16609 @end table
16610
16611 @item Name
16612 Name of the task in the program.
16613
16614 @end table
16615
16616 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16617 @item info task @var{taskno}
16618 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16619 the following example:
16620 @smallexample
16621 @iftex
16622 @leftskip=0.5cm
16623 @end iftex
16624 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16625 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16626 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16627 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16628 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16629 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16630 Name: task_1
16631 Thread: 0x807f378
16632 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16633 Base Priority: 15
16634 State: Runnable
16635 @end smallexample
16636
16637 @item task
16638 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16639 @cindex current Ada task ID
16640 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16641
16642 @smallexample
16643 @iftex
16644 @leftskip=0.5cm
16645 @end iftex
16646 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16647 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16648 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16649 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16650 (@value{GDBP}) task
16651 [Current task is 2]
16652 @end smallexample
16653
16654 @item task @var{taskno}
16655 @cindex Ada task switching
16656 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16657 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16658 from the current task to the given task.
16659
16660 @smallexample
16661 @iftex
16662 @leftskip=0.5cm
16663 @end iftex
16664 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16665 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16666 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16667 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16668 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16669 [Switching to task 1]
16670 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16671 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16672 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16673 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16674 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16675 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16676 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16677 @end smallexample
16678
16679 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16680 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16681 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16682 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16683 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16684 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16685 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16686 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16687 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16688
16689 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16690 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16691 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16692 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16693 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16694
16695 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16696 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16697 program.
16698
16699 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16700 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16701 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16702
16703 For example,
16704
16705 @smallexample
16706 @iftex
16707 @leftskip=0.5cm
16708 @end iftex
16709 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16710 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16711 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16712 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16713 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16714 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16715 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16716 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16717 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16718 Continuing.
16719 task # 1 running
16720 task # 2 running
16721
16722 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16723 15 flush;
16724 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16725 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16726 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16727 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16728 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16729 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16730 @end smallexample
16731 @end table
16732
16733 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16734 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16735 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16736
16737 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16738 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16739 the platform being used.
16740 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16741 switching is not supported.
16742
16743 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16744 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16745 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16746 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16747 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16748 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16749
16750 @node Ravenscar Profile
16751 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16752 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16753
16754 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16755 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16756 requirements.
16757
16758 @table @code
16759 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16760 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16761 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16762 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16763 Profile. This is the default.
16764
16765 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16766 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16767 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16768 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16769 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16770 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16771 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16772
16773 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16774 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16775 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16776 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16777
16778 @end table
16779
16780 @node Ada Glitches
16781 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16782 @cindex Ada, problems
16783
16784 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16785 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16786 @value{GDBN},
16787 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16788 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16789
16790 @itemize @bullet
16791 @item
16792 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16793 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16794
16795 @item
16796 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16797 argument lists are treated as positional).
16798
16799 @item
16800 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16801
16802 @item
16803 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16804 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16805 the host machine.
16806
16807 @item
16808 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16809 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16810 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16811 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16812 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16813 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16814 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16815 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16816 you can usually resolve the confusion
16817 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16818 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16819 @end itemize
16820
16821 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16822 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16823 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16824 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16825 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16826 enabled.
16827
16828 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16829 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16830 @table @code
16831
16832 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16833 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16834 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16835 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16836 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16837 This is the default.
16838
16839 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16840 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16841 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16842 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16843 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16844 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16845 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16846
16847 @end table
16848
16849 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16850 @cindex GNAT encoding
16851 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16852 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16853 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16854 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16855 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16856 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16857
16858 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16859 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16860 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16861 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16862 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16863 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16864 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16865 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16866
16867 @table @code
16868
16869 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16870 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16871 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16872 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16873
16874 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16875 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16876 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16877
16878 @end table
16879
16880 @node Unsupported Languages
16881 @section Unsupported Languages
16882
16883 @cindex unsupported languages
16884 @cindex minimal language
16885 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16886 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16887 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16888 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16889 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16890 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16891
16892 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16893 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16894 language.
16895
16896 @node Symbols
16897 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16898
16899 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16900 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16901 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16902 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16903 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16904 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16905 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16906
16907 @cindex symbol names
16908 @cindex names of symbols
16909 @cindex quoting names
16910 @anchor{quoting names}
16911 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16912 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16913 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16914 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16915 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16916 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16917 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16918 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16919
16920 @smallexample
16921 p 'foo.c'::x
16922 @end smallexample
16923
16924 @noindent
16925 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16926
16927 @table @code
16928 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16929 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16930 @kindex set case-sensitive
16931 @item set case-sensitive on
16932 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16933 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16934 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16935 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16936 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16937 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16938 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16939 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16940 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16941 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16942 case-insensitive matches.
16943
16944 @kindex show case-sensitive
16945 @item show case-sensitive
16946 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16947 lookups.
16948
16949 @kindex set print type methods
16950 @item set print type methods
16951 @itemx set print type methods on
16952 @itemx set print type methods off
16953 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16954 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16955 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16956 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16957 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16958 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16959
16960 @kindex show print type methods
16961 @item show print type methods
16962 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16963 classes.
16964
16965 @kindex set print type typedefs
16966 @item set print type typedefs
16967 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16968 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16969
16970 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16971 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16972 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16973 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16974 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16975 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16976 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16977 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16978 types.
16979
16980 @kindex show print type typedefs
16981 @item show print type typedefs
16982 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16983 printing classes.
16984
16985 @kindex info address
16986 @cindex address of a symbol
16987 @item info address @var{symbol}
16988 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16989 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16990 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16991 is always stored.
16992
16993 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16994 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16995 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16996
16997 @kindex info symbol
16998 @cindex symbol from address
16999 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17000 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17001 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17002 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17003 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17004
17005 @smallexample
17006 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17007 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17008 @end smallexample
17009
17010 @noindent
17011 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17012 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17013
17014 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17015 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17016
17017 @smallexample
17018 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17019 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17020 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17021 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17022 @end smallexample
17023
17024 @kindex demangle
17025 @cindex demangle
17026 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17027 Demangle @var{name}.
17028 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17029 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17030
17031 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17032 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17033
17034 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17035 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17036
17037 @kindex whatis
17038 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17039 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17040 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17041 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17042
17043 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17044 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17045 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17046
17047 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17048 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17049 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17050 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17051 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17052 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17053 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17054 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17055 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17056
17057 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17058 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17059 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17060 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17061 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17062 unroll it.
17063
17064 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17065 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17066 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17067
17068 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17069 Available flags are:
17070
17071 @table @code
17072 @item r
17073 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17074 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17075 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17076
17077 @item m
17078 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17079
17080 @item M
17081 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17082 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17083
17084 @item t
17085 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17086 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17087 names are substituted when printing other types.
17088
17089 @item T
17090 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17091 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17092 @end table
17093
17094 @kindex ptype
17095 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17096 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17097 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17098 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17099
17100 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17101 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17102 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17103 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17104 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17105 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17106 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17107 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17108
17109 For example, for this variable declaration:
17110
17111 @smallexample
17112 typedef double real_t;
17113 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17114 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17115 complex_t var;
17116 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17117 @end smallexample
17118
17119 @noindent
17120 the two commands give this output:
17121
17122 @smallexample
17123 @group
17124 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17125 type = complex_t
17126 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17127 type = struct complex @{
17128 real_t real;
17129 double imag;
17130 @}
17131 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17132 type = struct complex
17133 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17134 type = struct complex
17135 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17136 type = struct complex @{
17137 real_t real;
17138 double imag;
17139 @}
17140 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17141 type = real_t *
17142 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17143 type = double *
17144 @end group
17145 @end smallexample
17146
17147 @noindent
17148 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17149 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17150
17151 @cindex incomplete type
17152 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17153 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17154 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17155 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17156 given these declarations:
17157
17158 @smallexample
17159 struct foo;
17160 struct foo *fooptr;
17161 @end smallexample
17162
17163 @noindent
17164 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17165
17166 @smallexample
17167 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17168 $1 = <incomplete type>
17169 @end smallexample
17170
17171 @noindent
17172 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17173 completely specified.
17174
17175 @cindex unknown type
17176 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17177 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17178 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17179 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17180 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17181 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17182 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17183 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17184
17185 @smallexample
17186 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17187 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17188 @end smallexample
17189
17190 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17191 of such variables.
17192
17193 @kindex info types
17194 @item info types @var{regexp}
17195 @itemx info types
17196 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17197 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17198 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17199 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17200 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17201 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17202 name is @code{value}.
17203
17204 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17205 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17206 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17207
17208 @kindex info type-printers
17209 @item info type-printers
17210 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17211 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17212 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17213 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17214 type printers.
17215
17216 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17217
17218 @kindex enable type-printer
17219 @kindex disable type-printer
17220 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17221 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17222 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17223
17224 @kindex info scope
17225 @cindex local variables
17226 @item info scope @var{location}
17227 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17228 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17229 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17230 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17231 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17232
17233 @smallexample
17234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17235 Scope for command_line_handler:
17236 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17237 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17238 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17239 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17240 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17241 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17242 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17243 @end smallexample
17244
17245 @noindent
17246 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17247 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17248 collect}.
17249
17250 @kindex info source
17251 @item info source
17252 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17253 the function containing the current point of execution:
17254 @itemize @bullet
17255 @item
17256 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17257 @item
17258 the directory it was compiled in,
17259 @item
17260 its length, in lines,
17261 @item
17262 which programming language it is written in,
17263 @item
17264 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17265 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17266 @item
17267 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17268 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17269 @item
17270 whether the debugging information includes information about
17271 preprocessor macros.
17272 @end itemize
17273
17274
17275 @kindex info sources
17276 @item info sources
17277 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17278 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17279 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17280
17281 @kindex info functions
17282 @item info functions
17283 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17284
17285 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17286 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17287 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17288 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17289 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17290 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17291 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17292 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17293
17294 @kindex info variables
17295 @item info variables
17296 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17297 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17298
17299 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17300 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17301 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17302 @var{regexp}.
17303
17304 @kindex info classes
17305 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17306 @item info classes
17307 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17308 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17309 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17310 expression.
17311
17312 @kindex info selectors
17313 @item info selectors
17314 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17315 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17316 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17317 expression.
17318
17319 @ignore
17320 This was never implemented.
17321 @kindex info methods
17322 @item info methods
17323 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17324 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17325 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17326 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17327 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17328 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17329 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17330 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17331 @end ignore
17332
17333 @cindex opaque data types
17334 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17335 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17336 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17337 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17338 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17339 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17340 another source file. The default is on.
17341
17342 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17343 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17344
17345 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17346 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17347 is printed as follows:
17348 @smallexample
17349 @{<no data fields>@}
17350 @end smallexample
17351
17352 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17353 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17354 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17355
17356 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17357 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17358 @item set print symbol-loading
17359 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17360 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17361 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17362 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17363 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17364 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17365 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17366 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17367 can be annoying.
17368 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17369 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17370 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17371 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17372
17373 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17374 @item show print symbol-loading
17375 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17376 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17377
17378 @kindex maint print symbols
17379 @cindex symbol dump
17380 @kindex maint print psymbols
17381 @cindex partial symbol dump
17382 @kindex maint print msymbols
17383 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17384 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17385 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17386 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17387 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17388 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17389 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17390 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17391 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17392 that objfile.
17393 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17394 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17395 @code{main}.
17396 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17397 source file.
17398
17399 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17400 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17401 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17402 tables.
17403 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17404 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17405 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17406 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17407 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17408 ``ELF symbols''.
17409
17410 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17411 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17412
17413 @kindex maint info symtabs
17414 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17415 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17416 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17417 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17418 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17419 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17420 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17421
17422 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17423 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17424 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17425 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17426 structure in more detail. For example:
17427
17428 @smallexample
17429 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17430 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17431 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17432 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17433 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17434 readin no
17435 fullname (null)
17436 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17437 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17438 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17439 dependencies (none)
17440 @}
17441 @}
17442 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17443 (@value{GDBP})
17444 @end smallexample
17445 @noindent
17446 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17447 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17448 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17449 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17450 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17451
17452 @smallexample
17453 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17454 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17455 line 1574.
17456 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17457 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17458 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17459 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17460 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17461 dirname (null)
17462 fullname (null)
17463 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17464 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17465 debugformat DWARF 2
17466 @}
17467 @}
17468 (@value{GDBP})
17469 @end smallexample
17470
17471 @kindex maint info line-table
17472 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17473 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17474 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17475
17476 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17477 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17478 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17479
17480 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17481 @cindex symbol cache size
17482 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17483 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17484 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17485 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17486 with different sizes.
17487
17488 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17489 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17490 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17491
17492 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17493 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17494 @item maint print symbol-cache
17495 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17496 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17497
17498 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17499 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17500 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17501 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17502 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17503
17504 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17505 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17506 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17507 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17508 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17509 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17510
17511 @end table
17512
17513 @node Altering
17514 @chapter Altering Execution
17515
17516 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17517 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17518 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17519 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17520 program.
17521
17522 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17523 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17524 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17525
17526 @menu
17527 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17528 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17529 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17530 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17531 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17532 * Patching:: Patching your program
17533 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17534 @end menu
17535
17536 @node Assignment
17537 @section Assignment to Variables
17538
17539 @cindex assignment
17540 @cindex setting variables
17541 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17542 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17543
17544 @smallexample
17545 print x=4
17546 @end smallexample
17547
17548 @noindent
17549 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17550 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17551 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17552 information on operators in supported languages.
17553
17554 @kindex set variable
17555 @cindex variables, setting
17556 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17557 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17558 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17559 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17560 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17561
17562 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17563 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17564 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17565 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17566 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17567 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17568 command @code{set width}:
17569
17570 @smallexample
17571 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17572 type = double
17573 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17574 $4 = 13
17575 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17576 Invalid syntax in expression.
17577 @end smallexample
17578
17579 @noindent
17580 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17581 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17582
17583 @smallexample
17584 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17585 @end smallexample
17586
17587 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17588 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17589 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17590 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17591 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17592 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17593
17594 @smallexample
17595 @group
17596 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17597 type = double
17598 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17599 $1 = 1
17600 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17601 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17602 $2 = 1
17603 (@value{GDBP}) r
17604 The program being debugged has been started already.
17605 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17606 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17607 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17608 Invalid bfd target.
17609 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17610 The current BFD target is "=4".
17611 @end group
17612 @end smallexample
17613
17614 @noindent
17615 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17616 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17617 @code{g}, use
17618
17619 @smallexample
17620 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17621 @end smallexample
17622
17623 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17624 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17625 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17626 same length or shorter.
17627 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17628 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17629
17630 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17631 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17632 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17633 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17634 and representation in memory), and
17635
17636 @smallexample
17637 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17638 @end smallexample
17639
17640 @noindent
17641 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17642
17643 @node Jumping
17644 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17645
17646 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17647 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17648 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17649
17650 @table @code
17651 @kindex jump
17652 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17653 @item jump @var{location}
17654 @itemx j @var{location}
17655 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17656 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17657 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17658 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17659 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17660
17661 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17662 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17663 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17664 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17665 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17666 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17667 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17668 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17669 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17670 @end table
17671
17672 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17673 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17674 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17675 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17676 example,
17677
17678 @smallexample
17679 set $pc = 0x485
17680 @end smallexample
17681
17682 @noindent
17683 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17684 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17685 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17686
17687 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17688 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17689 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17690 detail.
17691
17692 @c @group
17693 @node Signaling
17694 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17695 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17696
17697 @table @code
17698 @kindex signal
17699 @item signal @var{signal}
17700 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17701 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17702 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17703 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17704
17705 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17706 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17707 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17708 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17709 signal.
17710
17711 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17712 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17713 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17714 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17715 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17716 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17717 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17718 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17719
17720 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17721 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17722 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17723 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17724 passes the signal directly to your program.
17725
17726 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17727 after executing the command.
17728
17729 @kindex queue-signal
17730 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17731 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17732 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17733 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17734 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17735 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17736 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17737 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17738 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17739
17740 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17741 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17742 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17743 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17744 @code{continue} command.
17745
17746 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17747 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17748 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17749 (@pxref{Signals}).
17750 @end table
17751 @c @end group
17752
17753 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17754 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17755
17756 @node Returning
17757 @section Returning from a Function
17758
17759 @table @code
17760 @cindex returning from a function
17761 @kindex return
17762 @item return
17763 @itemx return @var{expression}
17764 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17765 command. If you give an
17766 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17767 value.
17768 @end table
17769
17770 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17771 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17772 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17773 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17774
17775 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17776 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17777 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17778 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17779 of functions.
17780
17781 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17782 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17783 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17784 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17785 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17786
17787 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17788 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17789 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17790 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17791 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17792 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17793 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17794 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17795 assignment into the right register(s).
17796
17797 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17798 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17799 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17800 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17801 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17802 into a @code{long long int}:
17803
17804 @smallexample
17805 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17806 29 return 31;
17807 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17808 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17809 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17810 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17811 (@value{GDBP})
17812 @end smallexample
17813
17814 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17815 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17816 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17817 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17818 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17819 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17820 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17821 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17822
17823 @smallexample
17824 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17825 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17826 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17827 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17828 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17829 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17830 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17831 (@value{GDBP})
17832 @end smallexample
17833
17834 @node Calling
17835 @section Calling Program Functions
17836
17837 @table @code
17838 @cindex calling functions
17839 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17840 @item print @var{expr}
17841 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17842 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17843 debugged.
17844
17845 @kindex call
17846 @item call @var{expr}
17847 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17848 returned values.
17849
17850 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17851 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17852 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17853 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17854 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17855 value history.
17856 @end table
17857
17858 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17859 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17860 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17861 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17862
17863 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17864 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17865 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17866 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17867 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17868 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17869 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17870 in that case is controlled by the
17871 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17872
17873 @table @code
17874 @item set unwindonsignal
17875 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17876 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17877 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17878 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17879 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17880 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17881 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17882 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17883 received.
17884
17885 @item show unwindonsignal
17886 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17887 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17888 @value{GDBN}.
17889
17890 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17891 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17892 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17893 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17894 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17895 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17896 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17897 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17898 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17899 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17900
17901 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17902 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17903 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17904 @value{GDBN}.
17905
17906 @end table
17907
17908 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
17909
17910 @cindex no debug info functions
17911 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
17912 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
17913 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
17914 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
17915 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
17916 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
17917
17918 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
17919 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
17920 declared return type. For example:
17921
17922 @smallexample
17923 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
17924 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
17925 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
17926 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
17927 @end smallexample
17928
17929 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
17930 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
17931 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
17932 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
17933
17934 @smallexample
17935 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
17936 @end smallexample
17937
17938 @noindent
17939 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
17940
17941 @smallexample
17942 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
17943 @end smallexample
17944
17945 @noindent
17946 these calls are equivalent:
17947
17948 @smallexample
17949 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
17950 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17951 @end smallexample
17952
17953 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
17954 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
17955 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
17956 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
17957 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
17958 float parameters, and no debug info:
17959
17960 @smallexample
17961 float
17962 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
17963 float v1, v2;
17964 @{
17965 return v1 * v2;
17966 @}
17967 @end smallexample
17968
17969 @noindent
17970 you call it like this:
17971
17972 @smallexample
17973 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17974 @end smallexample
17975
17976 @node Patching
17977 @section Patching Programs
17978
17979 @cindex patching binaries
17980 @cindex writing into executables
17981 @cindex writing into corefiles
17982
17983 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17984 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17985 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17986 patching your program's binary.
17987
17988 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17989 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17990 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17991 repairs.
17992
17993 @table @code
17994 @kindex set write
17995 @item set write on
17996 @itemx set write off
17997 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17998 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17999 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18000
18001 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18002 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18003 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18004
18005 @item show write
18006 @kindex show write
18007 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18008 as well as reading.
18009 @end table
18010
18011 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18012 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18013 @cindex injecting code
18014 @cindex writing into executables
18015 @cindex compiling code
18016
18017 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18018 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18019 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18020 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18021
18022 @table @code
18023 @kindex compile code
18024 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18025 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18026 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18027 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18028 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18029 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18030 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18031 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18032 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18033 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18034 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18035 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18036
18037 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18038 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18039 E.g.:
18040
18041 @smallexample
18042 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18043 @end smallexample
18044
18045 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18046 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18047 from actual source code. E.g.:
18048
18049 @smallexample
18050 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18051 @end smallexample
18052
18053 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18054 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18055 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18056 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18057 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18058 editor.
18059
18060 @smallexample
18061 compile code
18062 >printf ("hello\n");
18063 >printf ("world\n");
18064 >end
18065 @end smallexample
18066
18067 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18068 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18069 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18070 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18071 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18072 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18073 inferior symbols otherwise.
18074
18075 @kindex compile file
18076 @item compile file @var{filename}
18077 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18078 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18079
18080 @smallexample
18081 compile file /home/user/example.c
18082 @end smallexample
18083 @end table
18084
18085 @table @code
18086 @item compile print @var{expr}
18087 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18088 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18089 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18090 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18091 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18092 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18093 Formats}.
18094
18095 @item compile print
18096 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18097 @cindex reprint the last value
18098 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18099 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18100 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18101 multiple-line editor.
18102 @end table
18103
18104 @noindent
18105 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18106
18107 @table @code
18108 @anchor{set debug compile}
18109 @item set debug compile
18110 @cindex compile command debugging info
18111 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18112 injecting the code. The default is off.
18113
18114 @item show debug compile
18115 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18116 compiling and injecting the code.
18117 @end table
18118
18119 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18120
18121 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18122 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18123 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18124 injecting process.
18125
18126 @noindent
18127 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18128
18129 @table @asis
18130 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18131 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18132 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18133 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18134
18135 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18136 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18137 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18138 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18139 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18140 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18141 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18142 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18143
18144 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18145 @end table
18146
18147 @noindent
18148 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18149
18150 @table @code
18151 @item set compile-args
18152 @cindex compile command options override
18153 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18154 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18155 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18156 compilation.
18157
18158 @item show compile-args
18159 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18160 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18161 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18162 @end table
18163
18164 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18165
18166 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18167 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18168 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18169
18170 @table @asis
18171 @item C code examples and caveats
18172 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18173 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18174 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18175 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18176 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18177
18178 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18179 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18180 much like any other normal debugging session.
18181
18182 @smallexample
18183 void function1 (void)
18184 @{
18185 int i = 42;
18186 printf ("function 1\n");
18187 @}
18188
18189 void function2 (void)
18190 @{
18191 int j = 12;
18192 function1 ();
18193 @}
18194
18195 int main(void)
18196 @{
18197 int k = 6;
18198 int *p;
18199 function2 ();
18200 return 0;
18201 @}
18202 @end smallexample
18203
18204 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18205 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18206 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18207
18208 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18209 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18210 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18211 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18212 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18213
18214 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18215 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18216 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18217 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18218 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18219 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18220 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18221 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18222 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18223 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18224
18225 @smallexample
18226 compile code k = 3;
18227 @end smallexample
18228
18229 @noindent
18230 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18231 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18232 @code{compile} command changes it.
18233
18234 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18235 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18236 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18237 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18238 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18239
18240 @smallexample
18241 compile code j = 3;
18242 @end smallexample
18243
18244 @noindent
18245 will result in a compilation error message.
18246
18247 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18248 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18249 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18250
18251 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18252 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18253 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18254 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18255
18256 @smallexample
18257 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18258 @end smallexample
18259
18260 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18261 command has completed:
18262
18263 @smallexample
18264 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18265 @end smallexample
18266
18267 @noindent
18268 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18269 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18270 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18271 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18272 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18273
18274 @smallexample
18275 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18276 @end smallexample
18277
18278 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18279 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18280 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18281 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18282 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18283 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18284 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18285 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18286
18287 @smallexample
18288 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18289 @end smallexample
18290
18291 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18292 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18293 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18294 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18295 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18296 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18297 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18298
18299 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18300 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18301 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18302 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18303 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18304 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18305
18306 @smallexample
18307 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18308 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18309 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18310 Compilation failed.
18311 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18312 42
18313 @end smallexample
18314
18315 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18316 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18317 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18318 will print to the console.
18319 @end table
18320
18321 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18322
18323 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18324 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18325 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18326 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18327 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18328 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18329 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18330 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18331
18332
18333 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18334 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18335 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18336 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18337 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18338 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18339 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18340
18341 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18342 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18343 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18344 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18345 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18346 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18347 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18348
18349 @table @code
18350 @item set compile-gcc
18351 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18352 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18353 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18354 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18355 default.
18356
18357 @item show compile-gcc
18358 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18359 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18360 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18361 @end table
18362
18363 @node GDB Files
18364 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18365
18366 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18367 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18368 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18369 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18370
18371 @menu
18372 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18373 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18374 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18375 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18376 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18377 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18378 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18379 @end menu
18380
18381 @node Files
18382 @section Commands to Specify Files
18383
18384 @cindex symbol table
18385 @cindex core dump file
18386
18387 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18388 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18389 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18390 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18391
18392 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18393 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18394 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18395 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18396 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18397 new files are useful.
18398
18399 @table @code
18400 @cindex executable file
18401 @kindex file
18402 @item file @var{filename}
18403 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18404 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18405 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18406 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18407 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18408 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18409 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18410 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18411
18412 @cindex unlinked object files
18413 @cindex patching object files
18414 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18415 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18416 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18417 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18418 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18419 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18420 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18421 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18422
18423 @item file
18424 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18425 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18426
18427 @kindex exec-file
18428 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18429 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18430 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18431 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18432 discard information on the executable file.
18433
18434 @kindex symbol-file
18435 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18436 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18437 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18438 table and program to run from the same file.
18439
18440 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18441 program's symbol table.
18442
18443 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18444 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18445 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18446 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18447 @value{GDBN}.
18448
18449 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18450 executing it once.
18451
18452 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18453 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18454 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18455 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18456 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18457 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18458 optimized code.
18459
18460 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18461 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18462 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18463 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18464 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18465
18466 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18467 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18468 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18469 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18470 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18471 Warnings and Messages}.)
18472
18473 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18474 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18475 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18476 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18477 in stabs format.
18478
18479 @kindex readnow
18480 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18481 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18482 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18483 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18484 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18485 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18486 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18487 entire symbol table available.
18488
18489 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18490 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18491 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18492 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18493 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18494 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18495 @c files.
18496
18497 @kindex core-file
18498 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18499 @itemx core
18500 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18501 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18502 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18503 executable file itself for other parts.
18504
18505 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18506 to be used.
18507
18508 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18509 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18510 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18511 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18512 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18513
18514 @kindex add-symbol-file
18515 @cindex dynamic linking
18516 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18517 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18518 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18519 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18520 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18521 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18522 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18523 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18524 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18525 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18526 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18527 @var{address} as an expression.
18528
18529 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18530 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18531 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18532 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18533
18534 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18535
18536 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18537 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18538 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18539 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18540 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18541 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18542 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18543 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18544 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18545
18546 @itemize @bullet
18547 @item
18548 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18549 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18550 @item
18551 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18552 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18553 @item
18554 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18555 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18556 @end itemize
18557
18558 @noindent
18559 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18560 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18561 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18562 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18563 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18564 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18565 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18566 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18567 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18568 way.
18569
18570 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18571
18572 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18573 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18574 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18575 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18576 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18577 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18578
18579 @smallexample
18580 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18581 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18582 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18583 (y or n) y
18584 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18585 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18586 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18587 (gdb)
18588 @end smallexample
18589
18590
18591 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18592
18593 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18594 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18595 @cindex load symbols from memory
18596 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18597 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18598 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18599 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18600 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18601 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18602 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18603 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18604 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18605
18606 @kindex section
18607 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18608 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18609 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18610 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18611 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18612 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18613 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18614 their addresses.
18615
18616 @kindex info files
18617 @kindex info target
18618 @item info files
18619 @itemx info target
18620 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18621 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18622 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18623 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18624 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18625 current ones.
18626
18627 @kindex maint info sections
18628 @item maint info sections
18629 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18630 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18631 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18632 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18633 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18634 may be arbitrarily combined):
18635
18636 @table @code
18637 @item ALLOBJ
18638 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18639 @item @var{sections}
18640 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18641 @item @var{section-flags}
18642 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18643 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18644 @table @code
18645 @item ALLOC
18646 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18647 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18648 @item LOAD
18649 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18650 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18651 @item RELOC
18652 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18653 @item READONLY
18654 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18655 @item CODE
18656 Section contains executable code only.
18657 @item DATA
18658 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18659 @item ROM
18660 Section will reside in ROM.
18661 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18662 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18663 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18664 Section is not empty.
18665 @item NEVER_LOAD
18666 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18667 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18668 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18669 COFF shared library information.
18670 @item IS_COMMON
18671 Section contains common symbols.
18672 @end table
18673 @end table
18674 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18675 @cindex read-only sections
18676 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18677 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18678 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18679 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18680 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18681 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18682 enhancement to debugging performance.
18683
18684 The default is off.
18685
18686 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18687 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18688 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18689 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18690
18691 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18692 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18693 @end table
18694
18695 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18696 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18697 name and remembers it that way.
18698
18699 @cindex shared libraries
18700 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18701 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18702 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18703 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18704
18705 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18706 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18707
18708 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18709 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18710 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18711 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18712 debugging a core file).
18713
18714 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18715 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18716 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18717
18718 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18719 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18720 particularly large or there are many of them.
18721
18722 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18723 commands:
18724
18725 @table @code
18726 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18727 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18728 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18729 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18730 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18731 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18732 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18733 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18734
18735 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18736 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18737 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18738 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18739 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18740 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18741 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18742 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18743 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18744
18745 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18746 @item show auto-solib-add
18747 Display the current autoloading mode.
18748 @end table
18749
18750 @cindex load shared library
18751 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18752 command:
18753
18754 @table @code
18755 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18756 @kindex info share
18757 @item info share @var{regex}
18758 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18759 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18760 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18761 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18762
18763 @kindex info dll
18764 @item info dll @var{regex}
18765 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18766
18767 @kindex sharedlibrary
18768 @kindex share
18769 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18770 @itemx share @var{regex}
18771 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18772 Unix regular expression.
18773 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18774 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18775 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18776 loaded.
18777
18778 @item nosharedlibrary
18779 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18780 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18781 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18782 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18783 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18784 discarded.
18785 @end table
18786
18787 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18788 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18789 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18790 Catchpoints}).
18791
18792 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18793 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18794 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18795 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18796
18797 @table @code
18798 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18799 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18800 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18801 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18802 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18803 shared library.
18804
18805 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18806 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18807 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18808 library events happen.
18809 @end table
18810
18811 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18812 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18813 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18814 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18815 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18816 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18817 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18818 not.
18819
18820 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18821 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18822 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18823 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18824 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18825
18826 @table @code
18827 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18828 @cindex system root, alternate
18829 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18830 @kindex set sysroot
18831 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18832 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18833 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18834 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18835 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18836 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18837 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18838 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18839 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18840 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18841 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18842 @var{path}.
18843
18844 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18845 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18846 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18847 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18848 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18849 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18850 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18851 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18852 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18853 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18854 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18855 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18856 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18857 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18858
18859 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18860 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18861 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18862 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18863 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18864
18865 @smallexample
18866 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18867 @end smallexample
18868
18869 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18870 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18871 system:
18872
18873 @smallexample
18874 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18875 @end smallexample
18876
18877 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18878 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18879 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18880 colons:
18881
18882 @smallexample
18883 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18884 @end smallexample
18885
18886 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18887 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18888 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18889 @samp{z}):
18890
18891 @smallexample
18892 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18893 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18894 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18895 @end smallexample
18896
18897 @noindent
18898 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18899 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18900 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18901
18902 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18903 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18904
18905 @smallexample
18906 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18907 @end smallexample
18908
18909 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18910 if you don't want or need to.
18911
18912 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18913 sysroot}.
18914
18915 @cindex default system root
18916 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18917 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18918 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18919 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18920 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18921 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18922 location.
18923
18924 @kindex show sysroot
18925 @item show sysroot
18926 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18927
18928 @kindex set solib-search-path
18929 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18930 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18931 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18932 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18933 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18934 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18935 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18936 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18937 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18938 of shared library symbols.
18939
18940 @kindex show solib-search-path
18941 @item show solib-search-path
18942 Display the current shared library search path.
18943
18944 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18945 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18946 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18947 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18948 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18949
18950 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18951 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18952 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18953 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18954 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18955 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18956 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18957 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18958 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18959 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18960 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18961 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18962 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18963 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18964 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18965 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18966 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18967 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18968 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18969 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18970 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18971 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18972
18973 @table @code
18974 @item unix
18975 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18976 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18977 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18978 the forward slash.
18979
18980 @item dos-based
18981 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18982 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18983 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18984 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18985 considered directory separators.
18986
18987 @item auto
18988 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18989 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18990 This is the default.
18991 @end table
18992 @end table
18993
18994 @cindex file name canonicalization
18995 @cindex base name differences
18996 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18997 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18998 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18999 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19000 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19001 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19002 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19003 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19004 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19005 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19006 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19007 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19008 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19009 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19010 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19011
19012 @table @code
19013 @item set basenames-may-differ
19014 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19015 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19016
19017 @item show basenames-may-differ
19018 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19019 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19020 @end table
19021
19022 @node File Caching
19023 @section File Caching
19024 @cindex caching of opened files
19025 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19026
19027 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19028 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19029 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19030 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19031
19032 @table @code
19033 @kindex maint info bfds
19034 @item maint info bfds
19035 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19036 @value{GDBN}.
19037
19038 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19039 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19040 @kindex bfd caching
19041 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19042 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19043 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19044 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19045 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19046 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19047 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19048 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19049 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19050
19051 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19052 @kindex bfd caching
19053 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19054 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19055
19056 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19057 @kindex bfd caching
19058 @item show debug bfd-cache
19059 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19060 @end table
19061
19062 @node Separate Debug Files
19063 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19064 @cindex separate debugging information files
19065 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19066 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19067 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19068 @cindex global debugging information directories
19069 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19070 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19071
19072 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19073 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19074 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19075 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19076 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19077 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19078 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19079
19080 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19081 file:
19082
19083 @itemize @bullet
19084 @item
19085 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19086 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19087 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19088 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19089 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19090 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19091 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19092 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19093
19094 @item
19095 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19096 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19097 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19098 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19099 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19100 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19101 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19102 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19103 below.
19104 @end itemize
19105
19106 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19107 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19108
19109 @itemize @bullet
19110 @item
19111 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19112 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19113 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19114 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19115 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19116
19117 @item
19118 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19119 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19120 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19121 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19122 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19123 hex characters, not 10.)
19124 @end itemize
19125
19126 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19127 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19128 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19129 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19130 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19131 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19132
19133 @itemize @minus
19134 @item
19135 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19136 @item
19137 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19138 @item
19139 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19140 @item
19141 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19142 @end itemize
19143
19144 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19145 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19146 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19147 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19148 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19149
19150 @table @code
19151
19152 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19153 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19154 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19155 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19156 concatenating them by a path separator.
19157
19158 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19159 @item show debug-file-directory
19160 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19161 information files.
19162
19163 @end table
19164
19165 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19166 @cindex debug link sections
19167 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19168 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19169
19170 @itemize
19171 @item
19172 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19173 a zero byte,
19174 @item
19175 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19176 boundary within the section, and
19177 @item
19178 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19179 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19180 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19181 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19182 @end itemize
19183
19184 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19185 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19186 described above.
19187
19188 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19189 @cindex build ID sections
19190 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19191 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19192 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19193 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19194 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19195 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19196 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19197 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19198 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19199
19200 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19201 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19202 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19203 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19204 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19205 in an ordinary executable.
19206
19207 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19208 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19209 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19210 following commands:
19211
19212 @smallexample
19213 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19214 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19215 @end smallexample
19216
19217 @noindent
19218 These commands remove the debugging
19219 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19220 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19221 two files:
19222
19223 @itemize @bullet
19224 @item
19225 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19226 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19227
19228 @smallexample
19229 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19230 @end smallexample
19231
19232 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19233 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19234 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19235 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19236
19237 @item
19238 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19239 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19240 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19241 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19242 @end itemize
19243
19244 @noindent
19245
19246 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19247 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19248 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19249
19250 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19251 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19252 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19253 @c different ways!
19254 @ifhtml
19255 @display
19256 @html
19257 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19258 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19259 @end html
19260 @end display
19261 @end ifhtml
19262 @ifnothtml
19263 @display
19264 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19265 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19266 @end display
19267 @end ifnothtml
19268
19269 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19270 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19271 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19272 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19273 CRC.
19274
19275 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19276 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19277 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19278 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19279 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19280
19281 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19282 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19283 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19284 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19285 @code{0xffffffff}.
19286
19287 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19288 @smallexample
19289 unsigned long
19290 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19291 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19292 @{
19293 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19294 @{
19295 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19296 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19297 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19298 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19299 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19300 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19301 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19302 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19303 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19304 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19305 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19306 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19307 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19308 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19309 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19310 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19311 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19312 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19313 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19314 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19315 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19316 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19317 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19318 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19319 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19320 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19321 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19322 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19323 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19324 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19325 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19326 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19327 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19328 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19329 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19330 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19331 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19332 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19333 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19334 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19335 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19336 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19337 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19338 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19339 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19340 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19341 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19342 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19343 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19344 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19345 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19346 0x2d02ef8d
19347 @};
19348 unsigned char *end;
19349
19350 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19351 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19352 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19353 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19354 @}
19355 @end smallexample
19356
19357 @noindent
19358 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19359
19360 @node MiniDebugInfo
19361 @section Debugging information in a special section
19362 @cindex separate debug sections
19363 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19364
19365 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19366 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19367 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19368 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19369
19370 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19371 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19372 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19373 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19374 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19375 debugging information might be included in the section.
19376
19377 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19378 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19379 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19380
19381 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19382 standard utilities:
19383
19384 @smallexample
19385 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19386 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19387 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19388 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19389
19390 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19391 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19392 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19393 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19394 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19395 | sort > funcsyms
19396
19397 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19398 # table.
19399 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19400
19401 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19402 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19403
19404 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19405 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19406 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19407 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19408
19409 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19410 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19411
19412 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19413 # original binary.
19414 xz mini_debuginfo
19415 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19416 @end smallexample
19417
19418 @node Index Files
19419 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19420 @cindex index files
19421 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19422
19423 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19424 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19425 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19426 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19427 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19428 startup.
19429
19430 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19431 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19432 using @command{objcopy}.
19433
19434 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19435
19436 @table @code
19437 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19438 @kindex save gdb-index
19439 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19440 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19441 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19442 @var{directory}.
19443 @end table
19444
19445 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19446 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19447
19448 @smallexample
19449 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19450 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19451 @end smallexample
19452
19453 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19454 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19455 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19456 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19457 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19458 The default is @code{off}.
19459 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19460 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19461
19462 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19463 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19464
19465 @smallexample
19466 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19467 @end smallexample
19468
19469 Instead you must do, for example,
19470
19471 @smallexample
19472 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19473 @end smallexample
19474
19475 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19476 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19477 currently work for programs using Ada.
19478
19479 @node Symbol Errors
19480 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19481
19482 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19483 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19484 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19485 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19486 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19487 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19488 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19489 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19490 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19491 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19492 Messages}).
19493
19494 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19495
19496 @table @code
19497 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19498
19499 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19500 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19501 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19502 in its outer scope blocks.
19503
19504 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19505 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19506 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19507 function.
19508
19509 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19510
19511 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19512 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19513 do so.
19514
19515 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19516 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19517 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19518 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19519 Messages}.)
19520
19521 @item bad block start address patched
19522
19523 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19524 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19525 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19526
19527 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19528 starting on the previous source line.
19529
19530 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19531
19532 @cindex foo
19533 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19534 larger than the size of the string table.
19535
19536 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19537 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19538 with this name.
19539
19540 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19541
19542 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19543 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19544 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19545
19546 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19547 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19548 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19549 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19550 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19551 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19552
19553 @item stub type has NULL name
19554
19555 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19556
19557 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19558 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19559 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19560 it.
19561
19562 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19563
19564 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19565
19566 @end table
19567
19568 @node Data Files
19569 @section GDB Data Files
19570
19571 @cindex prefix for data files
19572 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19573 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19574
19575 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19576 is currently using.
19577
19578 @table @code
19579 @kindex set data-directory
19580 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19581 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19582 to @var{directory}.
19583
19584 @kindex show data-directory
19585 @item show data-directory
19586 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19587 @end table
19588
19589 @cindex default data directory
19590 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19591 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19592 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19593 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19594 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19595 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19596 location.
19597
19598 The data directory may also be specified with the
19599 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19600 @xref{Mode Options}.
19601
19602 @node Targets
19603 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19604
19605 @cindex debugging target
19606 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19607
19608 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19609 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19610 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19611 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19612 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19613 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19614 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19615 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19616
19617 @cindex target architecture
19618 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19619 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19620 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19621 command.
19622
19623 @table @code
19624 @kindex set architecture
19625 @kindex show architecture
19626 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19627 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19628 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19629 supported architectures.
19630
19631 @item show architecture
19632 Show the current target architecture.
19633
19634 @item set processor
19635 @itemx processor
19636 @kindex set processor
19637 @kindex show processor
19638 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19639 and @code{show architecture}.
19640 @end table
19641
19642 @menu
19643 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19644 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19645 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19646 @end menu
19647
19648 @node Active Targets
19649 @section Active Targets
19650
19651 @cindex stacking targets
19652 @cindex active targets
19653 @cindex multiple targets
19654
19655 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19656 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19657 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19658 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19659 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19660 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19661 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19662 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19663 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19664
19665 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19666 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19667 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19668 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19669
19670 @node Target Commands
19671 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19672
19673 @table @code
19674 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19675 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19676 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19677 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19678 protocol of the target machine.
19679
19680 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19681 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19682 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19683
19684 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19685 after executing the command.
19686
19687 @kindex help target
19688 @item help target
19689 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19690 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19691 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19692
19693 @item help target @var{name}
19694 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19695 select it.
19696
19697 @kindex set gnutarget
19698 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19699 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19700 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19701 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19702 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19703 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19704
19705 @quotation
19706 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19707 you must know the actual BFD name.
19708 @end quotation
19709
19710 @noindent
19711 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19712
19713 @kindex show gnutarget
19714 @item show gnutarget
19715 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19716 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19717 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19718 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19719 @end table
19720
19721 @cindex common targets
19722 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19723 configuration):
19724
19725 @table @code
19726 @kindex target
19727 @item target exec @var{program}
19728 @cindex executable file target
19729 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19730 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19731
19732 @item target core @var{filename}
19733 @cindex core dump file target
19734 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19735 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19736
19737 @item target remote @var{medium}
19738 @cindex remote target
19739 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19740 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19741 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19742
19743 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19744 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19745
19746 @smallexample
19747 target remote /dev/ttya
19748 @end smallexample
19749
19750 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19751 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19752 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19753 clobbered by the download.
19754
19755 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19756 @cindex built-in simulator target
19757 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19758 In general,
19759 @smallexample
19760 target sim
19761 load
19762 run
19763 @end smallexample
19764 @noindent
19765 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19766 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19767 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19768 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19769 Processors}.
19770
19771 @item target native
19772 @cindex native target
19773 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19774 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19775 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19776 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19777
19778 @end table
19779
19780 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19781 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19782
19783 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19784 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19785 various aspects of this process.
19786
19787 @table @code
19788
19789 @item set hash
19790 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19791 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19792 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19793 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19794 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19795 monitor.
19796
19797 @item show hash
19798 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19799 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19800
19801 @item set debug monitor
19802 @kindex set debug monitor
19803 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19804 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19805 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19806
19807 @item show debug monitor
19808 @kindex show debug monitor
19809 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19810 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19811 @end table
19812
19813 @table @code
19814
19815 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19816 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19817 @anchor{load}
19818 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19819 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19820 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19821 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19822 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19823 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19824
19825 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19826 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19827 target is @dots{}}''
19828
19829 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19830 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19831 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19832 specifies a fixed address.
19833 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19834
19835 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19836 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19837 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19838
19839 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19840 load programs into flash memory.
19841
19842 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19843 @end table
19844
19845 @table @code
19846
19847 @kindex flash-erase
19848 @item flash-erase
19849 @anchor{flash-erase}
19850
19851 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19852
19853 @end table
19854
19855 @node Byte Order
19856 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19857
19858 @cindex choosing target byte order
19859 @cindex target byte order
19860
19861 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19862 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19863 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19864 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19865 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19866 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19867
19868 @table @code
19869 @kindex set endian
19870 @item set endian big
19871 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19872
19873 @item set endian little
19874 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19875
19876 @item set endian auto
19877 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19878 executable.
19879
19880 @item show endian
19881 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19882
19883 @end table
19884
19885 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19886 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19887 target system.
19888
19889
19890 @node Remote Debugging
19891 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19892 @cindex remote debugging
19893
19894 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19895 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19896 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19897 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19898 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19899
19900 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19901 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19902 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19903 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19904 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19905 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19906
19907 Other remote targets may be available in your
19908 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19909
19910 @menu
19911 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19912 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19913 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19914 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19915 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19916 @end menu
19917
19918 @node Connecting
19919 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19920 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19921 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19922 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19923 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19924 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19925 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19926
19927 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19928 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19929 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19930 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19931
19932 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19933
19934 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19935 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19936 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19937 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19938
19939 @table @asis
19940
19941 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19942 @item Result of detach or program exit
19943 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19944 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19945 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19946
19947 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19948 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19949 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19950 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19951
19952 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19953 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19954 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19955 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19956
19957 @item Specifying the program to debug
19958 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19959 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19960 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19961 target.
19962
19963 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19964 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19965 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19966
19967 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19968 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19969 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19970 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19971
19972 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19973 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19974 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19975 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19976 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19977 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19978 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19979 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19980 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19981
19982 @item The @code{run} command
19983 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19984 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19985 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19986 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19987 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19988
19989 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19990 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19991 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19992 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19993 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19994
19995 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19996 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19997 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19998 @code{target remote} mode.
19999
20000 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20001 @item Attaching
20002 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20003 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20004 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20005
20006 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20007 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20008 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20009 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20010 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20011
20012 @end table
20013
20014 @anchor{Host and target files}
20015 @subsection Host and Target Files
20016 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20017 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20018
20019 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20020 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20021 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20022 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20023 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20024
20025 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20026 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20027 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20028 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20029 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20030
20031 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20032 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20033 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20034 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20035 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20036 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20037 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20038 target libraries.
20039
20040 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20041 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20042 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20043 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20044 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20045 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20046 programs.
20047
20048 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20049 @cindex remote connection commands
20050 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20051 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20052 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20053 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20054 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20055 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20056 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20057
20058 @table @code
20059
20060 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20061 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20062 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20063 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20064 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20065
20066 @smallexample
20067 target remote /dev/ttyb
20068 @end smallexample
20069
20070 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20071 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20072 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20073 @code{target} command.
20074
20075 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20076 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20077 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20078 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20079 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20080 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20081 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
20082 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
20083 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
20084 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
20085 target.
20086
20087 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20088 @code{manyfarms}:
20089
20090 @smallexample
20091 target remote manyfarms:2828
20092 @end smallexample
20093
20094 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20095 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20096 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20097 port 1234 on your local machine:
20098
20099 @smallexample
20100 target remote :1234
20101 @end smallexample
20102 @noindent
20103
20104 Note that the colon is still required here.
20105
20106 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20107 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20108 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20109 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20110 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20111
20112 @smallexample
20113 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20114 @end smallexample
20115
20116 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20117 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20118 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20119 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20120
20121 @item target remote | @var{command}
20122 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20123 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20124 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20125 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20126 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20127 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20128 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20129 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20130 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20131
20132 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20133 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20134 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20135
20136 @end table
20137
20138 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20139 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20140 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20141 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20142 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20143 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20144 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20145
20146 @smallexample
20147 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20148 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20149 @end smallexample
20150
20151 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20152 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20153 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20154 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20155
20156 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20157 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20158
20159 @table @code
20160 @kindex detach (remote)
20161 @item detach
20162 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20163 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20164 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20165 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20166 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20167 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20168 still connected to the target.
20169
20170 @kindex disconnect
20171 @item disconnect
20172 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20173 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20174 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20175 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20176 another target.
20177
20178 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20179 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20180 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20181 @kindex monitor
20182 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20183 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20184 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20185 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20186 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20187 and implement.
20188 @end table
20189
20190 @node File Transfer
20191 @section Sending files to a remote system
20192 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20193 @cindex file transfer
20194 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20195
20196 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20197 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20198 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20199 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20200 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20201 the only way to upload or download files.
20202
20203 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20204
20205 @table @code
20206 @kindex remote put
20207 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20208 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20209 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20210
20211 @kindex remote get
20212 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20213 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20214 on the host system.
20215
20216 @kindex remote delete
20217 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20218 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20219
20220 @end table
20221
20222 @node Server
20223 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20224
20225 @kindex gdbserver
20226 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20227 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20228 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20229 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20230 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20231
20232 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20233 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20234 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20235 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20236 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20237 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20238 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20239 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20240 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20241 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20242 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20243 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20244 choice for debugging.
20245
20246 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20247 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20248 protocol.
20249
20250 @quotation
20251 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20252 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20253 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20254 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20255 @code{gdbserver}.
20256 @end quotation
20257
20258 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20259 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20260 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20261 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20262
20263 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20264 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20265 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20266 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20267 system does all the symbol handling.
20268
20269 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20270 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20271 syntax is:
20272
20273 @smallexample
20274 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20275 @end smallexample
20276
20277 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20278 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20279 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20280 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20281 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20282 @file{/dev/com1}:
20283
20284 @smallexample
20285 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20286 @end smallexample
20287
20288 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20289 with it.
20290
20291 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20292
20293 @smallexample
20294 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20295 @end smallexample
20296
20297 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20298 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20299 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20300 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20301 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20302 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20303 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20304 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20305 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20306 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20307 @code{target remote} command.
20308
20309 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20310 with ssh:
20311
20312 @smallexample
20313 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20314 @end smallexample
20315
20316 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20317 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20318 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20319 You could elide it if you want to.
20320
20321 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20322 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20323 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20324 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20325
20326 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20327 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20328 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20329 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20330
20331 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20332 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20333
20334 @smallexample
20335 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20336 @end smallexample
20337
20338 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20339 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20340
20341 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20342 @value{GDBN} attach command
20343 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20344
20345 @pindex pidof
20346 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20347 @code{pidof} utility:
20348
20349 @smallexample
20350 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20351 @end smallexample
20352
20353 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20354 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20355 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20356
20357 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20358
20359 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20360 port.
20361
20362 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20363 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20364 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20365 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20366 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20367 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20368 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20369 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20370
20371 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20372 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20373 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20374
20375 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20376 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20377 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20378 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20379 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20380 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20381 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20382 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20383 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20384 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20385 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20386 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20387
20388 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20389 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20390
20391 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20392 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20393 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20394 program. For more information,
20395 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20396
20397 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20398 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20399 status information about the debugging process.
20400 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20401 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20402 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20403 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20404
20405 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20406 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20407 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20408 Possible options are:
20409
20410 @table @code
20411 @item none
20412 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20413 @item all
20414 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20415 @item timestamps
20416 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20417 @end table
20418
20419 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20420 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20421
20422 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20423 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20424 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20425 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20426 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20427
20428 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20429 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20430 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20431 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20432
20433 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20434 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20435 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20436 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20437
20438 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20439 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20440 environment:
20441
20442 @smallexample
20443 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20444 @end smallexample
20445
20446 @cindex @option{--selftest}
20447 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20448
20449 @smallexample
20450 $ gdbserver --selftest
20451 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20452 @end smallexample
20453
20454 These tests are disabled in release.
20455 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20456
20457 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20458 @itemize
20459
20460 @item
20461 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20462
20463 @item
20464 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20465 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20466 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20467 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20468 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20469 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20470
20471 @item
20472 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20473 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20474 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20475 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20476 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20477 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20478 program is already on the target.
20479
20480 @end itemize
20481
20482 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20483 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20484 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20485
20486 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20487 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20488 Here are the available commands.
20489
20490 @table @code
20491 @item monitor help
20492 List the available monitor commands.
20493
20494 @item monitor set debug 0
20495 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20496 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20497
20498 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20499 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20500 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20501 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20502
20503 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20504 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20505 Possible options are:
20506
20507 @table @code
20508 @item none
20509 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20510 @item all
20511 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20512 @item timestamps
20513 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20514 @end table
20515
20516 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20517 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20518
20519 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20520 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20521 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20522 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20523 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20524 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20525
20526 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20527 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20528
20529 @item monitor exit
20530 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20531 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20532 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20533 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20534 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20535
20536 @end table
20537
20538 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20539 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20540
20541 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20542 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20543
20544 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20545 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20546 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20547 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20548 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20549 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20550 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20551 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20552 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20553 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20554 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20555 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20556
20557 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20558
20559 @table @code
20560 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20561
20562 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20563 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20564 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20565
20566 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20567
20568 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20569 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20570 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20571 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20572 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20573 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20574
20575 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20576
20577 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20578 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20579 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20580 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20581 command for that. For example:
20582
20583 @smallexample
20584 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20585 @end smallexample
20586
20587 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20588 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20589 @end table
20590
20591 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20592 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20593 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20594 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20595 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20596 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20597 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20598 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20599 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20600 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20601
20602 @smallexample
20603 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20604 @end smallexample
20605
20606 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20607
20608 @smallexample
20609 $ gdb myprogram
20610 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20611 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20612 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20613 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20614 @end smallexample
20615
20616 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20617 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20618 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20619 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20620 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20621 tracing.
20622
20623 @node Remote Configuration
20624 @section Remote Configuration
20625
20626 @kindex set remote
20627 @kindex show remote
20628 This section documents the configuration options available when
20629 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20630 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20631 system-call-allowed}.
20632
20633 @table @code
20634 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20635 @cindex address size for remote targets
20636 @cindex bits in remote address
20637 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20638 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20639 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20640 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20641
20642 @item show remoteaddresssize
20643 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20644
20645 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20646 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20647 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20648 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20649 remote targets.
20650
20651 @item show serial baud
20652 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20653
20654 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20655 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20656 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20657
20658 @item show serial parity
20659 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20660
20661 @item set remotebreak
20662 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20663 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20664 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20665 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20666 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20667 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20668 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20669 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20670
20671 @item show remotebreak
20672 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20673 interrupt the remote program.
20674
20675 @item set remoteflow on
20676 @itemx set remoteflow off
20677 @kindex set remoteflow
20678 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20679 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20680
20681 @item show remoteflow
20682 @kindex show remoteflow
20683 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20684
20685 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20686 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20687 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20688 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20689 @code{ascii}.
20690
20691 @item show remotelogbase
20692 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20693 protocol.
20694
20695 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20696 @cindex record serial communications on file
20697 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20698 default is not to record at all.
20699
20700 @item show remotelogfile.
20701 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20702 serial communications.
20703
20704 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20705 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20706 @cindex remote timeout
20707 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20708 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20709
20710 @item show remotetimeout
20711 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20712 responses.
20713
20714 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20715 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20716 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20717 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20718 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20719 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20720 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20721 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20722
20723 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20724 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20725 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20726 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20727 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20728 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20729 as unlimited.
20730
20731 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20732 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20733 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20734
20735 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20736 @itemx show remote exec-file
20737 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20738 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20739 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20740 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20741 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20742 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20743
20744 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20745 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20746 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20747 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20748 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20749 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20750 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20751 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20752 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20753 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20754
20755 @item show interrupt-sequence
20756 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20757 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20758 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20759 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20760
20761 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20762 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20763 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20764 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20765 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20766 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20767
20768 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20769 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20770 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20771
20772 @kindex set tcp
20773 @kindex show tcp
20774 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20775 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20776 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20777 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20778 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20779 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20780 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20781 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20782 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20783
20784 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20785 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20786
20787 @item show tcp auto-retry
20788 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20789
20790 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20791 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20792 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20793 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20794 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20795 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20796 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20797 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20798 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20799 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20800 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20801
20802 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20803 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20804 @end table
20805
20806 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20807 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20808 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20809 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20810 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20811 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20812 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20813 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20814 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20815
20816 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20817 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20818 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20819 @value{GDBN} developers.
20820
20821 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20822 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20823 are:
20824
20825 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20826 @item Command Name
20827 @tab Remote Packet
20828 @tab Related Features
20829
20830 @item @code{fetch-register}
20831 @tab @code{p}
20832 @tab @code{info registers}
20833
20834 @item @code{set-register}
20835 @tab @code{P}
20836 @tab @code{set}
20837
20838 @item @code{binary-download}
20839 @tab @code{X}
20840 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20841
20842 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20843 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20844 @tab @code{info auxv}
20845
20846 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20847 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20848 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20849
20850 @item @code{attach}
20851 @tab @code{vAttach}
20852 @tab @code{attach}
20853
20854 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20855 @tab @code{vCont}
20856 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20857
20858 @item @code{run}
20859 @tab @code{vRun}
20860 @tab @code{run}
20861
20862 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20863 @tab @code{Z0}
20864 @tab @code{break}
20865
20866 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20867 @tab @code{Z1}
20868 @tab @code{hbreak}
20869
20870 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20871 @tab @code{Z2}
20872 @tab @code{watch}
20873
20874 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20875 @tab @code{Z3}
20876 @tab @code{rwatch}
20877
20878 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20879 @tab @code{Z4}
20880 @tab @code{awatch}
20881
20882 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20883 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20884 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20885
20886 @item @code{target-features}
20887 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20888 @tab @code{set architecture}
20889
20890 @item @code{library-info}
20891 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20892 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20893
20894 @item @code{memory-map}
20895 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20896 @tab @code{info mem}
20897
20898 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20899 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20900 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20901
20902 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20903 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20904 @tab @code{info spu}
20905
20906 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20907 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20908 @tab @code{info spu}
20909
20910 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20911 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20912 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20913
20914 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20915 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20916 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20917
20918 @item @code{threads}
20919 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20920 @tab @code{info threads}
20921
20922 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20923 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20924 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20925
20926 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20927 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20928 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20929
20930 @item @code{search-memory}
20931 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20932 @tab @code{find}
20933
20934 @item @code{supported-packets}
20935 @tab @code{qSupported}
20936 @tab Remote communications parameters
20937
20938 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20939 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20940 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20941
20942 @item @code{pass-signals}
20943 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20944 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20945
20946 @item @code{program-signals}
20947 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20948 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20949
20950 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20951 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20952 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20953
20954 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20955 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20956 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20957
20958 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20959 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20960 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20961
20962 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20963 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20964 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20965
20966 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20967 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20968 @tab @code{remote delete}
20969
20970 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20971 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20972 @tab Host I/O
20973
20974 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20975 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20976 @tab Host I/O
20977
20978 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20979 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20980 @tab Host I/O
20981
20982 @item @code{noack-packet}
20983 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20984 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20985
20986 @item @code{osdata}
20987 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20988 @tab @code{info os}
20989
20990 @item @code{query-attached}
20991 @tab @code{qAttached}
20992 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20993
20994 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20995 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20996 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20997
20998 @item @code{trace-status}
20999 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21000 @tab @code{tstatus}
21001
21002 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21003 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21004 @tab Traceframe info
21005
21006 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21007 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21008 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21009
21010 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21011 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21012 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21013
21014 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21015 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21016 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21017
21018 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21019 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21020 @tab @code{set environment}
21021
21022 @item @code{environment-unset}
21023 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21024 @tab @code{unset environment}
21025
21026 @item @code{environment-reset}
21027 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21028 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21029
21030 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21031 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21032 @tab @code{set cwd}
21033
21034 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21035 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21036 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21037
21038 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21039 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21040 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21041
21042 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21043 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21044 @tab @code{break}
21045
21046 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21047 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21048 @tab @code{hbreak}
21049
21050 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21051 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21052 @tab @code{fork}
21053
21054 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21055 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21056 @tab @code{vfork}
21057
21058 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21059 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21060 @tab @code{exec}
21061
21062 @item @code{thread-events}
21063 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21064 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21065
21066 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21067 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21068 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21069
21070 @end multitable
21071
21072 @node Remote Stub
21073 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21074
21075 @cindex debugging stub, example
21076 @cindex remote stub, example
21077 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21078 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21079 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21080 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21081 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21082 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21083 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21084 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21085
21086 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21087 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21088 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21089 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21090 program, you need:
21091
21092 @enumerate
21093 @item
21094 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21095 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21096 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21097
21098 @item
21099 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21100 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21101
21102 @item
21103 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21104 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21105 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21106 documentation.
21107 @end enumerate
21108
21109 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21110 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21111 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21112
21113 @table @emph
21114 @item On the host,
21115 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21116 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21117 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21118
21119 @item On the target,
21120 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21121 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21122 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21123
21124 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21125 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21126 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21127 @end table
21128
21129 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21130 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21131 @sc{sparc} boards.
21132
21133 @cindex remote serial stub list
21134 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21135
21136 @table @code
21137
21138 @item i386-stub.c
21139 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21140 @cindex Intel
21141 @cindex i386
21142 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21143
21144 @item m68k-stub.c
21145 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21146 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21147 @cindex m680x0
21148 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21149
21150 @item sh-stub.c
21151 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21152 @cindex Renesas
21153 @cindex SH
21154 For Renesas SH architectures.
21155
21156 @item sparc-stub.c
21157 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21158 @cindex Sparc
21159 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21160
21161 @item sparcl-stub.c
21162 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21163 @cindex Fujitsu
21164 @cindex SparcLite
21165 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21166
21167 @end table
21168
21169 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21170 recently added stubs.
21171
21172 @menu
21173 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21174 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21175 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21176 @end menu
21177
21178 @node Stub Contents
21179 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21180
21181 @cindex remote serial stub
21182 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21183 subroutines:
21184
21185 @table @code
21186 @item set_debug_traps
21187 @findex set_debug_traps
21188 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21189 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21190 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21191 program's startup code.
21192
21193 @item handle_exception
21194 @findex handle_exception
21195 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21196 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21197 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21198 run when a trap is triggered.
21199
21200 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21201 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21202 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21203 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21204 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21205 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21206 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21207 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21208 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21209 machine.
21210
21211 @item breakpoint
21212 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21213 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21214 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21215 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21216 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21217 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21218 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21219 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21220 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21221 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21222 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21223
21224 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21225 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21226 start of your debugging session.
21227 @end table
21228
21229 @node Bootstrapping
21230 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21231
21232 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21233 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21234 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21235 debugging target machine.
21236
21237 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21238 serial port.
21239
21240 @table @code
21241 @item int getDebugChar()
21242 @findex getDebugChar
21243 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21244 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21245 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21246
21247 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21248 @findex putDebugChar
21249 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21250 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21251 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21252 @end table
21253
21254 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21255 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21256 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21257 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21258 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21259 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21260 remote system to stop.
21261
21262 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21263 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21264 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21265 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21266
21267 Other routines you need to supply are:
21268
21269 @table @code
21270 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21271 @findex exceptionHandler
21272 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21273 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21274 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21275 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21276 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21277 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21278 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21279 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21280 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21281 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21282 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21283 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21284 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21285
21286 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21287 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21288 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21289 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21290 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21291
21292 @item void flush_i_cache()
21293 @findex flush_i_cache
21294 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21295 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21296 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21297
21298 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21299 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21300 @end table
21301
21302 @noindent
21303 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21304
21305 @table @code
21306 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21307 @findex memset
21308 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21309 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21310 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21311 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21312 @end table
21313
21314 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21315 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21316 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21317 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21318
21319
21320 @node Debug Session
21321 @subsection Putting it All Together
21322
21323 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21324 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21325 steps.
21326
21327 @enumerate
21328 @item
21329 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21330 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21331 @display
21332 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21333 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21334 @end display
21335
21336 @item
21337 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21338 procedure is called:
21339
21340 @smallexample
21341 set_debug_traps();
21342 breakpoint();
21343 @end smallexample
21344
21345 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21346 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21347 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21348 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21349 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21350 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21351 progress.
21352
21353 @item
21354 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21355 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21356
21357 @smallexample
21358 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21359 @end smallexample
21360
21361 @noindent
21362 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21363 function in your program, that function is called when
21364 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21365 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21366 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21367
21368 @item
21369 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21370 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21371
21372 @item
21373 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21374 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21375
21376 @item
21377 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21378 @c document that. FIXME.
21379 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21380 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21381
21382 @item
21383 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21384 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21385
21386 @end enumerate
21387
21388 @node Configurations
21389 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21390
21391 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21392 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21393 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21394
21395 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21396 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21397 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21398 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21399 are quite different from each other.
21400
21401 @menu
21402 * Native::
21403 * Embedded OS::
21404 * Embedded Processors::
21405 * Architectures::
21406 @end menu
21407
21408 @node Native
21409 @section Native
21410
21411 This section describes details specific to particular native
21412 configurations.
21413
21414 @menu
21415 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21416 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21417 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21418 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21419 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21420 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21421 @end menu
21422
21423 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21424 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21425
21426 @cindex libkvm
21427 @cindex kernel memory image
21428 @cindex kernel crash dump
21429
21430 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21431 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21432 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21433 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21434 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21435 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21436 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21437 @code{kvm} target:
21438
21439 @smallexample
21440 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21441 @end smallexample
21442
21443 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21444 argument:
21445
21446 @smallexample
21447 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21448 @end smallexample
21449
21450 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21451 available:
21452
21453 @table @code
21454 @kindex kvm
21455 @item kvm pcb
21456 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21457
21458 @item kvm proc
21459 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21460 modern FreeBSD systems.
21461 @end table
21462
21463 @node SVR4 Process Information
21464 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21465 @cindex /proc
21466 @cindex examine process image
21467 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21468
21469 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21470 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21471 process using file-system subroutines.
21472
21473 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21474 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21475 information about the process running your program, or about any
21476 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21477 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21478
21479 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21480 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21481
21482 @table @code
21483 @kindex info proc
21484 @cindex process ID
21485 @item info proc
21486 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21487 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21488 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21489 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21490 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21491 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21492 executable file's absolute file name.
21493
21494 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21495 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21496 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21497 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21498 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21499 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21500
21501 @item info proc cmdline
21502 @cindex info proc cmdline
21503 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21504 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21505
21506 @item info proc cwd
21507 @cindex info proc cwd
21508 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21509 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21510
21511 @item info proc exe
21512 @cindex info proc exe
21513 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21514 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21515
21516 @item info proc mappings
21517 @cindex memory address space mappings
21518 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21519 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21520 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21521 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21522 memory access rights to that range.
21523
21524 @item info proc stat
21525 @itemx info proc status
21526 @cindex process detailed status information
21527 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21528 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21529 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21530 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21531 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21532 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21533 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21534
21535 @item info proc all
21536 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21537 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21538
21539 @ignore
21540 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21541 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21542 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21543 @kindex info proc times
21544 @item info proc times
21545 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21546 its children.
21547
21548 @kindex info proc id
21549 @item info proc id
21550 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21551 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21552 @end ignore
21553
21554 @item set procfs-trace
21555 @kindex set procfs-trace
21556 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21557 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21558
21559 @item show procfs-trace
21560 @kindex show procfs-trace
21561 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21562
21563 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21564 @kindex set procfs-file
21565 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21566 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21567 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21568 standard output.
21569
21570 @item show procfs-file
21571 @kindex show procfs-file
21572 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21573
21574 @item proc-trace-entry
21575 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21576 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21577 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21578 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21579 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21580 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21581 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21582 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21583 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21584
21585 @item info pidlist
21586 @kindex info pidlist
21587 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21588 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21589 processes and all the threads within each process.
21590
21591 @item info meminfo
21592 @kindex info meminfo
21593 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21594 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21595 @end table
21596
21597 @node DJGPP Native
21598 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21599 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21600 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21601 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21602
21603 @cindex DPMI
21604 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21605 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21606 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21607 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21608
21609 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21610 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21611 subsection describes those commands.
21612
21613 @table @code
21614 @kindex info dos
21615 @item info dos
21616 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21617 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21618
21619 @kindex sysinfo
21620 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21621 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21622 @item info dos sysinfo
21623 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21624 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21625 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21626
21627 @cindex GDT
21628 @cindex LDT
21629 @cindex IDT
21630 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21631 @cindex descriptor tables display
21632 @item info dos gdt
21633 @itemx info dos ldt
21634 @itemx info dos idt
21635 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21636 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21637 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21638 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21639 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21640 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21641 rights.
21642
21643 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21644 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21645 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21646 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21647 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21648
21649 @cindex garbled pointers
21650 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21651 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21652 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21653 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21654 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21655 debugged program's data segment:
21656
21657 @smallexample
21658 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21659 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21660 @end smallexample
21661
21662 @noindent
21663 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21664 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21665
21666 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21667 @item info dos pde
21668 @itemx info dos pte
21669 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21670 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21671 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21672 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21673 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21674 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21675 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21676 that is currently in use.
21677
21678 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21679 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21680 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21681 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21682 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21683 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21684 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21685
21686 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21687 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21688 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21689 controller.
21690
21691 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21692
21693 @cindex physical address from linear address
21694 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21695 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21696 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21697 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21698 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21699 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21700 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21701
21702 @smallexample
21703 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21704 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21705 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21706 @end smallexample
21707
21708 @noindent
21709 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21710 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21711 attributes of that page.
21712
21713 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21714 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21715 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21716 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21717 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21718 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21719
21720 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21721 transfer buffer:
21722
21723 @smallexample
21724 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21725 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21726 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21727 @end smallexample
21728
21729 @noindent
21730 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21731 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21732 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21733 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21734 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21735
21736 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21737 @end table
21738
21739 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21740 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21741 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21742 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21743
21744 @table @code
21745 @kindex set com1base
21746 @kindex set com1irq
21747 @kindex set com2base
21748 @kindex set com2irq
21749 @kindex set com3base
21750 @kindex set com3irq
21751 @kindex set com4base
21752 @kindex set com4irq
21753 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21754 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21755 port.
21756
21757 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21758 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21759 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21760
21761 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21762 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21763 other 3 COM ports.
21764
21765 @kindex show com1base
21766 @kindex show com1irq
21767 @kindex show com2base
21768 @kindex show com2irq
21769 @kindex show com3base
21770 @kindex show com3irq
21771 @kindex show com4base
21772 @kindex show com4irq
21773 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21774 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21775 lines used by the COM ports.
21776
21777 @item info serial
21778 @kindex info serial
21779 @cindex DOS serial port status
21780 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21781 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21782 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21783 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21784 @end table
21785
21786
21787 @node Cygwin Native
21788 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21789 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21790 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21791 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21792
21793 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21794 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21795
21796 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21797 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21798 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21799 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21800 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21801 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21802 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21803 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21804
21805 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21806 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21807 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21808
21809 @table @code
21810 @kindex info w32
21811 @item info w32
21812 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21813 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21814
21815 @item info w32 selector
21816 This command displays information returned by
21817 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21818 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21819 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21820 Without argument, this command displays information
21821 about the six segment registers.
21822
21823 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21824 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21825 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21826 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21827
21828 @kindex signal-event
21829 @item signal-event @var{id}
21830 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21831 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21832
21833 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21834 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21835 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21836 (for x86_64 versions):
21837
21838 @itemize @minus
21839 @item
21840 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21841 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21842 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21843
21844 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21845 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21846 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21847 to attach.
21848
21849 @item
21850 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21851 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21852 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21853 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21854 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21855 @end itemize
21856
21857 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21858 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21859 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21860 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21861 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21862 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21863 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21864 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21865 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21866 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21867 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21868
21869 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21870 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21871 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21872 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21873
21874 @kindex set new-console
21875 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21876 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21877 be started in a new console on next start.
21878 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21879 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21880
21881 @kindex show new-console
21882 @item show new-console
21883 Displays whether a new console is used
21884 when the debuggee is started.
21885
21886 @kindex set new-group
21887 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21888 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21889 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21890 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21891 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21892
21893 @kindex show new-group
21894 @item show new-group
21895 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21896
21897 @kindex set debugevents
21898 @item set debugevents
21899 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21900 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21901 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21902 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21903 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21904
21905 @kindex set debugexec
21906 @item set debugexec
21907 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21908 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21909
21910 @kindex set debugexceptions
21911 @item set debugexceptions
21912 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21913 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21914
21915 @kindex set debugmemory
21916 @item set debugmemory
21917 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21918 and writes by the debugger.
21919
21920 @kindex set shell
21921 @item set shell
21922 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21923 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21924
21925 @kindex show shell
21926 @item show shell
21927 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21928
21929 @end table
21930
21931 @menu
21932 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21933 @end menu
21934
21935 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21936 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21937 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21938 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21939
21940 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21941 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21942 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21943 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21944 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21945 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21946 ``minimal symbols''.
21947
21948 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21949 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21950 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21951 program run once to completion.
21952
21953 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21954
21955 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21956 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21957 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21958 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21959 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21960 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21961 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21962 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21963 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21964
21965 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21966 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21967 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21968 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21969 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21970 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21971
21972 @smallexample
21973 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21974 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21975
21976 Non-debugging symbols:
21977 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21978 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21979 @end smallexample
21980
21981 @smallexample
21982 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21983 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21984
21985 Non-debugging symbols:
21986 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21987 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21988 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21989 [etc...]
21990 @end smallexample
21991
21992 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21993
21994 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21995 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21996 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21997 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21998 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21999 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22000 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22001
22002 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22003 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22004 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22005 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22006 problem:
22007
22008 @smallexample
22009 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22010 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22011 @end smallexample
22012
22013 @smallexample
22014 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22015 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22016 @end smallexample
22017
22018 And two possible solutions:
22019
22020 @smallexample
22021 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22022 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22023 @end smallexample
22024
22025 @smallexample
22026 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22027 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22028 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22029 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22030 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22031 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22032 @end smallexample
22033
22034 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22035 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22036 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22037 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22038 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22039
22040 @smallexample
22041 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22042 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22043 @end smallexample
22044
22045 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22046 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22047 safe.
22048
22049 @node Hurd Native
22050 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22051 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22052
22053 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22054 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22055
22056 @table @code
22057 @item set signals
22058 @itemx set sigs
22059 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22060 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22061 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22062 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22063 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22064 @code{signals}.
22065
22066 @item show signals
22067 @itemx show sigs
22068 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22069 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22070 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22071
22072 @item set signal-thread
22073 @itemx set sigthread
22074 @kindex set signal-thread
22075 @kindex set sigthread
22076 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22077 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22078 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22079 signal-thread}.
22080
22081 @item show signal-thread
22082 @itemx show sigthread
22083 @kindex show signal-thread
22084 @kindex show sigthread
22085 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22086 delivered a signal.
22087
22088 @item set stopped
22089 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22090 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22091 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22092 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22093
22094 @item show stopped
22095 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22096 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22097 stopped.
22098
22099 @item set exceptions
22100 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22101 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22102 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22103 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22104 trapping on.
22105
22106 @item show exceptions
22107 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22108 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22109
22110 @item set task pause
22111 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22112 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22113 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22114 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22115 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22116 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22117 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22118 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22119 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22120
22121 @item show task pause
22122 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22123 Show the current state of task suspension.
22124
22125 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22126 @cindex task suspend count
22127 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22128 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22129 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22130
22131 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22132 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22133
22134 @item set task exception-port
22135 @itemx set task excp
22136 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22137 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22138 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22139 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22140
22141 @item set noninvasive
22142 @cindex noninvasive task options
22143 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22144 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22145 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22146 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22147
22148 @item info send-rights
22149 @itemx info receive-rights
22150 @itemx info port-rights
22151 @itemx info port-sets
22152 @itemx info dead-names
22153 @itemx info ports
22154 @itemx info psets
22155 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22156 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22157 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22158 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22159 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22160 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22161 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22162 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22163 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22164
22165 @item set thread pause
22166 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22167 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22168 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22169 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22170 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22171 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22172 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22173 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22174 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22175 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22176 only the current thread.
22177
22178 @item show thread pause
22179 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22180 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22181
22182 @item set thread run
22183 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22184
22185 @item show thread run
22186 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22187
22188 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22189 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22190 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22191 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22192 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22193 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22194 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22195
22196 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22197 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22198 detaching.
22199
22200 @item set thread exception-port
22201 @itemx set thread excp
22202 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22203 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22204 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22205
22206 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22207 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22208 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22209 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22210
22211 @item set thread default
22212 @itemx show thread default
22213 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22214 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22215 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22216 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22217 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22218 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22219 the non-default commands.
22220 @end table
22221
22222 @node Darwin
22223 @subsection Darwin
22224 @cindex Darwin
22225
22226 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22227
22228 @table @code
22229 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22230 @kindex set debug darwin
22231 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22232 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22233
22234 @item show debug darwin
22235 @kindex show debug darwin
22236 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22237
22238 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22239 @kindex set debug mach-o
22240 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22241 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22242 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22243 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22244 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22245 usage.
22246
22247 @item show debug mach-o
22248 @kindex show debug mach-o
22249 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22250
22251 @item set mach-exceptions on
22252 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22253 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22254 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22255 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22256 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22257 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22258
22259 @item show mach-exceptions
22260 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22261 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22262 @end table
22263
22264
22265 @node Embedded OS
22266 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22267
22268 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22269 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22270 architectures.
22271
22272 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22273 various real-time operating systems.
22274
22275 @node Embedded Processors
22276 @section Embedded Processors
22277
22278 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22279 configurations.
22280
22281 @cindex send command to simulator
22282 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22283 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22284
22285 @table @code
22286 @item sim @var{command}
22287 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22288 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22289 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22290 acceptable commands.
22291 @end table
22292
22293
22294 @menu
22295 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22296 * ARM:: ARM
22297 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22298 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22299 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22300 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22301 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22302 * CRIS:: CRIS
22303 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22304 @end menu
22305
22306 @node ARC
22307 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22308 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22309 @cindex ARC specific commands
22310 @cindex ARC600
22311 @cindex ARC700
22312 @cindex ARC EM
22313 @cindex ARC HS
22314
22315 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22316
22317 @table @code
22318 @item set debug arc
22319 @kindex set debug arc
22320 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22321 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22322
22323 @item show debug arc
22324 @kindex show debug arc
22325 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22326
22327 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22328 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22329 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22330
22331 @end table
22332
22333 @node ARM
22334 @subsection ARM
22335
22336 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22337
22338 @table @code
22339 @item set arm disassembler
22340 @kindex set arm
22341 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22342 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22343
22344 @item show arm disassembler
22345 @kindex show arm
22346 Show the current disassembly style.
22347
22348 @item set arm apcs32
22349 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22350 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22351
22352 @item show arm apcs32
22353 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22354
22355 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22356 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22357 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22358
22359 @table @code
22360 @item auto
22361 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22362 @item softfpa
22363 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22364 processors.
22365 @item fpa
22366 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22367 @item softvfp
22368 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22369 @item vfp
22370 VFP co-processor.
22371 @end table
22372
22373 @item show arm fpu
22374 Show the current type of the FPU.
22375
22376 @item set arm abi
22377 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22378
22379 @item show arm abi
22380 Show the currently used ABI.
22381
22382 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22383 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22384 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22385 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22386 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22387 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22388 register).
22389
22390 @item show arm fallback-mode
22391 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22392
22393 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22394 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22395 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22396 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22397 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22398
22399 @item show arm force-mode
22400 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22401
22402 @item set debug arm
22403 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22404 target support subsystem.
22405
22406 @item show debug arm
22407 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22408 @end table
22409
22410 @table @code
22411 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22412 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22413
22414 @table @code
22415 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22416 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22417 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22418 The default value is @code{all}.
22419
22420 @table @code
22421 @item none
22422 @item demon
22423 @item angel
22424 @item redboot
22425 @item all
22426 @end table
22427 @end table
22428 @end table
22429
22430 @node M68K
22431 @subsection M68k
22432
22433 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22434
22435 @node MicroBlaze
22436 @subsection MicroBlaze
22437 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22438 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22439
22440 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22441 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22442 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22443 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22444 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22445 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22446 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22447 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22448 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22449 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22450 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22451
22452 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22453
22454 @table @code
22455 @item target remote :1234
22456 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22457 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22458
22459 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22460 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22461 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22462
22463 @item load
22464 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22465
22466 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22467 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22468
22469 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22470 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22471 @end table
22472
22473 @node MIPS Embedded
22474 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22475
22476 @noindent
22477 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22478
22479 @table @code
22480 @item set mipsfpu double
22481 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22482 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22483 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22484 @itemx show mipsfpu
22485 @kindex set mipsfpu
22486 @kindex show mipsfpu
22487 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22488 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22489 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22490 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22491 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22492 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22493 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22494 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22495 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22496 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22497 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22498 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22499 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22500
22501 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22502 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22503 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22504
22505 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22506 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22507 @end table
22508
22509 @node PowerPC Embedded
22510 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22511
22512 @cindex DVC register
22513 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22514 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22515
22516 @smallexample
22517 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22518 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22519 @end smallexample
22520
22521 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22522 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22523 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22524 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22525 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22526 or newer.
22527
22528 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22529 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22530 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22531 watching variables of scalar types.
22532
22533 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22534 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22535
22536 @smallexample
22537 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22538 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22539 @end smallexample
22540
22541 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22542 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22543
22544 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22545 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22546 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22547 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22548 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22549 use the @code{break-range} command.
22550
22551 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22552
22553 @table @code
22554 @kindex break-range
22555 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22556 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22557 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22558 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22559 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22560 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22561 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22562 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22563 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22564
22565 @kindex set powerpc
22566 @item set powerpc soft-float
22567 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22568 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22569 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22570 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22571
22572 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22573 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22574 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22575 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22576 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22577 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22578 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22579 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22580
22581 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22582 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22583 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22584 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22585 address of its first byte.
22586
22587 @end table
22588
22589 @node AVR
22590 @subsection Atmel AVR
22591 @cindex AVR
22592
22593 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22594 following AVR-specific commands:
22595
22596 @table @code
22597 @item info io_registers
22598 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22599 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22600 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22601 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22602 @end table
22603
22604 @node CRIS
22605 @subsection CRIS
22606 @cindex CRIS
22607
22608 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22609 following CRIS-specific commands:
22610
22611 @table @code
22612 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22613 @cindex CRIS version
22614 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22615 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22616 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22617
22618 @item show cris-version
22619 Show the current CRIS version.
22620
22621 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22622 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22623 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22624 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22625 @code{R59}.
22626
22627 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22628 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22629
22630 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22631 @cindex CRIS mode
22632 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22633 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22634 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22635
22636 @item show cris-mode
22637 Show the current CRIS mode.
22638 @end table
22639
22640 @node Super-H
22641 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22642 @cindex Super-H
22643
22644 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22645 commands:
22646
22647 @table @code
22648 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22649 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22650 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22651 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22652 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22653 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22654 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22655 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22656 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22657 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22658 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22659 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22660
22661 @item show sh calling-convention
22662 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22663 Show the current calling convention setting.
22664
22665 @end table
22666
22667
22668 @node Architectures
22669 @section Architectures
22670
22671 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22672 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22673
22674 @menu
22675 * AArch64::
22676 * i386::
22677 * Alpha::
22678 * MIPS::
22679 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22680 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22681 * PowerPC::
22682 * Nios II::
22683 * Sparc64::
22684 @end menu
22685
22686 @node AArch64
22687 @subsection AArch64
22688 @cindex AArch64 support
22689
22690 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22691 following special commands:
22692
22693 @table @code
22694 @item set debug aarch64
22695 @kindex set debug aarch64
22696 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22697 messages are to be displayed.
22698
22699 @item show debug aarch64
22700 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22701
22702 @end table
22703
22704 @node i386
22705 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22706
22707 @table @code
22708 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22709 @kindex set struct-convention
22710 @cindex struct return convention
22711 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22712 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22713 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22714 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22715 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22716 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22717 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22718 be returned in a register.
22719
22720 @item show struct-convention
22721 @kindex show struct-convention
22722 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22723 from functions.
22724 @end table
22725
22726
22727 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22728 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22729
22730 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22731 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22732 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22733 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22734 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22735 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22736 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22737
22738 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22739 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22740 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22741 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22742 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22743 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22744
22745 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22746 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22747 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22748
22749 @smallexample
22750 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22751 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22752 @end smallexample
22753
22754 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22755 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22756 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22757 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22758 the pointer.
22759
22760 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22761 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22762 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22763 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22764 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22765
22766 @table @code
22767 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22768 @kindex show mpx bound
22769 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22770
22771 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22772 @kindex set mpx bound
22773 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22774 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22775 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22776 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22777 @end table
22778
22779 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22780 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22781 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22782 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22783
22784 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22785 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22786 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22787 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22788 function.
22789
22790 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22791 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22792 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22793 continuing the execution. For example:
22794
22795 @smallexample
22796 $ break *upper
22797 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22798 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22799 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22800 $ print $bnd0
22801 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22802 @end smallexample
22803
22804 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22805 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
22806 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22807
22808 @node Alpha
22809 @subsection Alpha
22810
22811 See the following section.
22812
22813 @node MIPS
22814 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22815
22816 @cindex stack on Alpha
22817 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22818 @cindex Alpha stack
22819 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22820 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22821 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22822 find the beginning of a function.
22823
22824 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22825 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22826 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22827 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22828 commands:
22829
22830 @table @code
22831 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22832 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22833 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22834 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22835 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22836 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22837 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22838 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22839
22840 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22841 Display the current limit.
22842 @end table
22843
22844 @noindent
22845 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22846 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22847
22848 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22849 programs:
22850
22851 @table @code
22852 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22853 @kindex set mips abi
22854 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22855 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22856 values of @var{arg} are:
22857
22858 @table @samp
22859 @item auto
22860 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22861 default).
22862 @item o32
22863 @item o64
22864 @item n32
22865 @item n64
22866 @item eabi32
22867 @item eabi64
22868 @end table
22869
22870 @item show mips abi
22871 @kindex show mips abi
22872 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22873
22874 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22875 @kindex set mips compression
22876 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22877 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22878 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22879 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22880 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22881 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22882 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22883 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22884 provided by the executable.
22885
22886 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22887 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22888 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22889 identified as such.
22890
22891 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22892 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22893 implicitly from an executable.
22894
22895 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22896 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22897 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22898 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22899 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22900
22901 @item show mips compression
22902 @kindex show mips compression
22903 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22904 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22905
22906 @item set mipsfpu
22907 @itemx show mipsfpu
22908 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22909
22910 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22911 @kindex set mips mask-address
22912 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22913 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22914 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22915 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22916 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22917
22918 @item show mips mask-address
22919 @kindex show mips mask-address
22920 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22921 not.
22922
22923 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22924 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22925 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22926 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22927 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22928 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22929
22930 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22931 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22932 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22933
22934 @item set debug mips
22935 @kindex set debug mips
22936 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22937 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22938
22939 @item show debug mips
22940 @kindex show debug mips
22941 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22942 @end table
22943
22944
22945 @node HPPA
22946 @subsection HPPA
22947 @cindex HPPA support
22948
22949 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22950 following special commands:
22951
22952 @table @code
22953 @item set debug hppa
22954 @kindex set debug hppa
22955 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22956 messages are to be displayed.
22957
22958 @item show debug hppa
22959 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22960
22961 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22962 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22963 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22964 given @var{address}.
22965
22966 @end table
22967
22968
22969 @node SPU
22970 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22971 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22972 @cindex SPU
22973
22974 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22975 it provides the following special commands:
22976
22977 @table @code
22978 @item info spu event
22979 @kindex info spu
22980 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22981 and pending event status.
22982
22983 @item info spu signal
22984 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22985 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22986 notification channels.
22987
22988 @item info spu mailbox
22989 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22990 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22991 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22992
22993 @item info spu dma
22994 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22995 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22996 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22997
22998 @item info spu proxydma
22999 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23000 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23001 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23002
23003 @end table
23004
23005 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23006 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23007 special commands:
23008
23009 @table @code
23010 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23011 @kindex set spu
23012 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23013 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23014 function. The default is @code{off}.
23015
23016 @item show spu stop-on-load
23017 @kindex show spu
23018 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23019
23020 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23021 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23022 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23023 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23024 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23025 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23026
23027 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23028 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23029
23030 @end table
23031
23032 @node PowerPC
23033 @subsection PowerPC
23034 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23035
23036 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23037 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23038 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23039 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23040 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23041
23042 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23043 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23044 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23045
23046 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23047 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23048
23049 @node Nios II
23050 @subsection Nios II
23051 @cindex Nios II architecture
23052
23053 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23054 it provides the following special commands:
23055
23056 @table @code
23057
23058 @item set debug nios2
23059 @kindex set debug nios2
23060 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23061 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23062
23063 @item show debug nios2
23064 @kindex show debug nios2
23065 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23066 @end table
23067
23068 @node Sparc64
23069 @subsection Sparc64
23070 @cindex Sparc64 support
23071 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23072 @subsubsection ADI Support
23073
23074 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23075 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23076 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23077 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23078 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23079 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23080 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23081 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23082 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23083 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23084 signal.
23085
23086 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23087 ADI-enabled.
23088
23089 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23090 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23091
23092
23093 @table @code
23094 @kindex adi examine
23095 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23096
23097 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23098 cacheline.
23099
23100 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23101 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23102 block size, to display.
23103
23104 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23105 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23106
23107 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23108
23109 @smallexample
23110 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23111 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23112 @end smallexample
23113
23114 @kindex adi assign
23115 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23116
23117 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23118 to an address.
23119
23120 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23121 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23122 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23123
23124 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23125 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23126
23127 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23128
23129 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23130 variable "shmaddr":
23131
23132 @smallexample
23133 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23134 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23135 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23136 @end smallexample
23137
23138 @end table
23139
23140 @node Controlling GDB
23141 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23142
23143 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23144 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23145 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23146 described here.
23147
23148 @menu
23149 * Prompt:: Prompt
23150 * Editing:: Command editing
23151 * Command History:: Command history
23152 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23153 * Numbers:: Numbers
23154 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23155 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23156 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23157 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23158 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23159 @end menu
23160
23161 @node Prompt
23162 @section Prompt
23163
23164 @cindex prompt
23165
23166 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23167 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23168 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23169 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23170 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23171 which one you are talking to.
23172
23173 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23174 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23175 or a prompt that does not.
23176
23177 @table @code
23178 @kindex set prompt
23179 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23180 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23181
23182 @kindex show prompt
23183 @item show prompt
23184 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23185 @end table
23186
23187 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23188 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23189 are:
23190
23191 @table @code
23192 @kindex set extended-prompt
23193 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23194 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23195 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23196 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23197 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23198 is displayed.
23199
23200 For example:
23201
23202 @smallexample
23203 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23204 @end smallexample
23205
23206 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23207 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23208
23209 @kindex show extended-prompt
23210 @item show extended-prompt
23211 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23212 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23213 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23214 @end table
23215
23216 @node Editing
23217 @section Command Editing
23218 @cindex readline
23219 @cindex command line editing
23220
23221 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23222 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23223 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23224 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23225 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23226 debugging sessions.
23227
23228 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23229 command @code{set}.
23230
23231 @table @code
23232 @kindex set editing
23233 @cindex editing
23234 @item set editing
23235 @itemx set editing on
23236 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23237
23238 @item set editing off
23239 Disable command line editing.
23240
23241 @kindex show editing
23242 @item show editing
23243 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23244 @end table
23245
23246 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23247 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23248 @end ifset
23249 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23250 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23251 @end ifclear
23252 for more details about the Readline
23253 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23254 encouraged to read that chapter.
23255
23256 @node Command History
23257 @section Command History
23258 @cindex command history
23259
23260 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23261 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23262 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23263 history facility.
23264
23265 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23266 package, to provide the history facility.
23267 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23268 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23269 @end ifset
23270 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23271 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23272 @end ifclear
23273 for the detailed description of the History library.
23274
23275 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23276 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23277 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23278 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23279 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23280 pressed on a line by itself.
23281
23282 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23283 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23284 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23285 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23286
23287 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23288 history.
23289
23290 @table @code
23291 @cindex history substitution
23292 @cindex history file
23293 @kindex set history filename
23294 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23295 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23296 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23297 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23298 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23299 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23300 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23301 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23302 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23303 is not set.
23304
23305 @cindex save command history
23306 @kindex set history save
23307 @item set history save
23308 @itemx set history save on
23309 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23310 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23311
23312 @item set history save off
23313 Stop recording command history in a file.
23314
23315 @cindex history size
23316 @kindex set history size
23317 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23318 @item set history size @var{size}
23319 @itemx set history size unlimited
23320 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23321 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23322 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23323 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23324 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23325 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23326
23327 @cindex remove duplicate history
23328 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23329 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23330 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23331 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23332 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23333 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23334 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23335 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23336 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23337
23338 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23339 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23340
23341 @end table
23342
23343 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23344 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23345 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23346 @end ifset
23347 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23348 @xref{Event Designators},
23349 @end ifclear
23350 for more details.
23351
23352 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23353 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23354 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23355 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23356 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23357 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23358 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23359 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23360
23361 The commands to control history expansion are:
23362
23363 @table @code
23364 @item set history expansion on
23365 @itemx set history expansion
23366 @kindex set history expansion
23367 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23368
23369 @item set history expansion off
23370 Disable history expansion.
23371
23372 @c @group
23373 @kindex show history
23374 @item show history
23375 @itemx show history filename
23376 @itemx show history save
23377 @itemx show history size
23378 @itemx show history expansion
23379 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23380 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23381 @c @end group
23382 @end table
23383
23384 @table @code
23385 @kindex show commands
23386 @cindex show last commands
23387 @cindex display command history
23388 @item show commands
23389 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23390
23391 @item show commands @var{n}
23392 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23393
23394 @item show commands +
23395 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23396 @end table
23397
23398 @node Screen Size
23399 @section Screen Size
23400 @cindex size of screen
23401 @cindex screen size
23402 @cindex pagination
23403 @cindex page size
23404 @cindex pauses in output
23405
23406 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23407 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23408 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23409 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23410 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23411 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23412 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23413 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23414
23415 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23416 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23417 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23418 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23419 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23420 width} commands:
23421
23422 @table @code
23423 @kindex set height
23424 @kindex set width
23425 @kindex show width
23426 @kindex show height
23427 @item set height @var{lpp}
23428 @itemx set height unlimited
23429 @itemx show height
23430 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23431 @itemx set width unlimited
23432 @itemx show width
23433 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23434 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23435 commands display the current settings.
23436
23437 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23438 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23439 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23440 buffer.
23441
23442 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23443 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23444
23445 @item set pagination on
23446 @itemx set pagination off
23447 @kindex set pagination
23448 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23449 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23450 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23451 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23452
23453 @item show pagination
23454 @kindex show pagination
23455 Show the current pagination mode.
23456 @end table
23457
23458 @node Numbers
23459 @section Numbers
23460 @cindex number representation
23461 @cindex entering numbers
23462
23463 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23464 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23465 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23466 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23467 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23468 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23469 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23470 both input and output with the commands described below.
23471
23472 @table @code
23473 @kindex set input-radix
23474 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23475 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23476 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23477 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23478 example, any of
23479
23480 @smallexample
23481 set input-radix 012
23482 set input-radix 10.
23483 set input-radix 0xa
23484 @end smallexample
23485
23486 @noindent
23487 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23488 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23489 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23490 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23491 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23492 change the radix.
23493
23494 @kindex set output-radix
23495 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23496 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23497 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23498 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23499
23500 @kindex show input-radix
23501 @item show input-radix
23502 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23503
23504 @kindex show output-radix
23505 @item show output-radix
23506 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23507
23508 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23509 @itemx show radix
23510 @kindex set radix
23511 @kindex show radix
23512 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23513 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23514 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23515 default value of 10.
23516
23517 @end table
23518
23519 @node ABI
23520 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23521
23522 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23523 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23524 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23525 current ABI.
23526
23527 @cindex OS ABI
23528 @kindex set osabi
23529 @kindex show osabi
23530 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23531
23532 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23533 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23534 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23535 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23536 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23537 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23538 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23539 platform provides.
23540
23541 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23542 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23543 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23544 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23545
23546 @table @code
23547 @item show osabi
23548 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23549
23550 @item set osabi
23551 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23552
23553 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23554 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23555 @end table
23556
23557 @cindex float promotion
23558
23559 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23560 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23561 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23562 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23563 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23564 @code{double} and then passed.
23565
23566 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23567 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23568 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23569
23570 @table @code
23571 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23572 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23573 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23574 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23575 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23576
23577 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23578 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23579 functions.
23580
23581 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23582 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23583 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23584 @end table
23585
23586 @kindex set cp-abi
23587 @kindex show cp-abi
23588 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23589 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23590 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23591 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23592 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23593 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23594 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23595 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23596 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23597 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23598 ``auto''.
23599
23600 @table @code
23601 @item show cp-abi
23602 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23603
23604 @item set cp-abi
23605 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23606
23607 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23608 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23609 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23610 @end table
23611
23612 @node Auto-loading
23613 @section Automatically loading associated files
23614 @cindex auto-loading
23615
23616 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23617 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23618 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23619 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23620 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23621 sources).
23622
23623 @menu
23624 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23625 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23626
23627 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23628 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23629 @end menu
23630
23631 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23632 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23633 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23634
23635 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23636 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23637 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23638
23639 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23640 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23641
23642 @table @code
23643 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23644 @kindex set auto-load off
23645 @item set auto-load off
23646 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23647 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23648 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23649 @smallexample
23650 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23651 @end smallexample
23652
23653 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23654 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23655 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23656 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23657 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23658 @code{set auto-load no}.
23659
23660 @anchor{show auto-load}
23661 @kindex show auto-load
23662 @item show auto-load
23663 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23664 or disabled.
23665
23666 @smallexample
23667 (gdb) show auto-load
23668 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23669 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23670 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23671 is on.
23672 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23673 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23674 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23675 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23676 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23677 @end smallexample
23678
23679 @anchor{info auto-load}
23680 @kindex info auto-load
23681 @item info auto-load
23682 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23683 not.
23684
23685 @smallexample
23686 (gdb) info auto-load
23687 gdb-scripts:
23688 Loaded Script
23689 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23690 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23691 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23692 loaded.
23693 python-scripts:
23694 Loaded Script
23695 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23696 @end smallexample
23697 @end table
23698
23699 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23700
23701 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23702 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23703 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23704 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23705 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23706 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23707 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23708 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23709 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23710 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23711 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23712 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23713 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23714 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23715 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23716 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23717 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23718 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23719 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23720 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23721 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23722 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23723 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23724 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23725 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23726 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23727 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23728 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23729 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23730 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23731 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23732 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23733 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23734 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23735 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23736 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23737 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23738 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23739 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23740 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23741 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23742 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23743 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23744 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23745 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23746 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23747 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23748 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23749 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23750 @end multitable
23751
23752 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23753 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23754 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23755
23756 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23757 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23758 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23759
23760 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23761 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23762
23763 @table @code
23764 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23765 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23766 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23767 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23768 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23769
23770 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23771 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23772 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23773 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23774 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23775
23776 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23777 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23778 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23779 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23780 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23781 @end table
23782
23783 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23784 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23785 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23786
23787 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23788
23789 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23790 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23791
23792 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23793 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23794 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23795 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23796 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23797 library.
23798
23799 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23800 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23801
23802 @table @code
23803 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23804 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23805 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23806 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23807
23808 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23809 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23810 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23811 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23812 enabled or disabled.
23813
23814 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23815 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23816 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23817 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23818 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23819 @end table
23820
23821 @node Auto-loading safe path
23822 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23823 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23824
23825 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23826 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23827 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23828 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23829 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23830
23831 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23832 get loaded:
23833
23834 @smallexample
23835 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23836 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23837 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23838 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23839 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23840 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23841 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23842 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23843 @end smallexample
23844
23845 @noindent
23846 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23847 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23848
23849 @smallexample
23850 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23851 @end smallexample
23852
23853 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23854
23855 @table @code
23856 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23857 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23858 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23859 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23860 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23861 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23862 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23863 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23864 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23865 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23866
23867 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23868 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23869 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23870
23871 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23872 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23873 @item show auto-load safe-path
23874 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23875 scripts.
23876
23877 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23878 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23879 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23880 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23881 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23882 by the host platform path separator in use.
23883 @end table
23884
23885 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23886 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23887 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23888 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23889 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23890
23891 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23892 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23893 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23894 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23895 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23896 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23897 init file in the current directory
23898 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23899
23900 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23901 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23902
23903 @table @asis
23904 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23905 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23906 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23907 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23908
23909 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23910 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23911 @value{GDBN} session.
23912
23913 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23914 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23915 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23916 from trusted sources.
23917
23918 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23919 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23920 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23921 trusted sources.
23922 @end table
23923
23924 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23925 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23926
23927 @table @asis
23928 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23929 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23930
23931 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23932 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23933 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23934 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23935 @end table
23936
23937 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23938 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23939 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23940 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23941 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23942 recommended to be entered.
23943
23944 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23945 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23946 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23947
23948 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23949 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23950 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23951 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23952 be printed.
23953
23954 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23955 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23956 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23957
23958 @smallexample
23959 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23960 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23961 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23962 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23963 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23964 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23965 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23966 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23967 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23968 @end smallexample
23969
23970 @table @code
23971 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23972 @kindex set debug auto-load
23973 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23974 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23975
23976 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23977 @kindex show debug auto-load
23978 @item show debug auto-load
23979 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23980 on or off.
23981 @end table
23982
23983 @node Messages/Warnings
23984 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23985
23986 @cindex verbose operation
23987 @cindex optional warnings
23988 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23989 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23990 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23991 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23992
23993 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23994 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23995 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23996
23997 @table @code
23998 @kindex set verbose
23999 @item set verbose on
24000 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24001
24002 @item set verbose off
24003 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24004
24005 @kindex show verbose
24006 @item show verbose
24007 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24008 @end table
24009
24010 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24011 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24012 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24013 Symbol Files}).
24014
24015 @table @code
24016
24017 @kindex set complaints
24018 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24019 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24020 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24021 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24022 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24023
24024 @kindex show complaints
24025 @item show complaints
24026 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24027
24028 @end table
24029
24030 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24031 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24032 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24033 you try to run a program which is already running:
24034
24035 @smallexample
24036 (@value{GDBP}) run
24037 The program being debugged has been started already.
24038 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24039 @end smallexample
24040
24041 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24042 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24043
24044 @table @code
24045
24046 @kindex set confirm
24047 @cindex flinching
24048 @cindex confirmation
24049 @cindex stupid questions
24050 @item set confirm off
24051 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24052 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24053 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24054
24055 @item set confirm on
24056 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24057
24058 @kindex show confirm
24059 @item show confirm
24060 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24061
24062 @end table
24063
24064 @cindex command tracing
24065 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24066 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24067 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24068 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24069
24070 @table @code
24071 @kindex set trace-commands
24072 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24073 @item set trace-commands on
24074 Enable command tracing.
24075 @item set trace-commands off
24076 Disable command tracing.
24077 @item show trace-commands
24078 Display the current state of command tracing.
24079 @end table
24080
24081 @node Debugging Output
24082 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24083 @cindex optional debugging messages
24084
24085 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24086 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24087 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24088 section documents those commands.
24089
24090 @table @code
24091 @kindex set exec-done-display
24092 @item set exec-done-display
24093 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24094 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24095 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24096 @kindex show exec-done-display
24097 @item show exec-done-display
24098 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24099 notification.
24100 @kindex set debug
24101 @cindex ARM AArch64
24102 @item set debug aarch64
24103 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24104 The default is off.
24105 @kindex show debug
24106 @item show debug aarch64
24107 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24108 ARM AArch64.
24109 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24110 @cindex architecture debugging info
24111 @item set debug arch
24112 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24113 @item show debug arch
24114 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24115 @item set debug aix-solib
24116 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24117 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24118 support module. The default is off.
24119 @item show debug aix-thread
24120 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24121 @item set debug aix-thread
24122 @cindex AIX threads
24123 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24124 module.
24125 @item show debug aix-thread
24126 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24127 @item set debug check-physname
24128 @cindex physname
24129 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24130 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24131 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24132 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24133 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24134 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24135 @item show debug check-physname
24136 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24137 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24138 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24139 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24140 exported symbols. The default is off.
24141 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24142 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24143 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24144 @item set debug dwarf-die
24145 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24146 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24147 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24148 A value of zero turns off the display.
24149 @item show debug dwarf-die
24150 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24151 @item set debug dwarf-line
24152 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24153 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24154 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24155 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24156 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24157 @item show debug dwarf-line
24158 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24159 @item set debug dwarf-read
24160 @cindex DWARF Reading
24161 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24162 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24163 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24164 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24165 @item show debug dwarf-read
24166 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24167 @item set debug displaced
24168 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24169 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24170 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24171 @item show debug displaced
24172 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24173 related to displaced stepping.
24174 @item set debug event
24175 @cindex event debugging info
24176 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24177 default is off.
24178 @item show debug event
24179 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24180 info.
24181 @item set debug expression
24182 @cindex expression debugging info
24183 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24184 expression parsing. The default is off.
24185 @item show debug expression
24186 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24187 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24188 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24189 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24190 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24191 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24192 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24193 @item set debug frame
24194 @cindex frame debugging info
24195 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24196 default is off.
24197 @item show debug frame
24198 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24199 info.
24200 @item set debug gnu-nat
24201 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24202 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24203 @item show debug gnu-nat
24204 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24205 @item set debug infrun
24206 @cindex inferior debugging info
24207 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24208 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24209 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24210 @item show debug infrun
24211 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24212 @item set debug jit
24213 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24214 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24215 @item show debug jit
24216 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24217 @item set debug lin-lwp
24218 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24219 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24220 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24221 @item show debug lin-lwp
24222 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24223 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24224 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24225 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24226 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24227 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24228 @item set debug mach-o
24229 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24230 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24231 processing. The default is off.
24232 @item show debug mach-o
24233 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24234 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24235 @item set debug notification
24236 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24237 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24238 The default is off.
24239 @item show debug notification
24240 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24241 @item set debug observer
24242 @cindex observer debugging info
24243 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24244 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24245 @item show debug observer
24246 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24247 @item set debug overload
24248 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24249 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24250 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24251 is off.
24252 @item show debug overload
24253 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24254 debugging info.
24255 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24256 @cindex debug expression parser
24257 @item set debug parser
24258 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24259 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24260 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24261 details. The default is off.
24262 @item show debug parser
24263 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24264 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24265 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24266 @cindex debug remote protocol
24267 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24268 @cindex display remote packets
24269 @item set debug remote
24270 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24271 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24272 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24273 @item show debug remote
24274 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24275
24276 @item set debug separate-debug-file
24277 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24278 @item show debug separate-debug-file
24279 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24280
24281 @item set debug serial
24282 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24283 default is off.
24284 @item show debug serial
24285 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24286 info.
24287 @item set debug solib-frv
24288 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24289 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24290 @item show debug solib-frv
24291 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24292 messages.
24293 @item set debug symbol-lookup
24294 @cindex symbol lookup
24295 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24296 The default is 0 (off).
24297 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24298 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24299 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24300 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24301 @item set debug symfile
24302 @cindex symbol file functions
24303 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24304 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24305 @item show debug symfile
24306 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24307 @item set debug symtab-create
24308 @cindex symbol table creation
24309 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24310 The default is 0 (off).
24311 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24312 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24313 @item show debug symtab-create
24314 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24315 @item set debug target
24316 @cindex target debugging info
24317 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24318 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24319 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24320 value of large memory transfers.
24321 @item show debug target
24322 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24323 info.
24324 @item set debug timestamp
24325 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24326 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24327 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24328 message.
24329 @item show debug timestamp
24330 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24331 debugging info.
24332 @item set debug varobj
24333 @cindex variable object debugging info
24334 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24335 info. The default is off.
24336 @item show debug varobj
24337 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24338 debugging info.
24339 @item set debug xml
24340 @cindex XML parser debugging
24341 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24342 @item show debug xml
24343 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24344 @end table
24345
24346 @node Other Misc Settings
24347 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24348 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24349
24350 @table @code
24351 @kindex set interactive-mode
24352 @item set interactive-mode
24353 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24354 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24355 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24356 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24357 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24358 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24359 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24360 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24361
24362 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24363 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24364 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24365 inside a cygwin window.
24366
24367 @kindex show interactive-mode
24368 @item show interactive-mode
24369 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24370 @end table
24371
24372 @node Extending GDB
24373 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24374 @cindex extending GDB
24375
24376 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24377 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24378 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24379 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24380 being debugged.
24381
24382 @menu
24383 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24384 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24385 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24386 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24387 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24388 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24389 @end menu
24390
24391 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24392 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24393 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24394 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24395 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24396 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24397
24398 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24399 setting:
24400
24401 @table @code
24402 @kindex set script-extension
24403 @kindex show script-extension
24404 @item set script-extension off
24405 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24406
24407 @item set script-extension soft
24408 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24409 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24410 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24411 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24412
24413 @item set script-extension strict
24414 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24415 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24416 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24417
24418 @item show script-extension
24419 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24420
24421 @end table
24422
24423 @node Sequences
24424 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24425
24426 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24427 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24428 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24429 files.
24430
24431 @menu
24432 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24433 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24434 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24435 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24436 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24437 @end menu
24438
24439 @node Define
24440 @subsection User-defined Commands
24441
24442 @cindex user-defined command
24443 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24444 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24445 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24446 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24447 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24448 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24449
24450 @smallexample
24451 define adder
24452 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24453 end
24454 @end smallexample
24455
24456 @noindent
24457 To execute the command use:
24458
24459 @smallexample
24460 adder 1 2 3
24461 @end smallexample
24462
24463 @noindent
24464 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24465 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24466 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24467 functions calls.
24468
24469 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24470 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24471 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24472 been passed.
24473
24474 @smallexample
24475 define adder
24476 if $argc == 2
24477 print $arg0 + $arg1
24478 end
24479 if $argc == 3
24480 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24481 end
24482 end
24483 @end smallexample
24484
24485 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24486 to process a variable number of arguments:
24487
24488 @smallexample
24489 define adder
24490 set $i = 0
24491 set $sum = 0
24492 while $i < $argc
24493 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24494 set $i = $i + 1
24495 end
24496 print $sum
24497 end
24498 @end smallexample
24499
24500 @table @code
24501
24502 @kindex define
24503 @item define @var{commandname}
24504 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24505 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24506 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24507 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24508 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24509 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24510
24511 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24512 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24513 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24514
24515 @kindex document
24516 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24517 @item document @var{commandname}
24518 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24519 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24520 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24521 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24522 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24523 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24524
24525 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24526 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24527 does not change the documentation.
24528
24529 @kindex dont-repeat
24530 @cindex don't repeat command
24531 @item dont-repeat
24532 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24533 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24534 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24535
24536 @kindex help user-defined
24537 @item help user-defined
24538 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24539 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24540 included (if any).
24541
24542 @kindex show user
24543 @item show user
24544 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24545 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24546 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24547 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24548 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24549
24550 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24551 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24552 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24553 @item show max-user-call-depth
24554 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24555 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24556 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24557 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24558 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24559 @end table
24560
24561 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24562 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24563
24564 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24565 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24566 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24567
24568 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24569 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24570 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24571 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24572
24573 @node Hooks
24574 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24575 @cindex command hooks
24576 @cindex hooks, for commands
24577 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24578
24579 @kindex hook
24580 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24581 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24582 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24583 before that command.
24584
24585 @cindex hooks, post-command
24586 @kindex hookpost
24587 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24588 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24589 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24590 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24591 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24592
24593 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24594 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24595
24596 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24597 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24598
24599 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24600 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24601 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24602 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24603 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24604
24605 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24606 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24607 you could define:
24608
24609 @smallexample
24610 define hook-stop
24611 handle SIGALRM nopass
24612 end
24613
24614 define hook-run
24615 handle SIGALRM pass
24616 end
24617
24618 define hook-continue
24619 handle SIGALRM pass
24620 end
24621 @end smallexample
24622
24623 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24624 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24625 you could define:
24626
24627 @smallexample
24628 define hook-echo
24629 echo <<<---
24630 end
24631
24632 define hookpost-echo
24633 echo --->>>\n
24634 end
24635
24636 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24637 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24638 (@value{GDBP})
24639
24640 @end smallexample
24641
24642 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24643 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24644 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24645 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24646 @c or not?
24647 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24648 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24649 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24650
24651 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24652 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24653 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24654
24655 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24656 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24657
24658 @node Command Files
24659 @subsection Command Files
24660
24661 @cindex command files
24662 @cindex scripting commands
24663 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24664 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24665 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24666 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24667 terminal.
24668
24669 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24670 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24671 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24672 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24673 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24674
24675 @table @code
24676 @kindex source
24677 @cindex execute commands from a file
24678 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24679 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24680 @end table
24681
24682 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24683 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24684 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24685 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24686 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24687
24688 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24689 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24690 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24691 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24692 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24693 is not relevant to scripts.
24694
24695 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24696 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24697 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24698 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24699 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24700 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24701 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24702 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24703 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24704 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24705 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24706 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24707 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24708 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24709
24710 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24711 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24712 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24713
24714 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24715 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24716 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24717 when called from command files.
24718
24719 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24720 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24721 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24722 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24723 the next command.
24724
24725 @smallexample
24726 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24727 @end smallexample
24728
24729 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24730 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24731 would be directed to @file{log}.
24732
24733 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24734 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24735 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24736 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24737 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24738 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24739 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24740 conditionally, etc.
24741
24742 @table @code
24743 @kindex if
24744 @kindex else
24745 @item if
24746 @itemx else
24747 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24748 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24749 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24750 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24751 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24752 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24753 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24754
24755 @kindex while
24756 @item while
24757 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24758 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24759 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24760 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24761 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24762 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24763
24764 @kindex loop_break
24765 @item loop_break
24766 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24767 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24768 line.
24769
24770 @kindex loop_continue
24771 @item loop_continue
24772 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24773 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24774 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24775 the controlling expression.
24776
24777 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24778 @item end
24779 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24780 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24781 @end table
24782
24783
24784 @node Output
24785 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24786
24787 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24788 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24789 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24790 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24791 want.
24792
24793 @table @code
24794 @kindex echo
24795 @item echo @var{text}
24796 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24797 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24798 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24799 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24800 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24801 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24802 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24803 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24804 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24805 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24806 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24807
24808 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24809 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24810
24811 @smallexample
24812 echo This is some text\n\
24813 which is continued\n\
24814 onto several lines.\n
24815 @end smallexample
24816
24817 produces the same output as
24818
24819 @smallexample
24820 echo This is some text\n
24821 echo which is continued\n
24822 echo onto several lines.\n
24823 @end smallexample
24824
24825 @kindex output
24826 @item output @var{expression}
24827 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24828 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24829 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24830 on expressions.
24831
24832 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24833 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24834 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24835 Formats}, for more information.
24836
24837 @kindex printf
24838 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24839 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24840 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24841 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24842 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24843 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24844 executing the code below:
24845
24846 @smallexample
24847 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24848 @end smallexample
24849
24850 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24851 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24852 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24853 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24854 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24855 printed.
24856
24857 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24858
24859 @smallexample
24860 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24861 @end smallexample
24862
24863 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24864 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24865 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24866
24867 @itemize @bullet
24868 @item
24869 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24870
24871 @item
24872 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24873 width.
24874
24875 @item
24876 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24877 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24878
24879 @item
24880 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24881 supported.
24882
24883 @item
24884 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24885
24886 @item
24887 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24888 @end itemize
24889
24890 @noindent
24891 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24892 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24893 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24894 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24895
24896 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24897 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24898 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24899 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24900 supported.
24901
24902 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24903 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24904 together with a floating point specifier.
24905 letters:
24906
24907 @itemize @bullet
24908 @item
24909 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24910
24911 @item
24912 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24913
24914 @item
24915 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24916 @end itemize
24917
24918 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24919 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24920 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24921
24922 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24923 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24924
24925 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24926 @smallexample
24927 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24928 @end smallexample
24929
24930 @anchor{eval}
24931 @kindex eval
24932 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24933 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24934 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24935
24936 @end table
24937
24938 @node Auto-loading sequences
24939 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24940 @cindex native script auto-loading
24941
24942 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24943 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24944 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24945 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24946
24947 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24948 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24949
24950 @table @code
24951 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24952 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24953 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24954 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24955
24956 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24957 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24958 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24959 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24960 disabled.
24961
24962 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24963 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24964 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24965 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24966 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24967 auto-loaded.
24968 @end table
24969
24970 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24971 matching names are printed.
24972
24973 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24974 @include python.texi
24975
24976 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24977 @include guile.texi
24978
24979 @node Auto-loading extensions
24980 @section Auto-loading extensions
24981 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24982
24983 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24984 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24985 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24986 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24987 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24988
24989 @menu
24990 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24991 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24992 * Which flavor to choose?::
24993 @end menu
24994
24995 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24996 debugging commands and features.
24997
24998 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24999 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25000 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25001 for more information.
25002 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25003 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25004
25005 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25006 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25007
25008 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25009 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25010 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25011 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25012 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25013
25014 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25015 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25016 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25017 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25018
25019 @table @code
25020 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25021 GDB's own command language
25022 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25023 Python
25024 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25025 Guile
25026 @end table
25027
25028 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25029 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25030 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25031 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25032 script in the specified extension language.
25033
25034 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25035 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25036
25037 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25038 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25039
25040 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25041 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25042 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25043 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25044 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25045 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25046
25047 @table @code
25048 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25049 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25050 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25051 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25052 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25053 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25054
25055 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25056 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25057
25058 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25059 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25060 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25061 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25062
25063 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25064 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25065 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25066 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25067 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25068 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25069 platform.
25070
25071 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25072 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25073 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25074
25075 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25076 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25077 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25078 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25079
25080 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25081 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25082 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25083 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25084 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25085 @end table
25086
25087 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25088 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25089 @var{objfile} is opened.
25090 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25091 is evaluated more than once.
25092
25093 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25094 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25095 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25096
25097 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25098 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25099 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25100 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25101 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25102 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25103 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25104
25105 The following entries are supported:
25106
25107 @table @code
25108 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25109 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25110 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25111 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25112 @end table
25113
25114 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25115
25116 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25117 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25118 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25119 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25120 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25121
25122 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25123 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25124
25125 @example
25126 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25127 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25128 asm("\
25129 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25130 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25131 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25132 .popsection \n\
25133 ");
25134 @end example
25135
25136 @noindent
25137 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25138 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25139
25140 @example
25141 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25142 @end example
25143
25144 The script name may include directories if desired.
25145
25146 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25147 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25148
25149 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25150 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25151 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25152 will remove duplicates.
25153
25154 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25155
25156 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25157 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25158 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25159 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25160 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25161 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25162 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25163 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25164 on its name.
25165
25166 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25167 testsuite.
25168
25169 @example
25170 #include "symcat.h"
25171 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25172 asm(
25173 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25174 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25175 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25176 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25177 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25178 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25179 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25180 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25181 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25182 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25183 ".byte 0\n"
25184 ".popsection\n"
25185 );
25186 @end example
25187
25188 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25189 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25190 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25191 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25192
25193 @node Which flavor to choose?
25194 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25195
25196 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25197 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25198
25199 @noindent
25200 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25201
25202 @itemize @bullet
25203 @item
25204 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25205
25206 @item
25207 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25208
25209 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25210 in the source search path.
25211 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25212 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25213
25214 @item
25215 Doesn't require source code additions.
25216 @end itemize
25217
25218 @noindent
25219 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25220
25221 @itemize @bullet
25222 @item
25223 Works with static linking.
25224
25225 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25226 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25227 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25228 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25229 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25230
25231 @item
25232 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25233
25234 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25235 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25236
25237 @item
25238 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25239
25240 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25241 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25242 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25243 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25244 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25245 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25246 @end itemize
25247
25248 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25249 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25250
25251 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25252 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25253 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25254
25255 @subsection Python comes first
25256
25257 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25258 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25259 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25260 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25261 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25262 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25263 pretty-printed form of a value).
25264 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25265 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25266 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25267
25268 @node Aliases
25269 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25270 @cindex aliases for commands
25271
25272 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25273 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25274 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25275 that involves less typing.
25276
25277 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25278 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25279 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25280
25281 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25282 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25283 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25284
25285 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25286
25287 @table @code
25288
25289 @kindex alias
25290 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25291
25292 @end table
25293
25294 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25295 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25296 underscores.
25297
25298 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25299 that is being aliased.
25300
25301 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25302 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25303 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25304
25305 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25306 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25307
25308 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25309 of a command so that there is less to type.
25310 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25311 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25312 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25313 The following will accomplish this.
25314
25315 @smallexample
25316 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25317 @end smallexample
25318
25319 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25320 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25321 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25322 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25323
25324 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25325 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25326 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25327 of a command.
25328
25329 @smallexample
25330 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25331 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25332 (gdb) set p elms 20
25333 (gdb) show p elms
25334 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25335 @end smallexample
25336
25337 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25338 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25339 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25340
25341 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25342 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25343
25344 @smallexample
25345 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25346 @end smallexample
25347
25348 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25349 alias for a more complex command.
25350 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25351
25352 @smallexample
25353 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25354 (gdb) spe 20
25355 @end smallexample
25356
25357 @node Interpreters
25358 @chapter Command Interpreters
25359 @cindex command interpreters
25360
25361 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25362 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25363 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25364
25365 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25366 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25367 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25368 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25369
25370 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25371 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25372 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25373 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25374
25375 @table @code
25376 @item console
25377 @cindex console interpreter
25378 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25379 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25380 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25381
25382 @item mi
25383 @cindex mi interpreter
25384 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25385 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25386 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25387 Interface}.
25388
25389 @item mi2
25390 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25391 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25392
25393 @item mi1
25394 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25395 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25396
25397 @end table
25398
25399 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25400
25401 @kindex interpreter-exec
25402 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25403 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25404 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25405
25406 @smallexample
25407 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25408 @end smallexample
25409
25410 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25411 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25412
25413 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25414 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25415 permanently.
25416
25417 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25418
25419 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25420 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25421 device (usually a tty).
25422
25423 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25424 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25425 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25426 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25427 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25428 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25429 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25430 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25431 the separate MI interpreter.
25432
25433 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25434 @code{new-ui} command:
25435
25436 @kindex new-ui
25437 @cindex new user interface
25438 @smallexample
25439 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25440 @end smallexample
25441
25442 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25443 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25444 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25445 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25446 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25447 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25448
25449 @smallexample
25450 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25451 @end smallexample
25452
25453 @noindent
25454 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25455
25456 @node TUI
25457 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25458 @cindex TUI
25459 @cindex Text User Interface
25460
25461 @menu
25462 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25463 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25464 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25465 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25466 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25467 @end menu
25468
25469 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25470 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25471 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25472 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25473 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25474 is available.
25475
25476 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25477 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25478 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25479 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25480 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25481 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25482
25483 @node TUI Overview
25484 @section TUI Overview
25485
25486 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25487
25488 @table @emph
25489 @item command
25490 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25491 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25492 managed using readline.
25493
25494 @item source
25495 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25496 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25497
25498 @item assembly
25499 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25500
25501 @item register
25502 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25503 when their values change.
25504 @end table
25505
25506 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25507 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25508 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25509 indicates the breakpoint type:
25510
25511 @table @code
25512 @item B
25513 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25514
25515 @item b
25516 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25517
25518 @item H
25519 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25520
25521 @item h
25522 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25523 @end table
25524
25525 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25526
25527 @table @code
25528 @item +
25529 Breakpoint is enabled.
25530
25531 @item -
25532 Breakpoint is disabled.
25533 @end table
25534
25535 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25536 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25537 changes.
25538
25539 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25540 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25541 layouts:
25542
25543 @itemize @bullet
25544 @item
25545 source only,
25546
25547 @item
25548 assembly only,
25549
25550 @item
25551 source and assembly,
25552
25553 @item
25554 source and registers, or
25555
25556 @item
25557 assembly and registers.
25558 @end itemize
25559
25560 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25561
25562 @table @emph
25563 @item target
25564 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25565 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25566
25567 @item process
25568 Gives the current process or thread number.
25569 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25570
25571 @item function
25572 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25573 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25574 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25575 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25576
25577 @item line
25578 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25579 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25580
25581 @item pc
25582 Indicates the current program counter address.
25583 @end table
25584
25585 @node TUI Keys
25586 @section TUI Key Bindings
25587 @cindex TUI key bindings
25588
25589 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25590 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25591 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25592 @end ifset
25593 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25594 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25595 @end ifclear
25596 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25597 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25598
25599 @table @kbd
25600 @kindex C-x C-a
25601 @item C-x C-a
25602 @kindex C-x a
25603 @itemx C-x a
25604 @kindex C-x A
25605 @itemx C-x A
25606 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25607 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25608 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25609 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25610 The screen is then refreshed.
25611
25612 @kindex C-x 1
25613 @item C-x 1
25614 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25615 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25616 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25617
25618 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25619
25620 @kindex C-x 2
25621 @item C-x 2
25622 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25623 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25624 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25625 previous layout and the new one.
25626
25627 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25628
25629 @kindex C-x o
25630 @item C-x o
25631 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25632 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25633 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25634
25635 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25636
25637 @kindex C-x s
25638 @item C-x s
25639 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25640 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25641 @end table
25642
25643 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25644
25645 @table @asis
25646 @kindex PgUp
25647 @item @key{PgUp}
25648 Scroll the active window one page up.
25649
25650 @kindex PgDn
25651 @item @key{PgDn}
25652 Scroll the active window one page down.
25653
25654 @kindex Up
25655 @item @key{Up}
25656 Scroll the active window one line up.
25657
25658 @kindex Down
25659 @item @key{Down}
25660 Scroll the active window one line down.
25661
25662 @kindex Left
25663 @item @key{Left}
25664 Scroll the active window one column left.
25665
25666 @kindex Right
25667 @item @key{Right}
25668 Scroll the active window one column right.
25669
25670 @kindex C-L
25671 @item @kbd{C-L}
25672 Refresh the screen.
25673 @end table
25674
25675 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25676 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25677 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25678 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25679 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25680
25681 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25682 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25683 @cindex TUI single key mode
25684
25685 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25686 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25687 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25688
25689 @table @kbd
25690 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25691 @item c
25692 continue
25693
25694 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25695 @item d
25696 down
25697
25698 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25699 @item f
25700 finish
25701
25702 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25703 @item n
25704 next
25705
25706 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25707 @item o
25708 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
25709
25710 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25711 @item q
25712 exit the SingleKey mode.
25713
25714 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25715 @item r
25716 run
25717
25718 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25719 @item s
25720 step
25721
25722 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25723 @item i
25724 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
25725
25726 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25727 @item u
25728 up
25729
25730 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25731 @item v
25732 info locals
25733
25734 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25735 @item w
25736 where
25737 @end table
25738
25739 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25740 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25741 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25742 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25743 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25744 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25745
25746
25747 @node TUI Commands
25748 @section TUI-specific Commands
25749 @cindex TUI commands
25750
25751 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25752 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25753 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25754 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25755
25756 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25757 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25758 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25759 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25760 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25761
25762 @table @code
25763 @item tui enable
25764 @kindex tui enable
25765 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25766 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25767 otherwise a default layout is used.
25768
25769 @item tui disable
25770 @kindex tui disable
25771 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25772
25773 @item info win
25774 @kindex info win
25775 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25776
25777 @item layout @var{name}
25778 @kindex layout
25779 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25780 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25781 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25782
25783 @table @code
25784 @item next
25785 Display the next layout.
25786
25787 @item prev
25788 Display the previous layout.
25789
25790 @item src
25791 Display the source and command windows.
25792
25793 @item asm
25794 Display the assembly and command windows.
25795
25796 @item split
25797 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25798
25799 @item regs
25800 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25801 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25802 register, assembler, and command windows.
25803 @end table
25804
25805 @item focus @var{name}
25806 @kindex focus
25807 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25808 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25809
25810 @table @code
25811 @item next
25812 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25813
25814 @item prev
25815 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25816
25817 @item src
25818 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25819
25820 @item asm
25821 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25822
25823 @item regs
25824 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25825
25826 @item cmd
25827 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25828 @end table
25829
25830 @item refresh
25831 @kindex refresh
25832 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25833
25834 @item tui reg @var{group}
25835 @kindex tui reg
25836 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25837 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25838 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25839 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25840 following groups are available on most targets:
25841 @table @code
25842 @item next
25843 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25844 through all of the available register groups.
25845
25846 @item prev
25847 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25848 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25849 @var{next}.
25850
25851 @item general
25852 Display the general registers.
25853 @item float
25854 Display the floating point registers.
25855 @item system
25856 Display the system registers.
25857 @item vector
25858 Display the vector registers.
25859 @item all
25860 Display all registers.
25861 @end table
25862
25863 @item update
25864 @kindex update
25865 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25866
25867 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25868 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25869 @kindex winheight
25870 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25871 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25872 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25873 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25874 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25875
25876 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25877 @kindex tabset
25878 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25879 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25880 assembly windows.
25881 @end table
25882
25883 @node TUI Configuration
25884 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25885 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25886
25887 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25888
25889 @table @code
25890 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25891 @kindex set tui border-kind
25892 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25893 The possible values are the following:
25894 @table @code
25895 @item space
25896 Use a space character to draw the border.
25897
25898 @item ascii
25899 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25900
25901 @item acs
25902 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25903 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25904 @end table
25905
25906 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25907 @kindex set tui border-mode
25908 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25909 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25910 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25911 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25912 @table @code
25913 @item normal
25914 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25915
25916 @item standout
25917 Use standout mode.
25918
25919 @item reverse
25920 Use reverse video mode.
25921
25922 @item half
25923 Use half bright mode.
25924
25925 @item half-standout
25926 Use half bright and standout mode.
25927
25928 @item bold
25929 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25930
25931 @item bold-standout
25932 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25933 @end table
25934 @end table
25935
25936 @node Emacs
25937 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25938
25939 @cindex Emacs
25940 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25941 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25942 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25943 @value{GDBN}.
25944
25945 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25946 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25947 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25948 created Emacs buffer.
25949 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25950
25951 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25952 things:
25953
25954 @itemize @bullet
25955 @item
25956 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25957 the GUD buffer.
25958
25959 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25960 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25961
25962 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25963 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25964 in this way.
25965
25966 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25967 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25968 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25969 stop.
25970
25971 @item
25972 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25973
25974 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25975 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25976 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25977 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25978 and the source.
25979
25980 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25981 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25982 @end itemize
25983
25984 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25985 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25986 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25987 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25988
25989 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25990 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25991 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25992 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25993 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25994 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25995 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25996 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25997 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25998
25999 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26000 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26001 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26002 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26003
26004 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26005 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26006 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26007 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26008 one you want.
26009
26010 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26011 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26012
26013 @table @kbd
26014 @item C-h m
26015 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26016
26017 @item C-c C-s
26018 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26019 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26020
26021 @item C-c C-n
26022 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26023 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26024 to show the current file and location.
26025
26026 @item C-c C-i
26027 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26028 display window accordingly.
26029
26030 @item C-c C-f
26031 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26032 @code{finish} command.
26033
26034 @item C-c C-r
26035 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26036 command.
26037
26038 @item C-c <
26039 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26040 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26041 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26042
26043 @item C-c >
26044 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26045 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26046 @end table
26047
26048 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26049 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26050
26051 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26052 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26053 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26054 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26055 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26056 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26057 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26058
26059 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26060 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26061 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26062 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26063 frame.
26064
26065 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26066 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26067 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26068 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26069 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26070 to correspond properly with the code.
26071
26072 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26073 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26074 Emacs Manual}).
26075
26076 @node GDB/MI
26077 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26078
26079 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26080
26081 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26082 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26083 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26084 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26085 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26086 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26087
26088 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26089 in the form of a reference manual.
26090
26091 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26092 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26093 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26094
26095 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26096
26097 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26098 This chapter uses the following notation:
26099
26100 @itemize @bullet
26101 @item
26102 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26103
26104 @item
26105 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26106 it may or may not be given.
26107
26108 @item
26109 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26110 may repeat zero or more times.
26111
26112 @item
26113 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26114 may repeat one or more times.
26115
26116 @item
26117 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26118 @end itemize
26119
26120 @ignore
26121 @heading Dependencies
26122 @end ignore
26123
26124 @menu
26125 * GDB/MI General Design::
26126 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26127 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26128 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26129 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26130 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26131 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26132 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26133 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26134 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26135 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26136 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26137 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26138 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26139 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26140 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26141 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26142 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26143 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26144 @ignore
26145 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26146 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26147 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26148 @end ignore
26149 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26150 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26151 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26152 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26153 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26154 @end menu
26155
26156 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26157 @node GDB/MI General Design
26158 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26159 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26160
26161 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26162 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26163 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26164 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26165 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26166 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26167 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26168 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26169 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26170 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26171
26172 The important examples of notifications are:
26173 @itemize @bullet
26174
26175 @item
26176 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26177 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26178 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26179 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26180 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26181 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26182 command itself was successfully executed.
26183
26184 @item
26185 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26186 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26187 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26188 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26189 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26190 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26191
26192 @item
26193 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26194 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26195 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26196 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26197 orthogonal frontend design.
26198
26199 @end itemize
26200
26201 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26202 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26203 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26204 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26205 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26206 the user interface.
26207
26208
26209 @menu
26210 * Context management::
26211 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26212 * Thread groups::
26213 @end menu
26214
26215 @node Context management
26216 @subsection Context management
26217
26218 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26219
26220 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26221 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26222 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26223 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26224 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26225 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26226 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26227 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26228 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26229
26230 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26231 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26232 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26233 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26234 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26235 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26236 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26237 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26238 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26239 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26240 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26241
26242 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26243 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26244 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26245 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26246 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26247 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26248 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26249 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26250 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26251 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26252
26253 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26254 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26255 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26256 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26257 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26258 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26259 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26260 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26261 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26262 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26263 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26264 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26265 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26266 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26267 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26268 @samp{--frame} options.
26269
26270 @subsubsection Language
26271
26272 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26273 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26274 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26275 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26276 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26277 For instance:
26278
26279 @smallexample
26280 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26281 ^done,value="4"
26282 (gdb)
26283 @end smallexample
26284
26285 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26286 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26287 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26288
26289 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26290 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26291
26292 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26293 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26294 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26295 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26296 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26297 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26298 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26299 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26300 @code{-list-target-features} command.
26301
26302 @table @code
26303 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
26304 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
26305 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26306
26307 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26308 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26309 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26310
26311 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26312 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26313 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26314 MI commands even while the target is running.
26315
26316 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26317 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26318 @end table
26319
26320 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26321 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26322 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26323 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26324 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26325 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26326
26327 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26328 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26329 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26330 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26331 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26332 are running.
26333
26334 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26335 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26336 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26337 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26338 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26339 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26340 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26341 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26342 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26343 @samp{--thread} option).
26344
26345 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26346 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26347 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26348 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26349
26350 @node Thread groups
26351 @subsection Thread groups
26352 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26353 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26354 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26355 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26356 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26357
26358 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26359 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26360 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26361 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26362 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26363 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26364 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26365 into processes.
26366
26367 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26368 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26369 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26370 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26371 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26372 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26373 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26374 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26375 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26376 the members of specific thread group.
26377
26378 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26379 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26380 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26381 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26382 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26383 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26384 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26385 after attaching to that thread group.
26386
26387 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26388 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26389 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26390 such thread groups.
26391
26392 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26393 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26394 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26395
26396 @menu
26397 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26398 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26399 @end menu
26400
26401 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26402 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26403
26404 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26405 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26406 @table @code
26407 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26408 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26409
26410 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26411 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26412 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26413
26414 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26415 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26416 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26417
26418 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26419 "any sequence of digits"
26420
26421 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26422 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26423
26424 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26425 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26426
26427 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26428 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26429
26430 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26431 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26432 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26433
26434 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26435 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26436
26437 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26438 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26439 @end table
26440
26441 @noindent
26442 Notes:
26443
26444 @itemize @bullet
26445 @item
26446 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26447 output is described below.
26448
26449 @item
26450 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26451 finishes.
26452
26453 @item
26454 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26455 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26456 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26457 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26458 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26459 @end itemize
26460
26461 Pragmatics:
26462
26463 @itemize @bullet
26464 @item
26465 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26466
26467 @item
26468 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26469 @end itemize
26470
26471 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26472 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26473
26474 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26475 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26476 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26477 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26478 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26479 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26480
26481 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26482 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26483 @var{token}.
26484
26485 @table @code
26486 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26487 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26488
26489 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26490 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26491
26492 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26493 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26494
26495 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26496 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26497
26498 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26499 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26500
26501 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26502 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26503
26504 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26505 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26506
26507 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26508 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26509
26510 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26511 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26512
26513 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26514 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26515 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26516
26517 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26518 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26519
26520 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26521 @code{ @var{string} }
26522
26523 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26524 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26525
26526 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26527 @code{@var{c-string}}
26528
26529 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26530 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26531
26532 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26533 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26534 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26535
26536 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26537 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26538
26539 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26540 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26541
26542 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26543 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26544
26545 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26546 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26547
26548 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26549 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26550
26551 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26552 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26553 @end table
26554
26555 @noindent
26556 Notes:
26557
26558 @itemize @bullet
26559 @item
26560 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26561
26562 @item
26563 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26564 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26565 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26566 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26567 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26568 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26569 prior command.
26570
26571 @item
26572 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26573 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26574 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26575 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26576
26577 @item
26578 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26579 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26580 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26581 @samp{*}.
26582
26583 @item
26584 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26585 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26586 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26587 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26588
26589 @item
26590 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26591 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26592 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26593 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26594
26595 @item
26596 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26597 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26598 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26599
26600 @item
26601 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26602 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26603 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26604 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26605
26606 @item
26607 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26608 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26609 @var{values}.
26610
26611
26612 @end itemize
26613
26614 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26615 details about the various output records.
26616
26617 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26618 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26619 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26620
26621 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26622 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26623
26624 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26625 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26626 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26627 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26628 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26629 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26630
26631 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26632 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26633 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26634
26635 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26636 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26637 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26638 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26639
26640 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26641 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26642
26643 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26644 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26645 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26646 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26647 might change.
26648
26649 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26650 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26651 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26652 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26653
26654 @itemize @bullet
26655 @item
26656 New MI commands may be added.
26657
26658 @item
26659 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26660
26661 @item
26662 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26663 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26664
26665 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26666 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26667
26668 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26669 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26670 @end itemize
26671
26672 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26673 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26674 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26675 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26676 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26677
26678 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26679 @c version?
26680
26681 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26682 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26683 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26684 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26685 @cindex mailing lists
26686
26687 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26688 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26689 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26690
26691 @menu
26692 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26693 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26694 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26695 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26696 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26697 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26698 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26699 @end menu
26700
26701 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26702 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26703
26704 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26705 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26706 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26707 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26708
26709 @table @code
26710 @findex ^done
26711 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26712 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26713 values.
26714
26715 @item "^running"
26716 @findex ^running
26717 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26718 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26719 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26720 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26721 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26722 which threads are resumed.
26723
26724 @item "^connected"
26725 @findex ^connected
26726 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26727
26728 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26729 @findex ^error
26730 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26731 the corresponding error message.
26732
26733 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26734 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26735 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26736
26737 @table @samp
26738 @item "undefined-command"
26739 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26740 @end table
26741
26742 @item "^exit"
26743 @findex ^exit
26744 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26745
26746 @end table
26747
26748 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26749 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26750
26751 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26752 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26753 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26754 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26755 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26756
26757 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26758 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26759 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26760 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26761 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26762
26763 @table @code
26764 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26765 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26766 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26767
26768 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26769 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26770 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26771 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26772
26773 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26774 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26775 internals.
26776 @end table
26777
26778 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26779 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26780
26781 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26782 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26783 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26784 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26785 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26786 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26787
26788 The following is the list of possible async records:
26789
26790 @table @code
26791
26792 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26793 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26794 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26795 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26796 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26797 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26798 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26799 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26800 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26801 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26802 it run freely.
26803
26804 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26805 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26806 following values:
26807
26808 @table @code
26809 @item breakpoint-hit
26810 A breakpoint was reached.
26811 @item watchpoint-trigger
26812 A watchpoint was triggered.
26813 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26814 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26815 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26816 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26817 @item function-finished
26818 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26819 @item location-reached
26820 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26821 @item watchpoint-scope
26822 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26823 @item end-stepping-range
26824 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26825 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26826 @item exited-signalled
26827 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26828 @item exited
26829 The inferior exited.
26830 @item exited-normally
26831 The inferior exited normally.
26832 @item signal-received
26833 A signal was received by the inferior.
26834 @item solib-event
26835 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26836 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26837 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26838 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26839 @item fork
26840 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26841 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26842 @item vfork
26843 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26844 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26845 @item syscall-entry
26846 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26847 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26848 @item syscall-return
26849 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26850 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26851 @item exec
26852 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26853 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26854 @end table
26855
26856 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26857 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26858 Depending on whether all-stop
26859 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26860 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26861 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26862 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26863 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26864 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26865 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26866 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26867 if such information is not available.
26868
26869 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26870 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26871 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26872 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26873 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26874 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26875 cannot be used in any way.
26876
26877 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26878 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26879 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26880 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26881 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26882 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26883
26884 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26885 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26886 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26887 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26888 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26889 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26890
26891 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26892 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26893 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26894 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26895 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26896
26897 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26898 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26899 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26900 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26901 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26902 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26903 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26904 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26905 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26906
26907 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26908 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26909
26910 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26911 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26912 that thread.
26913
26914 @item =library-loaded,...
26915 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26916 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26917 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
26918 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26919 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26920 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26921 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26922 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26923 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26924 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26925 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26926 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26927 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
26928 to this library.
26929
26930 @item =library-unloaded,...
26931 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26932 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26933 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26934 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26935 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26936 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26937 thread groups.
26938
26939 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26940 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26941 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26942 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26943 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26944
26945 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26946 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26947 initial value @var{initial}.
26948
26949 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26950 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26951 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26952 trace state variables are deleted.
26953
26954 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26955 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26956 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26957 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26958 value of trace state variable is known.
26959
26960 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26961 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26962 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26963 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26964 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26965 user.
26966
26967 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26968 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26969 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26970
26971 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26972 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26973
26974 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26975 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26976 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26977 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26978 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26979
26980 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26981 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26982 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26983 for existing method and format values.
26984
26985 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26986 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26987 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26988 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26989 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26990 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26991
26992 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26993 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26994 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26995 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26996 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26997 executable code.
26998 @end table
26999
27000 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27001 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27002
27003 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27004 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27005 following fields:
27006
27007 @table @code
27008 @item number
27009 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27010 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27011 @samp{1.2}.
27012
27013 @item type
27014 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27015 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27016
27017 @item catch-type
27018 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27019 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27020
27021 @item disp
27022 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27023 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27024 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27025
27026 @item enabled
27027 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27028 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27029 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27030
27031 @item addr
27032 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27033 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27034 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27035 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27036 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27037
27038 @item func
27039 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27040 If not known, this field is not present.
27041
27042 @item filename
27043 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27044 If not known, this field is not present.
27045
27046 @item fullname
27047 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27048 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27049
27050 @item line
27051 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27052 If not known, this field is not present.
27053
27054 @item at
27055 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27056 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27057 by a symbol name.
27058
27059 @item pending
27060 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27061 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27062
27063 @item evaluated-by
27064 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27065 @samp{target}.
27066
27067 @item thread
27068 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27069 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27070
27071 @item task
27072 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27073 field will hold the task identifier.
27074
27075 @item cond
27076 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27077
27078 @item ignore
27079 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27080
27081 @item enable
27082 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27083
27084 @item traceframe-usage
27085 FIXME.
27086
27087 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27088 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27089
27090 @item mask
27091 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27092
27093 @item pass
27094 A tracepoint's pass count.
27095
27096 @item original-location
27097 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27098 This field is optional.
27099
27100 @item times
27101 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27102
27103 @item installed
27104 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27105 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27106 is not.
27107
27108 @item what
27109 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27110
27111 @end table
27112
27113 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27114 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27115
27116 @smallexample
27117 -> -break-insert main
27118 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27119 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27120 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27121 times="0"@}
27122 <- (gdb)
27123 @end smallexample
27124
27125 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27126 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27127
27128 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27129 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27130 fields:
27131
27132 @table @code
27133 @item level
27134 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27135 zero. This field is always present.
27136
27137 @item func
27138 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27139 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27140
27141 @item addr
27142 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27143
27144 @item file
27145 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27146 address. This field may be absent.
27147
27148 @item line
27149 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27150 may be absent.
27151
27152 @item from
27153 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27154 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27155
27156 @end table
27157
27158 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27159 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27160
27161 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27162 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27163 stated otherwise.
27164
27165 @table @code
27166 @item id
27167 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27168
27169 @item target-id
27170 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27171
27172 @item details
27173 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27174 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27175 frontend. This field is optional.
27176
27177 @item name
27178 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27179 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27180 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27181 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27182 field is omitted.
27183
27184 @item state
27185 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27186 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27187
27188 @item frame
27189 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27190 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27191 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27192
27193 @item core
27194 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27195 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27196 @end table
27197
27198 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27199 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27200
27201 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27202 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27203 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27204 the @code{exception-name} field.
27205
27206 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27207 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27208 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27209 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27210
27211 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27212 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27213 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27214 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27215
27216 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27217 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27218
27219 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27220
27221 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27222 information of the breakpoint.
27223
27224 @smallexample
27225 -> -break-insert main
27226 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27227 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27228 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27229 times="0"@}
27230 <- (gdb)
27231 @end smallexample
27232
27233 @subheading Program Execution
27234
27235 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27236 reason that execution stopped.
27237
27238 @smallexample
27239 -> -exec-run
27240 <- ^running
27241 <- (gdb)
27242 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27243 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27244 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27245 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27246 <- (gdb)
27247 -> -exec-continue
27248 <- ^running
27249 <- (gdb)
27250 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27251 <- (gdb)
27252 @end smallexample
27253
27254 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27255
27256 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27257
27258 @smallexample
27259 -> (gdb)
27260 <- -gdb-exit
27261 <- ^exit
27262 @end smallexample
27263
27264 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27265 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27266 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27267 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27268 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27269 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27270
27271 @subheading A Bad Command
27272
27273 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27274
27275 @smallexample
27276 -> -rubbish
27277 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27278 <- (gdb)
27279 @end smallexample
27280
27281
27282 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27283 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27284 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27285
27286 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27287 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27288
27289 @subheading Motivation
27290
27291 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27292
27293 @subheading Introduction
27294
27295 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27296
27297 @subheading Commands
27298
27299 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27300
27301 @subsubheading Synopsis
27302
27303 @smallexample
27304 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27305 @end smallexample
27306
27307 @subsubheading Result
27308
27309 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27310
27311 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27312
27313 @subsubheading Example
27314
27315 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27316 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27317
27318
27319 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27320 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27321 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27322
27323 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27324 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27325 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27326 breakpoints.
27327
27328 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27329 @findex -break-after
27330
27331 @subsubheading Synopsis
27332
27333 @smallexample
27334 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27335 @end smallexample
27336
27337 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27338 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27339 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27340 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27341
27342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27343
27344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27345
27346 @subsubheading Example
27347
27348 @smallexample
27349 (gdb)
27350 -break-insert main
27351 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27352 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27353 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27354 times="0"@}
27355 (gdb)
27356 -break-after 1 3
27357 ~
27358 ^done
27359 (gdb)
27360 -break-list
27361 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27362 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27363 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27364 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27365 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27366 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27367 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27368 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27369 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27370 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27371 (gdb)
27372 @end smallexample
27373
27374 @ignore
27375 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27376 @findex -break-catch
27377 @end ignore
27378
27379 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27380 @findex -break-commands
27381
27382 @subsubheading Synopsis
27383
27384 @smallexample
27385 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27386 @end smallexample
27387
27388 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27389 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27390 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27391 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27392 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27393 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27394
27395 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27396
27397 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27398
27399 @subsubheading Example
27400
27401 @smallexample
27402 (gdb)
27403 -break-insert main
27404 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27405 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27406 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27407 times="0"@}
27408 (gdb)
27409 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27410 ^done
27411 (gdb)
27412 @end smallexample
27413
27414 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27415 @findex -break-condition
27416
27417 @subsubheading Synopsis
27418
27419 @smallexample
27420 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27421 @end smallexample
27422
27423 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27424 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27425 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27426 command below).
27427
27428 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27429
27430 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27431
27432 @subsubheading Example
27433
27434 @smallexample
27435 (gdb)
27436 -break-condition 1 1
27437 ^done
27438 (gdb)
27439 -break-list
27440 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27441 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27442 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27443 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27444 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27445 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27446 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27447 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27448 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27449 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27450 (gdb)
27451 @end smallexample
27452
27453 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27454 @findex -break-delete
27455
27456 @subsubheading Synopsis
27457
27458 @smallexample
27459 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27460 @end smallexample
27461
27462 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27463 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27464
27465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27466
27467 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27468
27469 @subsubheading Example
27470
27471 @smallexample
27472 (gdb)
27473 -break-delete 1
27474 ^done
27475 (gdb)
27476 -break-list
27477 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27478 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27479 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27480 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27481 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27482 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27483 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27484 body=[]@}
27485 (gdb)
27486 @end smallexample
27487
27488 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27489 @findex -break-disable
27490
27491 @subsubheading Synopsis
27492
27493 @smallexample
27494 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27495 @end smallexample
27496
27497 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27498 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27499
27500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27501
27502 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27503
27504 @subsubheading Example
27505
27506 @smallexample
27507 (gdb)
27508 -break-disable 2
27509 ^done
27510 (gdb)
27511 -break-list
27512 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27513 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27514 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27515 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27516 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27517 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27518 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27519 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27520 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27521 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27522 (gdb)
27523 @end smallexample
27524
27525 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27526 @findex -break-enable
27527
27528 @subsubheading Synopsis
27529
27530 @smallexample
27531 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27532 @end smallexample
27533
27534 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27535
27536 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27537
27538 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27539
27540 @subsubheading Example
27541
27542 @smallexample
27543 (gdb)
27544 -break-enable 2
27545 ^done
27546 (gdb)
27547 -break-list
27548 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27549 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27550 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27551 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27552 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27553 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27554 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27555 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27556 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27557 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27558 (gdb)
27559 @end smallexample
27560
27561 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27562 @findex -break-info
27563
27564 @subsubheading Synopsis
27565
27566 @smallexample
27567 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27568 @end smallexample
27569
27570 @c REDUNDANT???
27571 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27572
27573 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27574 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27575 table.
27576
27577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27578
27579 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27580
27581 @subsubheading Example
27582 N.A.
27583
27584 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27585 @findex -break-insert
27586 @anchor{-break-insert}
27587
27588 @subsubheading Synopsis
27589
27590 @smallexample
27591 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27592 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27593 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27594 @end smallexample
27595
27596 @noindent
27597 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27598
27599 @table @var
27600 @item linespec location
27601 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27602
27603 @item explicit location
27604 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27605 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27606 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27607
27608 @table @samp
27609 @item --source @var{filename}
27610 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27611 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27612
27613 @item --function @var{function}
27614 The name of a function or method.
27615
27616 @item --label @var{label}
27617 The name of a label.
27618
27619 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27620 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27621 @end table
27622
27623 @item address location
27624 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27625 @end table
27626
27627 @noindent
27628 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27629
27630 @table @samp
27631 @item -t
27632 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27633 @item -h
27634 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27635 @item -f
27636 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27637 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27638 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27639 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27640 cannot be parsed.
27641 @item -d
27642 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27643 @item -a
27644 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27645 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27646 @item -c @var{condition}
27647 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27648 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27649 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27650 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27651 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27652 @var{thread-id}.
27653 @end table
27654
27655 @subsubheading Result
27656
27657 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27658 resulting breakpoint.
27659
27660 Note: this format is open to change.
27661 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27662
27663 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27664
27665 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27666 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27667
27668 @subsubheading Example
27669
27670 @smallexample
27671 (gdb)
27672 -break-insert main
27673 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27674 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27675 times="0"@}
27676 (gdb)
27677 -break-insert -t foo
27678 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27679 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27680 times="0"@}
27681 (gdb)
27682 -break-list
27683 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27684 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27685 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27686 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27687 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27688 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27689 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27690 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27691 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27692 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27693 times="0"@},
27694 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27695 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27696 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27697 times="0"@}]@}
27698 (gdb)
27699 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27700 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27701 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27702 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27703 @c times="0"@}
27704 @c (gdb)
27705 @end smallexample
27706
27707 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27708 @findex -dprintf-insert
27709
27710 @subsubheading Synopsis
27711
27712 @smallexample
27713 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27714 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27715 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27716 [ @var{argument} ]
27717 @end smallexample
27718
27719 @noindent
27720 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27721 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27722
27723 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27724
27725 @table @samp
27726 @item -t
27727 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27728 @item -f
27729 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27730 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27731 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27732 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27733 cannot be parsed.
27734 @item -d
27735 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27736 @item -c @var{condition}
27737 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27738 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27739 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27740 to @var{ignore-count}.
27741 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27742 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27743 @var{thread-id}.
27744 @end table
27745
27746 @subsubheading Result
27747
27748 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27749 resulting breakpoint.
27750
27751 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27752
27753 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27754
27755 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27756
27757 @subsubheading Example
27758
27759 @smallexample
27760 (gdb)
27761 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27762 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27763 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27764 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27765 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27766 original-location="foo"@}
27767 (gdb)
27768 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27769 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27770 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27771 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27772 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27773 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27774 (gdb)
27775 @end smallexample
27776
27777 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27778 @findex -break-list
27779
27780 @subsubheading Synopsis
27781
27782 @smallexample
27783 -break-list
27784 @end smallexample
27785
27786 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27787
27788 @table @samp
27789 @item Number
27790 number of the breakpoint
27791 @item Type
27792 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27793 @item Disposition
27794 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27795 or @samp{nokeep}
27796 @item Enabled
27797 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27798 @item Address
27799 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27800 @item What
27801 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27802 name, line number
27803 @item Thread-groups
27804 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27805 @item Times
27806 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27807 @end table
27808
27809 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27810 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27811
27812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27813
27814 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27815
27816 @subsubheading Example
27817
27818 @smallexample
27819 (gdb)
27820 -break-list
27821 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27822 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27823 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27824 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27825 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27826 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27827 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27828 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27829 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27830 times="0"@},
27831 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27832 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27833 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27834 (gdb)
27835 @end smallexample
27836
27837 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27838
27839 @smallexample
27840 (gdb)
27841 -break-list
27842 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27843 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27844 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27845 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27846 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27847 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27848 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27849 body=[]@}
27850 (gdb)
27851 @end smallexample
27852
27853 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27854 @findex -break-passcount
27855
27856 @subsubheading Synopsis
27857
27858 @smallexample
27859 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27860 @end smallexample
27861
27862 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27863 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27864 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27865 command @samp{passcount}.
27866
27867 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27868 @findex -break-watch
27869
27870 @subsubheading Synopsis
27871
27872 @smallexample
27873 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27874 @end smallexample
27875
27876 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27877 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27878 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27879 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27880 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27881 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27882 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27883 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27884
27885 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27886 breakpoints inserted.
27887
27888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27889
27890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27891 @samp{rwatch}.
27892
27893 @subsubheading Example
27894
27895 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27896
27897 @smallexample
27898 (gdb)
27899 -break-watch x
27900 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27901 (gdb)
27902 -exec-continue
27903 ^running
27904 (gdb)
27905 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27906 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27907 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27908 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27909 (gdb)
27910 @end smallexample
27911
27912 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27913 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27914 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27915
27916 @smallexample
27917 (gdb)
27918 -break-watch C
27919 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27920 (gdb)
27921 -exec-continue
27922 ^running
27923 (gdb)
27924 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27925 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27926 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27927 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27928 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27929 (gdb)
27930 -exec-continue
27931 ^running
27932 (gdb)
27933 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27934 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27935 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27936 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27937 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27938 (gdb)
27939 @end smallexample
27940
27941 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27942 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27943 deleted.
27944
27945 @smallexample
27946 (gdb)
27947 -break-watch C
27948 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27949 (gdb)
27950 -break-list
27951 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27952 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27953 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27954 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27955 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27956 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27957 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27958 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27959 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27960 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27961 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27962 times="1"@},
27963 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27964 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27965 (gdb)
27966 -exec-continue
27967 ^running
27968 (gdb)
27969 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27970 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27971 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27972 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27973 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27974 (gdb)
27975 -break-list
27976 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27977 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27978 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27979 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27980 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27981 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27982 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27983 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27984 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27985 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27986 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27987 times="1"@},
27988 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27989 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27990 (gdb)
27991 -exec-continue
27992 ^running
27993 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27994 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27995 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27996 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27997 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27998 (gdb)
27999 -break-list
28000 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28001 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28002 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28003 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28004 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28005 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28006 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28007 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28008 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28009 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28010 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28011 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28012 (gdb)
28013 @end smallexample
28014
28015
28016 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28017 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28018 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28019
28020 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28021 catchpoints.
28022
28023 @menu
28024 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28025 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28026 @end menu
28027
28028 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28029 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28030
28031 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28032 @findex -catch-load
28033
28034 @subsubheading Synopsis
28035
28036 @smallexample
28037 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28038 @end smallexample
28039
28040 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28041 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28042 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28043 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28044 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28045
28046
28047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28048
28049 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28050
28051 @subsubheading Example
28052
28053 @smallexample
28054 -catch-load -t foo.so
28055 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28056 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28057 (gdb)
28058 @end smallexample
28059
28060
28061 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28062 @findex -catch-unload
28063
28064 @subsubheading Synopsis
28065
28066 @smallexample
28067 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28068 @end smallexample
28069
28070 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28071 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28072 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28073 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28074 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28075
28076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28077
28078 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28079
28080 @subsubheading Example
28081
28082 @smallexample
28083 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28084 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28085 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28086 (gdb)
28087 @end smallexample
28088
28089 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28090 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28091
28092 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28093 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28094
28095 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28096 @findex -catch-assert
28097
28098 @subsubheading Synopsis
28099
28100 @smallexample
28101 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28102 @end smallexample
28103
28104 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28105
28106 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28107
28108 @table @samp
28109 @item -c @var{condition}
28110 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28111 @item -d
28112 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28113 @item -t
28114 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28115 @end table
28116
28117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28118
28119 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28120
28121 @subsubheading Example
28122
28123 @smallexample
28124 -catch-assert
28125 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28126 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28127 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28128 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28129 (gdb)
28130 @end smallexample
28131
28132 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28133 @findex -catch-exception
28134
28135 @subsubheading Synopsis
28136
28137 @smallexample
28138 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28139 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28140 @end smallexample
28141
28142 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28143 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28144 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28145 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28146 catchpoints.
28147
28148 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28149
28150 @table @samp
28151 @item -c @var{condition}
28152 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28153 @item -d
28154 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28155 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28156 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28157 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28158 @item -t
28159 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28160 @item -u
28161 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28162 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28163 @end table
28164
28165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28166
28167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28168 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28169
28170 @subsubheading Example
28171
28172 @smallexample
28173 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28174 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28175 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28176 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28177 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28178 (gdb)
28179 @end smallexample
28180
28181 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28182 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28183 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28184
28185 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28186 @findex -exec-arguments
28187
28188
28189 @subsubheading Synopsis
28190
28191 @smallexample
28192 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28193 @end smallexample
28194
28195 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28196 @samp{-exec-run}.
28197
28198 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28199
28200 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28201
28202 @subsubheading Example
28203
28204 @smallexample
28205 (gdb)
28206 -exec-arguments -v word
28207 ^done
28208 (gdb)
28209 @end smallexample
28210
28211
28212 @ignore
28213 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28214 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28215
28216 @subsubheading Synopsis
28217
28218 @smallexample
28219 -exec-show-arguments
28220 @end smallexample
28221
28222 Print the arguments of the program.
28223
28224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28225
28226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28227
28228 @subsubheading Example
28229 N.A.
28230 @end ignore
28231
28232
28233 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28234 @findex -environment-cd
28235
28236 @subsubheading Synopsis
28237
28238 @smallexample
28239 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28240 @end smallexample
28241
28242 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28243
28244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28245
28246 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28247
28248 @subsubheading Example
28249
28250 @smallexample
28251 (gdb)
28252 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28253 ^done
28254 (gdb)
28255 @end smallexample
28256
28257
28258 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28259 @findex -environment-directory
28260
28261 @subsubheading Synopsis
28262
28263 @smallexample
28264 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28265 @end smallexample
28266
28267 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28268 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28269 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28270 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28271 occurs as normal.
28272 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28273 multiple directories in a single command
28274 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28275 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28276 If blanks are needed as
28277 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28278 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28279 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28280 character must not be used
28281 in any directory name.
28282 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28283
28284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28285
28286 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28287
28288 @subsubheading Example
28289
28290 @smallexample
28291 (gdb)
28292 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28293 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28294 (gdb)
28295 -environment-directory ""
28296 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28297 (gdb)
28298 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28299 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28300 (gdb)
28301 -environment-directory -r
28302 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28303 (gdb)
28304 @end smallexample
28305
28306
28307 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28308 @findex -environment-path
28309
28310 @subsubheading Synopsis
28311
28312 @smallexample
28313 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28314 @end smallexample
28315
28316 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28317 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28318 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28319 supplied in addition to the
28320 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28321 occurs as normal.
28322 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28323 multiple directories in a single command
28324 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28325 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28326 If blanks are needed as
28327 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28328 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28329 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28330 character must not be used
28331 in any directory name.
28332 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28333
28334
28335 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28336
28337 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28338
28339 @subsubheading Example
28340
28341 @smallexample
28342 (gdb)
28343 -environment-path
28344 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28345 (gdb)
28346 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28347 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28348 (gdb)
28349 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28350 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28351 (gdb)
28352 @end smallexample
28353
28354
28355 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28356 @findex -environment-pwd
28357
28358 @subsubheading Synopsis
28359
28360 @smallexample
28361 -environment-pwd
28362 @end smallexample
28363
28364 Show the current working directory.
28365
28366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28367
28368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28369
28370 @subsubheading Example
28371
28372 @smallexample
28373 (gdb)
28374 -environment-pwd
28375 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28376 (gdb)
28377 @end smallexample
28378
28379 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28380 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28381 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28382
28383
28384 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28385 @findex -thread-info
28386
28387 @subsubheading Synopsis
28388
28389 @smallexample
28390 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28391 @end smallexample
28392
28393 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28394 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28395 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28396 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28397 current thread.
28398
28399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28400
28401 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28402 about all threads.
28403
28404 @subsubheading Result
28405
28406 The result contains the following attributes:
28407
28408 @table @samp
28409 @item threads
28410 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28411 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28412
28413 @item current-thread-id
28414 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28415 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28416 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28417 the command.
28418
28419 @end table
28420
28421 @subsubheading Example
28422
28423 @smallexample
28424 -thread-info
28425 ^done,threads=[
28426 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28427 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28428 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28429 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28430 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28431 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28432 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28433 state="running"@}],
28434 current-thread-id="1"
28435 (gdb)
28436 @end smallexample
28437
28438 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28439 @findex -thread-list-ids
28440
28441 @subsubheading Synopsis
28442
28443 @smallexample
28444 -thread-list-ids
28445 @end smallexample
28446
28447 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28448 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28449 threads.
28450
28451 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28452 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28453
28454 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28455
28456 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28457
28458 @subsubheading Example
28459
28460 @smallexample
28461 (gdb)
28462 -thread-list-ids
28463 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28464 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28465 (gdb)
28466 @end smallexample
28467
28468
28469 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28470 @findex -thread-select
28471
28472 @subsubheading Synopsis
28473
28474 @smallexample
28475 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28476 @end smallexample
28477
28478 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28479 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28480 topmost frame for that thread.
28481
28482 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28483 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28484
28485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28486
28487 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28488
28489 @subsubheading Example
28490
28491 @smallexample
28492 (gdb)
28493 -exec-next
28494 ^running
28495 (gdb)
28496 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28497 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28498 (gdb)
28499 -thread-list-ids
28500 ^done,
28501 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28502 number-of-threads="3"
28503 (gdb)
28504 -thread-select 3
28505 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28506 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28507 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28508 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28509 (gdb)
28510 @end smallexample
28511
28512 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28513 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28514 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28515
28516 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28517 @findex -ada-task-info
28518
28519 @subsubheading Synopsis
28520
28521 @smallexample
28522 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28523 @end smallexample
28524
28525 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28526 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28527
28528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28529
28530 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28531 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28532
28533 @subsubheading Result
28534
28535 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28536 defined for each Ada task:
28537
28538 @table @samp
28539 @item current
28540 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28541
28542 @item id
28543 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28544
28545 @item task-id
28546 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28547
28548 @item thread-id
28549 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28550 task.
28551
28552 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28553 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28554 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28555
28556 @item parent-id
28557 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28558 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28559
28560 @item priority
28561 The base priority of the task.
28562
28563 @item state
28564 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28565 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28566
28567 @item name
28568 The name of the task.
28569
28570 @end table
28571
28572 @subsubheading Example
28573
28574 @smallexample
28575 -ada-task-info
28576 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28577 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28578 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28579 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28580 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28581 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28582 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28583 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28584 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28585 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28586 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28587 (gdb)
28588 @end smallexample
28589
28590 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28591 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28592 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28593
28594 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28595 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28596 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28597 other cases.
28598
28599 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28600 @findex -exec-continue
28601
28602 @subsubheading Synopsis
28603
28604 @smallexample
28605 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28606 @end smallexample
28607
28608 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28609 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28610 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28611 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28612 @itemize @bullet
28613 @item
28614 breakpoints or watchpoints
28615 @item
28616 signals or exceptions
28617 @item
28618 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28619 @item
28620 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28621 @end itemize
28622 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28623 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28624 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28625 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28626 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28627 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28628
28629 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28630
28631 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28632
28633 @subsubheading Example
28634
28635 @smallexample
28636 -exec-continue
28637 ^running
28638 (gdb)
28639 @@Hello world
28640 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28641 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28642 line="13"@}
28643 (gdb)
28644 @end smallexample
28645
28646
28647 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28648 @findex -exec-finish
28649
28650 @subsubheading Synopsis
28651
28652 @smallexample
28653 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28654 @end smallexample
28655
28656 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28657 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28658 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28659 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28660 function was called.
28661
28662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28663
28664 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28665
28666 @subsubheading Example
28667
28668 Function returning @code{void}.
28669
28670 @smallexample
28671 -exec-finish
28672 ^running
28673 (gdb)
28674 @@hello from foo
28675 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28676 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28677 (gdb)
28678 @end smallexample
28679
28680 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28681 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28682 value itself.
28683
28684 @smallexample
28685 -exec-finish
28686 ^running
28687 (gdb)
28688 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28689 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28690 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28691 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28692 (gdb)
28693 @end smallexample
28694
28695
28696 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28697 @findex -exec-interrupt
28698
28699 @subsubheading Synopsis
28700
28701 @smallexample
28702 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28703 @end smallexample
28704
28705 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28706 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28707 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28708 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28709 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28710
28711 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28712 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28713 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28714 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28715
28716 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28717 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28718 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28719 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28720
28721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28722
28723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28724
28725 @subsubheading Example
28726
28727 @smallexample
28728 (gdb)
28729 111-exec-continue
28730 111^running
28731
28732 (gdb)
28733 222-exec-interrupt
28734 222^done
28735 (gdb)
28736 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28737 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28738 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28739 (gdb)
28740
28741 (gdb)
28742 -exec-interrupt
28743 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28744 (gdb)
28745 @end smallexample
28746
28747 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28748 @findex -exec-jump
28749
28750 @subsubheading Synopsis
28751
28752 @smallexample
28753 -exec-jump @var{location}
28754 @end smallexample
28755
28756 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28757 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28758 different forms of @var{location}.
28759
28760 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28761
28762 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28763
28764 @subsubheading Example
28765
28766 @smallexample
28767 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28768 *running,thread-id="all"
28769 ^running
28770 @end smallexample
28771
28772
28773 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28774 @findex -exec-next
28775
28776 @subsubheading Synopsis
28777
28778 @smallexample
28779 -exec-next [--reverse]
28780 @end smallexample
28781
28782 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28783 of the next source line is reached.
28784
28785 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28786 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28787 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28788 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28789 source line where the function was called.
28790
28791
28792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28793
28794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28795
28796 @subsubheading Example
28797
28798 @smallexample
28799 -exec-next
28800 ^running
28801 (gdb)
28802 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28803 (gdb)
28804 @end smallexample
28805
28806
28807 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28808 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28809
28810 @subsubheading Synopsis
28811
28812 @smallexample
28813 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28814 @end smallexample
28815
28816 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28817 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28818 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28819 printed as well.
28820
28821 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28822 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28823 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28824 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28825 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28826
28827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28828
28829 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28830
28831 @subsubheading Example
28832
28833 @smallexample
28834 (gdb)
28835 -exec-next-instruction
28836 ^running
28837
28838 (gdb)
28839 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28840 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28841 (gdb)
28842 @end smallexample
28843
28844
28845 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28846 @findex -exec-return
28847
28848 @subsubheading Synopsis
28849
28850 @smallexample
28851 -exec-return
28852 @end smallexample
28853
28854 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28855 Displays the new current frame.
28856
28857 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28858
28859 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28860
28861 @subsubheading Example
28862
28863 @smallexample
28864 (gdb)
28865 200-break-insert callee4
28866 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28867 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28868 (gdb)
28869 000-exec-run
28870 000^running
28871 (gdb)
28872 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28873 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28874 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28875 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28876 (gdb)
28877 205-break-delete
28878 205^done
28879 (gdb)
28880 111-exec-return
28881 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28882 args=[@{name="strarg",
28883 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28884 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28885 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28886 (gdb)
28887 @end smallexample
28888
28889
28890 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28891 @findex -exec-run
28892
28893 @subsubheading Synopsis
28894
28895 @smallexample
28896 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28897 @end smallexample
28898
28899 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28900 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28901 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28902 the program has exited exceptionally.
28903
28904 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28905 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28906 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28907 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28908 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28909
28910 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28911 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28912 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28913 (@pxref{Starting}).
28914
28915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28916
28917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28918
28919 @subsubheading Examples
28920
28921 @smallexample
28922 (gdb)
28923 -break-insert main
28924 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28925 (gdb)
28926 -exec-run
28927 ^running
28928 (gdb)
28929 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28930 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28931 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28932 (gdb)
28933 @end smallexample
28934
28935 @noindent
28936 Program exited normally:
28937
28938 @smallexample
28939 (gdb)
28940 -exec-run
28941 ^running
28942 (gdb)
28943 x = 55
28944 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28945 (gdb)
28946 @end smallexample
28947
28948 @noindent
28949 Program exited exceptionally:
28950
28951 @smallexample
28952 (gdb)
28953 -exec-run
28954 ^running
28955 (gdb)
28956 x = 55
28957 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28958 (gdb)
28959 @end smallexample
28960
28961 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28962 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28963
28964 @smallexample
28965 (gdb)
28966 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28967 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28968 @end smallexample
28969
28970
28971 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28972
28973
28974 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28975 @findex -exec-step
28976
28977 @subsubheading Synopsis
28978
28979 @smallexample
28980 -exec-step [--reverse]
28981 @end smallexample
28982
28983 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28984 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28985 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28986 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28987 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28988 previously executed source line.
28989
28990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28991
28992 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28993
28994 @subsubheading Example
28995
28996 Stepping into a function:
28997
28998 @smallexample
28999 -exec-step
29000 ^running
29001 (gdb)
29002 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29003 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29004 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29005 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
29006 (gdb)
29007 @end smallexample
29008
29009 Regular stepping:
29010
29011 @smallexample
29012 -exec-step
29013 ^running
29014 (gdb)
29015 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29016 (gdb)
29017 @end smallexample
29018
29019
29020 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29021 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29022
29023 @subsubheading Synopsis
29024
29025 @smallexample
29026 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29027 @end smallexample
29028
29029 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29030 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29031 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29032 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29033 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29034 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29035 as well.
29036
29037 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29038
29039 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29040
29041 @subsubheading Example
29042
29043 @smallexample
29044 (gdb)
29045 -exec-step-instruction
29046 ^running
29047
29048 (gdb)
29049 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29050 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29051 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29052 (gdb)
29053 -exec-step-instruction
29054 ^running
29055
29056 (gdb)
29057 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29058 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29059 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29060 (gdb)
29061 @end smallexample
29062
29063
29064 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29065 @findex -exec-until
29066
29067 @subsubheading Synopsis
29068
29069 @smallexample
29070 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29071 @end smallexample
29072
29073 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29074 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29075 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29076 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29077
29078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29079
29080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29081
29082 @subsubheading Example
29083
29084 @smallexample
29085 (gdb)
29086 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29087 ^running
29088 (gdb)
29089 x = 55
29090 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29091 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29092 (gdb)
29093 @end smallexample
29094
29095 @ignore
29096 @subheading -file-clear
29097 Is this going away????
29098 @end ignore
29099
29100 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29101 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29102 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29103
29104 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29105 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29106
29107 @smallexample
29108 -enable-frame-filters
29109 @end smallexample
29110
29111 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29112 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29113 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29114 request that this functionality be enabled.
29115
29116 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29117
29118 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29119 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29120
29121 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29122 @findex -stack-info-frame
29123
29124 @subsubheading Synopsis
29125
29126 @smallexample
29127 -stack-info-frame
29128 @end smallexample
29129
29130 Get info on the selected frame.
29131
29132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29133
29134 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29135 (without arguments).
29136
29137 @subsubheading Example
29138
29139 @smallexample
29140 (gdb)
29141 -stack-info-frame
29142 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29143 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29144 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29145 (gdb)
29146 @end smallexample
29147
29148 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29149 @findex -stack-info-depth
29150
29151 @subsubheading Synopsis
29152
29153 @smallexample
29154 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29155 @end smallexample
29156
29157 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29158 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29159
29160 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29161
29162 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29163
29164 @subsubheading Example
29165
29166 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29167
29168 @smallexample
29169 (gdb)
29170 -stack-info-depth
29171 ^done,depth="12"
29172 (gdb)
29173 -stack-info-depth 4
29174 ^done,depth="4"
29175 (gdb)
29176 -stack-info-depth 12
29177 ^done,depth="12"
29178 (gdb)
29179 -stack-info-depth 11
29180 ^done,depth="11"
29181 (gdb)
29182 -stack-info-depth 13
29183 ^done,depth="12"
29184 (gdb)
29185 @end smallexample
29186
29187 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29188 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29189 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29190
29191 @subsubheading Synopsis
29192
29193 @smallexample
29194 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29195 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29196 @end smallexample
29197
29198 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29199 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29200 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29201 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29202 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29203 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29204 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29205 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29206
29207 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29208 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29209 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29210 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29211 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29212 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29213
29214 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29215 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29216 are still displayed, however.
29217
29218 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29219 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29220
29221 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29222
29223 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29224 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29225 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29226
29227 @subsubheading Example
29228
29229 @smallexample
29230 (gdb)
29231 -stack-list-frames
29232 ^done,
29233 stack=[
29234 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29235 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29236 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29237 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29238 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29239 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29240 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29241 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29242 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29243 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29244 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29245 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29246 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29247 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29248 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29249 (gdb)
29250 -stack-list-arguments 0
29251 ^done,
29252 stack-args=[
29253 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29254 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29255 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29256 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29257 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29258 (gdb)
29259 -stack-list-arguments 1
29260 ^done,
29261 stack-args=[
29262 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29263 frame=@{level="1",
29264 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29265 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29266 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29267 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29268 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29269 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29270 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29271 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29272 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29273 (gdb)
29274 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29275 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29276 (gdb)
29277 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29278 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29279 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29280 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29281 (gdb)
29282 @end smallexample
29283
29284 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29285
29286
29287 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29288 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29289 @findex -stack-list-frames
29290
29291 @subsubheading Synopsis
29292
29293 @smallexample
29294 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29295 @end smallexample
29296
29297 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29298 following info:
29299
29300 @table @samp
29301 @item @var{level}
29302 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29303 @item @var{addr}
29304 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29305 @item @var{func}
29306 Function name.
29307 @item @var{file}
29308 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29309 @item @var{fullname}
29310 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29311 @item @var{line}
29312 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29313 @item @var{from}
29314 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29315 if the frame's function is not known.
29316 @end table
29317
29318 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29319 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29320 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29321 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29322 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29323 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29324 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29325 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29326 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29327
29328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29329
29330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29331
29332 @subsubheading Example
29333
29334 Full stack backtrace:
29335
29336 @smallexample
29337 (gdb)
29338 -stack-list-frames
29339 ^done,stack=
29340 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29341 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29342 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29343 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29344 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29345 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29346 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29347 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29348 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29349 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29350 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29351 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29352 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29353 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29354 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29355 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29356 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29357 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29358 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29359 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29360 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29361 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29362 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29363 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29364 (gdb)
29365 @end smallexample
29366
29367 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29368
29369 @smallexample
29370 (gdb)
29371 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29372 ^done,stack=
29373 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29374 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29375 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29376 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29377 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29378 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29379 (gdb)
29380 @end smallexample
29381
29382 Show a single frame:
29383
29384 @smallexample
29385 (gdb)
29386 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29387 ^done,stack=
29388 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29389 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29390 (gdb)
29391 @end smallexample
29392
29393
29394 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29395 @findex -stack-list-locals
29396 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29397
29398 @subsubheading Synopsis
29399
29400 @smallexample
29401 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29402 @end smallexample
29403
29404 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29405 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29406 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29407 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29408 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29409 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29410 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29411 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29412 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29413 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29414
29415 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29416 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29417 variables are still displayed, however.
29418
29419 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29420 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29421
29422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29423
29424 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29425
29426 @subsubheading Example
29427
29428 @smallexample
29429 (gdb)
29430 -stack-list-locals 0
29431 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29432 (gdb)
29433 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29434 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29435 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29436 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29437 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29438 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29439 (gdb)
29440 @end smallexample
29441
29442 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29443 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29444 @findex -stack-list-variables
29445
29446 @subsubheading Synopsis
29447
29448 @smallexample
29449 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29450 @end smallexample
29451
29452 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29453 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29454 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29455 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29456 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29457 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29458 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29459
29460 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29461 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29462 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29463
29464 @subsubheading Example
29465
29466 @smallexample
29467 (gdb)
29468 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29469 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29470 (gdb)
29471 @end smallexample
29472
29473
29474 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29475 @findex -stack-select-frame
29476
29477 @subsubheading Synopsis
29478
29479 @smallexample
29480 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29481 @end smallexample
29482
29483 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29484 the stack.
29485
29486 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29487 option to every command.
29488
29489 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29490
29491 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29492 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29493
29494 @subsubheading Example
29495
29496 @smallexample
29497 (gdb)
29498 -stack-select-frame 2
29499 ^done
29500 (gdb)
29501 @end smallexample
29502
29503 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29504 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29505 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29506
29507 @ignore
29508
29509 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29510
29511 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29512 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29513 used by @code{Insight}.
29514
29515 The two main reasons for that are:
29516
29517 @enumerate 1
29518 @item
29519 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29520
29521 @item
29522 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29523 now).
29524 @end enumerate
29525
29526 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29527 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29528 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29529 hints about their use.
29530
29531 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29532 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29533 least, the following operations:
29534
29535 @itemize @bullet
29536 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29537 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29538 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29539 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29540 @end itemize
29541
29542 @end ignore
29543
29544 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29545
29546 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29547
29548 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29549 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29550 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29551 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29552 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29553 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29554 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29555 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29556 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29557 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29558 object, or to change display format.
29559
29560 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29561 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29562 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29563 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29564 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29565 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29566 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29567 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29568 child will be created.
29569
29570 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29571 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29572 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29573 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29574 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29575
29576 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29577 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29578 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29579 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29580 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29581 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29582 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29583 variables that frontend has created.
29584
29585 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29586 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29587 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29588 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29589 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29590 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29591 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29592 implicitly updated.
29593
29594 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29595 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29596 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29597 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29598 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29599 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29600 frame. Consider this example:
29601
29602 @smallexample
29603 void do_work(...)
29604 @{
29605 struct work_state state;
29606
29607 if (...)
29608 do_work(...);
29609 @}
29610 @end smallexample
29611
29612 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29613 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29614 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29615 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29616 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29617
29618 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29619 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29620 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29621 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29622 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29623 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29624
29625 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29626 access this functionality:
29627
29628 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29629 @item @strong{Operation}
29630 @tab @strong{Description}
29631
29632 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29633 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29634 @item @code{-var-create}
29635 @tab create a variable object
29636 @item @code{-var-delete}
29637 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29638 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29639 @tab set the display format of this variable
29640 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29641 @tab show the display format of this variable
29642 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29643 @tab tells how many children this object has
29644 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29645 @tab return a list of the object's children
29646 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29647 @tab show the type of this variable object
29648 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29649 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29650 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29651 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29652 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29653 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29654 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29655 @tab get the value of this variable
29656 @item @code{-var-assign}
29657 @tab set the value of this variable
29658 @item @code{-var-update}
29659 @tab update the variable and its children
29660 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29661 @tab set frozeness attribute
29662 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29663 @tab set range of children to display on update
29664 @end multitable
29665
29666 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29667 how it can be used.
29668
29669 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29670
29671 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29672 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29673
29674 @smallexample
29675 -enable-pretty-printing
29676 @end smallexample
29677
29678 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29679 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29680 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29681 request that this functionality be enabled.
29682
29683 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29684
29685 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29686 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29687
29688 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29689 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29690
29691 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29692 @findex -var-create
29693
29694 @subsubheading Synopsis
29695
29696 @smallexample
29697 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29698 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29699 @end smallexample
29700
29701 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29702 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29703 register.
29704
29705 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29706 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29707 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29708 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29709 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29710
29711 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29712 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29713 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29714 object must be created.
29715
29716 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29717 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29718
29719 @itemize @bullet
29720 @item
29721 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29722
29723 @item
29724 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29725
29726 @item
29727 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29728 @end itemize
29729
29730 @cindex dynamic varobj
29731 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29732 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29733 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29734 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29735 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29736 compatibility for existing clients.
29737
29738 @subsubheading Result
29739
29740 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29741 are:
29742
29743 @table @samp
29744 @item name
29745 The name of the varobj.
29746
29747 @item numchild
29748 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29749 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29750 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29751
29752 @item value
29753 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29754 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29755 will not be interesting.
29756
29757 @item type
29758 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29759 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29760 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29761 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29762 @emph{declared} one.
29763
29764 @item thread-id
29765 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29766 thread's global identifier.
29767
29768 @item has_more
29769 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29770 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29771
29772 @item dynamic
29773 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29774 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29775 then this attribute will not be present.
29776
29777 @item displayhint
29778 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29779 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29780 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29781 @end table
29782
29783 Typical output will look like this:
29784
29785 @smallexample
29786 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29787 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29788 @end smallexample
29789
29790
29791 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29792 @findex -var-delete
29793
29794 @subsubheading Synopsis
29795
29796 @smallexample
29797 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29798 @end smallexample
29799
29800 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29801 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29802
29803 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29804
29805
29806 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29807 @findex -var-set-format
29808
29809 @subsubheading Synopsis
29810
29811 @smallexample
29812 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29813 @end smallexample
29814
29815 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29816 @var{format-spec}.
29817
29818 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29819 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29820
29821 @smallexample
29822 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29823 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29824 @end smallexample
29825
29826 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29827 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29828 for pointers, etc.).
29829
29830 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29831 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29832 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29833 zero-hexadecimal format.
29834
29835 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29836 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29837
29838 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29839 @findex -var-show-format
29840
29841 @subsubheading Synopsis
29842
29843 @smallexample
29844 -var-show-format @var{name}
29845 @end smallexample
29846
29847 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29848
29849 @smallexample
29850 @var{format} @expansion{}
29851 @var{format-spec}
29852 @end smallexample
29853
29854
29855 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29856 @findex -var-info-num-children
29857
29858 @subsubheading Synopsis
29859
29860 @smallexample
29861 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29862 @end smallexample
29863
29864 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29865
29866 @smallexample
29867 numchild=@var{n}
29868 @end smallexample
29869
29870 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29871 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29872 be available.
29873
29874
29875 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29876 @findex -var-list-children
29877
29878 @subsubheading Synopsis
29879
29880 @smallexample
29881 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29882 @end smallexample
29883 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29884
29885 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29886 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29887 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29888 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29889 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29890 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29891 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29892 and unions.
29893
29894 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29895 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29896 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29897 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29898 reported.
29899
29900 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29901 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29902 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29903 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29904 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29905 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29906 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29907 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29908 the visible items.
29909
29910 For each child the following results are returned:
29911
29912 @table @var
29913
29914 @item name
29915 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29916
29917 @item exp
29918 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29919 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29920
29921 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29922 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29923
29924 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29925 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29926 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29927 type and value are not present.
29928
29929 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29930 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29931 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29932
29933 @item numchild
29934 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29935 0.
29936
29937 @item type
29938 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29939 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29940 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29941 @emph{declared} one.
29942
29943 @item value
29944 If values were requested, this is the value.
29945
29946 @item thread-id
29947 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29948 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29949
29950 @item frozen
29951 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29952
29953 @item displayhint
29954 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29955 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29956 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29957
29958 @item dynamic
29959 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29960 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29961 then this attribute will not be present.
29962
29963 @end table
29964
29965 The result may have its own attributes:
29966
29967 @table @samp
29968 @item displayhint
29969 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29970 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29971 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29972
29973 @item has_more
29974 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29975 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29976 @end table
29977
29978 @subsubheading Example
29979
29980 @smallexample
29981 (gdb)
29982 -var-list-children n
29983 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29984 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29985 (gdb)
29986 -var-list-children --all-values n
29987 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29988 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29989 @end smallexample
29990
29991
29992 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29993 @findex -var-info-type
29994
29995 @subsubheading Synopsis
29996
29997 @smallexample
29998 -var-info-type @var{name}
29999 @end smallexample
30000
30001 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30002 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30003 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30004
30005 @smallexample
30006 type=@var{typename}
30007 @end smallexample
30008
30009
30010 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30011 @findex -var-info-expression
30012
30013 @subsubheading Synopsis
30014
30015 @smallexample
30016 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30017 @end smallexample
30018
30019 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30020 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30021 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30022
30023 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30024 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30025
30026 @smallexample
30027 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30028 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30029 @end smallexample
30030
30031 @noindent
30032 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30033 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30034
30035 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30036 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30037 is of limited use.
30038
30039 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30040 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30041
30042 @subsubheading Synopsis
30043
30044 @smallexample
30045 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30046 @end smallexample
30047
30048 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30049 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30050 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30051 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30052 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30053 watchpoint from a variable object.
30054
30055 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30056 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30057
30058 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30059 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30060 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30061 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30062 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30063 @smallexample
30064 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30065 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30066 @end smallexample
30067
30068 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30069 @findex -var-show-attributes
30070
30071 @subsubheading Synopsis
30072
30073 @smallexample
30074 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30075 @end smallexample
30076
30077 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30078
30079 @smallexample
30080 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30081 @end smallexample
30082
30083 @noindent
30084 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30085
30086 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30087 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30088
30089 @subsubheading Synopsis
30090
30091 @smallexample
30092 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30093 @end smallexample
30094
30095 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30096 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30097 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30098 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30099 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30100 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30101 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30102
30103 @smallexample
30104 value=@var{value}
30105 @end smallexample
30106
30107 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30108 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30109
30110 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30111 @findex -var-assign
30112
30113 @subsubheading Synopsis
30114
30115 @smallexample
30116 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30117 @end smallexample
30118
30119 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30120 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30121 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30122 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30123
30124 @subsubheading Example
30125
30126 @smallexample
30127 (gdb)
30128 -var-assign var1 3
30129 ^done,value="3"
30130 (gdb)
30131 -var-update *
30132 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30133 (gdb)
30134 @end smallexample
30135
30136 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30137 @findex -var-update
30138
30139 @subsubheading Synopsis
30140
30141 @smallexample
30142 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30143 @end smallexample
30144
30145 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30146 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30147 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30148 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30149 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30150 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30151 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30152 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30153 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30154 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30155 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30156 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30157 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30158
30159 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30160 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30161 diagnostic.
30162
30163 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30164 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30165
30166 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30167 @samp{changelist}.
30168
30169 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30170
30171 @table @samp
30172 @item name
30173 The name of the varobj.
30174
30175 @item value
30176 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30177 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30178
30179 @item in_scope
30180 @anchor{-var-update}
30181 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30182
30183 @table @code
30184 @item "true"
30185 The variable object's current value is valid.
30186
30187 @item "false"
30188 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30189 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30190 scope.
30191
30192 @item "invalid"
30193 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30194 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30195 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30196 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30197 objects.
30198 @end table
30199
30200 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30201 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30202
30203 @item type_changed
30204 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30205 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30206 be @samp{false}.
30207
30208 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30209 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30210 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30211 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30212 unset.
30213
30214 @item new_type
30215 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30216 hold the new type.
30217
30218 @item new_num_children
30219 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30220 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30221
30222 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30223 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30224 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30225 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30226 children which may be available.
30227
30228 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30229 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30230 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30231 only happen at the end of the update range).
30232
30233 @item displayhint
30234 The display hint, if any.
30235
30236 @item has_more
30237 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30238 available outside the varobj's update range.
30239
30240 @item dynamic
30241 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30242 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30243 then this attribute will not be present.
30244
30245 @item new_children
30246 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30247 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30248 be listed in this attribute.
30249 @end table
30250
30251 @subsubheading Example
30252
30253 @smallexample
30254 (gdb)
30255 -var-assign var1 3
30256 ^done,value="3"
30257 (gdb)
30258 -var-update --all-values var1
30259 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30260 type_changed="false"@}]
30261 (gdb)
30262 @end smallexample
30263
30264 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30265 @findex -var-set-frozen
30266 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30267
30268 @subsubheading Synopsis
30269
30270 @smallexample
30271 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30272 @end smallexample
30273
30274 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30275 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30276 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30277 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30278 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30279 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30280 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30281 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30282 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30283 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30284 @code{-var-update} does.
30285
30286 @subsubheading Example
30287
30288 @smallexample
30289 (gdb)
30290 -var-set-frozen V 1
30291 ^done
30292 (gdb)
30293 @end smallexample
30294
30295 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30296 @findex -var-set-update-range
30297 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30298
30299 @subsubheading Synopsis
30300
30301 @smallexample
30302 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30303 @end smallexample
30304
30305 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30306 @code{-var-update}.
30307
30308 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30309 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30310 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30311 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30312
30313 @subsubheading Example
30314
30315 @smallexample
30316 (gdb)
30317 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30318 ^done
30319 @end smallexample
30320
30321 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30322 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30323 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30324
30325 @subsubheading Synopsis
30326
30327 @smallexample
30328 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30329 @end smallexample
30330
30331 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30332
30333 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30334 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30335
30336 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30337 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30338 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30339 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30340 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30341 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30342 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30343
30344 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30345 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30346 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30347 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30348
30349 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30350 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30351 can be used to check this.
30352
30353 @subsubheading Example
30354
30355 Resetting the visualizer:
30356
30357 @smallexample
30358 (gdb)
30359 -var-set-visualizer V None
30360 ^done
30361 @end smallexample
30362
30363 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30364
30365 @smallexample
30366 (gdb)
30367 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30368 ^done
30369 @end smallexample
30370
30371 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30372 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30373
30374 @smallexample
30375 (gdb)
30376 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30377 ^done
30378 @end smallexample
30379
30380 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30381 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30382 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30383
30384 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30385 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30386 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30387 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30388
30389 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30390 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30391
30392 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30393 @c @subheading -data-assign
30394 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30395 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30396 @c set variable
30397 @c @subsubheading Example
30398 @c N.A.
30399
30400 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30401 @findex -data-disassemble
30402
30403 @subsubheading Synopsis
30404
30405 @smallexample
30406 -data-disassemble
30407 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30408 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30409 -- @var{mode}
30410 @end smallexample
30411
30412 @noindent
30413 Where:
30414
30415 @table @samp
30416 @item @var{start-addr}
30417 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30418 @item @var{end-addr}
30419 is the end address
30420 @item @var{filename}
30421 is the name of the file to disassemble
30422 @item @var{linenum}
30423 is the line number to disassemble around
30424 @item @var{lines}
30425 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30426 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30427 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30428 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30429 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30430 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30431 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30432 are displayed.
30433 @item @var{mode}
30434 is one of:
30435 @itemize @bullet
30436 @item 0 disassembly only
30437 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30438 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30439 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30440 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30441 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30442 @end itemize
30443
30444 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30445 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30446 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30447 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30448 @end table
30449
30450 @subsubheading Result
30451
30452 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30453 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30454 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30455
30456 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30457 following fields:
30458
30459 @table @code
30460 @item address
30461 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30462
30463 @item func-name
30464 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30465
30466 @item offset
30467 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30468
30469 @item inst
30470 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30471
30472 @item opcodes
30473 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30474 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30475
30476 @end table
30477
30478 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30479 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30480
30481 @table @code
30482 @item line
30483 The line number within @samp{file}.
30484
30485 @item file
30486 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30487 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30488 used.
30489
30490 @item fullname
30491 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30492 using the source file search path
30493 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30494 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30495
30496 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30497 present in the debug information.
30498
30499 @item line_asm_insn
30500 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30501 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30502 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30503 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30504 @samp{opcodes}.
30505
30506 @end table
30507
30508 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30509 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30510 adjust its format.
30511
30512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30513
30514 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30515
30516 @subsubheading Example
30517
30518 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30519
30520 @smallexample
30521 (gdb)
30522 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30523 ^done,
30524 asm_insns=[
30525 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30526 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30527 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30528 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30529 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30530 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30531 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30532 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30533 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30534 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30535 (gdb)
30536 @end smallexample
30537
30538 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30539 @code{main}.
30540
30541 @smallexample
30542 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30543 ^done,asm_insns=[
30544 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30545 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30546 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30547 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30548 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30549 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30550 [@dots{}]
30551 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30552 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30553 (gdb)
30554 @end smallexample
30555
30556 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30557
30558 @smallexample
30559 (gdb)
30560 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30561 ^done,asm_insns=[
30562 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30563 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30564 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30565 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30566 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30567 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30568 (gdb)
30569 @end smallexample
30570
30571 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30572
30573 @smallexample
30574 (gdb)
30575 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30576 ^done,asm_insns=[
30577 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30578 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30579 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30580 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30581 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30582 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30583 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30584 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30585 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30586 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30587 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30588 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30589 (gdb)
30590 @end smallexample
30591
30592
30593 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30594 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30595
30596 @subsubheading Synopsis
30597
30598 @smallexample
30599 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30600 @end smallexample
30601
30602 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30603 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30604 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30605
30606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30607
30608 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30609 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30610 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30611
30612 @subsubheading Example
30613
30614 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30615 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30616 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30617 output.
30618
30619 @smallexample
30620 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30621 211^done,value="1"
30622 (gdb)
30623 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30624 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30625 (gdb)
30626 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30627 411^done,value="4"
30628 (gdb)
30629 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30630 511^done,value="4"
30631 (gdb)
30632 @end smallexample
30633
30634
30635 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30636 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30637
30638 @subsubheading Synopsis
30639
30640 @smallexample
30641 -data-list-changed-registers
30642 @end smallexample
30643
30644 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30645
30646 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30647
30648 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30649 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30650
30651 @subsubheading Example
30652
30653 On a PPC MBX board:
30654
30655 @smallexample
30656 (gdb)
30657 -exec-continue
30658 ^running
30659
30660 (gdb)
30661 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30662 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30663 line="5"@}
30664 (gdb)
30665 -data-list-changed-registers
30666 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30667 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30668 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30669 (gdb)
30670 @end smallexample
30671
30672
30673 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30674 @findex -data-list-register-names
30675
30676 @subsubheading Synopsis
30677
30678 @smallexample
30679 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30680 @end smallexample
30681
30682 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30683 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30684 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30685 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30686 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30687 include empty register names.
30688
30689 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30690
30691 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30692 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30693 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30694
30695 @subsubheading Example
30696
30697 For the PPC MBX board:
30698 @smallexample
30699 (gdb)
30700 -data-list-register-names
30701 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30702 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30703 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30704 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30705 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30706 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30707 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30708 (gdb)
30709 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30710 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30711 (gdb)
30712 @end smallexample
30713
30714 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30715 @findex -data-list-register-values
30716
30717 @subsubheading Synopsis
30718
30719 @smallexample
30720 -data-list-register-values
30721 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30722 @end smallexample
30723
30724 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30725 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30726 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30727 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30728 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30729 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30730
30731 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30732
30733 @table @code
30734 @item x
30735 Hexadecimal
30736 @item o
30737 Octal
30738 @item t
30739 Binary
30740 @item d
30741 Decimal
30742 @item r
30743 Raw
30744 @item N
30745 Natural
30746 @end table
30747
30748 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30749
30750 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30751 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30752
30753 @subsubheading Example
30754
30755 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30756 don't appear in the actual output):
30757
30758 @smallexample
30759 (gdb)
30760 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30761 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30762 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30763 (gdb)
30764 -data-list-register-values x
30765 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30766 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30767 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30768 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30769 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30770 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30771 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30772 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30773 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30774 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30775 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30776 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30777 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30778 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30779 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30780 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30781 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30782 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30783 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30784 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30785 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30786 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30787 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30788 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30789 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30790 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30791 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30792 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30793 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30794 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30795 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30796 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30797 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30798 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30799 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30800 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30801 (gdb)
30802 @end smallexample
30803
30804
30805 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30806 @findex -data-read-memory
30807
30808 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30809
30810 @subsubheading Synopsis
30811
30812 @smallexample
30813 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30814 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30815 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30816 @end smallexample
30817
30818 @noindent
30819 where:
30820
30821 @table @samp
30822 @item @var{address}
30823 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30824 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30825 quoted using the C convention.
30826
30827 @item @var{word-format}
30828 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30829 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30830 ,Output Formats}).
30831
30832 @item @var{word-size}
30833 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30834
30835 @item @var{nr-rows}
30836 The number of rows in the output table.
30837
30838 @item @var{nr-cols}
30839 The number of columns in the output table.
30840
30841 @item @var{aschar}
30842 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30843 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30844 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30845 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30846
30847 @item @var{byte-offset}
30848 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30849 @end table
30850
30851 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30852 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30853 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30854 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30855 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30856 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30857 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30858 @samp{addr}.
30859
30860 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30861 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30862 @samp{prev-page}.
30863
30864 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30865
30866 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30867 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30868
30869 @subsubheading Example
30870
30871 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30872 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30873 word. Display each word in hex.
30874
30875 @smallexample
30876 (gdb)
30877 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30878 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30879 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30880 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30881 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30882 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30883 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30884 (gdb)
30885 @end smallexample
30886
30887 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30888 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30889
30890 @smallexample
30891 (gdb)
30892 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30893 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30894 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30895 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30896 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30897 (gdb)
30898 @end smallexample
30899
30900 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30901 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30902 used as the non-printable character.
30903
30904 @smallexample
30905 (gdb)
30906 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30907 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30908 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30909 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30910 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30911 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30912 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30913 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30914 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30915 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30916 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30917 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30918 (gdb)
30919 @end smallexample
30920
30921 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30922 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30923
30924 @subsubheading Synopsis
30925
30926 @smallexample
30927 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30928 @var{address} @var{count}
30929 @end smallexample
30930
30931 @noindent
30932 where:
30933
30934 @table @samp
30935 @item @var{address}
30936 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30937 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30938 quoted using the C convention.
30939
30940 @item @var{count}
30941 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30942 literal.
30943
30944 @item @var{offset}
30945 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30946 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30947 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30948 arithmetics itself.
30949
30950 @end table
30951
30952 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30953 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30954 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30955 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30956 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30957 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30958
30959 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30960 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30961 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30962 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30963 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30964 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30965 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30966 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30967
30968 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30969 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30970 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30971 and has the following fields:
30972
30973 @table @code
30974 @item begin
30975 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30976
30977 @item end
30978 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30979
30980 @item offset
30981 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30982 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30983
30984 @item contents
30985 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30986
30987 @end table
30988
30989
30990
30991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30992
30993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30994
30995 @subsubheading Example
30996
30997 @smallexample
30998 (gdb)
30999 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31000 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31001 end="0xbffff15e",
31002 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31003 (gdb)
31004 @end smallexample
31005
31006
31007 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31008 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31009
31010 @subsubheading Synopsis
31011
31012 @smallexample
31013 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31014 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31015 @end smallexample
31016
31017 @noindent
31018 where:
31019
31020 @table @samp
31021 @item @var{address}
31022 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31023 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31024 be quoted using the C convention.
31025
31026 @item @var{contents}
31027 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31028 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31029
31030 @item @var{count}
31031 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31032 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31033 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31034 @var{count} memory units.
31035
31036 @end table
31037
31038 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31039
31040 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31041
31042 @subsubheading Example
31043
31044 @smallexample
31045 (gdb)
31046 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31047 ^done
31048 (gdb)
31049 @end smallexample
31050
31051 @smallexample
31052 (gdb)
31053 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31054 ^done
31055 (gdb)
31056 @end smallexample
31057
31058 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31059 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31060 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31061
31062 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31063 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31064
31065 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31066 @findex -trace-find
31067
31068 @subsubheading Synopsis
31069
31070 @smallexample
31071 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31072 @end smallexample
31073
31074 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31075 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31076 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31077
31078 @table @samp
31079
31080 @item none
31081 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31082
31083 @item frame-number
31084 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31085 that index.
31086
31087 @item tracepoint-number
31088 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31089 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31090
31091 @item pc
31092 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31093 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31094 address.
31095
31096 @item pc-inside-range
31097 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31098 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31099 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31100
31101 @item pc-outside-range
31102 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31103 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31104 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31105
31106 @item line
31107 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31108 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31109 the specified location.
31110
31111 @end table
31112
31113 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31114 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31115
31116 @table @samp
31117 @item found
31118 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31119 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31120
31121 @item traceframe
31122 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31123 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31124
31125 @item tracepoint
31126 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31127 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31128
31129 @item frame
31130 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31131 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31132 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31133
31134 @end table
31135
31136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31137
31138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31139
31140 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31141 @findex -trace-define-variable
31142
31143 @subsubheading Synopsis
31144
31145 @smallexample
31146 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31147 @end smallexample
31148
31149 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31150 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31151 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31152 with the @samp{$} character.
31153
31154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31155
31156 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31157
31158 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31159 @findex -trace-frame-collected
31160
31161 @subsubheading Synopsis
31162
31163 @smallexample
31164 -trace-frame-collected
31165 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31166 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31167 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31168 [--memory-contents]
31169 @end smallexample
31170
31171 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31172 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31173 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31174 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31175 See the output description table below for more details.
31176
31177 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31178 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31179 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31180 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31181 memory range and which is a computed expression.
31182
31183 For instance, if the actions were
31184 @smallexample
31185 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31186 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31187 @end smallexample
31188
31189 @noindent
31190 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31191 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31192 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31193 objects would be computed expressions.
31194
31195 An example output would be:
31196
31197 @smallexample
31198 (gdb)
31199 -trace-frame-collected
31200 ^done,
31201 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31202 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31203 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31204 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31205 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31206 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31207 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31208 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31209 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31210 ...
31211 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31212 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31213 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31214 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31215 (gdb)
31216 @end smallexample
31217
31218 Where:
31219
31220 @table @code
31221 @item explicit-variables
31222 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31223 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31224 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31225 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31226 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31227 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31228 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31229 arrays, structures and unions.
31230
31231 @item computed-expressions
31232 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31233 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31234 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31235 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31236
31237 @item registers
31238 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31239 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31240 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31241 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31242 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31243
31244 @item tvars
31245 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31246 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31247 current value are returned.
31248
31249 @item memory
31250 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31251 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31252 collected memory range and has the following fields:
31253
31254 @table @code
31255 @item address
31256 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31257
31258 @item length
31259 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31260
31261 @item contents
31262 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31263 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31264
31265 @end table
31266
31267 @end table
31268
31269 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31270
31271 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31272
31273 @subsubheading Example
31274
31275 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31276 @findex -trace-list-variables
31277
31278 @subsubheading Synopsis
31279
31280 @smallexample
31281 -trace-list-variables
31282 @end smallexample
31283
31284 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31285 table has the following fields:
31286
31287 @table @samp
31288 @item name
31289 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31290
31291 @item initial
31292 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31293 field is always present.
31294
31295 @item current
31296 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31297 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31298 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31299 presently running.
31300
31301 @end table
31302
31303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31304
31305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31306
31307 @subsubheading Example
31308
31309 @smallexample
31310 (gdb)
31311 -trace-list-variables
31312 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31313 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31314 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31315 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31316 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31317 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31318 (gdb)
31319 @end smallexample
31320
31321 @subheading -trace-save
31322 @findex -trace-save
31323
31324 @subsubheading Synopsis
31325
31326 @smallexample
31327 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31328 @end smallexample
31329
31330 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31331 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31332 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31333 to perform the save.
31334
31335 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31336 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31337 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31338
31339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31340
31341 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31342
31343
31344 @subheading -trace-start
31345 @findex -trace-start
31346
31347 @subsubheading Synopsis
31348
31349 @smallexample
31350 -trace-start
31351 @end smallexample
31352
31353 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31354 have any fields.
31355
31356 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31357
31358 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31359
31360 @subheading -trace-status
31361 @findex -trace-status
31362
31363 @subsubheading Synopsis
31364
31365 @smallexample
31366 -trace-status
31367 @end smallexample
31368
31369 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31370 the following fields:
31371
31372 @table @samp
31373
31374 @item supported
31375 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31376 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31377 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31378 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31379 started. This field is always present.
31380
31381 @item running
31382 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31383 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31384 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31385
31386 @item stop-reason
31387 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31388 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31389 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31390 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31391 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31392 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31393 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31394 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31395 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31396
31397 @item stopping-tracepoint
31398 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31399 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31400 @samp{passcount}.
31401
31402 @item frames
31403 @itemx frames-created
31404 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31405 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31406 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31407 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31408
31409 @item buffer-size
31410 @itemx buffer-free
31411 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31412 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31413
31414 @item circular
31415 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31416 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31417 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31418 and may fill up.
31419
31420 @item disconnected
31421 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31422 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31423 that the trace run will stop.
31424
31425 @item trace-file
31426 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31427 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31428
31429 @end table
31430
31431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31432
31433 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31434
31435 @subheading -trace-stop
31436 @findex -trace-stop
31437
31438 @subsubheading Synopsis
31439
31440 @smallexample
31441 -trace-stop
31442 @end smallexample
31443
31444 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31445 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31446 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31447
31448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31449
31450 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31451
31452
31453 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31454 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31455 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31456
31457
31458 @ignore
31459 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31460 @findex -symbol-info-address
31461
31462 @subsubheading Synopsis
31463
31464 @smallexample
31465 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31466 @end smallexample
31467
31468 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31469
31470 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31471
31472 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31473
31474 @subsubheading Example
31475 N.A.
31476
31477
31478 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31479 @findex -symbol-info-file
31480
31481 @subsubheading Synopsis
31482
31483 @smallexample
31484 -symbol-info-file
31485 @end smallexample
31486
31487 Show the file for the symbol.
31488
31489 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31490
31491 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31492 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31493
31494 @subsubheading Example
31495 N.A.
31496
31497
31498 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31499 @findex -symbol-info-function
31500
31501 @subsubheading Synopsis
31502
31503 @smallexample
31504 -symbol-info-function
31505 @end smallexample
31506
31507 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31508
31509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31510
31511 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31512
31513 @subsubheading Example
31514 N.A.
31515
31516
31517 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31518 @findex -symbol-info-line
31519
31520 @subsubheading Synopsis
31521
31522 @smallexample
31523 -symbol-info-line
31524 @end smallexample
31525
31526 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31527
31528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31529
31530 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31531 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31532
31533 @subsubheading Example
31534 N.A.
31535
31536
31537 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31538 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31539
31540 @subsubheading Synopsis
31541
31542 @smallexample
31543 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31544 @end smallexample
31545
31546 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31547
31548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31549
31550 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31551
31552 @subsubheading Example
31553 N.A.
31554
31555
31556 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31557 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31558
31559 @subsubheading Synopsis
31560
31561 @smallexample
31562 -symbol-list-functions
31563 @end smallexample
31564
31565 List the functions in the executable.
31566
31567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31568
31569 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31570 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31571
31572 @subsubheading Example
31573 N.A.
31574 @end ignore
31575
31576
31577 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31578 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31579
31580 @subsubheading Synopsis
31581
31582 @smallexample
31583 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31584 @end smallexample
31585
31586 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31587 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31588 ascending PC order.
31589
31590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31591
31592 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31593
31594 @subsubheading Example
31595 @smallexample
31596 (gdb)
31597 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31598 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31599 (gdb)
31600 @end smallexample
31601
31602
31603 @ignore
31604 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31605 @findex -symbol-list-types
31606
31607 @subsubheading Synopsis
31608
31609 @smallexample
31610 -symbol-list-types
31611 @end smallexample
31612
31613 List all the type names.
31614
31615 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31616
31617 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31618 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31619
31620 @subsubheading Example
31621 N.A.
31622
31623
31624 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31625 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31626
31627 @subsubheading Synopsis
31628
31629 @smallexample
31630 -symbol-list-variables
31631 @end smallexample
31632
31633 List all the global and static variable names.
31634
31635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31636
31637 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31638
31639 @subsubheading Example
31640 N.A.
31641
31642
31643 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31644 @findex -symbol-locate
31645
31646 @subsubheading Synopsis
31647
31648 @smallexample
31649 -symbol-locate
31650 @end smallexample
31651
31652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31653
31654 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31655
31656 @subsubheading Example
31657 N.A.
31658
31659
31660 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31661 @findex -symbol-type
31662
31663 @subsubheading Synopsis
31664
31665 @smallexample
31666 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31667 @end smallexample
31668
31669 Show type of @var{variable}.
31670
31671 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31672
31673 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31674 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31675
31676 @subsubheading Example
31677 N.A.
31678 @end ignore
31679
31680
31681 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31682 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31683 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31684
31685 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31686 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31687
31688 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31689 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31690
31691 @subsubheading Synopsis
31692
31693 @smallexample
31694 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31695 @end smallexample
31696
31697 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31698 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31699 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31700 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31701 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31702 notification.
31703
31704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31705
31706 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31707
31708 @subsubheading Example
31709
31710 @smallexample
31711 (gdb)
31712 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31713 ^done
31714 (gdb)
31715 @end smallexample
31716
31717
31718 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31719 @findex -file-exec-file
31720
31721 @subsubheading Synopsis
31722
31723 @smallexample
31724 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31725 @end smallexample
31726
31727 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31728 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31729 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31730 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31731 notification.
31732
31733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31734
31735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31736
31737 @subsubheading Example
31738
31739 @smallexample
31740 (gdb)
31741 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31742 ^done
31743 (gdb)
31744 @end smallexample
31745
31746
31747 @ignore
31748 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31749 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31750
31751 @subsubheading Synopsis
31752
31753 @smallexample
31754 -file-list-exec-sections
31755 @end smallexample
31756
31757 List the sections of the current executable file.
31758
31759 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31760
31761 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31762 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31763 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31764
31765 @subsubheading Example
31766 N.A.
31767 @end ignore
31768
31769
31770 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31771 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31772
31773 @subsubheading Synopsis
31774
31775 @smallexample
31776 -file-list-exec-source-file
31777 @end smallexample
31778
31779 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31780 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31781 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31782 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31783
31784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31785
31786 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31787
31788 @subsubheading Example
31789
31790 @smallexample
31791 (gdb)
31792 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31793 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31794 (gdb)
31795 @end smallexample
31796
31797
31798 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31799 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31800
31801 @subsubheading Synopsis
31802
31803 @smallexample
31804 -file-list-exec-source-files
31805 @end smallexample
31806
31807 List the source files for the current executable.
31808
31809 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31810 name) of a source file.
31811
31812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31813
31814 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31815 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31816
31817 @subsubheading Example
31818 @smallexample
31819 (gdb)
31820 -file-list-exec-source-files
31821 ^done,files=[
31822 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31823 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31824 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31825 (gdb)
31826 @end smallexample
31827
31828 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31829 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31830
31831 @subsubheading Synopsis
31832
31833 @smallexample
31834 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31835 @end smallexample
31836
31837 List the shared libraries in the program.
31838 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31839 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31840
31841 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31842
31843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
31844 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31845 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31846 library. Each range has the following fields:
31847
31848 @table @samp
31849 @item from
31850 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31851 @item to
31852 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31853 @end table
31854
31855 @subsubheading Example
31856 @smallexample
31857 (gdb)
31858 -file-list-exec-source-files
31859 ^done,shared-libraries=[
31860 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31861 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31862 (gdb)
31863 @end smallexample
31864
31865
31866 @ignore
31867 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31868 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31869
31870 @subsubheading Synopsis
31871
31872 @smallexample
31873 -file-list-symbol-files
31874 @end smallexample
31875
31876 List symbol files.
31877
31878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31879
31880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31881
31882 @subsubheading Example
31883 N.A.
31884 @end ignore
31885
31886
31887 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31888 @findex -file-symbol-file
31889
31890 @subsubheading Synopsis
31891
31892 @smallexample
31893 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31894 @end smallexample
31895
31896 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31897 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31898 produced, except for a completion notification.
31899
31900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31901
31902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31903
31904 @subsubheading Example
31905
31906 @smallexample
31907 (gdb)
31908 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31909 ^done
31910 (gdb)
31911 @end smallexample
31912
31913 @ignore
31914 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31915 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31916 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31917
31918 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31919
31920 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31921
31922 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31923
31924 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31925
31926 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31927
31928 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31929
31930 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31931
31932 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31933
31934 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31935 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31936 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31937
31938 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31939
31940 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31941
31942 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31943
31944 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31945 @end ignore
31946
31947
31948 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31949 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31950 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31951
31952
31953 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31954 @findex -target-attach
31955
31956 @subsubheading Synopsis
31957
31958 @smallexample
31959 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31960 @end smallexample
31961
31962 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31963 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31964 group, the id previously returned by
31965 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31966
31967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31968
31969 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31970
31971 @subsubheading Example
31972 @smallexample
31973 (gdb)
31974 -target-attach 34
31975 =thread-created,id="1"
31976 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31977 ^done
31978 (gdb)
31979 @end smallexample
31980
31981 @ignore
31982 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31983 @findex -target-compare-sections
31984
31985 @subsubheading Synopsis
31986
31987 @smallexample
31988 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31989 @end smallexample
31990
31991 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31992 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31993
31994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31995
31996 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31997
31998 @subsubheading Example
31999 N.A.
32000 @end ignore
32001
32002
32003 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32004 @findex -target-detach
32005
32006 @subsubheading Synopsis
32007
32008 @smallexample
32009 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32010 @end smallexample
32011
32012 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32013 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32014 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32015
32016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32017
32018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32019
32020 @subsubheading Example
32021
32022 @smallexample
32023 (gdb)
32024 -target-detach
32025 ^done
32026 (gdb)
32027 @end smallexample
32028
32029
32030 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32031 @findex -target-disconnect
32032
32033 @subsubheading Synopsis
32034
32035 @smallexample
32036 -target-disconnect
32037 @end smallexample
32038
32039 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32040 generally not resumed.
32041
32042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32043
32044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32045
32046 @subsubheading Example
32047
32048 @smallexample
32049 (gdb)
32050 -target-disconnect
32051 ^done
32052 (gdb)
32053 @end smallexample
32054
32055
32056 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32057 @findex -target-download
32058
32059 @subsubheading Synopsis
32060
32061 @smallexample
32062 -target-download
32063 @end smallexample
32064
32065 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32066 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32067
32068 @table @samp
32069 @item section
32070 The name of the section.
32071 @item section-sent
32072 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32073 @item section-size
32074 The size of the section.
32075 @item total-sent
32076 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32077 @item total-size
32078 The size of the overall executable to download.
32079 @end table
32080
32081 @noindent
32082 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32083 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32084
32085 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32086 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32087
32088 @table @samp
32089 @item section
32090 The name of the section.
32091 @item section-size
32092 The size of the section.
32093 @item total-size
32094 The size of the overall executable to download.
32095 @end table
32096
32097 @noindent
32098 At the end, a summary is printed.
32099
32100 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32101
32102 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32103
32104 @subsubheading Example
32105
32106 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32107 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32108
32109 @smallexample
32110 (gdb)
32111 -target-download
32112 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32113 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32114 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32115 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32116 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32117 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32118 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32119 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32120 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32121 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32122 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32123 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32124 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32125 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32126 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32127 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32128 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32129 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32130 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32131 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32132 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32133 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32134 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32135 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32136 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32137 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32138 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32139 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32140 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32141 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32142 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32143 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32144 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32145 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32146 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32147 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32148 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32149 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32150 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32151 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32152 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32153 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32154 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32155 write-rate="429"
32156 (gdb)
32157 @end smallexample
32158
32159
32160 @ignore
32161 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32162 @findex -target-exec-status
32163
32164 @subsubheading Synopsis
32165
32166 @smallexample
32167 -target-exec-status
32168 @end smallexample
32169
32170 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32171 not, for instance).
32172
32173 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32174
32175 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32176
32177 @subsubheading Example
32178 N.A.
32179
32180
32181 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32182 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32183
32184 @subsubheading Synopsis
32185
32186 @smallexample
32187 -target-list-available-targets
32188 @end smallexample
32189
32190 List the possible targets to connect to.
32191
32192 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32193
32194 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32195
32196 @subsubheading Example
32197 N.A.
32198
32199
32200 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32201 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32202
32203 @subsubheading Synopsis
32204
32205 @smallexample
32206 -target-list-current-targets
32207 @end smallexample
32208
32209 Describe the current target.
32210
32211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32212
32213 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32214 other things).
32215
32216 @subsubheading Example
32217 N.A.
32218
32219
32220 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32221 @findex -target-list-parameters
32222
32223 @subsubheading Synopsis
32224
32225 @smallexample
32226 -target-list-parameters
32227 @end smallexample
32228
32229 @c ????
32230 @end ignore
32231
32232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32233
32234 No equivalent.
32235
32236 @subsubheading Example
32237 N.A.
32238
32239 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32240 @findex -target-flash-erase
32241
32242 @subsubheading Synopsis
32243
32244 @smallexample
32245 -target-flash-erase
32246 @end smallexample
32247
32248 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32249
32250 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32251
32252 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32253 addresses and memory region sizes.
32254
32255 @smallexample
32256 (gdb)
32257 -target-flash-erase
32258 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32259 (gdb)
32260 @end smallexample
32261
32262 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32263 @findex -target-select
32264
32265 @subsubheading Synopsis
32266
32267 @smallexample
32268 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32269 @end smallexample
32270
32271 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32272
32273 @table @samp
32274 @item @var{type}
32275 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32276 @item @var{parameters}
32277 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32278 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32279 @end table
32280
32281 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32282 which the target program is, in the following form:
32283
32284 @smallexample
32285 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32286 args=[@var{arg list}]
32287 @end smallexample
32288
32289 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32290
32291 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32292
32293 @subsubheading Example
32294
32295 @smallexample
32296 (gdb)
32297 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32298 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32299 (gdb)
32300 @end smallexample
32301
32302 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32303 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32304 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32305
32306
32307 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32308 @findex -target-file-put
32309
32310 @subsubheading Synopsis
32311
32312 @smallexample
32313 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32314 @end smallexample
32315
32316 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32317 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32318
32319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32320
32321 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32322
32323 @subsubheading Example
32324
32325 @smallexample
32326 (gdb)
32327 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32328 ^done
32329 (gdb)
32330 @end smallexample
32331
32332
32333 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32334 @findex -target-file-get
32335
32336 @subsubheading Synopsis
32337
32338 @smallexample
32339 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32340 @end smallexample
32341
32342 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32343 on the host system.
32344
32345 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32346
32347 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32348
32349 @subsubheading Example
32350
32351 @smallexample
32352 (gdb)
32353 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32354 ^done
32355 (gdb)
32356 @end smallexample
32357
32358
32359 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32360 @findex -target-file-delete
32361
32362 @subsubheading Synopsis
32363
32364 @smallexample
32365 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32366 @end smallexample
32367
32368 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32369
32370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32371
32372 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32373
32374 @subsubheading Example
32375
32376 @smallexample
32377 (gdb)
32378 -target-file-delete remotefile
32379 ^done
32380 (gdb)
32381 @end smallexample
32382
32383
32384 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32385 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32386 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32387
32388 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32389 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32390
32391 @subsubheading Synopsis
32392
32393 @smallexample
32394 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32395 @end smallexample
32396
32397 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32398 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32399 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32400
32401 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32402
32403 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32404
32405 @subsubheading Result
32406
32407 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32408 defined for each exception:
32409
32410 @table @samp
32411 @item name
32412 The name of the exception.
32413
32414 @item address
32415 The address of the exception.
32416
32417 @end table
32418
32419 @subsubheading Example
32420
32421 @smallexample
32422 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32423 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32424 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32425 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32426 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32427 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32428 @end smallexample
32429
32430 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32431
32432 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32433 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32434 Catchpoint Commands}.
32435
32436
32437 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32438 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32439 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32440
32441 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32442 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32443 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32444 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32445
32446 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32447 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32448 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32449
32450 @subsubheading Synopsis
32451
32452 @smallexample
32453 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32454 @end smallexample
32455
32456 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32457
32458 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32459 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32460 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32461 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32462 dash.
32463
32464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32465
32466 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32467
32468 @subsubheading Result
32469
32470 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32471
32472 @table @samp
32473 @item exists
32474 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32475 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32476
32477 @end table
32478
32479 @subsubheading Example
32480
32481 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32482
32483 @smallexample
32484 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32485 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32486 @end smallexample
32487
32488 @noindent
32489 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32490 to the debugger:
32491
32492 @smallexample
32493 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32494 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32495 @end smallexample
32496
32497 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32498 @findex -list-features
32499 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32500
32501 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32502 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32503 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32504 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32505 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32506 startup.
32507
32508 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32509 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32510 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32511 is given below.
32512
32513 Example output:
32514
32515 @smallexample
32516 (gdb) -list-features
32517 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32518 @end smallexample
32519
32520 The current list of features is:
32521
32522 @ftable @samp
32523 @item frozen-varobjs
32524 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32525 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32526 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32527 @item pending-breakpoints
32528 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32529 command.
32530 @item python
32531 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32532 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32533 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32534 @item thread-info
32535 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32536 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32537 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32538 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32539 @item breakpoint-notifications
32540 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32541 CLI will be announced via async records.
32542 @item ada-task-info
32543 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32544 @item language-option
32545 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32546 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32547 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32548 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32549 @item undefined-command-error-code
32550 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32551 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32552 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32553 @item exec-run-start-option
32554 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32555 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32556 @end ftable
32557
32558 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32559 @findex -list-target-features
32560
32561 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32562 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32563 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32564 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32565 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32566 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32567 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32568 Example output:
32569
32570 @smallexample
32571 (gdb) -list-target-features
32572 ^done,result=["async"]
32573 @end smallexample
32574
32575 The current list of features is:
32576
32577 @table @samp
32578 @item async
32579 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32580 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32581 while the target is running.
32582
32583 @item reverse
32584 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32585 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32586
32587 @end table
32588
32589 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32590 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32591 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32592
32593 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32594
32595 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32596 @findex -gdb-exit
32597
32598 @subsubheading Synopsis
32599
32600 @smallexample
32601 -gdb-exit
32602 @end smallexample
32603
32604 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32605
32606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32607
32608 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32609
32610 @subsubheading Example
32611
32612 @smallexample
32613 (gdb)
32614 -gdb-exit
32615 ^exit
32616 @end smallexample
32617
32618
32619 @ignore
32620 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32621 @findex -exec-abort
32622
32623 @subsubheading Synopsis
32624
32625 @smallexample
32626 -exec-abort
32627 @end smallexample
32628
32629 Kill the inferior running program.
32630
32631 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32632
32633 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32634
32635 @subsubheading Example
32636 N.A.
32637 @end ignore
32638
32639
32640 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32641 @findex -gdb-set
32642
32643 @subsubheading Synopsis
32644
32645 @smallexample
32646 -gdb-set
32647 @end smallexample
32648
32649 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32650 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32651
32652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32653
32654 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32655
32656 @subsubheading Example
32657
32658 @smallexample
32659 (gdb)
32660 -gdb-set $foo=3
32661 ^done
32662 (gdb)
32663 @end smallexample
32664
32665
32666 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32667 @findex -gdb-show
32668
32669 @subsubheading Synopsis
32670
32671 @smallexample
32672 -gdb-show
32673 @end smallexample
32674
32675 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32676
32677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32678
32679 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32680
32681 @subsubheading Example
32682
32683 @smallexample
32684 (gdb)
32685 -gdb-show annotate
32686 ^done,value="0"
32687 (gdb)
32688 @end smallexample
32689
32690 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32691
32692
32693 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32694 @findex -gdb-version
32695
32696 @subsubheading Synopsis
32697
32698 @smallexample
32699 -gdb-version
32700 @end smallexample
32701
32702 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32703
32704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32705
32706 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32707 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32708
32709 @subsubheading Example
32710
32711 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32712 @c box in TeX.
32713 @smallexample
32714 (gdb)
32715 -gdb-version
32716 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32717 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32718 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32719 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32720 ~ certain conditions.
32721 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32722 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32723 ~ details.
32724 ~This GDB was configured as
32725 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32726 ^done
32727 (gdb)
32728 @end smallexample
32729
32730 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32731 @findex -list-thread-groups
32732
32733 @subheading Synopsis
32734
32735 @smallexample
32736 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32737 @end smallexample
32738
32739 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32740 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32741 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32742 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32743 top-level thread groups.
32744
32745 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32746 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32747 available on the target.
32748
32749 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32750 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32751 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32752 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32753 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32754 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32755 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32756 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32757
32758 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32759 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32760 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32761 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32762 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32763 @samp{threads} field.
32764
32765 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32766 the following caveats:
32767
32768 @itemize @bullet
32769 @item
32770 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32771 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32772 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32773
32774 @item
32775 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32776 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32777 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32778 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32779 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32780 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32781
32782 @end itemize
32783
32784 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32785 have the following fields:
32786
32787 @table @code
32788 @item id
32789 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32790 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32791 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32792
32793 @item type
32794 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32795 valid type.
32796
32797 @item pid
32798 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32799 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32800
32801 @item exit-code
32802 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32803 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32804 only if the process is not running.
32805
32806 @item num_children
32807 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32808 absent for an available thread group.
32809
32810 @item threads
32811 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32812 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32813 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32814
32815 @item cores
32816 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32817 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32818 such information is not available.
32819
32820 @item executable
32821 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32822 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32823 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32824
32825 @end table
32826
32827 @subheading Example
32828
32829 @smallexample
32830 @value{GDBP}
32831 -list-thread-groups
32832 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32833 -list-thread-groups 17
32834 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32835 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32836 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32837 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32838 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32839 -list-thread-groups --available
32840 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32841 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32842 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32843 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32844 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32845 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32846 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32847 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32848 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32849 @end smallexample
32850
32851 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32852 @findex -info-os
32853
32854 @subsubheading Synopsis
32855
32856 @smallexample
32857 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32858 @end smallexample
32859
32860 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32861 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32862 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32863 of data of that type.
32864
32865 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32866 system.
32867
32868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32869
32870 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32871
32872 @subsubheading Example
32873
32874 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32875 like this:
32876
32877 @smallexample
32878 @value{GDBP}
32879 -info-os
32880 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32881 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32882 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32883 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32884 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32885 col2="CPUs"@},
32886 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32887 col2="File descriptors"@},
32888 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32889 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32890 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32891 col2="Message queues"@},
32892 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32893 col2="Processes"@},
32894 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32895 col2="Process groups"@},
32896 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32897 col2="Semaphores"@},
32898 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32899 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32900 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32901 col2="Sockets"@},
32902 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32903 col2="Threads"@}]
32904 @value{GDBP}
32905 -info-os processes
32906 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32907 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32908 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32909 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32910 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32911 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32912 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32913 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32914 ...
32915 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32916 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32917 (gdb)
32918 @end smallexample
32919
32920 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32921 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32922 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32923 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32924 @code{info os} omits it.)
32925
32926 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32927 @findex -add-inferior
32928
32929 @subheading Synopsis
32930
32931 @smallexample
32932 -add-inferior
32933 @end smallexample
32934
32935 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32936 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32937 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32938 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32939 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32940 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32941
32942 @subheading Example
32943
32944 @smallexample
32945 @value{GDBP}
32946 -add-inferior
32947 ^done,inferior="i3"
32948 @end smallexample
32949
32950 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32951 @findex -interpreter-exec
32952
32953 @subheading Synopsis
32954
32955 @smallexample
32956 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32957 @end smallexample
32958 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32959
32960 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32961
32962 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32963
32964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32965
32966 @subheading Example
32967
32968 @smallexample
32969 (gdb)
32970 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32971 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32972 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32973 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32974 ^done
32975 (gdb)
32976 @end smallexample
32977
32978 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32979 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32980
32981 @subheading Synopsis
32982
32983 @smallexample
32984 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32985 @end smallexample
32986
32987 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32988
32989 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32990
32991 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32992
32993 @subheading Example
32994
32995 @smallexample
32996 (gdb)
32997 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32998 ^done
32999 (gdb)
33000 @end smallexample
33001
33002 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33003 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33004
33005 @subheading Synopsis
33006
33007 @smallexample
33008 -inferior-tty-show
33009 @end smallexample
33010
33011 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33012
33013 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33014
33015 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33016
33017 @subheading Example
33018
33019 @smallexample
33020 (gdb)
33021 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33022 ^done
33023 (gdb)
33024 -inferior-tty-show
33025 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33026 (gdb)
33027 @end smallexample
33028
33029 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33030 @findex -enable-timings
33031
33032 @subheading Synopsis
33033
33034 @smallexample
33035 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33036 @end smallexample
33037
33038 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33039 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33040 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33041 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33042
33043 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33044
33045 No equivalent.
33046
33047 @subheading Example
33048
33049 @smallexample
33050 (gdb)
33051 -enable-timings
33052 ^done
33053 (gdb)
33054 -break-insert main
33055 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33056 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33057 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33058 times="0"@},
33059 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33060 (gdb)
33061 -enable-timings no
33062 ^done
33063 (gdb)
33064 -exec-run
33065 ^running
33066 (gdb)
33067 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33068 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33069 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33070 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33071 (gdb)
33072 @end smallexample
33073
33074 @node Annotations
33075 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33076
33077 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33078 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33079 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33080 relatively high level.
33081
33082 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33083 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33084
33085 @ignore
33086 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33087 @end ignore
33088
33089 @menu
33090 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33091 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33092 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33093 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33094 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33095 * Annotations for Running::
33096 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33097 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33098 @end menu
33099
33100 @node Annotations Overview
33101 @section What is an Annotation?
33102 @cindex annotations
33103
33104 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33105 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33106 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33107 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33108 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33109 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33110 cannot contain newline characters.
33111
33112 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33113 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33114 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33115 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33116 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33117 means those three characters as output.
33118
33119 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33120 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33121 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33122 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33123 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33124 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33125 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33126 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33127 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33128
33129 @table @code
33130 @kindex set annotate
33131 @item set annotate @var{level}
33132 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33133 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33134
33135 @item show annotate
33136 @kindex show annotate
33137 Show the current annotation level.
33138 @end table
33139
33140 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33141
33142 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33143
33144 @smallexample
33145 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33146 GNU gdb 6.0
33147 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33148 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33149 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33150 under certain conditions.
33151 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33152 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33153 for details.
33154 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33155
33156 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33157 (@value{GDBP})
33158 ^Z^Zprompt
33159 @kbd{quit}
33160
33161 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33162 $
33163 @end smallexample
33164
33165 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33166 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33167 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33168 output from @value{GDBN}.
33169
33170 @node Server Prefix
33171 @section The Server Prefix
33172 @cindex server prefix
33173
33174 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33175 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33176 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33177 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33178 a transparent manner.
33179
33180 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33181 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33182 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33183 @code{print} command.
33184
33185 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33186 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33187
33188 @node Prompting
33189 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33190
33191 @cindex annotations for prompts
33192 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33193 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33194 over, etc.
33195
33196 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33197 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33198 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33199 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33200 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33201 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33202 features the following annotations:
33203
33204 @smallexample
33205 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33206 ^Z^Zprompt
33207 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33208 @end smallexample
33209
33210 The input types are
33211
33212 @table @code
33213 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33214 @findex prompt annotation
33215 @findex post-prompt annotation
33216 @item prompt
33217 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33218
33219 @findex pre-commands annotation
33220 @findex commands annotation
33221 @findex post-commands annotation
33222 @item commands
33223 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33224 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33225
33226 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33227 @findex overload-choice annotation
33228 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33229 @item overload-choice
33230 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33231
33232 @findex pre-query annotation
33233 @findex query annotation
33234 @findex post-query annotation
33235 @item query
33236 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33237
33238 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33239 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33240 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33241 @item prompt-for-continue
33242 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33243 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33244 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33245 presence of annotations.
33246 @end table
33247
33248 @node Errors
33249 @section Errors
33250 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33251
33252 @findex quit annotation
33253 @smallexample
33254 ^Z^Zquit
33255 @end smallexample
33256
33257 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33258
33259 @findex error annotation
33260 @smallexample
33261 ^Z^Zerror
33262 @end smallexample
33263
33264 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33265
33266 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33267 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33268 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33269 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33270 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33271 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33272 to the top level.
33273
33274 @findex error-begin annotation
33275 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33276
33277 @smallexample
33278 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33279 @end smallexample
33280
33281 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33282 message.
33283
33284 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33285 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33286 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33287
33288 @node Invalidation
33289 @section Invalidation Notices
33290
33291 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33292 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33293 changed.
33294
33295 @table @code
33296 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33297 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33298
33299 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33300 have changed.
33301
33302 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33303 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33304
33305 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33306 deleted a breakpoint.
33307 @end table
33308
33309 @node Annotations for Running
33310 @section Running the Program
33311 @cindex annotations for running programs
33312
33313 @findex starting annotation
33314 @findex stopping annotation
33315 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33316 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33317
33318 @smallexample
33319 ^Z^Zstarting
33320 @end smallexample
33321
33322 is output. When the program stops,
33323
33324 @smallexample
33325 ^Z^Zstopped
33326 @end smallexample
33327
33328 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33329 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33330
33331 @table @code
33332 @findex exited annotation
33333 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33334 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33335 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33336
33337 @findex signalled annotation
33338 @findex signal-name annotation
33339 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33340 @findex signal-string annotation
33341 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33342 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33343 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33344 annotation continues:
33345
33346 @smallexample
33347 @var{intro-text}
33348 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33349 @var{name}
33350 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33351 @var{middle-text}
33352 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33353 @var{string}
33354 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33355 @var{end-text}
33356 @end smallexample
33357
33358 @noindent
33359 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33360 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33361 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33362 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33363 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33364
33365 @findex signal annotation
33366 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33367 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33368 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33369 terminated with it.
33370
33371 @findex breakpoint annotation
33372 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33373 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33374
33375 @findex watchpoint annotation
33376 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33377 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33378 @end table
33379
33380 @node Source Annotations
33381 @section Displaying Source
33382 @cindex annotations for source display
33383
33384 @findex source annotation
33385 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33386
33387 @smallexample
33388 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33389 @end smallexample
33390
33391 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33392 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33393 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33394 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33395 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33396 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33397 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33398 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33399 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33400 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33401 depend on the language).
33402
33403 @node JIT Interface
33404 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33405 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33406 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33407
33408 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33409 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33410 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33411 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33412
33413 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33414 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33415 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33416 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33417 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33418 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33419
33420 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33421 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33422 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33423 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33424 LLVM JIT.
33425
33426 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33427 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33428 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33429 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33430 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33431 out about additional code.
33432
33433 @menu
33434 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33435 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33436 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33437 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33438 @end menu
33439
33440 @node Declarations
33441 @section JIT Declarations
33442
33443 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33444 implement the interface:
33445
33446 @smallexample
33447 typedef enum
33448 @{
33449 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33450 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33451 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33452 @} jit_actions_t;
33453
33454 struct jit_code_entry
33455 @{
33456 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33457 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33458 const char *symfile_addr;
33459 uint64_t symfile_size;
33460 @};
33461
33462 struct jit_descriptor
33463 @{
33464 uint32_t version;
33465 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33466 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33467 uint32_t action_flag;
33468 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33469 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33470 @};
33471
33472 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33473 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33474
33475 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33476 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33477 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33478 @end smallexample
33479
33480 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33481 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33482 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33483
33484 @node Registering Code
33485 @section Registering Code
33486
33487 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33488
33489 @itemize @bullet
33490 @item
33491 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33492 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33493
33494 @item
33495 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33496 file.
33497
33498 @item
33499 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33500
33501 @item
33502 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33503
33504 @item
33505 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33506 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33507 @end itemize
33508
33509 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33510 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33511 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33512 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33513
33514 @node Unregistering Code
33515 @section Unregistering Code
33516
33517 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33518
33519 @itemize @bullet
33520 @item
33521 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33522
33523 @item
33524 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33525
33526 @item
33527 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33528 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33529 @end itemize
33530
33531 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33532 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33533
33534 @node Custom Debug Info
33535 @section Custom Debug Info
33536 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33537 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33538
33539 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33540 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33541 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33542 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33543 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33544 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33545 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33546 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33547 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33548
33549 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33550 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33551 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33552 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33553 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33554 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33555 compiler.
33556
33557 @menu
33558 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33559 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33560 @end menu
33561
33562 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33563 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33564 @kindex jit-reader-load
33565 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33566
33567 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33568 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33569
33570 @table @code
33571 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33572 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33573 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33574 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33575 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33576 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33577 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33578
33579 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33580 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33581 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33582 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33583 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33584
33585 @item jit-reader-unload
33586 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33587
33588 @end table
33589
33590 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33591 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33592 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33593
33594 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33595 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33596
33597 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33598 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33599 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33600 the system include directory.
33601
33602 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33603 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33604 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33605
33606 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33607 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33608
33609 @findex gdb_init_reader
33610 @smallexample
33611 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33612 @end smallexample
33613
33614 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33615
33616 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33617 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33618 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33619 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33620 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33621 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33622
33623 @smallexample
33624 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33625 @{
33626 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33627 int reader_version;
33628
33629 /* For use by the reader. */
33630 void *priv_data;
33631
33632 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33633 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33634 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33635 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33636 @};
33637 @end smallexample
33638
33639 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33640 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33641
33642 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33643 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33644 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33645 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33646 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33647 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33648 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33649 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33650 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33651 target's address space.
33652
33653 @node In-Process Agent
33654 @chapter In-Process Agent
33655 @cindex debugging agent
33656 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33657 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33658 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33659 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33660 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33661 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33662 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33663 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33664 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33665 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33666 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33667 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33668 behavior without interrupting it.
33669
33670 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33671 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33672 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33673 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33674 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33675 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33676 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33677 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33678 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33679
33680 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33681 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33682 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33683 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33684
33685 @anchor{Control Agent}
33686 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33687 debugging with the following commands:
33688
33689 @table @code
33690 @kindex set agent on
33691 @item set agent on
33692 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33693 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33694 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33695 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33696 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33697 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33698
33699 @kindex set agent off
33700 @item set agent off
33701 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33702 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33703
33704 @kindex show agent
33705 @item show agent
33706 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33707 the in-process agent.
33708 @end table
33709
33710 @menu
33711 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33712 @end menu
33713
33714 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33715 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33716 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33717
33718 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33719 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33720 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33721 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33722 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33723 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33724 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33725 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33726 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33727
33728 @menu
33729 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33730 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33731 @end menu
33732
33733 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33734 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33735 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33736
33737 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33738 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33739
33740 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33741 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33742 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33743 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33744
33745 @enumerate
33746 @item
33747 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33748 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33749 @item
33750 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33751 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33752 the other one.
33753 @end enumerate
33754
33755 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33756
33757 @enumerate
33758 @item
33759 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33760 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33761 @anchor{agent expression object}
33762 @item
33763 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33764 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33765 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33766 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33767 @item
33768 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33769 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33770
33771 @end enumerate
33772
33773 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33774 object:
33775
33776 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33777 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33778 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33779 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33780 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33781 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33782 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33783 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33784 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33785 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33786 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33787 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33788 memory address for collecting.
33789 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33790 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33791 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33792 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33793 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33794 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33795 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33796 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33797 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33798 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33799 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33800 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33801 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33802 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33803 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33804 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33805 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33806 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33807 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33808 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33809 @ref{agent expression object}
33810 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33811 @ref{agent expression object}
33812 @item actions @tab variable
33813 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33814 @end multitable
33815
33816 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33817 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33818 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33819
33820 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33821 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33822
33823 @table @samp
33824
33825 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33826 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33827 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33828 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33829 in IPA finally.
33830
33831 Replies:
33832 @table @samp
33833 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33834 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33835 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33836 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33837 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33838 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33839 @item E @var{NN}
33840 for an error
33841
33842 @end table
33843
33844 @item close
33845 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33846 is about to kill inferiors.
33847
33848 @item qTfSTM
33849 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33850 @item qTsSTM
33851 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33852 @item qTSTMat
33853 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33854 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33855 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33856
33857 Replies:
33858 @table @samp
33859 @item E @var{NN}
33860 for an error
33861 @end table
33862 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33863 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33864 @end table
33865
33866 @node GDB Bugs
33867 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33868 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33869 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33870
33871 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33872
33873 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33874 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33875 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33876 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33877
33878 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33879 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33880
33881 @menu
33882 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33883 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33884 @end menu
33885
33886 @node Bug Criteria
33887 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33888 @cindex bug criteria
33889
33890 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33891
33892 @itemize @bullet
33893 @cindex fatal signal
33894 @cindex debugger crash
33895 @cindex crash of debugger
33896 @item
33897 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33898 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33899
33900 @cindex error on valid input
33901 @item
33902 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33903 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33904 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33905
33906 @cindex invalid input
33907 @item
33908 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33909 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33910 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33911 for traditional practice''.
33912
33913 @item
33914 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33915 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33916 @end itemize
33917
33918 @node Bug Reporting
33919 @section How to Report Bugs
33920 @cindex bug reports
33921 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33922
33923 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33924 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33925 contact that organization first.
33926
33927 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33928 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33929 distribution.
33930 @c should add a web page ref...
33931
33932 @ifset BUGURL
33933 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33934 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33935 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33936 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33937 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33938 be used.
33939
33940 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33941 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33942 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33943 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33944
33945 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33946 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33947 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33948 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33949 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33950 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33951 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33952 bug reports to the mailing list.
33953 @end ifset
33954 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33955 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33956 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33957 @end ifclear
33958 @end ifset
33959
33960 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33961 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33962 fact or leave it out, state it!
33963
33964 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33965 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33966 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33967 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33968 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33969 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33970 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33971 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33972 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33973
33974 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33975 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33976 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33977 self-contained.
33978
33979 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33980 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33981 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33982 bugs properly.
33983
33984 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33985
33986 @itemize @bullet
33987 @item
33988 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33989 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33990 version}.
33991
33992 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33993 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33994
33995 @item
33996 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33997 version number.
33998
33999 @item
34000 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34001 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34002 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34003 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34004
34005 @item
34006 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34007 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34008
34009 @item
34010 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34011 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34012 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34013 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34014 those compilers.
34015
34016 @item
34017 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34018 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34019 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34020 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34021
34022 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34023 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34024
34025 @item
34026 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34027 reproduce the bug.
34028
34029 @item
34030 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34031 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34032
34033 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34034 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34035 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34036 a chance to make a mistake.
34037
34038 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34039 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34040 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34041 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34042 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34043 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34044 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34045 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34046
34047 @pindex script
34048 @cindex recording a session script
34049 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34050 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34051 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34052 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34053
34054 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34055 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34056
34057 @item
34058 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34059 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34060 it by context, not by line number.
34061
34062 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34063 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34064
34065 @end itemize
34066
34067 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34068
34069 @itemize @bullet
34070 @item
34071 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34072
34073 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34074 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34075 changes will not affect it.
34076
34077 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34078 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34079 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34080 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34081
34082 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34083 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34084 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34085 less time, and so on.
34086
34087 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34088 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34089
34090 @item
34091 A patch for the bug.
34092
34093 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34094 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34095 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34096 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34097
34098 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34099 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34100 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34101 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34102
34103 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34104 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34105 help us to understand.
34106
34107 @item
34108 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34109
34110 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34111 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34112 @end itemize
34113
34114 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34115 @c and consists of the two following files:
34116 @c rluser.texi
34117 @c hsuser.texi
34118 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34119 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34120 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34121 @include rluser.texi
34122 @include hsuser.texi
34123 @end ifclear
34124
34125 @node In Memoriam
34126 @appendix In Memoriam
34127
34128 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34129 contributors:
34130
34131 @table @code
34132 @item Fred Fish
34133 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34134 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34135 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34136
34137 @item Michael Snyder
34138 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34139 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34140 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34141 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34142 @end table
34143
34144 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34145 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34146
34147 @node Formatting Documentation
34148 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34149
34150 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34151 @cindex reference card
34152 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34153 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34154 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34155 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34156 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34157 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34158
34159 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34160 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34161
34162 @smallexample
34163 make refcard.dvi
34164 @end smallexample
34165
34166 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34167 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34168 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34169 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34170 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34171
34172 @cindex documentation
34173
34174 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34175 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34176 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34177 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34178 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34179 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34180
34181 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34182 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34183 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34184 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34185 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34186 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34187 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34188 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34189
34190 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34191 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34192 @code{makeinfo}.
34193
34194 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34195 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34196 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34197
34198 @smallexample
34199 cd gdb
34200 make gdb.info
34201 @end smallexample
34202
34203 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34204 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34205 Texinfo definitions file.
34206
34207 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34208 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34209 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34210 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34211 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34212 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34213 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34214
34215 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34216 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34217 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34218 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34219 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34220 directory.
34221
34222 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34223 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34224 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34225 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34226
34227 @smallexample
34228 make gdb.dvi
34229 @end smallexample
34230
34231 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34232
34233 @node Installing GDB
34234 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34235 @cindex installation
34236
34237 @menu
34238 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34239 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34240 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34241 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34242 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34243 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34244 @end menu
34245
34246 @node Requirements
34247 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34248 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34249
34250 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34251 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34252
34253 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34254 @table @asis
34255 @item ISO C90 compiler
34256 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34257 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34258
34259 @end table
34260
34261 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34262 @table @asis
34263 @item Expat
34264 @anchor{Expat}
34265 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34266 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34267 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34268 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34269 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34270 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34271
34272 Expat is used for:
34273
34274 @itemize @bullet
34275 @item
34276 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34277 @item
34278 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34279 @item
34280 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34281 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34282 @item
34283 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34284 @item
34285 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34286 @item
34287 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34288 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34289 @end itemize
34290
34291 @item MPFR
34292 @anchor{MPFR}
34293 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
34294 library. This library may be included with your operating system
34295 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34296 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
34297 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
34298 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
34299 option to specify its location.
34300
34301 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
34302 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
34303 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
34304 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
34305
34306 @item zlib
34307 @cindex compressed debug sections
34308 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34309 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34310 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34311 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34312 information in such binaries.
34313
34314 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34315 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34316 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34317
34318 @item iconv
34319 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34320 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34321 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34322 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34323
34324 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34325 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34326 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34327 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34328
34329 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34330 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34331 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34332
34333 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34334 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34335 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34336 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34337 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34338 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34339 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34340 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34341 @end table
34342
34343 @node Running Configure
34344 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34345 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34346 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34347 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34348 build the @code{gdb} program.
34349 @iftex
34350 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34351 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34352 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34353 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34354 @end iftex
34355
34356 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34357 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34358 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34359
34360 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34361 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34362
34363 @table @code
34364 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34365 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34366
34367 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34368 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34369
34370 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34371 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34372
34373 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34374 @sc{gnu} include files
34375
34376 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34377 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34378
34379 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34380 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34381
34382 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34383 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34384
34385 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34386 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34387
34388 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34389 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34390 @end table
34391
34392 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34393 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34394 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34395
34396 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34397 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34398 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34399 argument.
34400
34401 For example:
34402
34403 @smallexample
34404 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34405 ./configure @var{host}
34406 make
34407 @end smallexample
34408
34409 @noindent
34410 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34411 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34412 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34413 correct value by examining your system.)
34414
34415 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34416 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34417 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34418 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34419
34420 @need 750
34421 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34422 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34423 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34424
34425 @smallexample
34426 sh configure @var{host}
34427 @end smallexample
34428
34429 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34430 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34431 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34432 @file{configure}
34433 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34434 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34435
34436 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34437 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34438 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34439 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34440 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34441 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34442 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34443 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34444 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34445
34446 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34447 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34448 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34449 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34450 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34451
34452 @node Separate Objdir
34453 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34454
34455 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34456 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34457 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34458 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34459 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34460 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34461 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34462 program specified there.
34463
34464 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34465 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34466 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34467 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34468 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34469 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34470
34471 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34472 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34473
34474 @smallexample
34475 @group
34476 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34477 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34478 cd ../gdb-sun4
34479 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34480 make
34481 @end group
34482 @end smallexample
34483
34484 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34485 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34486 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34487 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34488 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34489 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34490
34491 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34492 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34493 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34494 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34495 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34496
34497 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34498 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34499 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34500 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34501 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34502 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34503
34504 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34505 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34506 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34507
34508 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34509 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34510 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34511 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34512 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34513
34514 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34515 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34516 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34517 with each other.
34518
34519 @node Config Names
34520 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34521
34522 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34523 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34524 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34525 of information in the following pattern:
34526
34527 @smallexample
34528 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34529 @end smallexample
34530
34531 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34532 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34533 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34534
34535 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34536 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34537 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34538 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34539 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34540 abbreviations---for example:
34541
34542 @smallexample
34543 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34544 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34545 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34546 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34547 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34548 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34549 % sh config.sub sun4
34550 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34551 % sh config.sub sun3
34552 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34553 % sh config.sub i986v
34554 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34555 @end smallexample
34556
34557 @noindent
34558 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34559 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34560
34561 @node Configure Options
34562 @section @file{configure} Options
34563
34564 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34565 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34566 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34567 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34568
34569 @smallexample
34570 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34571 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34572 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34573 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34574 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34575 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34576 @var{host}
34577 @end smallexample
34578
34579 @noindent
34580 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34581 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34582 @samp{--}.
34583
34584 @table @code
34585 @item --help
34586 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34587
34588 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34589 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34590 @file{@var{dir}}.
34591
34592 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34593 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34594 @file{@var{dir}}.
34595
34596 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34597 @need 2000
34598 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34599 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34600 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34601 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34602 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34603 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34604 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34605 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34606 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34607 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34608 @var{dirname}.
34609
34610 @item --norecursion
34611 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34612 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34613
34614 @item --target=@var{target}
34615 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34616 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34617 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34618
34619 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34620
34621 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34622 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34623
34624 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34625 @end table
34626
34627 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34628 needed for special purposes only.
34629
34630 @node System-wide configuration
34631 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34632 @cindex system-wide init file
34633
34634 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34635 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34636 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34637
34638 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34639
34640 @table @code
34641 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34642 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34643 @var{file}.
34644 @end table
34645
34646 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34647 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34648
34649 @itemize @bullet
34650 @item
34651 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34652 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34653 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34654 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34655 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34656 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34657
34658 @item
34659 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34660 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34661 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34662 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34663 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34664 @end itemize
34665
34666 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34667 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34668 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34669 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34670 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34671 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34672 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34673 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34674 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34675 reread.
34676
34677 @menu
34678 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34679 @end menu
34680
34681 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34682 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34683 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34684
34685 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34686 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34687 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34688 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34689 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34690 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34691
34692 The following scripts are currently available:
34693 @itemize @bullet
34694
34695 @item @file{elinos.py}
34696 @pindex elinos.py
34697 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34698 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34699 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34700 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34701 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34702 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34703
34704 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34705 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34706 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34707 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34708 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34709 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34710
34711 @end itemize
34712
34713 @node Maintenance Commands
34714 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34715 @cindex maintenance commands
34716 @cindex internal commands
34717
34718 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34719 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34720 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34721 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34722 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34723
34724 @table @code
34725 @kindex maint agent
34726 @kindex maint agent-eval
34727 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34728 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34729 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34730 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34731 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34732 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34733 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34734 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34735 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34736 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34737 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34738 addition and return the sum.
34739 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34740 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34741
34742 @kindex maint agent-printf
34743 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34744 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34745 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34746 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34747 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34748
34749 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34750 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34751 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34752 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34753 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34754 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34755 is shown:
34756
34757 @table @code
34758 @item breakpoint
34759 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34760
34761 @item watchpoint
34762 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34763
34764 @item longjmp
34765 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34766 @code{longjmp} calls.
34767
34768 @item longjmp resume
34769 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34770
34771 @item until
34772 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34773
34774 @item finish
34775 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34776
34777 @item shlib events
34778 Shared library events.
34779
34780 @end table
34781
34782 @kindex maint info btrace
34783 @item maint info btrace
34784 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34785
34786 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34787 @item maint btrace packet-history
34788 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34789 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34790 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34791 recording format.
34792
34793 @table @code
34794 @item bts
34795 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34796 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34797
34798 @table @asis
34799 @item Block number
34800 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34801 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34802 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34803 @end table
34804
34805 @item pt
34806 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34807 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34808 information is printed:
34809
34810 @table @asis
34811 @item Packet number
34812 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34813 @item Trace offset
34814 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34815 @item Packet opcode and payload
34816 @end table
34817 @end table
34818
34819 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34820 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34821 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34822 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34823 needed.
34824
34825 @kindex maint btrace clear
34826 @item maint btrace clear
34827 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34828 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34829
34830 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34831 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34832 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34833 buffer.
34834
34835 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34836 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34837 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34838 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34839 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34840 packet history.
34841
34842 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34843 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34844 @cindex displaced stepping support
34845 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34846 @item set displaced-stepping
34847 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34848 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34849 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34850 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34851 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34852 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34853
34854 @table @code
34855 @item set displaced-stepping on
34856 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34857 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34858
34859 @item set displaced-stepping off
34860 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34861 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34862
34863 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34864 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34865 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34866 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34867 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34868 @end table
34869
34870 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34871 @item maint check-psymtabs
34872 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34873 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34874
34875 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34876 @item maint check-symtabs
34877 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34878
34879 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34880 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34881 Expand symbol tables.
34882 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34883 names matching @var{regexp}.
34884
34885 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34886 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34887 @cindex demangler crashes
34888 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34889 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34890 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34891 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34892 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34893 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34894 option to terminate the current session.
34895
34896 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34897 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34898 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34899
34900 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34901 @item maint cplus namespace
34902 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34903
34904 @kindex maint deprecate
34905 @kindex maint undeprecate
34906 @cindex deprecated commands
34907 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34908 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34909 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34910 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34911 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34912 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34913 the replacement as part of the warning.
34914
34915 @kindex maint dump-me
34916 @item maint dump-me
34917 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34918 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34919 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34920 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34921
34922 @kindex maint internal-error
34923 @kindex maint internal-warning
34924 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34925 @cindex demangler crashes
34926 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34927 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34928 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34929
34930 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34931 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34932 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34933 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34934 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34935 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34936 @value{GDBN} session.
34937
34938 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34939 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34940
34941 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34942
34943 @smallexample
34944 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34945 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34946 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34947 debugging may prove unreliable.
34948 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34949 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34950 (@value{GDBP})
34951 @end smallexample
34952
34953 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34954 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34955 @cindex demangler crashes
34956
34957 @kindex maint set internal-error
34958 @kindex maint show internal-error
34959 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34960 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34961 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34962 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34963 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34964 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34965 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34966 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34967 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34968 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34969 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34970 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34971 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34972 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34973 described in the table below.
34974
34975 @table @samp
34976 @item quit
34977 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34978 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34979
34980 @item corefile
34981 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34982 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34983 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34984 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34985 disabled.
34986 @end table
34987
34988 @kindex maint packet
34989 @item maint packet @var{text}
34990 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34991 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34992 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34993 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34994 checksum.
34995
34996 @kindex maint print architecture
34997 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34998 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34999 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
35000
35001 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35002 @item maint print c-tdesc
35003 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
35004 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
35005 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
35006 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
35007 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
35008 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
35009 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
35010 modify XML target descriptions.
35011
35012 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
35013 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
35014 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
35015 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
35016
35017 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
35018 @item maint print dummy-frames
35019 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35020
35021 @smallexample
35022 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35023 @dots{}
35024 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35025 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
35026 58 return (a + b);
35027 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35028 @dots{}
35029 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
35030 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35031 (@value{GDBP})
35032 @end smallexample
35033
35034 Takes an optional file parameter.
35035
35036 @kindex maint print registers
35037 @kindex maint print raw-registers
35038 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
35039 @kindex maint print register-groups
35040 @kindex maint print remote-registers
35041 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35042 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35043 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35044 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35045 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35046 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35047
35048 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35049 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35050 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35051 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35052 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35053 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35054 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35055 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35056
35057 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35058 write the information.
35059
35060 @kindex maint print reggroups
35061 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35062 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35063 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35064 information.
35065
35066 The register groups info looks like this:
35067
35068 @smallexample
35069 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35070 Group Type
35071 general user
35072 float user
35073 all user
35074 vector user
35075 system user
35076 save internal
35077 restore internal
35078 @end smallexample
35079
35080 @kindex flushregs
35081 @item flushregs
35082 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35083
35084 @kindex maint print objfiles
35085 @cindex info for known object files
35086 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35087 Print a dump of all known object files.
35088 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35089 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35090 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35091
35092 @kindex maint print user-registers
35093 @cindex user registers
35094 @item maint print user-registers
35095 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35096 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35097 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35098 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35099 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35100 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35101 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35102
35103 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35104 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35105 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35106 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35107 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35108 matching @var{regexp}.
35109 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35110 and the full path if known.
35111 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35112
35113 @kindex maint print statistics
35114 @cindex bcache statistics
35115 @item maint print statistics
35116 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35117 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35118 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35119 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35120 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35121 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35122 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35123 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35124 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35125 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35126 lengths.
35127
35128 @kindex maint print target-stack
35129 @cindex target stack description
35130 @item maint print target-stack
35131 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35132 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35133 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35134 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35135 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35136 address.
35137
35138 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35139 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35140
35141 @kindex maint print type
35142 @cindex type chain of a data type
35143 @item maint print type @var{expr}
35144 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35145 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35146 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35147 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35148 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35149
35150 @kindex maint selftest
35151 @cindex self tests
35152 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35153 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35154 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35155 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35156 name will by ran.
35157
35158 @kindex "maint info selftests"
35159 @cindex self tests
35160 @item maint info selftests
35161 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35162
35163 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35164 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35165 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35166 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35167 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35168 information.
35169
35170 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35171 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35172 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35173 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35174 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35175 always see the disassembly form.
35176
35177 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35178
35179 @smallexample
35180 (gdb) info addr argc
35181 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35182 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35183 @end smallexample
35184
35185 For more information on these expressions, see
35186 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35187
35188 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35189 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35190 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35191 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35192 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35193
35194 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35195 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35196 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35197 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35198 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35199 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35200 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35201 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35202 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35203
35204 @kindex maint set profile
35205 @kindex maint show profile
35206 @cindex profiling GDB
35207 @item maint set profile
35208 @itemx maint show profile
35209 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35210
35211 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35212 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35213 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35214 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35215 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35216 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35217 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35218
35219 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35220 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35221
35222 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35223 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35224 @cindex hardware debug registers
35225 @item maint set show-debug-regs
35226 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35227 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35228 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35229 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35230 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35231 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35232
35233 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35234 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35235 @item maint set show-all-tib
35236 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35237 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35238 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35239 command.
35240
35241 @kindex maint set target-async
35242 @kindex maint show target-async
35243 @item maint set target-async
35244 @itemx maint show target-async
35245 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35246 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35247 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35248 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35249
35250 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35251 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
35252 @item maint set target-non-stop
35253 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
35254
35255 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35256 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35257 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35258 if supported by the target.
35259
35260 @table @code
35261 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
35262 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35263 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35264
35265 @item maint set target-non-stop on
35266 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35267 does not indicate support.
35268
35269 @item maint set target-non-stop off
35270 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35271 target supports it.
35272 @end table
35273
35274 @kindex maint set per-command
35275 @kindex maint show per-command
35276 @item maint set per-command
35277 @itemx maint show per-command
35278 @cindex resources used by commands
35279
35280 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35281 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35282
35283 @table @code
35284 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35285 @itemx maint show per-command space
35286 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35287 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35288 took, following the command's own output.
35289 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35290 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35291
35292 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35293 @itemx maint show per-command time
35294 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35295 for each command.
35296 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35297 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35298 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35299 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35300 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35301 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35302 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35303 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35304 spent by the program been debugged.
35305 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35306 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35307
35308 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35309 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
35310 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35311 for each command.
35312 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35313
35314 @enumerate a
35315 @item
35316 number of symbol tables
35317 @item
35318 number of primary symbol tables
35319 @item
35320 number of blocks in the blockvector
35321 @end enumerate
35322 @end table
35323
35324 @kindex maint space
35325 @cindex memory used by commands
35326 @item maint space @var{value}
35327 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35328 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35329
35330 @kindex maint time
35331 @cindex time of command execution
35332 @item maint time @var{value}
35333 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35334 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35335
35336 @kindex maint translate-address
35337 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35338 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35339 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35340 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35341 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35342 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35343 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35344
35345 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35346 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35347 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35348
35349 @end table
35350
35351 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35352 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35353
35354 @table @code
35355 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35356 @kindex set watchdog
35357 @cindex watchdog timer
35358 @cindex timeout for commands
35359 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35360 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35361 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35362
35363 @item show watchdog
35364 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35365 @end table
35366
35367 @node Remote Protocol
35368 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35369
35370 @menu
35371 * Overview::
35372 * Packets::
35373 * Stop Reply Packets::
35374 * General Query Packets::
35375 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35376 * Tracepoint Packets::
35377 * Host I/O Packets::
35378 * Interrupts::
35379 * Notification Packets::
35380 * Remote Non-Stop::
35381 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35382 * Examples::
35383 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35384 * Library List Format::
35385 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35386 * Memory Map Format::
35387 * Thread List Format::
35388 * Traceframe Info Format::
35389 * Branch Trace Format::
35390 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35391 @end menu
35392
35393 @node Overview
35394 @section Overview
35395
35396 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35397 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35398 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35399 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35400
35401 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35402 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35403
35404 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35405 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35406 @cindex remote serial protocol
35407 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35408 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35409 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35410 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35411 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35412
35413 @smallexample
35414 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35415 @end smallexample
35416 @noindent
35417
35418 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35419 @noindent
35420 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35421 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35422 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35423
35424 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35425 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35426
35427 @smallexample
35428 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35429 @end smallexample
35430
35431 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35432 @noindent
35433 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35434 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35435 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35436
35437 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35438 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35439 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35440 retransmission):
35441
35442 @smallexample
35443 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35444 <- @code{+}
35445 @end smallexample
35446 @noindent
35447
35448 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35449 once a connection is established.
35450 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35451
35452 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35453 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35454 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35455 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35456 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35457 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35458 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35459
35460 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35461 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35462 exceptions).
35463
35464 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35465 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35466 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35467 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35468
35469 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35470 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35471 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35472
35473 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35474 @anchor{Binary Data}
35475 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35476 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35477 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35478 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35479 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35480 binary data.
35481
35482 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35483 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35484 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35485 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35486 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35487 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35488 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35489 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35490 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35491 (described next).
35492
35493 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35494 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35495 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35496 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35497 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35498 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35499 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35500 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35501 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35502 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35503 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35504 3}} more times.
35505
35506 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35507 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35508 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35509 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35510 @samp{0*"00}.
35511
35512 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35513 error number. That number is not well defined.
35514
35515 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35516 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35517 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35518 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35519 on that response.
35520
35521 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35522 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35523 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35524 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35525 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35526 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35527
35528 @node Packets
35529 @section Packets
35530
35531 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35532 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35533 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35534 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35535
35536 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35537 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35538 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35539 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35540 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35541 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35542 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35543 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35544 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35545 @var{baz}.
35546
35547 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35548 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35549 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35550 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35551 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35552 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35553 pick any thread.
35554
35555 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35556 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35557 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35558 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35559 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35560 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35561 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35562 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35563 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35564 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35565 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35566 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35567 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35568
35569 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35570 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35571 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35572 more information.
35573
35574 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35575 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35576
35577 Here are the packet descriptions.
35578
35579 @table @samp
35580
35581 @item !
35582 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35583 @anchor{extended mode}
35584 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35585 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35586 debugged.
35587
35588 Reply:
35589 @table @samp
35590 @item OK
35591 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35592 @end table
35593
35594 @item ?
35595 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35596 @anchor{? packet}
35597 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35598 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35599 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35600
35601 Reply:
35602 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35603
35604 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35605 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35606 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35607 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35608 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35609
35610 Reply:
35611 @table @samp
35612 @item OK
35613 The arguments were set.
35614 @item E @var{NN}
35615 An error occurred.
35616 @end table
35617
35618 @item b @var{baud}
35619 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35620 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35621 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35622
35623 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35624 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35625 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35626
35627 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35628 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35629 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35630 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35631 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35632
35633 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35634 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35635 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35636 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35637
35638 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35639 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35640
35641 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35642 @anchor{bc}
35643 @item bc
35644 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35645 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35646
35647 Reply:
35648 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35649
35650 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35651 @anchor{bs}
35652 @item bs
35653 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35654 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35655
35656 Reply:
35657 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35658
35659 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35660 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35661 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35662 is omitted, resume at current address.
35663
35664 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35665 packet}.
35666
35667 Reply:
35668 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35669
35670 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35671 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35672 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35673 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35674
35675 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35676 packet}.
35677
35678 Reply:
35679 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35680
35681 @item d
35682 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35683 Toggle debug flag.
35684
35685 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35686 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35687
35688 @item D
35689 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35690 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35691 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35692 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35693 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35694
35695 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35696 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35697 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35698 big-endian hex string.
35699
35700 Reply:
35701 @table @samp
35702 @item OK
35703 for success
35704 @item E @var{NN}
35705 for an error
35706 @end table
35707
35708 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35709 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35710 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35711 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35712 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35713
35714 @item g
35715 @anchor{read registers packet}
35716 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35717 Read general registers.
35718
35719 Reply:
35720 @table @samp
35721 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35722 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35723 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35724 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35725 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35726 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35727
35728 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35729 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35730 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35731 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35732 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35733 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35734 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35735 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35736
35737 @smallexample
35738 -> @code{g}
35739 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35740 @end smallexample
35741
35742 @item E @var{NN}
35743 for an error.
35744 @end table
35745
35746 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35747 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35748 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35749 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35750
35751 Reply:
35752 @table @samp
35753 @item OK
35754 for success
35755 @item E @var{NN}
35756 for an error
35757 @end table
35758
35759 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35760 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35761 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35762 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35763 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35764 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35765 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35766 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35767 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35768
35769 Reply:
35770 @table @samp
35771 @item OK
35772 for success
35773 @item E @var{NN}
35774 for an error
35775 @end table
35776
35777 @c FIXME: JTC:
35778 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35779 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35780 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35781 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35782 @c described. For example:
35783 @c
35784 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35785 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35786 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35787 @c
35788 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35789 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35790 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35791
35792 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35793 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35794 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35795 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35796 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35797 step starting at that address.
35798
35799 @item I
35800 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35801 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35802 step packet}.
35803
35804 @item k
35805 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35806 Kill request.
35807
35808 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35809
35810 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35811 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35812
35813 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35814
35815 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35816 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35817 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35818
35819 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35820 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35821 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35822
35823 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35824 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35825 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35826 (@pxref{? packet}).
35827
35828 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35829 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35830 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35831 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35832 any particular boundary.
35833
35834 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35835 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35836 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35837 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35838 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35839 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35840 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35841 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35842
35843 Reply:
35844 @table @samp
35845 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35846 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35847 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35848 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35849 @item E @var{NN}
35850 @var{NN} is errno
35851 @end table
35852
35853 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35854 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35855 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35856 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35857 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35858
35859 Reply:
35860 @table @samp
35861 @item OK
35862 for success
35863 @item E @var{NN}
35864 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35865 written).
35866 @end table
35867
35868 @item p @var{n}
35869 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35870 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35871 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35872 register value is encoded.
35873
35874 Reply:
35875 @table @samp
35876 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35877 the register's value
35878 @item E @var{NN}
35879 for an error
35880 @item @w{}
35881 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35882 @end table
35883
35884 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35885 @anchor{write register packet}
35886 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35887 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35888 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35889 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35890
35891 Reply:
35892 @table @samp
35893 @item OK
35894 for success
35895 @item E @var{NN}
35896 for an error
35897 @end table
35898
35899 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35900 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35901 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35902 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35903 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35904 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35905
35906 @item r
35907 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35908 Reset the entire system.
35909
35910 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35911
35912 @item R @var{XX}
35913 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35914 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35915 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35916
35917 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35918
35919 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35920 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35921 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35922 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35923
35924 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35925 packet}.
35926
35927 Reply:
35928 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35929
35930 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35931 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35932 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35933 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35934 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35935
35936 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35937 packet}.
35938
35939 Reply:
35940 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35941
35942 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35943 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35944 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35945 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35946 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35947
35948 @item T @var{thread-id}
35949 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35950 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35951
35952 Reply:
35953 @table @samp
35954 @item OK
35955 thread is still alive
35956 @item E @var{NN}
35957 thread is dead
35958 @end table
35959
35960 @item v
35961 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35962 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35963
35964 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35965 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35966 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35967 The process ID is a
35968 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35969 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35970 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35971
35972 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35973 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35974 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35975 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35976 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35977 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35978 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35979 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35980
35981 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35982
35983 Reply:
35984 @table @samp
35985 @item E @var{nn}
35986 for an error
35987 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35988 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35989 @item OK
35990 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35991 @end table
35992
35993 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35994 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35995 @anchor{vCont packet}
35996 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35997
35998 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35999 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
36000 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
36001 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
36002 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
36003 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
36004 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
36005 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
36006 error.
36007
36008 Currently supported actions are:
36009
36010 @table @samp
36011 @item c
36012 Continue.
36013 @item C @var{sig}
36014 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36015 @item s
36016 Step.
36017 @item S @var{sig}
36018 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36019 @item t
36020 Stop.
36021 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
36022 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36023 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36024 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36025 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36026 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36027
36028 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36029 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36030 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36031 jumps to @var{start}).
36032
36033 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36034 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36035 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36036
36037 @end table
36038
36039 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36040 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36041 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
36042
36043 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36044 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36045 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36046 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36047 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36048 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36049 as an implementation detail.
36050
36051 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36052 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36053 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36054 stopped.
36055
36056 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36057 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36058 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36059
36060 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36061 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36062
36063 Reply:
36064 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36065
36066 @item vCont?
36067 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36068 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36069
36070 Reply:
36071 @table @samp
36072 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36073 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36074 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36075 @item @w{}
36076 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
36077 @end table
36078
36079 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
36080 @item vCtrlC
36081 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36082 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36083 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36084 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36085 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36086 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36087 variant.
36088
36089 Reply:
36090 @table @samp
36091 @item E @var{nn}
36092 for an error
36093 @item OK
36094 for success
36095 @end table
36096
36097 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36098 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36099 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36100 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36101
36102 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36103 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36104 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36105 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36106 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36107 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36108 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36109 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36110 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36111 packet is received.
36112
36113 Reply:
36114 @table @samp
36115 @item OK
36116 for success
36117 @item E @var{NN}
36118 for an error
36119 @end table
36120
36121 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36122 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36123 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36124 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36125 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36126 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36127 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36128 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36129 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36130 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36131 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36132 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36133
36134
36135 Reply:
36136 @table @samp
36137 @item OK
36138 for success
36139 @item E.memtype
36140 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36141 @item E @var{NN}
36142 for an error
36143 @end table
36144
36145 @item vFlashDone
36146 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36147 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36148 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36149 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36150 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36151 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36152 request is completed.
36153
36154 @item vKill;@var{pid}
36155 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36156 @anchor{vKill packet}
36157 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36158 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36159 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36160 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36161
36162 Reply:
36163 @table @samp
36164 @item E @var{nn}
36165 for an error
36166 @item OK
36167 for success
36168 @end table
36169
36170 @item vMustReplyEmpty
36171 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36172 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36173 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36174 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36175
36176 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36177 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36178 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36179 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
36180 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
36181 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
36182
36183 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
36184 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
36185 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
36186 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
36187 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
36188 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
36189 state.
36190
36191 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
36192
36193 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36194
36195 Reply:
36196 @table @samp
36197 @item E @var{nn}
36198 for an error
36199 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36200 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36201 @end table
36202
36203 @item vStopped
36204 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
36205 @xref{Notification Packets}.
36206
36207 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36208 @anchor{X packet}
36209 @cindex @samp{X} packet
36210 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
36211 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
36212 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
36213 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36214
36215 Reply:
36216 @table @samp
36217 @item OK
36218 for success
36219 @item E @var{NN}
36220 for an error
36221 @end table
36222
36223 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36224 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36225 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
36226 @cindex @samp{z} packet
36227 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
36228 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36229 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36230
36231 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36232 separately.
36233
36234 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36235 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36236 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36237 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36238 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36239 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36240
36241 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36242 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36243 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
36244 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36245 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36246 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36247
36248 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36249 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36250 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36251 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36252 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36253 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36254 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36255 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36256 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36257 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36258 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36259 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36260 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36261
36262 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36263 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36264
36265 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36266 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36267
36268 @table @samp
36269
36270 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36271 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36272 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36273
36274 @end table
36275
36276 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36277 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36278 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36279 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36280 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36281 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36282 separators. Each expression has the following form:
36283
36284 @table @samp
36285
36286 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36287 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36288 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36289
36290 @end table
36291
36292 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36293 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36294 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36295 target, is not defined.}
36296
36297 Reply:
36298 @table @samp
36299 @item OK
36300 success
36301 @item @w{}
36302 not supported
36303 @item E @var{NN}
36304 for an error
36305 @end table
36306
36307 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36308 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36309 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
36310 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36311 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36312 address @var{addr}.
36313
36314 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36315 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36316 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36317 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36318
36319 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36320 movement.}
36321
36322 Reply:
36323 @table @samp
36324 @item OK
36325 success
36326 @item @w{}
36327 not supported
36328 @item E @var{NN}
36329 for an error
36330 @end table
36331
36332 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36333 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36334 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36335 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36336 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36337 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36338
36339 Reply:
36340 @table @samp
36341 @item OK
36342 success
36343 @item @w{}
36344 not supported
36345 @item E @var{NN}
36346 for an error
36347 @end table
36348
36349 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36350 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36351 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36352 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36353 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36354 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36355
36356 Reply:
36357 @table @samp
36358 @item OK
36359 success
36360 @item @w{}
36361 not supported
36362 @item E @var{NN}
36363 for an error
36364 @end table
36365
36366 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36367 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36368 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36369 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36370 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36371 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36372
36373 Reply:
36374 @table @samp
36375 @item OK
36376 success
36377 @item @w{}
36378 not supported
36379 @item E @var{NN}
36380 for an error
36381 @end table
36382
36383 @end table
36384
36385 @node Stop Reply Packets
36386 @section Stop Reply Packets
36387 @cindex stop reply packets
36388
36389 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36390 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36391 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36392 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36393 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36394 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36395 @value{GDBN} source code.
36396
36397 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36398 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36399 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36400
36401 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36402 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36403 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36404 components.
36405
36406 @table @samp
36407
36408 @item S @var{AA}
36409 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36410 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36411 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36412
36413 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36414 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36415 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36416 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36417 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36418 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36419 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36420 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36421
36422 @itemize @bullet
36423 @item
36424 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36425 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36426 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36427 two-digit hex number.
36428
36429 @item
36430 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36431 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36432
36433 @item
36434 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36435 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36436
36437 @item
36438 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36439 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36440 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36441 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36442
36443 @item
36444 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36445 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36446 future.
36447 @end itemize
36448
36449 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36450
36451 @table @samp
36452 @item watch
36453 @itemx rwatch
36454 @itemx awatch
36455 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36456 hex.
36457
36458 @item syscall_entry
36459 @itemx syscall_return
36460 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36461 syscall number, in hex.
36462
36463 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36464 @item library
36465 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36466 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36467 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36468
36469 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36470 @item replaylog
36471 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36472 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36473 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36474 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36475 for more information.
36476
36477 @item swbreak
36478 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36479 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36480 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36481 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36482 part must be left empty.
36483
36484 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36485 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36486 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36487 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36488 address.
36489
36490 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36491 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36492 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36493 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36494 indicating support.
36495
36496 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36497
36498 @item hwbreak
36499 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36500 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36501
36502 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36503 apply.
36504
36505 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36506 @item fork
36507 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36508 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36509 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36510 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36511 fork events.
36512
36513 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36514 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36515 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36516 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36517 indicating support.
36518
36519 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36520 @item vfork
36521 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36522 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36523 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36524 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36525 vfork events.
36526
36527 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36528 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36529 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36530 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36531 indicating support.
36532
36533 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36534 @item vforkdone
36535 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36536 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36537 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36538 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36539 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36540
36541 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36542 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36543 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36544 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36545 indicating support.
36546
36547 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36548 @item exec
36549 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36550 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36551 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36552
36553 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36554 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36555 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36556 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36557 indicating support.
36558
36559 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36560 @anchor{thread create event}
36561 @item create
36562 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36563 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36564 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36565 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36566 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36567 @var{r} part is ignored.
36568
36569 @end table
36570
36571 @item W @var{AA}
36572 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36573 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36574 applicable to certain targets.
36575
36576 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36577 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36578 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36579 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36580 hex strings.
36581
36582 @item X @var{AA}
36583 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36584 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36585
36586 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36587 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36588 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36589 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36590 hex strings.
36591
36592 @anchor{thread exit event}
36593 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36594 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36595
36596 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36597 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36598 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36599 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36600
36601 @item N
36602 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36603 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36604 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36605 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36606 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36607 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36608 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36609 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36610 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36611 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36612 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36613 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36614 support.
36615
36616 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36617 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36618 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36619 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36620 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36621
36622 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36623 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36624 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36625 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36626 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36627 system calls.
36628
36629 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36630 this very system call.
36631
36632 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36633 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36634 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36635 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36636 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36637 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36638
36639 @end table
36640
36641 @node General Query Packets
36642 @section General Query Packets
36643 @cindex remote query requests
36644
36645 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36646 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36647 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36648 sending information to and from the stub.
36649
36650 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36651 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36652 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36653 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36654 conventions:
36655
36656 @itemize @bullet
36657 @item
36658 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36659 @item
36660 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36661 letter.
36662 @item
36663 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36664 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36665 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36666 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36667 @end itemize
36668
36669 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36670 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36671 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36672 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36673 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36674 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36675 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36676 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36677 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36678 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36679 packet.}.
36680
36681 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36682 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36683 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36684 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36685 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36686
36687 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36688
36689 @table @samp
36690
36691 @item QAgent:1
36692 @itemx QAgent:0
36693 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36694 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36695
36696 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36697 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36698 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36699 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36700 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36701 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36702 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36703 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36704 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36705 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36706 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36707
36708 @item qC
36709 @cindex current thread, remote request
36710 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36711 Return the current thread ID.
36712
36713 Reply:
36714 @table @samp
36715 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36716 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36717 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36718 @item @r{(anything else)}
36719 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36720 @end table
36721
36722 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36723 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36724 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36725 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36726 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36727 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36728 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36729 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36730
36731 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36732 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36733 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36734 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36735 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36736 detect trailing zeros.
36737
36738 Reply:
36739 @table @samp
36740 @item E @var{NN}
36741 An error (such as memory fault)
36742 @item C @var{crc32}
36743 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36744 @end table
36745
36746 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36747 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36748 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36749 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36750 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36751 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36752 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36753 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36754 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36755 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36756 randomization.
36757
36758 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36759
36760 Reply:
36761 @table @samp
36762 @item OK
36763 The request succeeded.
36764
36765 @item E @var{nn}
36766 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36767
36768 @item @w{}
36769 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36770 by the stub.
36771 @end table
36772
36773 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36774 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36775 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36776 address space randomization.
36777
36778 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
36779 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
36780 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
36781 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
36782 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
36783 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
36784 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
36785 inferior using a shell or not.
36786
36787 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
36788 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
36789 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
36790 values are considered an error.
36791
36792 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36793 mode}).
36794
36795 Reply:
36796 @table @samp
36797 @item OK
36798 The request succeeded.
36799
36800 @item E @var{nn}
36801 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36802 @end table
36803
36804 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36805 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36806 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36807 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
36808
36809 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
36810 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
36811
36812 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
36813 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36814 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
36815 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
36816 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
36817 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
36818 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
36819 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
36820 environment}).
36821
36822 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36823 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
36824 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
36825 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
36826 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
36827 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
36828 not be present.
36829
36830 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36831 mode}).
36832
36833 Reply:
36834 @table @samp
36835 @item OK
36836 The request succeeded.
36837 @end table
36838
36839 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36840 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36841 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36842 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36843 inferior.
36844
36845 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
36846 @pxref{set environment}.
36847
36848 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
36849 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
36850 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
36851 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
36852 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
36853 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
36854 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
36855 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
36856
36857 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36858 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
36859
36860 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36861 mode}).
36862
36863 Reply:
36864 @table @samp
36865 @item OK
36866 The request succeeded.
36867 @end table
36868
36869 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36870 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36871 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36872 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36873 inferior.
36874
36875 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
36876 @pxref{unset environment}.
36877
36878 @item QEnvironmentReset
36879 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
36880 @cindex reset environment, remote request
36881 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
36882 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
36883 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
36884 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
36885 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
36886 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
36887 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36888 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
36889 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
36890
36891 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36892 mode}).
36893
36894 Reply:
36895 @table @samp
36896 @item OK
36897 The request succeeded.
36898 @end table
36899
36900 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36901 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36902 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36903 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36904 inferior.
36905
36906 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
36907 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
36908 @cindex set working directory, remote request
36909 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
36910 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
36911 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
36912
36913 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
36914 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
36915 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
36916 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
36917 directory to its original, empty value.
36918
36919 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36920 mode}).
36921
36922 Reply:
36923 @table @samp
36924 @item OK
36925 The request succeeded.
36926 @end table
36927
36928 @item qfThreadInfo
36929 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36930 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36931 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36932 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36933 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36934 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36935 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36936 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36937 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36938 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36939
36940 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36941
36942 Reply:
36943 @table @samp
36944 @item m @var{thread-id}
36945 A single thread ID
36946 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36947 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36948 @item l
36949 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36950 @end table
36951
36952 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36953 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36954 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36955 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36956 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36957 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36958 fields.
36959
36960 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36961 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36962 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36963 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36964 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36965
36966 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36967 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36968 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36969 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36970 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36971
36972 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36973 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36974
36975 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36976 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36977 information associated with the variable.)
36978
36979 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36980 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36981 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36982 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36983 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36984 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36985
36986 Reply:
36987 @table @samp
36988 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36989 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36990 local storage requested.
36991
36992 @item E @var{nn}
36993 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36994
36995 @item @w{}
36996 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36997 @end table
36998
36999 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
37000 @cindex get thread information block address
37001 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
37002 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
37003
37004 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
37005
37006 Reply:
37007 @table @samp
37008 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37009 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
37010 thread information block.
37011
37012 @item E @var{nn}
37013 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
37014 address could not be retrieved.
37015
37016 @item @w{}
37017 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37018 @end table
37019
37020 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37021 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37022 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37023 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37024 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37025 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37026 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37027
37028 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37029
37030 Reply:
37031 @table @samp
37032 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37033 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37034 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37035 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37036 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37037 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37038 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37039 @end table
37040
37041 @item qOffsets
37042 @cindex section offsets, remote request
37043 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
37044 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
37045 image.
37046
37047 Reply:
37048 @table @samp
37049 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
37050 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
37051 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
37052 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
37053 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
37054 segments by the supplied offsets.
37055
37056 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
37057 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
37058 to the @code{Bss} section.}
37059
37060 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
37061 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
37062 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
37063 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
37064 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37065 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37066 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37067 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37068 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37069 @end table
37070
37071 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
37072 @cindex thread information, remote request
37073 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
37074 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
37075 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
37076 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
37077
37078 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
37079 (see below).
37080
37081 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
37082
37083 @item QNonStop:1
37084 @itemx QNonStop:0
37085 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
37086 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
37087 @anchor{QNonStop}
37088 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
37089 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
37090
37091 Reply:
37092 @table @samp
37093 @item OK
37094 The request succeeded.
37095
37096 @item E @var{nn}
37097 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37098
37099 @item @w{}
37100 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
37101 the stub.
37102 @end table
37103
37104 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37105 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37106 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37107 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37108
37109 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37110 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37111 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37112 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37113 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37114 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37115 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37116
37117 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37118 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37119 is listed, every system call should be reported.
37120
37121 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37122 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37123 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37124 report the requested syscalls.
37125
37126 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37127 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37128
37129 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37130 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37131 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37132 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37133
37134 Reply:
37135 @table @samp
37136 @item OK
37137 The request succeeded.
37138
37139 @item E @var{nn}
37140 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37141
37142 @item @w{}
37143 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37144 the stub.
37145 @end table
37146
37147 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37148 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37149 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37150 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37151
37152 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37153 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37154 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37155 @anchor{QPassSignals}
37156 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37157 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37158 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37159 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37160 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37161 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37162 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37163 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37164 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37165
37166 Reply:
37167 @table @samp
37168 @item OK
37169 The request succeeded.
37170
37171 @item E @var{nn}
37172 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37173
37174 @item @w{}
37175 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37176 the stub.
37177 @end table
37178
37179 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
37180 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
37181 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37182 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37183
37184 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37185 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
37186 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
37187 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
37188 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
37189 Others should be silently discarded.
37190
37191 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
37192 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
37193 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
37194 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
37195 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
37196 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
37197 signals.
37198
37199 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
37200 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
37201
37202 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37203 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37204 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
37205 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
37206 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37207
37208 Reply:
37209 @table @samp
37210 @item OK
37211 The request succeeded.
37212
37213 @item E @var{nn}
37214 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37215
37216 @item @w{}
37217 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
37218 by the stub.
37219 @end table
37220
37221 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
37222 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
37223 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37224 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37225
37226 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
37227 @item QThreadEvents:1
37228 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
37229 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
37230 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
37231
37232 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
37233 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
37234 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
37235 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
37236 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
37237 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
37238 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
37239 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
37240 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
37241 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37242
37243 Reply:
37244 @table @samp
37245 @item OK
37246 The request succeeded.
37247
37248 @item E @var{nn}
37249 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37250
37251 @item @w{}
37252 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
37253 the stub.
37254 @end table
37255
37256 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
37257 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
37258
37259 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
37260 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
37261 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
37262 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
37263 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
37264 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
37265 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
37266 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
37267 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
37268
37269 Reply:
37270 @table @samp
37271 @item OK
37272 A command response with no output.
37273 @item @var{OUTPUT}
37274 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
37275 @item E @var{NN}
37276 Indicate a badly formed request.
37277 @item @w{}
37278 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
37279 @end table
37280
37281 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
37282 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37283 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37284 packets.)
37285
37286 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
37287 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
37288 @ifnotinfo
37289 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
37290 @end ifnotinfo
37291 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
37292 @anchor{qSearch memory}
37293 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
37294 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
37295 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
37296
37297 Reply:
37298 @table @samp
37299 @item 0
37300 The pattern was not found.
37301 @item 1,address
37302 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
37303 @item E @var{NN}
37304 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
37305 @item @w{}
37306 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
37307 @end table
37308
37309 @item QStartNoAckMode
37310 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
37311 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
37312 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
37313 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
37314
37315 Reply:
37316 @table @samp
37317 @item OK
37318 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
37319 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
37320 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
37321 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
37322 @item @w{}
37323 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
37324 @end table
37325
37326 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
37327 @cindex supported packets, remote query
37328 @cindex features of the remote protocol
37329 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
37330 @anchor{qSupported}
37331 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
37332 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
37333 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
37334 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
37335 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
37336 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
37337 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
37338 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
37339 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
37340 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
37341 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
37342 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
37343 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
37344 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37345
37346 Reply:
37347 @table @samp
37348 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37349 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37350 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37351 possible forms).
37352 @item @w{}
37353 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37354 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37355 @end table
37356
37357 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37358 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37359 are:
37360
37361 @table @samp
37362 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
37363 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37364 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37365 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37366 @item @var{name}+
37367 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37368 need an associated value.
37369 @item @var{name}-
37370 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37371 @item @var{name}?
37372 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37373 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37374 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37375 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37376 @end table
37377
37378 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37379 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37380 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37381 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37382 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37383
37384 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37385 are defined:
37386
37387 @table @samp
37388 @item multiprocess
37389 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37390 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37391 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37392 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37393 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37394
37395 @item xmlRegisters
37396 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37397 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37398 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37399 description.
37400
37401 @item qRelocInsn
37402 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37403 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37404 instruction reply packet}).
37405
37406 @item swbreak
37407 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37408 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37409
37410 @item hwbreak
37411 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37412 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37413
37414 @item fork-events
37415 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37416 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37417 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37418 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37419
37420 @item vfork-events
37421 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37422 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37423 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37424 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37425
37426 @item exec-events
37427 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37428 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37429 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37430 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37431
37432 @item vContSupported
37433 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37434 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37435 @end table
37436
37437 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37438 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37439 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37440 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37441 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37442 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37443 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37444 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
37445 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
37446 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
37447 all the features it supports.
37448
37449 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
37450 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
37451
37452 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
37453 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
37454 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
37455 form response.
37456
37457 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
37458 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
37459 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
37460 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
37461
37462 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
37463 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
37464 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
37465 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
37466 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
37467
37468 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
37469
37470 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
37471 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
37472 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
37473 @item Feature Name
37474 @tab Value Required
37475 @tab Default
37476 @tab Probe Allowed
37477
37478 @item @samp{PacketSize}
37479 @tab Yes
37480 @tab @samp{-}
37481 @tab No
37482
37483 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37484 @tab No
37485 @tab @samp{-}
37486 @tab Yes
37487
37488 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37489 @tab No
37490 @tab @samp{-}
37491 @tab Yes
37492
37493 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37494 @tab No
37495 @tab @samp{-}
37496 @tab Yes
37497
37498 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37499 @tab No
37500 @tab @samp{-}
37501 @tab Yes
37502
37503 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37504 @tab No
37505 @tab @samp{-}
37506 @tab Yes
37507
37508 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37509 @tab No
37510 @tab @samp{-}
37511 @tab Yes
37512
37513 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37514 @tab No
37515 @tab @samp{-}
37516 @tab Yes
37517
37518 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37519 @tab No
37520 @tab @samp{-}
37521 @tab No
37522
37523 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37524 @tab No
37525 @tab @samp{-}
37526 @tab Yes
37527
37528 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37529 @tab No
37530 @tab @samp{-}
37531 @tab Yes
37532
37533 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37534 @tab No
37535 @tab @samp{-}
37536 @tab Yes
37537
37538 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37539 @tab No
37540 @tab @samp{-}
37541 @tab Yes
37542
37543 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37544 @tab No
37545 @tab @samp{-}
37546 @tab Yes
37547
37548 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37549 @tab No
37550 @tab @samp{-}
37551 @tab Yes
37552
37553 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37554 @tab No
37555 @tab @samp{-}
37556 @tab Yes
37557
37558 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37559 @tab No
37560 @tab @samp{-}
37561 @tab Yes
37562
37563 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37564 @tab No
37565 @tab @samp{-}
37566 @tab Yes
37567
37568 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37569 @tab No
37570 @tab @samp{-}
37571 @tab Yes
37572
37573 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37574 @tab Yes
37575 @tab @samp{-}
37576 @tab Yes
37577
37578 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37579 @tab Yes
37580 @tab @samp{-}
37581 @tab Yes
37582
37583 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37584 @tab Yes
37585 @tab @samp{-}
37586 @tab Yes
37587
37588 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37589 @tab Yes
37590 @tab @samp{-}
37591 @tab Yes
37592
37593 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37594 @tab Yes
37595 @tab @samp{-}
37596 @tab Yes
37597
37598 @item @samp{QNonStop}
37599 @tab No
37600 @tab @samp{-}
37601 @tab Yes
37602
37603 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37604 @tab No
37605 @tab @samp{-}
37606 @tab Yes
37607
37608 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37609 @tab No
37610 @tab @samp{-}
37611 @tab Yes
37612
37613 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37614 @tab No
37615 @tab @samp{-}
37616 @tab Yes
37617
37618 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37619 @tab No
37620 @tab @samp{-}
37621 @tab No
37622
37623 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37624 @tab No
37625 @tab @samp{-}
37626 @tab No
37627
37628 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37629 @tab No
37630 @tab @samp{-}
37631 @tab No
37632
37633 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37634 @tab No
37635 @tab @samp{-}
37636 @tab No
37637
37638 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37639 @tab No
37640 @tab @samp{-}
37641 @tab No
37642
37643 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37644 @tab No
37645 @tab @samp{-}
37646 @tab No
37647
37648 @item @samp{QAgent}
37649 @tab No
37650 @tab @samp{-}
37651 @tab No
37652
37653 @item @samp{QAllow}
37654 @tab No
37655 @tab @samp{-}
37656 @tab No
37657
37658 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37659 @tab No
37660 @tab @samp{-}
37661 @tab No
37662
37663 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37664 @tab No
37665 @tab @samp{-}
37666 @tab No
37667
37668 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37669 @tab No
37670 @tab @samp{-}
37671 @tab No
37672
37673 @item @samp{tracenz}
37674 @tab No
37675 @tab @samp{-}
37676 @tab No
37677
37678 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37679 @tab No
37680 @tab @samp{-}
37681 @tab No
37682
37683 @item @samp{swbreak}
37684 @tab No
37685 @tab @samp{-}
37686 @tab No
37687
37688 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37689 @tab No
37690 @tab @samp{-}
37691 @tab No
37692
37693 @item @samp{fork-events}
37694 @tab No
37695 @tab @samp{-}
37696 @tab No
37697
37698 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37699 @tab No
37700 @tab @samp{-}
37701 @tab No
37702
37703 @item @samp{exec-events}
37704 @tab No
37705 @tab @samp{-}
37706 @tab No
37707
37708 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37709 @tab No
37710 @tab @samp{-}
37711 @tab No
37712
37713 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37714 @tab No
37715 @tab @samp{-}
37716 @tab No
37717
37718 @end multitable
37719
37720 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37721
37722 @table @samp
37723 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37724 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37725 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37726 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37727 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37728 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37729 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37730 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37731 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37732 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37733
37734 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37735 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37736 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37737
37738 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37739 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37740 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37741
37742 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37743 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37744 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37745
37746 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37747 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37748 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37749
37750 @item qXfer:features:read
37751 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37752 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37753
37754 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37755 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37756 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37757
37758 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37759 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37760 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37761
37762 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37763 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37764 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37765 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37766
37767 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37768 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37769 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37770
37771 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37772 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37773 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37774
37775 @item qXfer:spu:read
37776 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37777 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37778
37779 @item qXfer:spu:write
37780 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37781 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37782
37783 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37784 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37785 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37786
37787 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37788 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37789 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37790
37791 @item qXfer:threads:read
37792 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37793 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37794
37795 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37796 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37797 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37798
37799 @item qXfer:uib:read
37800 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37801 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37802
37803 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37804 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37805 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37806
37807 @item QNonStop
37808 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37809 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37810
37811 @item QCatchSyscalls
37812 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37813 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37814
37815 @item QPassSignals
37816 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37817 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37818
37819 @item QStartNoAckMode
37820 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37821 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37822
37823 @item multiprocess
37824 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37825 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37826 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37827 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37828 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37829 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37830 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37831 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37832 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37833 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37834 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37835
37836 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37837 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37838 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37839
37840 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37841 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37842 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37843 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37844
37845 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37846 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37847 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37848
37849 @item ReverseContinue
37850 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37851 (@pxref{bc}).
37852
37853 @item ReverseStep
37854 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37855 (@pxref{bs}).
37856
37857 @item TracepointSource
37858 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37859 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37860
37861 @item QAgent
37862 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37863
37864 @item QAllow
37865 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37866
37867 @item QDisableRandomization
37868 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37869
37870 @item StaticTracepoint
37871 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37872 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37873
37874 @item InstallInTrace
37875 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37876 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37877
37878 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37879 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37880 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37881 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37882
37883 @item QTBuffer:size
37884 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37885 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37886
37887 @item tracenz
37888 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37889 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37890 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37891
37892 @item BreakpointCommands
37893 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37894 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37895 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37896
37897 @item Qbtrace:off
37898 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37899
37900 @item Qbtrace:bts
37901 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37902
37903 @item Qbtrace:pt
37904 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37905
37906 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37907 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37908
37909 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37910 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37911
37912 @item swbreak
37913 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37914 breakpoints.
37915
37916 @item hwbreak
37917 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37918 breakpoints.
37919
37920 @item fork-events
37921 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37922
37923 @item vfork-events
37924 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37925 and vforkdone events.
37926
37927 @item exec-events
37928 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37929
37930 @item vContSupported
37931 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37932 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37933
37934 @item QThreadEvents
37935 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37936
37937 @item no-resumed
37938 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37939
37940 @end table
37941
37942 @item qSymbol::
37943 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37944 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37945 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37946 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37947
37948 Reply:
37949 @table @samp
37950 @item OK
37951 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37952 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37953 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37954 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37955 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37956 below.
37957 @end table
37958
37959 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37960 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37961
37962 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37963 target has previously requested.
37964
37965 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37966 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37967 will be empty.
37968
37969 Reply:
37970 @table @samp
37971 @item OK
37972 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37973 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37974 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37975 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37976 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37977 @end table
37978
37979 @item qTBuffer
37980 @itemx QTBuffer
37981 @itemx QTDisconnected
37982 @itemx QTDP
37983 @itemx QTDPsrc
37984 @itemx QTDV
37985 @itemx qTfP
37986 @itemx qTfV
37987 @itemx QTFrame
37988 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37989
37990 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37991
37992 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37993 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37994 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37995 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37996 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37997 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37998 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37999 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38000 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38001 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38002 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38003
38004 Reply:
38005 @table @samp
38006 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38007 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38008 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38009 the thread's attributes.
38010 @end table
38011
38012 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38013 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38014 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38015 packets.)
38016
38017 @item QTNotes
38018 @itemx qTP
38019 @itemx QTSave
38020 @itemx qTsP
38021 @itemx qTsV
38022 @itemx QTStart
38023 @itemx QTStop
38024 @itemx QTEnable
38025 @itemx QTDisable
38026 @itemx QTinit
38027 @itemx QTro
38028 @itemx qTStatus
38029 @itemx qTV
38030 @itemx qTfSTM
38031 @itemx qTsSTM
38032 @itemx qTSTMat
38033 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38034
38035 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38036 @cindex read special object, remote request
38037 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38038 @anchor{qXfer read}
38039 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38040 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38041 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
38042 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
38043 additional details about what data to access.
38044
38045 Reply:
38046 @table @samp
38047 @item m @var{data}
38048 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
38049 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
38050 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
38051 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
38052 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
38053 request.
38054
38055 @item l @var{data}
38056 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
38057 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
38058 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
38059
38060 @item l
38061 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
38062 There is no more data to be read.
38063
38064 @item E00
38065 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38066
38067 @item E @var{nn}
38068 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38069 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38070
38071 @item @w{}
38072 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
38073 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
38074 @end table
38075
38076 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38077 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38078 formats, listed above.
38079
38080 @table @samp
38081 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38082 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
38083 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
38084 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
38085
38086 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38087 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38088
38089 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38090 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
38091
38092 Return a description of the current branch trace.
38093 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
38094 packet may have one of the following values:
38095
38096 @table @code
38097 @item all
38098 Returns all available branch trace.
38099
38100 @item new
38101 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
38102 the last read request.
38103
38104 @item delta
38105 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38106 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38107 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38108 used to stitch traces together.
38109
38110 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38111 @end table
38112
38113 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38114 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38115
38116 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38117 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38118
38119 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38120 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38121
38122 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38123 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38124
38125 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38126 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38127 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38128 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38129 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38130 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38131 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38132
38133 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38134 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38135
38136 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38137 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
38138 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38139 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38140 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38141
38142 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38143 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38144
38145 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38146 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
38147 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38148 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38149 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38150
38151 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38152 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38153 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38154
38155 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38156 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38157
38158 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38159 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38160 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38161 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38162 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38163 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38164 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38165 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38166
38167 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38168 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38169
38170 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38171 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38172
38173 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38174 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38175 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38176 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38177
38178 @table @code
38179 @item start=@var{address}
38180 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38181 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
38182 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
38183 chosen as the starting point.
38184
38185 @item prev=@var{address}
38186 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38187 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
38188 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
38189 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
38190 exists prior to the starting point.
38191
38192 @end table
38193
38194 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
38195 ignored.
38196
38197 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38198 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
38199 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
38200 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38201 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38202
38203 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38204 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38205
38206 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38207 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
38208
38209 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
38210 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
38211 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
38212 Action Lists}.
38213
38214 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38215 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38216 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38217
38218 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38219 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
38220 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
38221 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38222 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38223
38224 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38225 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38226 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38227
38228 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38229 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
38230 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38231 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
38232 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38233 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38234 in that context to be accessed.
38235
38236 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38237 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38238 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38239
38240 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38241 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
38242 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
38243 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38244 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38245
38246 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38247 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38248
38249 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38250 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
38251
38252 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
38253 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
38254 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38255
38256 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38257 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38258
38259 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38260 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
38261
38262 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
38263 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
38264
38265 This packet is not probed by default.
38266
38267 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38268 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
38269 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
38270 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
38271 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
38272
38273 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38274 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38275
38276 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38277 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
38278 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
38279 @xref{Operating System Information}.
38280
38281 @end table
38282
38283 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38284 @cindex write data into object, remote request
38285 @anchor{qXfer write}
38286 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
38287 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
38288 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
38289 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
38290 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
38291 to access.
38292
38293 Reply:
38294 @table @samp
38295 @item @var{nn}
38296 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
38297 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
38298
38299 @item E00
38300 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38301
38302 @item E @var{nn}
38303 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
38304 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38305
38306 @item @w{}
38307 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
38308 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
38309 @end table
38310
38311 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38312 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38313 formats, listed above.
38314
38315 @table @samp
38316 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38317 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
38318 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
38319 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38320 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
38321
38322 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38323 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38324 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38325
38326 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38327 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
38328 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38329 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
38330 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38331 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38332 in that context to be accessed.
38333
38334 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38335 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38336 @end table
38337
38338 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
38339 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
38340 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
38341 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
38342 must respond with an empty packet.
38343
38344 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
38345 @cindex query attached, remote request
38346 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38347 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38348 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38349 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38350 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38351 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38352 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38353
38354 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38355 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38356 the @code{quit} command.
38357
38358 Reply:
38359 @table @samp
38360 @item 1
38361 The remote server attached to an existing process.
38362 @item 0
38363 The remote server created a new process.
38364 @item E @var{NN}
38365 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38366 @end table
38367
38368 @item Qbtrace:bts
38369 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38370
38371 Reply:
38372 @table @samp
38373 @item OK
38374 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38375 @item E.errtext
38376 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38377 @end table
38378
38379 @item Qbtrace:pt
38380 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38381
38382 Reply:
38383 @table @samp
38384 @item OK
38385 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38386 @item E.errtext
38387 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38388 @end table
38389
38390 @item Qbtrace:off
38391 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38392
38393 Reply:
38394 @table @samp
38395 @item OK
38396 Branch tracing has been disabled.
38397 @item E.errtext
38398 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38399 @end table
38400
38401 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38402 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38403 btrace recording method in bts format.
38404
38405 Reply:
38406 @table @samp
38407 @item OK
38408 The ring buffer size has been set.
38409 @item E.errtext
38410 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38411 @end table
38412
38413 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38414 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38415 btrace recording method in pt format.
38416
38417 Reply:
38418 @table @samp
38419 @item OK
38420 The ring buffer size has been set.
38421 @item E.errtext
38422 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38423 @end table
38424
38425 @end table
38426
38427 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38428 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38429
38430 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38431 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38432 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38433
38434 @menu
38435 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38436 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38437 @end menu
38438
38439 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38440 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38441
38442 @menu
38443 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38444 @end menu
38445
38446 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
38447 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
38448 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
38449
38450 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38451
38452 @table @r
38453
38454 @item 2
38455 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
38456
38457 @item 3
38458 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
38459
38460 @item 4
38461 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
38462
38463 @end table
38464
38465 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
38466 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
38467
38468 @menu
38469 * MIPS Register packet Format::
38470 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
38471 @end menu
38472
38473 @node MIPS Register packet Format
38474 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
38475 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
38476
38477 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
38478 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
38479 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
38480 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
38481 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38482 most-significant -- least-significant.
38483
38484 @table @r
38485
38486 @item MIPS32
38487 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
38488 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38489 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38490
38491 @item MIPS64
38492 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38493 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38494 as @code{MIPS32}.
38495
38496 @end table
38497
38498 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38499 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38500 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38501
38502 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38503
38504 @table @r
38505
38506 @item 2
38507 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38508
38509 @item 3
38510 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38511
38512 @item 4
38513 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38514
38515 @item 5
38516 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38517
38518 @end table
38519
38520 @node Tracepoint Packets
38521 @section Tracepoint Packets
38522 @cindex tracepoint packets
38523 @cindex packets, tracepoint
38524
38525 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38526 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38527
38528 @table @samp
38529
38530 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38531 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38532 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38533 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38534 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38535 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38536 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38537 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38538 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38539 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38540 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38541 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38542 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38543 actions.
38544
38545 Replies:
38546 @table @samp
38547 @item OK
38548 The packet was understood and carried out.
38549 @item qRelocInsn
38550 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38551 @item @w{}
38552 The packet was not recognized.
38553 @end table
38554
38555 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38556 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38557 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38558 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38559 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38560 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38561 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38562
38563 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38564 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38565 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38566 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38567 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38568 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38569 tracepoint actions.
38570
38571 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38572 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38573 following forms:
38574
38575 @table @samp
38576
38577 @item R @var{mask}
38578 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38579 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38580 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38581 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38582 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38583
38584 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38585 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38586 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38587 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38588 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38589 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38590 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38591
38592 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38593 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38594 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38595 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38596 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38597 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38598 packet).
38599
38600 @end table
38601
38602 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38603 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38604 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38605 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38606 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38607 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38608 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38609 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38610
38611 Replies:
38612 @table @samp
38613 @item OK
38614 The packet was understood and carried out.
38615 @item qRelocInsn
38616 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38617 @item @w{}
38618 The packet was not recognized.
38619 @end table
38620
38621 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38622 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38623 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38624 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38625 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38626 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38627 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38628 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38629
38630 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38631 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38632 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38633 fit in a single packet.
38634 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38635 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38636
38637 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38638 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38639 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38640 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38641
38642 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38643 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38644 query packets.
38645
38646 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38647 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38648 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38649 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38650 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38651 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38652 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38653 be found.
38654
38655 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38656 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38657 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38658 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38659 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38660 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38661 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38662 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38663 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38664 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38665 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38666 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38667 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38668 variable.
38669
38670 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38671 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38672 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38673 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38674 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38675
38676 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38677 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38678 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38679 one of the following forms:
38680
38681 @table @samp
38682 @item F @var{f}
38683 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38684 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38685 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38686
38687 @item T @var{t}
38688 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38689 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38690
38691 @end table
38692
38693 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38694 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38695 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38696 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38697
38698 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38699 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38700 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38701 is a hexadecimal number.
38702
38703 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38704 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38705 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38706 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38707 numbers.
38708
38709 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38710 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38711 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38712
38713 @item qTMinFTPILen
38714 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38715 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38716 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38717 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38718 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38719 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38720 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38721 arrange for that.
38722
38723 Replies:
38724
38725 @table @samp
38726 @item 0
38727 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38728 @item @var{length}
38729 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38730 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38731 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38732 regardless of size.
38733 @item E
38734 An error has occurred.
38735 @item @w{}
38736 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38737 @end table
38738
38739 @item QTStart
38740 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38741 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38742 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38743 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38744 instruction reply packet}).
38745
38746 @item QTStop
38747 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38748 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38749
38750 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38751 @anchor{QTEnable}
38752 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38753 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38754 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38755 of data from it will resume.
38756
38757 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38758 @anchor{QTDisable}
38759 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38760 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38761 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38762 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38763
38764 @item QTinit
38765 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38766 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38767
38768 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38769 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38770 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38771 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38772 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38773
38774 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38775 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38776 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38777 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38778
38779 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38780 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38781 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38782 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38783 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38784 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38785
38786 @item qTStatus
38787 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38788 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38789
38790 The reply has the form:
38791
38792 @table @samp
38793
38794 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38795 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38796 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38797 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38798
38799 @end table
38800
38801 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38802 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38803
38804 @table @samp
38805
38806 @item tnotrun:0
38807 No trace has been run yet.
38808
38809 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38810 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38811 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38812 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38813 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38814
38815 @item tfull:0
38816 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38817
38818 @item tdisconnected:0
38819 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38820
38821 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38822 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38823
38824 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38825 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38826 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38827 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38828 is hex encoded.
38829
38830 @item tunknown:0
38831 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38832
38833 @end table
38834
38835 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38836 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38837 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38838 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38839 trace.
38840
38841 @table @samp
38842
38843 @item tframes:@var{n}
38844 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38845
38846 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38847 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38848 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38849
38850 @item tsize:@var{n}
38851 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38852
38853 @item tfree:@var{n}
38854 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38855
38856 @item circular:@var{n}
38857 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38858 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38859 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38860 and may fill up.
38861
38862 @item disconn:@var{n}
38863 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38864 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38865 that the trace run will stop.
38866
38867 @end table
38868
38869 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38870 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38871 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38872 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38873 address @var{addr}.
38874
38875 Replies:
38876 @table @samp
38877 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38878 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38879 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38880 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38881 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38882
38883 @end table
38884
38885 @item qTV:@var{var}
38886 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38887 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38888 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38889
38890 Replies:
38891 @table @samp
38892 @item V@var{value}
38893 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38894 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38895 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38896 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38897 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38898 program is running.
38899
38900 @item U
38901 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38902 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38903 was not collected.
38904 @end table
38905
38906 @item qTfP
38907 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38908 @itemx qTsP
38909 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38910 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38911 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38912 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38913 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38914 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38915
38916 @item qTfV
38917 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38918 @itemx qTsV
38919 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38920 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38921 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38922 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38923 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38924 trace state variables.
38925
38926 @item qTfSTM
38927 @itemx qTsSTM
38928 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38929 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38930 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38931 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38932 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38933 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38934 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38935 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38936
38937 Reply:
38938 @table @samp
38939 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38940 A single marker
38941 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38942 a comma-separated list of markers
38943 @item l
38944 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38945 @item E @var{nn}
38946 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38947 @item @w{}
38948 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38949 stub.
38950 @end table
38951
38952 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38953 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38954
38955 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38956 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38957 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38958 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38959 @dfn{last}).
38960
38961 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38962 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38963 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38964 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38965 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38966 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38967 tracepoint markers.
38968
38969 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38970 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38971 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38972 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38973 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38974 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38975
38976 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38977 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38978 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38979 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38980 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38981 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38982 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38983 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38984 available.
38985
38986 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38987 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38988 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38989
38990 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38991 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38992 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38993 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38994 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38995 use whatever size it prefers.
38996
38997 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38998 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38999 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39000 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39001 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39002
39003 @end table
39004
39005 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39006 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39007 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39008 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39009 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39010 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39011 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39012 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39013 it had executed in the original location.
39014
39015 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39016 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39017 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39018 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39019 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39020 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39021 format of the request is:
39022
39023 @table @samp
39024 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39025
39026 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39027 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39028 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39029 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39030 memory starting at @var{to}.
39031 @end table
39032
39033 Replies:
39034 @table @samp
39035 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39036 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39037 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39038 @item E @var{NN}
39039 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39040 relocating the instruction.
39041 @end table
39042
39043 @node Host I/O Packets
39044 @section Host I/O Packets
39045 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39046 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39047
39048 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39049 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39050 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39051 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39052 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39053 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39054 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39055 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39056 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39057 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39058
39059 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39060 its arguments. They have this format:
39061
39062 @table @samp
39063
39064 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39065 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39066 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39067 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39068 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39069 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39070 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39071 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39072 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39073
39074 @end table
39075
39076 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
39077
39078 @table @samp
39079
39080 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
39081 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
39082 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
39083 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
39084 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
39085 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
39086 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
39087 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
39088 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
39089 @var{attachment}.
39090
39091 @item @w{}
39092 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
39093
39094 @end table
39095
39096 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39097
39098 @table @samp
39099 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39100 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39101 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
39102 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39103 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39104 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39105 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39106
39107 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39108 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39109 -1 if an error occurs.
39110
39111 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39112 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39113 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39114 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39115 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39116 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39117 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39118 @var{count} was zero.
39119
39120 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39121 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39122 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39123 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39124 some characters were escaped.
39125
39126 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39127 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39128 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39129 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39130 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39131 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39132 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39133 error occurred.
39134
39135 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39136 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39137 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39138 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39139 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39140 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39141
39142 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39143 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39144 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39145
39146 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39147 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39148 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39149
39150 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39151 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39152 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39153 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39154 some characters were escaped.
39155
39156 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39157 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39158 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39159 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39160 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39161 inferior(s).
39162
39163 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39164 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39165 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39166 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39167 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39168 operation.
39169
39170 @end table
39171
39172 @node Interrupts
39173 @section Interrupts
39174 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39175 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39176
39177 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39178 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39179 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
39180 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
39181
39182 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
39183 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
39184 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
39185 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
39186 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
39187
39188 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
39189 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
39190 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
39191 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
39192 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
39193 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
39194 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
39195 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
39196
39197 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
39198 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
39199 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
39200
39201 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
39202 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
39203 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
39204 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
39205 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
39206 @code{0x03}.
39207
39208 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
39209 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
39210 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
39211 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
39212 currently-executing threads and processes.
39213 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
39214 running program, it should send one of the stop
39215 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
39216 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
39217 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
39218 Interrupts received while the
39219 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
39220 it is resumed next time.
39221
39222 @node Notification Packets
39223 @section Notification Packets
39224 @cindex notification packets
39225 @cindex packets, notification
39226
39227 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
39228 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
39229 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
39230 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
39231 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
39232 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
39233 is not a problem.
39234
39235 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
39236 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
39237 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
39238 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
39239 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
39240 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
39241 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
39242
39243 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
39244 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
39245
39246 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
39247 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
39248 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
39249 not they understand it.
39250
39251 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
39252 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
39253 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
39254 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
39255 recipients.
39256
39257 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
39258 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
39259 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
39260 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
39261 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
39262
39263 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
39264 @table @samp
39265 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
39266 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
39267 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
39268 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
39269 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
39270 @item @var{ack}
39271 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
39272 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
39273 @end table
39274
39275 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
39276 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
39277
39278 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
39279 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
39280 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
39281 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
39282 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
39283 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
39284 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
39285 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
39286 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
39287 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
39288
39289 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
39290 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
39291 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
39292 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
39293 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
39294 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
39295
39296 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
39297 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
39298 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
39299 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
39300 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
39301
39302 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
39303 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
39304 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
39305 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
39306 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
39307 normally.
39308
39309 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
39310 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
39311 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
39312 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
39313 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
39314 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
39315 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
39316 the process shall be repeated.
39317
39318 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
39319 following example:
39320 @smallexample
39321 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
39322 @code{...}
39323 -> @code{vStopped}
39324 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
39325 -> @code{vStopped}
39326 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
39327 -> @code{vStopped}
39328 <- @code{OK}
39329 @end smallexample
39330
39331 The following notifications are defined:
39332 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
39333
39334 @item Notification
39335 @tab Ack
39336 @tab Event
39337 @tab Description
39338
39339 @item Stop
39340 @tab vStopped
39341 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
39342 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
39343 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
39344 @value{GDBN}.
39345 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39346
39347 @end multitable
39348
39349 @node Remote Non-Stop
39350 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39351
39352 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39353 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39354 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39355 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39356
39357 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39358 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39359 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39360 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39361 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39362 probe the target state after a mode change.
39363
39364 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39365 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39366 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39367 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39368 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39369 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39370 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39371 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39372 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39373 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39374 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39375
39376 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39377 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39378 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39379 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39380 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39381 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39382 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39383 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39384 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39385 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39386 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39387 @samp{OK}.
39388
39389 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39390 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39391 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39392 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39393 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39394 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39395 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39396 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39397 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39398 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39399 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39400 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39401 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39402
39403 @node Packet Acknowledgment
39404 @section Packet Acknowledgment
39405
39406 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39407 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39408 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39409 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39410 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39411 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39412 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39413
39414 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39415 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39416 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39417 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39418 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39419
39420 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39421 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39422 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39423 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39424
39425 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39426 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39427 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39428 @pxref{qSupported}.
39429 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39430 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39431 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39432 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39433 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39434 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39435 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39436
39437 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39438 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39439 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39440 connection.
39441 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39442 new connection is established,
39443 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39444 for the current connection, once disabled.
39445
39446 @node Examples
39447 @section Examples
39448
39449 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
39450 does not get any direct output:
39451
39452 @smallexample
39453 -> @code{R00}
39454 <- @code{+}
39455 @emph{target restarts}
39456 -> @code{?}
39457 <- @code{+}
39458 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39459 -> @code{+}
39460 @end smallexample
39461
39462 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
39463
39464 @smallexample
39465 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
39466 <- @code{+}
39467 -> @code{s}
39468 <- @code{+}
39469 @emph{time passes}
39470 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39471 -> @code{+}
39472 -> @code{g}
39473 <- @code{+}
39474 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
39475 -> @code{+}
39476 @end smallexample
39477
39478 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39479 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39480 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
39481
39482 @menu
39483 * File-I/O Overview::
39484 * Protocol Basics::
39485 * The F Request Packet::
39486 * The F Reply Packet::
39487 * The Ctrl-C Message::
39488 * Console I/O::
39489 * List of Supported Calls::
39490 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39491 * Constants::
39492 * File-I/O Examples::
39493 @end menu
39494
39495 @node File-I/O Overview
39496 @subsection File-I/O Overview
39497 @cindex file-i/o overview
39498
39499 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39500 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39501 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39502 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39503 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39504 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39505
39506 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39507 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39508 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39509 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39510 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39511
39512 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39513 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39514 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39515 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39516 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39517 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39518 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39519
39520 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39521 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39522 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39523 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39524 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39525
39526 @smallexample
39527 (@value{GDBP}) continue
39528 <- target requests 'system call X'
39529 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39530 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39531 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39532 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39533 @end smallexample
39534
39535 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39536 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39537 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39538 system are not supported by this protocol.
39539
39540 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39541
39542 @node Protocol Basics
39543 @subsection Protocol Basics
39544 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39545
39546 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39547 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39548 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39549 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39550 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39551 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39552 to call the appropriate host system call:
39553
39554 @itemize @bullet
39555 @item
39556 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39557
39558 @item
39559 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39560 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39561 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39562 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39563
39564 @end itemize
39565
39566 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39567
39568 @itemize @bullet
39569 @item
39570 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39571 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39572 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39573 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39574 packet.
39575
39576 @item
39577 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39578 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39579
39580 @item
39581 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39582
39583 @item
39584 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39585
39586 @item
39587 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39588 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39589 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39590 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39591 packet.
39592
39593 @end itemize
39594
39595 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39596 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39597
39598 @itemize @bullet
39599 @item
39600 Return value.
39601
39602 @item
39603 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39604
39605 @item
39606 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39607
39608 @end itemize
39609
39610 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39611 the latest continue or step action.
39612
39613 @node The F Request Packet
39614 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39615 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39616 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39617
39618 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39619
39620 @table @samp
39621 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39622
39623 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39624 This is just the name of the function.
39625
39626 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39627 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39628 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39629 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39630 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39631 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39632 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39633
39634 @end table
39635
39636
39637
39638 @node The F Reply Packet
39639 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39640 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39641 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39642
39643 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39644
39645 @table @samp
39646
39647 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39648
39649 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39650
39651 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39652 representation.
39653 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39654
39655 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39656 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39657 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39658
39659 @smallexample
39660 F0,0,C
39661 @end smallexample
39662
39663 @noindent
39664 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39665
39666 @smallexample
39667 F-1,4,C
39668 @end smallexample
39669
39670 @noindent
39671 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39672
39673 @end table
39674
39675
39676 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39677 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39678 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39679
39680 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39681 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39682 the target should behave as if it had
39683 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39684 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39685 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39686 packet.
39687
39688 It's important for the target to know in which
39689 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39690
39691 @itemize @bullet
39692 @item
39693 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39694
39695 @item
39696 The system call on the host has been finished.
39697
39698 @end itemize
39699
39700 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39701 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39702 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39703 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39704 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39705 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39706
39707 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39708 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39709 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39710 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39711 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39712 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39713 or the full action has been completed.
39714
39715 @node Console I/O
39716 @subsection Console I/O
39717 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39718
39719 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39720 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39721 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39722 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39723 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39724 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39725 conditions is met:
39726
39727 @itemize @bullet
39728 @item
39729 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39730 @code{read}
39731 system call is treated as finished.
39732
39733 @item
39734 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39735 newline.
39736
39737 @item
39738 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39739 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39740
39741 @end itemize
39742
39743 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39744 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39745 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39746 is stopped at the user's request.
39747
39748
39749 @node List of Supported Calls
39750 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39751 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39752
39753 @menu
39754 * open::
39755 * close::
39756 * read::
39757 * write::
39758 * lseek::
39759 * rename::
39760 * unlink::
39761 * stat/fstat::
39762 * gettimeofday::
39763 * isatty::
39764 * system::
39765 @end menu
39766
39767 @node open
39768 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39769 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39770
39771 @table @asis
39772 @item Synopsis:
39773 @smallexample
39774 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39775 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39776 @end smallexample
39777
39778 @item Request:
39779 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39780
39781 @noindent
39782 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39783
39784 @table @code
39785 @item O_CREAT
39786 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39787 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39788 are concerned.
39789
39790 @item O_EXCL
39791 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39792 an error and open() fails.
39793
39794 @item O_TRUNC
39795 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39796 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39797 truncated to zero length.
39798
39799 @item O_APPEND
39800 The file is opened in append mode.
39801
39802 @item O_RDONLY
39803 The file is opened for reading only.
39804
39805 @item O_WRONLY
39806 The file is opened for writing only.
39807
39808 @item O_RDWR
39809 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39810 @end table
39811
39812 @noindent
39813 Other bits are silently ignored.
39814
39815
39816 @noindent
39817 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39818
39819 @table @code
39820 @item S_IRUSR
39821 User has read permission.
39822
39823 @item S_IWUSR
39824 User has write permission.
39825
39826 @item S_IRGRP
39827 Group has read permission.
39828
39829 @item S_IWGRP
39830 Group has write permission.
39831
39832 @item S_IROTH
39833 Others have read permission.
39834
39835 @item S_IWOTH
39836 Others have write permission.
39837 @end table
39838
39839 @noindent
39840 Other bits are silently ignored.
39841
39842
39843 @item Return value:
39844 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39845 occurred.
39846
39847 @item Errors:
39848
39849 @table @code
39850 @item EEXIST
39851 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39852
39853 @item EISDIR
39854 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39855
39856 @item EACCES
39857 The requested access is not allowed.
39858
39859 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39860 @var{pathname} was too long.
39861
39862 @item ENOENT
39863 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39864
39865 @item ENODEV
39866 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39867
39868 @item EROFS
39869 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39870 write access was requested.
39871
39872 @item EFAULT
39873 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39874
39875 @item ENOSPC
39876 No space on device to create the file.
39877
39878 @item EMFILE
39879 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39880
39881 @item ENFILE
39882 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39883 has been reached.
39884
39885 @item EINTR
39886 The call was interrupted by the user.
39887 @end table
39888
39889 @end table
39890
39891 @node close
39892 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39893 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39894
39895 @table @asis
39896 @item Synopsis:
39897 @smallexample
39898 int close(int fd);
39899 @end smallexample
39900
39901 @item Request:
39902 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39903
39904 @item Return value:
39905 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39906
39907 @item Errors:
39908
39909 @table @code
39910 @item EBADF
39911 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39912
39913 @item EINTR
39914 The call was interrupted by the user.
39915 @end table
39916
39917 @end table
39918
39919 @node read
39920 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39921 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39922
39923 @table @asis
39924 @item Synopsis:
39925 @smallexample
39926 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39927 @end smallexample
39928
39929 @item Request:
39930 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39931
39932 @item Return value:
39933 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39934 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39935 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39936
39937 @item Errors:
39938
39939 @table @code
39940 @item EBADF
39941 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39942 reading.
39943
39944 @item EFAULT
39945 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39946
39947 @item EINTR
39948 The call was interrupted by the user.
39949 @end table
39950
39951 @end table
39952
39953 @node write
39954 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39955 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39956
39957 @table @asis
39958 @item Synopsis:
39959 @smallexample
39960 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39961 @end smallexample
39962
39963 @item Request:
39964 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39965
39966 @item Return value:
39967 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39968 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39969 is returned.
39970
39971 @item Errors:
39972
39973 @table @code
39974 @item EBADF
39975 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39976 writing.
39977
39978 @item EFAULT
39979 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39980
39981 @item EFBIG
39982 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39983 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39984
39985 @item ENOSPC
39986 No space on device to write the data.
39987
39988 @item EINTR
39989 The call was interrupted by the user.
39990 @end table
39991
39992 @end table
39993
39994 @node lseek
39995 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39996 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39997
39998 @table @asis
39999 @item Synopsis:
40000 @smallexample
40001 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40002 @end smallexample
40003
40004 @item Request:
40005 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40006
40007 @var{flag} is one of:
40008
40009 @table @code
40010 @item SEEK_SET
40011 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40012
40013 @item SEEK_CUR
40014 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40015 bytes.
40016
40017 @item SEEK_END
40018 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40019 bytes.
40020 @end table
40021
40022 @item Return value:
40023 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40024 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40025 value of -1 is returned.
40026
40027 @item Errors:
40028
40029 @table @code
40030 @item EBADF
40031 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40032
40033 @item ESPIPE
40034 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40035
40036 @item EINVAL
40037 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40038
40039 @item EINTR
40040 The call was interrupted by the user.
40041 @end table
40042
40043 @end table
40044
40045 @node rename
40046 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40047 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40048
40049 @table @asis
40050 @item Synopsis:
40051 @smallexample
40052 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40053 @end smallexample
40054
40055 @item Request:
40056 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40057
40058 @item Return value:
40059 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40060
40061 @item Errors:
40062
40063 @table @code
40064 @item EISDIR
40065 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40066 directory.
40067
40068 @item EEXIST
40069 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40070
40071 @item EBUSY
40072 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40073 process.
40074
40075 @item EINVAL
40076 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
40077 of itself.
40078
40079 @item ENOTDIR
40080 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
40081 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
40082 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
40083
40084 @item EFAULT
40085 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
40086
40087 @item EACCES
40088 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40089
40090 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40091
40092 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
40093
40094 @item ENOENT
40095 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40096
40097 @item EROFS
40098 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40099
40100 @item ENOSPC
40101 The device containing the file has no room for the new
40102 directory entry.
40103
40104 @item EINTR
40105 The call was interrupted by the user.
40106 @end table
40107
40108 @end table
40109
40110 @node unlink
40111 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40112 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40113
40114 @table @asis
40115 @item Synopsis:
40116 @smallexample
40117 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40118 @end smallexample
40119
40120 @item Request:
40121 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40122
40123 @item Return value:
40124 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40125
40126 @item Errors:
40127
40128 @table @code
40129 @item EACCES
40130 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40131
40132 @item EPERM
40133 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40134
40135 @item EBUSY
40136 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40137 being used by another process.
40138
40139 @item EFAULT
40140 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40141
40142 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40143 @var{pathname} was too long.
40144
40145 @item ENOENT
40146 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40147
40148 @item ENOTDIR
40149 A component of the path is not a directory.
40150
40151 @item EROFS
40152 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40153
40154 @item EINTR
40155 The call was interrupted by the user.
40156 @end table
40157
40158 @end table
40159
40160 @node stat/fstat
40161 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40162 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40163 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40164
40165 @table @asis
40166 @item Synopsis:
40167 @smallexample
40168 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40169 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40170 @end smallexample
40171
40172 @item Request:
40173 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40174 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40175
40176 @item Return value:
40177 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40178
40179 @item Errors:
40180
40181 @table @code
40182 @item EBADF
40183 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
40184
40185 @item ENOENT
40186 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
40187 path is an empty string.
40188
40189 @item ENOTDIR
40190 A component of the path is not a directory.
40191
40192 @item EFAULT
40193 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40194
40195 @item EACCES
40196 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40197
40198 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40199 @var{pathname} was too long.
40200
40201 @item EINTR
40202 The call was interrupted by the user.
40203 @end table
40204
40205 @end table
40206
40207 @node gettimeofday
40208 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
40209 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
40210
40211 @table @asis
40212 @item Synopsis:
40213 @smallexample
40214 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
40215 @end smallexample
40216
40217 @item Request:
40218 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
40219
40220 @item Return value:
40221 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
40222
40223 @item Errors:
40224
40225 @table @code
40226 @item EINVAL
40227 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
40228
40229 @item EFAULT
40230 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40231 @end table
40232
40233 @end table
40234
40235 @node isatty
40236 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
40237 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
40238
40239 @table @asis
40240 @item Synopsis:
40241 @smallexample
40242 int isatty(int fd);
40243 @end smallexample
40244
40245 @item Request:
40246 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
40247
40248 @item Return value:
40249 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
40250
40251 @item Errors:
40252
40253 @table @code
40254 @item EINTR
40255 The call was interrupted by the user.
40256 @end table
40257
40258 @end table
40259
40260 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
40261 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
40262 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
40263 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
40264 needed.
40265
40266
40267 @node system
40268 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
40269 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
40270
40271 @table @asis
40272 @item Synopsis:
40273 @smallexample
40274 int system(const char *command);
40275 @end smallexample
40276
40277 @item Request:
40278 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
40279
40280 @item Return value:
40281 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
40282 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
40283 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
40284 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
40285 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
40286 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
40287 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
40288
40289 @item Errors:
40290
40291 @table @code
40292 @item EINTR
40293 The call was interrupted by the user.
40294 @end table
40295
40296 @end table
40297
40298 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
40299 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
40300 the host is simplified before it's returned
40301 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
40302 is discarded, and the return value consists
40303 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
40304
40305 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
40306 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
40307 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
40308
40309 @table @code
40310 @item set remote system-call-allowed
40311 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
40312 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
40313 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
40314
40315 @item show remote system-call-allowed
40316 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
40317 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
40318 protocol.
40319 @end table
40320
40321 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40322 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40323 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40324
40325 @menu
40326 * Integral Datatypes::
40327 * Pointer Values::
40328 * Memory Transfer::
40329 * struct stat::
40330 * struct timeval::
40331 @end menu
40332
40333 @node Integral Datatypes
40334 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
40335 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40336
40337 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
40338 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
40339 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
40340
40341 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
40342 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
40343
40344 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40345
40346 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40347 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40348
40349 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40350
40351 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40352 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40353 byte order.
40354
40355 @node Pointer Values
40356 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40357 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40358
40359 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40360 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40361 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40362 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40363
40364 @smallexample
40365 @code{1aaf/12}
40366 @end smallexample
40367
40368 @noindent
40369 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40370 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40371 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40372 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40373
40374 @smallexample
40375 @code{123456/d}
40376 @end smallexample
40377
40378 @node Memory Transfer
40379 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40380 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40381
40382 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40383 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40384 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40385 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40386 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40387 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40388 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40389
40390
40391 @node struct stat
40392 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40393 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40394
40395 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40396 is defined as follows:
40397
40398 @smallexample
40399 struct stat @{
40400 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40401 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40402 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40403 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40404 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40405 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40406 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40407 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40408 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40409 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40410 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40411 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40412 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40413 @};
40414 @end smallexample
40415
40416 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40417 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40418 structure is of size 64 bytes.
40419
40420 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40421 range of values.
40422
40423 @table @code
40424
40425 @item st_dev
40426 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40427
40428 @item st_ino
40429 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40430
40431 @item st_mode
40432 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40433 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40434
40435 @item st_uid
40436 @itemx st_gid
40437 @itemx st_rdev
40438 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40439
40440 @item st_atime
40441 @itemx st_mtime
40442 @itemx st_ctime
40443 These values have a host and file system dependent
40444 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
40445 support exact timing values.
40446 @end table
40447
40448 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
40449 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
40450 continuing.
40451
40452 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
40453 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
40454 get truncated on the target.
40455
40456 @node struct timeval
40457 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
40458 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
40459
40460 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
40461 is defined as follows:
40462
40463 @smallexample
40464 struct timeval @{
40465 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
40466 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
40467 @};
40468 @end smallexample
40469
40470 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40471 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40472 structure is of size 8 bytes.
40473
40474 @node Constants
40475 @subsection Constants
40476 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
40477
40478 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
40479 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
40480 values before and after the call as needed.
40481
40482 @menu
40483 * Open Flags::
40484 * mode_t Values::
40485 * Errno Values::
40486 * Lseek Flags::
40487 * Limits::
40488 @end menu
40489
40490 @node Open Flags
40491 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40492 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40493
40494 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40495
40496 @smallexample
40497 O_RDONLY 0x0
40498 O_WRONLY 0x1
40499 O_RDWR 0x2
40500 O_APPEND 0x8
40501 O_CREAT 0x200
40502 O_TRUNC 0x400
40503 O_EXCL 0x800
40504 @end smallexample
40505
40506 @node mode_t Values
40507 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40508 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40509
40510 All values are given in octal representation.
40511
40512 @smallexample
40513 S_IFREG 0100000
40514 S_IFDIR 040000
40515 S_IRUSR 0400
40516 S_IWUSR 0200
40517 S_IXUSR 0100
40518 S_IRGRP 040
40519 S_IWGRP 020
40520 S_IXGRP 010
40521 S_IROTH 04
40522 S_IWOTH 02
40523 S_IXOTH 01
40524 @end smallexample
40525
40526 @node Errno Values
40527 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40528 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40529
40530 All values are given in decimal representation.
40531
40532 @smallexample
40533 EPERM 1
40534 ENOENT 2
40535 EINTR 4
40536 EBADF 9
40537 EACCES 13
40538 EFAULT 14
40539 EBUSY 16
40540 EEXIST 17
40541 ENODEV 19
40542 ENOTDIR 20
40543 EISDIR 21
40544 EINVAL 22
40545 ENFILE 23
40546 EMFILE 24
40547 EFBIG 27
40548 ENOSPC 28
40549 ESPIPE 29
40550 EROFS 30
40551 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40552 EUNKNOWN 9999
40553 @end smallexample
40554
40555 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40556 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40557
40558 @node Lseek Flags
40559 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40560 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40561
40562 @smallexample
40563 SEEK_SET 0
40564 SEEK_CUR 1
40565 SEEK_END 2
40566 @end smallexample
40567
40568 @node Limits
40569 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40570 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40571
40572 All values are given in decimal representation.
40573
40574 @smallexample
40575 INT_MIN -2147483648
40576 INT_MAX 2147483647
40577 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40578 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40579 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40580 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40581 @end smallexample
40582
40583 @node File-I/O Examples
40584 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40585 @cindex file-i/o examples
40586
40587 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40588 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40589
40590 @smallexample
40591 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40592 @emph{request memory read from target}
40593 -> @code{m1234,6}
40594 <- XXXXXX
40595 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40596 -> @code{F6}
40597 @end smallexample
40598
40599 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40600 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40601
40602 @smallexample
40603 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40604 @emph{request memory write to target}
40605 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40606 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40607 -> @code{F6}
40608 @end smallexample
40609
40610 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40611 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40612
40613 @smallexample
40614 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40615 -> @code{F-1,9}
40616 @end smallexample
40617
40618 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40619 host is called:
40620
40621 @smallexample
40622 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40623 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40624 <- @code{T02}
40625 @end smallexample
40626
40627 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40628 host is called:
40629
40630 @smallexample
40631 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40632 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40633 <- @code{T02}
40634 @end smallexample
40635
40636 @node Library List Format
40637 @section Library List Format
40638 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40639
40640 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40641 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40642 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40643 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40644 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40645 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40646 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40647 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40648 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40649 are loaded.
40650
40651 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40652 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40653 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40654 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40655
40656 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40657 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40658 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40659 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40660 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40661 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40662
40663 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40664 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40665
40666 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40667 offset, looks like this:
40668
40669 @smallexample
40670 <library-list>
40671 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40672 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40673 </library>
40674 </library-list>
40675 @end smallexample
40676
40677 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40678 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40679
40680 @smallexample
40681 <library-list>
40682 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40683 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40684 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40685 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40686 </library>
40687 </library-list>
40688 @end smallexample
40689
40690 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40691
40692 @smallexample
40693 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40694 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40695 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40696 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40697 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40698 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40699 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40700 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40701 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40702 @end smallexample
40703
40704 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40705 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40706 section for each library.
40707
40708 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40709 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40710 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40711
40712 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40713 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40714 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40715 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40716
40717 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40718 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40719 target, the following parameters are reported:
40720
40721 @itemize @minus
40722 @item
40723 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40724 @code{struct link_map}.
40725 @item
40726 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40727 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40728 @item
40729 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40730 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40731 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40732 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40733 @item
40734 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40735 @end itemize
40736
40737 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40738 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40739 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40740
40741 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40742 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40743
40744 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40745 looks like this:
40746
40747 @smallexample
40748 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40749 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40750 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40751 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40752 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40753 </library-list-svr>
40754 @end smallexample
40755
40756 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40757
40758 @smallexample
40759 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40760 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40761 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40762 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40763 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40764 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40765 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40766 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40767 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40768 @end smallexample
40769
40770 @node Memory Map Format
40771 @section Memory Map Format
40772 @cindex memory map format
40773
40774 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40775 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40776 memory map.
40777
40778 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40779 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40780 lists memory regions.
40781
40782 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40783 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40784
40785 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40786
40787 @smallexample
40788 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40789 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40790 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40791 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40792 <memory-map>
40793 region...
40794 </memory-map>
40795 @end smallexample
40796
40797 Each region can be either:
40798
40799 @itemize
40800
40801 @item
40802 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40803 bytes from there:
40804
40805 @smallexample
40806 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40807 @end smallexample
40808
40809
40810 @item
40811 A region of read-only memory:
40812
40813 @smallexample
40814 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40815 @end smallexample
40816
40817
40818 @item
40819 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40820 bytes in length:
40821
40822 @smallexample
40823 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40824 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40825 </memory>
40826 @end smallexample
40827
40828 @end itemize
40829
40830 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40831 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40832 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40833
40834 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40835
40836 @smallexample
40837 <!-- ................................................... -->
40838 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40839 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40840 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40841 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40842 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40843 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40844 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40845 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40846 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40847 and its type, or device. -->
40848 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40849 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40850 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40851 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40852 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40853 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40854 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40855 @end smallexample
40856
40857 @node Thread List Format
40858 @section Thread List Format
40859 @cindex thread list format
40860
40861 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40862 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40863 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40864 the following structure:
40865
40866 @smallexample
40867 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40868 <threads>
40869 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40870 ... description ...
40871 </thread>
40872 </threads>
40873 @end smallexample
40874
40875 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40876 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40877 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40878 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40879 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40880 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40881 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
40882 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
40883
40884
40885 @node Traceframe Info Format
40886 @section Traceframe Info Format
40887 @cindex traceframe info format
40888
40889 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40890 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40891 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40892 collected in a traceframe.
40893
40894 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40895 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40896
40897 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40898 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40899
40900 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40901
40902 @smallexample
40903 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40904 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40905 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40906 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40907 <traceframe-info>
40908 block...
40909 </traceframe-info>
40910 @end smallexample
40911
40912 Each traceframe block can be either:
40913
40914 @itemize
40915
40916 @item
40917 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40918 @var{length} bytes from there:
40919
40920 @smallexample
40921 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40922 @end smallexample
40923
40924 @item
40925 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40926 collected:
40927
40928 @smallexample
40929 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40930 @end smallexample
40931
40932 @end itemize
40933
40934 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40935
40936 @smallexample
40937 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40938 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40939
40940 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40941 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40942 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40943 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40944 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40945 @end smallexample
40946
40947 @node Branch Trace Format
40948 @section Branch Trace Format
40949 @cindex branch trace format
40950
40951 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40952 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40953 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40954 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40955
40956 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40957 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40958
40959 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40960 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40961
40962 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40963
40964 @smallexample
40965 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40966 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40967 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40968 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40969 <btrace>
40970 block...
40971 </btrace>
40972 @end smallexample
40973
40974 @itemize
40975
40976 @item
40977 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40978 and ending at @var{end}:
40979
40980 @smallexample
40981 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40982 @end smallexample
40983
40984 @end itemize
40985
40986 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40987
40988 @smallexample
40989 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40990 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40991
40992 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40993 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40994 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40995
40996 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40997
40998 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40999
41000 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
41001 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
41002 family CDATA #REQUIRED
41003 model CDATA #REQUIRED
41004 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
41005
41006 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
41007 @end smallexample
41008
41009 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
41010 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
41011 @cindex branch trace configuration format
41012
41013 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
41014 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41015 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
41016
41017 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41018 settings for that format. The following information is described:
41019
41020 @table @code
41021 @item bts
41022 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41023 @table @code
41024 @item size
41025 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41026 @end table
41027 @item pt
41028 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41029 PT}) format.
41030 @table @code
41031 @item size
41032 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41033 @end table
41034 @end table
41035
41036 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41037 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41038
41039 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41040
41041 @smallexample
41042 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
41043 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41044
41045 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
41046 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41047
41048 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
41049 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41050 @end smallexample
41051
41052 @include agentexpr.texi
41053
41054 @node Target Descriptions
41055 @appendix Target Descriptions
41056 @cindex target descriptions
41057
41058 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41059 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41060 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41061 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41062 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41063 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41064 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41065
41066 @itemize @bullet
41067 @item
41068 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41069 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41070 @item
41071 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41072 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41073 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41074 @item
41075 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41076 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
41077 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
41078 @end itemize
41079
41080 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
41081 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
41082 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
41083 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
41084 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
41085
41086 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41087 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
41088
41089 @menu
41090 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
41091 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
41092 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
41093 descriptions.
41094 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
41095 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41096 @end menu
41097
41098 @node Retrieving Descriptions
41099 @section Retrieving Descriptions
41100
41101 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41102 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41103 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41104 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41105 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41106 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41107 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41108 Format}.
41109
41110 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41111 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41112 specify a file are:
41113
41114 @table @code
41115 @cindex set tdesc filename
41116 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41117 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41118
41119 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41120 @item unset tdesc filename
41121 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41122 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41123
41124 @cindex show tdesc filename
41125 @item show tdesc filename
41126 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41127 @end table
41128
41129
41130 @node Target Description Format
41131 @section Target Description Format
41132 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41133
41134 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41135 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41136 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41137 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41138 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41139 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41140 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41141
41142 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41143 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41144 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41145 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41146 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41147
41148 Here is a simple target description:
41149
41150 @smallexample
41151 <target version="1.0">
41152 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41153 </target>
41154 @end smallexample
41155
41156 @noindent
41157 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41158 the x86-64 architecture.
41159
41160 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41161 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41162 are explained further below.
41163
41164 @smallexample
41165 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41166 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41167 <target version="1.0">
41168 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41169 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41170 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41171 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41172 </target>
41173 @end smallexample
41174
41175 @noindent
41176 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41177 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41178 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41179 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41180 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41181 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41182 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41183 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41184 the version mismatch.
41185
41186 @subsection Inclusion
41187 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41188 @cindex XInclude
41189 @ifnotinfo
41190 @cindex <xi:include>
41191 @end ifnotinfo
41192
41193 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41194 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41195 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41196 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41197 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41198
41199 @smallexample
41200 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41201 @end smallexample
41202
41203 @noindent
41204 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41205 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41206 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41207 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41208 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41209 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41210 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41211 original description.
41212
41213 @subsection Architecture
41214 @cindex <architecture>
41215
41216 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41217
41218 @smallexample
41219 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41220 @end smallexample
41221
41222 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41223 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41224
41225 @subsection OS ABI
41226 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
41227
41228 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41229 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41230
41231 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41232
41233 @smallexample
41234 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41235 @end smallexample
41236
41237 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41238 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41239
41240 @subsection Compatible Architecture
41241 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
41242
41243 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41244 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41245
41246 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
41247
41248 @smallexample
41249 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
41250 @end smallexample
41251
41252 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41253 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41254
41255 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
41256 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
41257 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
41258 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
41259 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
41260 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
41261 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
41262
41263 @smallexample
41264 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
41265 <compatible>spu</compatible>
41266 @end smallexample
41267
41268 @subsection Features
41269 @cindex <feature>
41270
41271 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
41272 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
41273 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
41274 has this form:
41275
41276 @smallexample
41277 <feature name="@var{name}">
41278 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
41279 @var{reg}@dots{}
41280 </feature>
41281 @end smallexample
41282
41283 @noindent
41284 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
41285 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
41286 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
41287 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
41288
41289 @subsection Types
41290
41291 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
41292 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
41293 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
41294 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
41295 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
41296 and enum types.
41297
41298 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
41299 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
41300 Types must be defined before they are used.
41301
41302 @cindex <vector>
41303 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
41304 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
41305 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
41306 @var{count}:
41307
41308 @smallexample
41309 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
41310 @end smallexample
41311
41312 @cindex <union>
41313 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
41314 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
41315 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
41316 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
41317
41318 @smallexample
41319 <union id="@var{id}">
41320 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41321 @dots{}
41322 </union>
41323 @end smallexample
41324
41325 @cindex <struct>
41326 @cindex <flags>
41327 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
41328 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
41329 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
41330 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
41331 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
41332 specified.
41333
41334 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
41335
41336 @smallexample
41337 <struct id="@var{id}">
41338 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41339 @dots{}
41340 </struct>
41341 @end smallexample
41342
41343 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
41344 No implicit padding is added.
41345
41346 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41347
41348 @smallexample
41349 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41350 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41351 @dots{}
41352 </struct>
41353 @end smallexample
41354
41355 @smallexample
41356 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41357 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41358 @dots{}
41359 </flags>
41360 @end smallexample
41361
41362 The @var{name} value is required.
41363 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41364 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41365 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41366
41367 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41368 is optional.
41369 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41370 and zero represents the least significant bit.
41371
41372 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41373 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41374
41375 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41376
41377 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41378 defining them with @samp{struct}:
41379
41380 @itemize @bullet
41381 @item
41382 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41383 @item
41384 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41385 @end itemize
41386
41387 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41388 defining them with @samp{flags}:
41389
41390 @itemize @bullet
41391 @item
41392 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41393
41394 @smallexample
41395 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41396 $1 = 42
41397 @end smallexample
41398
41399 @end itemize
41400
41401 @subsection Registers
41402 @cindex <reg>
41403
41404 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41405
41406 @smallexample
41407 <reg name="@var{name}"
41408 bitsize="@var{size}"
41409 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41410 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41411 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41412 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41413 @end smallexample
41414
41415 @noindent
41416 The components are as follows:
41417
41418 @table @var
41419
41420 @item name
41421 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41422
41423 @item bitsize
41424 The register's size, in bits.
41425
41426 @item regnum
41427 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41428 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41429 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41430 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41431 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41432 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41433 in order of increasing register number.
41434
41435 @item save-restore
41436 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41437 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41438 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41439 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41440 ABI.
41441
41442 @item type
41443 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41444 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41445 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
41446 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
41447 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
41448 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
41449
41450 @item group
41451 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
41452 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
41453 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
41454 in @code{info registers}.
41455
41456 @end table
41457
41458 @node Predefined Target Types
41459 @section Predefined Target Types
41460 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
41461
41462 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
41463 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
41464 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
41465 types. The currently supported types are:
41466
41467 @table @code
41468
41469 @item bool
41470 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
41471
41472 @item int8
41473 @itemx int16
41474 @itemx int32
41475 @itemx int64
41476 @itemx int128
41477 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41478
41479 @item uint8
41480 @itemx uint16
41481 @itemx uint32
41482 @itemx uint64
41483 @itemx uint128
41484 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41485
41486 @item code_ptr
41487 @itemx data_ptr
41488 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41489 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41490 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41491 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41492 may be marked as data pointers.
41493
41494 @item ieee_single
41495 Single precision IEEE floating point.
41496
41497 @item ieee_double
41498 Double precision IEEE floating point.
41499
41500 @item arm_fpa_ext
41501 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41502
41503 @item i387_ext
41504 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41505
41506 @item i386_eflags
41507 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41508
41509 @item i386_mxcsr
41510 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41511
41512 @end table
41513
41514 @node Enum Target Types
41515 @section Enum Target Types
41516 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
41517
41518 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41519 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41520
41521 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41522
41523 @smallexample
41524 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41525 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41526 @dots{}
41527 </enum>
41528 @end smallexample
41529
41530 Enums must be defined before they are used.
41531
41532 @smallexample
41533 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41534 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41535 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41536 </enum>
41537 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41538 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41539 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41540 </flags>
41541 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41542 @end smallexample
41543
41544 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41545 would be printed as:
41546
41547 @smallexample
41548 (gdb) info register flags
41549 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41550 @end smallexample
41551
41552 @node Standard Target Features
41553 @section Standard Target Features
41554 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
41555
41556 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41557 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41558 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41559 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41560 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41561 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41562 can recognize them.
41563
41564 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41565 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41566 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41567 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41568 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41569 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41570 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41571 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41572
41573 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41574 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41575 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41576
41577 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41578 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41579 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41580 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41581
41582 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41583 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41584 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41585
41586 @menu
41587 * AArch64 Features::
41588 * ARC Features::
41589 * ARM Features::
41590 * i386 Features::
41591 * MicroBlaze Features::
41592 * MIPS Features::
41593 * M68K Features::
41594 * NDS32 Features::
41595 * Nios II Features::
41596 * PowerPC Features::
41597 * S/390 and System z Features::
41598 * Sparc Features::
41599 * TIC6x Features::
41600 @end menu
41601
41602
41603 @node AArch64 Features
41604 @subsection AArch64 Features
41605 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41606
41607 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41608 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41609 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41610
41611 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41612 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41613 and @samp{fpcr}.
41614
41615 @node ARC Features
41616 @subsection ARC Features
41617 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41618
41619 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41620 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41621 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41622 that one of the core registers features is present.
41623 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41624
41625 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41626 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41627 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41628 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41629 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41630 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41631 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41632
41633 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41634 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41635 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41636 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41637 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41638 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41639
41640 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41641 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41642 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41643 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41644 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41645 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41646 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41647 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41648 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41649 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41650
41651 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41652 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41653
41654 @node ARM Features
41655 @subsection ARM Features
41656 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41657
41658 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41659 ARM targets.
41660 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41661 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41662
41663 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41664 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41665 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41666 and @samp{xpsr}.
41667
41668 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41669 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41670
41671 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41672 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41673 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41674 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41675
41676 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41677 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41678 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41679 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41680 halves of the double-precision registers.
41681
41682 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41683 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41684 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41685 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41686 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41687 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41688
41689 @node i386 Features
41690 @subsection i386 Features
41691 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41692
41693 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41694 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41695
41696 @itemize @minus
41697 @item
41698 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41699 @item
41700 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41701 @item
41702 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41703 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41704 @item
41705 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41706 @item
41707 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41708 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41709 @end itemize
41710
41711 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41712
41713 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41714 describe registers:
41715
41716 @itemize @minus
41717 @item
41718 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41719 @item
41720 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41721 @item
41722 @samp{mxcsr}
41723 @end itemize
41724
41725 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41726 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41727 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41728
41729 @itemize @minus
41730 @item
41731 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41732 @item
41733 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41734 @end itemize
41735
41736 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41737 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41738
41739 @itemize @minus
41740 @item
41741 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41742 @item
41743 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41744 @end itemize
41745
41746 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41747 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41748
41749 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41750 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41751
41752 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41753 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41754 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41755
41756 @itemize @minus
41757 @item
41758 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41759 @end itemize
41760
41761 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41762
41763 @itemize @minus
41764 @item
41765 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41766 @end itemize
41767
41768 It should
41769 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41770
41771 @itemize @minus
41772 @item
41773 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41774 @item
41775 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41776 @end itemize
41777
41778 It should
41779 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41780
41781 @itemize @minus
41782 @item
41783 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41784 @end itemize
41785
41786 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41787 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41788 valid for i386 and amd64.
41789
41790 @node MicroBlaze Features
41791 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41792 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41793
41794 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41795 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41796 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41797 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41798 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41799
41800 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41801 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41802
41803 @node MIPS Features
41804 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41805 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41806
41807 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41808 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41809 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41810 on the target.
41811
41812 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41813 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41814 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41815
41816 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41817 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41818 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41819 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41820
41821 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41822 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41823 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41824 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41825
41826 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41827 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41828 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41829
41830 @node M68K Features
41831 @subsection M68K Features
41832 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41833
41834 @table @code
41835 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41836 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41837 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41838 One of those features must be always present.
41839 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41840 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41841 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41842 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41843
41844 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41845 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41846 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41847 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41848 @end table
41849
41850 @node NDS32 Features
41851 @subsection NDS32 Features
41852 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41853
41854 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41855 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41856 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41857 and @samp{pc}.
41858
41859 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41860 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41861 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41862 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41863
41864 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41865 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41866 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41867 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41868 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41869 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41870 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41871
41872 @node Nios II Features
41873 @subsection Nios II Features
41874 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41875
41876 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41877 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41878 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41879 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41880 @samp{mpuacc}).
41881
41882 @node PowerPC Features
41883 @subsection PowerPC Features
41884 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41885
41886 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41887 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41888 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41889 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41890
41891 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41892 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41893
41894 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41895 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41896 and @samp{vrsave}.
41897
41898 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41899 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41900 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41901 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41902 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41903 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41904
41905 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41906 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41907 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41908 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41909 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41910 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41911 user.
41912
41913 @node S/390 and System z Features
41914 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41915 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41916 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41917
41918 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41919 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41920 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41921 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41922 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41923 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41924 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41925 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41926 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41927
41928 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41929 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41930 @samp{fpc}.
41931
41932 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41933 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41934
41935 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41936 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41937 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41938 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41939 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41940 32-bit wide.
41941
41942 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41943 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41944 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41945
41946 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41947 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41948 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41949 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41950 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41951 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41952 @samp{v31}.
41953
41954 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
41955 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
41956 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
41957
41958 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
41959 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
41960 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
41961
41962 @node Sparc Features
41963 @subsection Sparc Features
41964 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
41965 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
41966 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41967 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41968
41969 @itemize @minus
41970 @item
41971 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
41972 @item
41973 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
41974 @item
41975 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
41976 @item
41977 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
41978 @end itemize
41979
41980 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41981
41982 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41983 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41984
41985 @itemize @minus
41986 @item
41987 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
41988 @item
41989 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
41990 @end itemize
41991
41992 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41993 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41994
41995 @itemize @minus
41996 @item
41997 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
41998 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
41999 @item
42000 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
42001 for sparc64
42002 @end itemize
42003
42004 @node TIC6x Features
42005 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42006 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42007 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42008 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42009 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42010 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42011
42012 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42013 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42014 through @samp{B31}.
42015
42016 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42017 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42018
42019 @node Operating System Information
42020 @appendix Operating System Information
42021 @cindex operating system information
42022
42023 @menu
42024 * Process list::
42025 @end menu
42026
42027 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42028 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42029 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42030 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42031 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42032 on a different aspect of target.
42033
42034 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42035 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42036 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42037 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42038
42039 @node Process list
42040 @appendixsection Process list
42041 @cindex operating system information, process list
42042
42043 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42044 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42045 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42046 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42047
42048 An example document is:
42049
42050 @smallexample
42051 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42052 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42053 <osdata type="processes">
42054 <item>
42055 <column name="pid">1</column>
42056 <column name="user">root</column>
42057 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
42058 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
42059 </item>
42060 </osdata>
42061 @end smallexample
42062
42063 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
42064 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
42065 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
42066 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
42067 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
42068 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
42069 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
42070
42071 @node Trace File Format
42072 @appendix Trace File Format
42073 @cindex trace file format
42074
42075 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
42076 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
42077
42078 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
42079 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
42080 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
42081 in the future.
42082
42083 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
42084 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
42085 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
42086 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
42087 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
42088 of this section.
42089
42090 @table @code
42091 @item R @var{size}
42092 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
42093 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
42094 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
42095 a single trace file.
42096
42097 @item status @var{status}
42098 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
42099 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
42100 file.
42101
42102 @item tp @var{payload}
42103 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42104 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
42105 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42106 reply packets.
42107
42108 @item tsv @var{payload}
42109 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42110 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
42111 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42112 reply packets.
42113
42114 @item tdesc @var{payload}
42115 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42116 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42117 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42118 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42119 file. Includes are not allowed.
42120
42121 @end table
42122
42123 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42124 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42125 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42126 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42127 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42128 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42129 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42130 endianness.
42131
42132 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42133
42134 @table @code
42135 @item R @var{bytes}
42136 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42137 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42138 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42139
42140 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42141 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42142 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42143 @var{length} bytes.
42144
42145 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42146 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42147 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42148
42149 @end table
42150
42151 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42152 of blocks.
42153
42154 @node Index Section Format
42155 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42156 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42157 @cindex index section format
42158
42159 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42160 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42161 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42162 description.
42163
42164 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42165 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42166 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42167 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42168 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42169 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42170
42171 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42172
42173 @enumerate
42174 @item
42175 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42176 unless otherwise noted:
42177
42178 @enumerate
42179 @item
42180 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42181 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42182 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42183 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42184 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42185 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42186 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42187
42188 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42189 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42190 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42191 currently not flagged as deprecated.
42192
42193 @item
42194 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42195
42196 @item
42197 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42198 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42199 to the next offset.
42200
42201 @item
42202 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42203
42204 @item
42205 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42206
42207 @item
42208 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42209 @end enumerate
42210
42211 @item
42212 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42213 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42214 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42215 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42216 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
42217 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42218 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42219 CU indices.
42220
42221 @item
42222 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42223 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42224 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42225 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42226
42227 @item
42228 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42229 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42230
42231 @enumerate
42232 @item
42233 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42234
42235 @item
42236 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42237 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42238
42239 @item
42240 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42241 @end enumerate
42242
42243 @item
42244 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42245 the hash table is always a power of 2.
42246
42247 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42248 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42249 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42250 constant pool.
42251
42252 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42253 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42254 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42255
42256 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42257 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42258 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42259 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42260 index version:
42261
42262 @table @asis
42263 @item Version 4
42264 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42265
42266 @item Versions 5 to 7
42267 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42268 @end table
42269
42270 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42271
42272 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42273 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42274 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42275 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42276 collision.
42277
42278 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42279 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42280 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42281 the code.
42282
42283 @item
42284 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42285 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42286 strings.
42287
42288 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42289 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42290 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42291 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42292 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42293 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42294
42295 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42296 @end enumerate
42297
42298 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42299 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42300 CU index+attributes value for each use.
42301
42302 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42303 (bit 0 = LSB):
42304
42305 @table @asis
42306
42307 @item Bits 0-23
42308 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42309 @item Bits 24-27
42310 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42311 @item Bits 28-30
42312 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42313
42314 @table @asis
42315 @item 0
42316 This value is reserved and should not be used.
42317 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42318 with previous versions of the index.
42319 @item 1
42320 The symbol is a type.
42321 @item 2
42322 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42323 @item 3
42324 The symbol is a function.
42325 @item 4
42326 Any other kind of symbol.
42327 @item 5,6,7
42328 These values are reserved.
42329 @end table
42330
42331 @item Bit 31
42332 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42333
42334 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42335 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42336 @value{GDBN} sources.
42337
42338 @end table
42339
42340 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42341 global/static attributes in the index.
42342
42343 @smallexample
42344 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42345 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42346 switch (die->tag)
42347 @{
42348 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42349 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42350 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42351 kind = TYPE;
42352 is_static = 1;
42353 break;
42354 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42355 kind = VARIABLE;
42356 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42357 break;
42358 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42359 kind = FUNCTION;
42360 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42361 break;
42362 case DW_TAG_constant:
42363 kind = VARIABLE;
42364 is_static = ! is_external;
42365 break;
42366 case DW_TAG_variable:
42367 kind = VARIABLE;
42368 is_static = ! is_external;
42369 break;
42370 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42371 kind = TYPE;
42372 is_static = 0;
42373 break;
42374 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42375 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42376 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42377 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42378 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42379 kind = TYPE;
42380 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42381 break;
42382 default:
42383 assert (0);
42384 @}
42385 @end smallexample
42386
42387 @node Man Pages
42388 @appendix Manual pages
42389 @cindex Man pages
42390
42391 @menu
42392 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42393 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42394 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42395 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42396 @end menu
42397
42398 @node gdb man
42399 @heading gdb man
42400
42401 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42402
42403 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42404 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42405 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42406 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42407 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42408 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42409 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42410 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42411 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42412 @c man end
42413
42414 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42415 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42416 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42417 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42418
42419 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42420 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42421
42422 @itemize @bullet
42423 @item
42424 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42425
42426 @item
42427 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42428
42429 @item
42430 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42431
42432 @item
42433 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42434 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42435 @end itemize
42436
42437 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42438 Modula-2.
42439
42440 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42441 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42442 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42443 by using the command @code{help}.
42444
42445 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42446 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42447 executable program as the argument:
42448
42449 @smallexample
42450 gdb program
42451 @end smallexample
42452
42453 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42454
42455 @smallexample
42456 gdb program core
42457 @end smallexample
42458
42459 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42460 to debug a running process:
42461
42462 @smallexample
42463 gdb program 1234
42464 gdb -p 1234
42465 @end smallexample
42466
42467 @noindent
42468 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42469 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42470 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42471
42472 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42473
42474 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42475 @table @env
42476 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42477 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42478
42479 @item run [@var{arglist}]
42480 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42481
42482 @item bt
42483 Backtrace: display the program stack.
42484
42485 @item print @var{expr}
42486 Display the value of an expression.
42487
42488 @item c
42489 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42490
42491 @item next
42492 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42493 function calls in the line.
42494
42495 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42496 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42497
42498 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42499 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42500
42501 @item step
42502 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42503 function calls in the line.
42504
42505 @item help [@var{name}]
42506 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42507 about using @value{GDBN}.
42508
42509 @item quit
42510 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42511 @end table
42512
42513 @ifset man
42514 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42515 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42516 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42517 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42518 @end ifset
42519 @c man end
42520
42521 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42522 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42523 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42524 encountered with no
42525 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42526 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42527 Many options have
42528 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42529 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42530 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42531 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42532 more usual convention.)
42533
42534 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42535 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42536 option is used.
42537
42538 @table @env
42539 @item -help
42540 @itemx -h
42541 List all options, with brief explanations.
42542
42543 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42544 @itemx -s @var{file}
42545 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42546
42547 @item -write
42548 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42549
42550 @item -exec=@var{file}
42551 @itemx -e @var{file}
42552 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42553 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42554 dump.
42555
42556 @item -se=@var{file}
42557 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42558 file.
42559
42560 @item -core=@var{file}
42561 @itemx -c @var{file}
42562 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42563
42564 @item -command=@var{file}
42565 @itemx -x @var{file}
42566 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42567
42568 @item -ex @var{command}
42569 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42570
42571 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42572 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42573 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42574
42575 @item -nh
42576 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42577
42578 @item -nx
42579 @itemx -n
42580 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42581
42582 @item -quiet
42583 @itemx -q
42584 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42585 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42586
42587 @item -batch
42588 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42589 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42590 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42591 commands in the command files.
42592
42593 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42594 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42595 more useful, the message
42596
42597 @smallexample
42598 Program exited normally.
42599 @end smallexample
42600
42601 @noindent
42602 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42603 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42604
42605 @item -cd=@var{directory}
42606 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42607 instead of the current directory.
42608
42609 @item -fullname
42610 @itemx -f
42611 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42612 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42613 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42614 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42615 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42616 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42617 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42618 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42619
42620 @item -b @var{bps}
42621 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42622 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42623
42624 @item -tty=@var{device}
42625 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42626 @end table
42627 @c man end
42628
42629 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42630 @ifset man
42631 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42632 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42633 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42634
42635 @smallexample
42636 info gdb
42637 @end smallexample
42638
42639 @noindent
42640 should give you access to the complete manual.
42641
42642 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42643 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42644 @end ifset
42645 @c man end
42646
42647 @node gdbserver man
42648 @heading gdbserver man
42649
42650 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42651 @format
42652 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42653 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42654
42655 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42656
42657 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42658 @c man end
42659 @end format
42660
42661 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42662 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42663 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42664
42665 @ifclear man
42666 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42667 @end ifclear
42668 @ifset man
42669 Usage (server (target) side):
42670 @end ifset
42671
42672 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42673 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42674 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42675 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42676
42677 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42678 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42679 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42680
42681 @smallexample
42682 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42683 @end smallexample
42684
42685 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42686
42687 @smallexample
42688 @ifset man
42689 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42690 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42691 @end ifset
42692 @ifclear man
42693 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42694 @end ifclear
42695 @end smallexample
42696
42697 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42698 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42699 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42700
42701 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42702
42703 @smallexample
42704 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42705 @end smallexample
42706
42707 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42708 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42709 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42710 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42711 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42712 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42713 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42714 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42715 print an error message and exit.
42716
42717 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42718 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42719
42720 @smallexample
42721 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42722 @end smallexample
42723
42724 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42725 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42726
42727 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42728 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42729 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42730 the program you want to debug.
42731
42732 @smallexample
42733 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42734 @end smallexample
42735
42736 @ifclear man
42737 @subheading Usage (host side)
42738 @end ifclear
42739 @ifset man
42740 Usage (host side):
42741 @end ifset
42742
42743 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42744 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42745 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42746 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42747 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42748 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42749 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42750 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42751 descriptor. For example:
42752
42753 @smallexample
42754 @ifset man
42755 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42756 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42757 @end ifset
42758 @ifclear man
42759 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42760 @end ifclear
42761 @end smallexample
42762
42763 @noindent
42764 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42765
42766 @smallexample
42767 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42768 @end smallexample
42769
42770 @noindent
42771 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42772 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42773 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42774 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42775 `Connection refused'.
42776
42777 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42778 described in
42779 @ifset man
42780 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42781 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42782 @end ifset
42783 @ifclear man
42784 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42785 @end ifclear
42786 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42787
42788 @smallexample
42789 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42790 @end smallexample
42791
42792 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42793 case.
42794 @c man end
42795
42796 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42797 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42798
42799 @itemize @bullet
42800
42801 @item
42802 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42803
42804 @smallexample
42805 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42806 @end smallexample
42807
42808 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42809 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42810 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42811 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42812 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42813 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42814 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42815
42816 @item
42817 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42818 program:
42819
42820 @smallexample
42821 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42822 @end smallexample
42823
42824 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42825 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42826 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42827 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42828
42829 @item
42830 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42831
42832 @smallexample
42833 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42834 @end smallexample
42835
42836 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42837 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42838 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42839 debug several processes in the same session.
42840 @end itemize
42841
42842 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42843
42844 @table @env
42845
42846 @item --help
42847 List all options, with brief explanations.
42848
42849 @item --version
42850 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42851
42852 @item --attach
42853 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42854
42855 @smallexample
42856 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42857 @end smallexample
42858
42859 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42860 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42861
42862 @item --multi
42863 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42864 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42865 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42866 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42867
42868 @smallexample
42869 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42870 @end smallexample
42871
42872 @item --debug
42873 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42874 process.
42875 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42876 the developers.
42877
42878 @item --remote-debug
42879 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42880 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42881 the developers.
42882
42883 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42884 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42885 of debugging output.
42886 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42887
42888 @item --wrapper
42889 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42890 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42891 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42892 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42893
42894 @item --once
42895 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42896 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42897 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42898 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42899
42900 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42901
42902 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42903 @c QDisableRandomization.
42904
42905 @end table
42906 @c man end
42907
42908 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42909 @ifset man
42910 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42911 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42912 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42913
42914 @smallexample
42915 info gdb
42916 @end smallexample
42917
42918 should give you access to the complete manual.
42919
42920 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42921 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42922 @end ifset
42923 @c man end
42924
42925 @node gcore man
42926 @heading gcore
42927
42928 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42929
42930 @format
42931 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42932 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42933 @c man end
42934 @end format
42935
42936 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42937 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42938 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42939 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42940 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42941 running without any change.
42942 @c man end
42943
42944 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42945 @table @env
42946 @item -o @var{filename}
42947 The optional argument
42948 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42949 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42950 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42951 @end table
42952 @c man end
42953
42954 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42955 @ifset man
42956 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42957 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42958 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42959
42960 @smallexample
42961 info gdb
42962 @end smallexample
42963
42964 @noindent
42965 should give you access to the complete manual.
42966
42967 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42968 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42969 @end ifset
42970 @c man end
42971
42972 @node gdbinit man
42973 @heading gdbinit
42974
42975 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42976
42977 @format
42978 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42979 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42980 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42981 @end ifset
42982
42983 ~/.gdbinit
42984
42985 ./.gdbinit
42986 @c man end
42987 @end format
42988
42989 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42990 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42991 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42992 described in
42993 @ifset man
42994 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42995 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42996 @end ifset
42997 @ifclear man
42998 @ref{Sequences}.
42999 @end ifclear
43000
43001 Please read more in
43002 @ifset man
43003 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43004 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43005 @end ifset
43006 @ifclear man
43007 @ref{Startup}.
43008 @end ifclear
43009
43010 @table @env
43011 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43012 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43013 @end ifset
43014 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43015 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
43016 @end ifclear
43017 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43018 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43019 See more in
43020 @ifset man
43021 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43022 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43023 @end ifset
43024 @ifclear man
43025 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
43026 @end ifclear
43027
43028 @item ~/.gdbinit
43029 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43030 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43031
43032 @item ./.gdbinit
43033 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43034 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43035 See more in
43036 @ifset man
43037 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43038 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43039 @end ifset
43040 @ifclear man
43041 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43042 @end ifclear
43043 @end table
43044 @c man end
43045
43046 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
43047 @ifset man
43048 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
43049
43050 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43051 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43052 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43053
43054 @smallexample
43055 info gdb
43056 @end smallexample
43057
43058 should give you access to the complete manual.
43059
43060 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43061 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43062 @end ifset
43063 @c man end
43064
43065 @include gpl.texi
43066
43067 @node GNU Free Documentation License
43068 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
43069 @include fdl.texi
43070
43071 @node Concept Index
43072 @unnumbered Concept Index
43073
43074 @printindex cp
43075
43076 @node Command and Variable Index
43077 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
43078
43079 @printindex fn
43080
43081 @tex
43082 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
43083 % meantime:
43084 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
43085 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
43086 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
43087 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
43088 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
43089 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
43090 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
43091 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
43092 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
43093 \page\colophon
43094 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
43095 @end tex
43096
43097 @bye